diff options
author | Richard Purdie <richard.purdie@linuxfoundation.org> | 2020-09-14 22:48:44 +0200 |
---|---|---|
committer | Richard Purdie <richard.purdie@linuxfoundation.org> | 2020-09-17 10:09:35 +0100 |
commit | 292598164a304a3da3288e6fb8963f13045d1e7f (patch) | |
tree | efedbbdc16cb2e0978a4d40e6a6294e32b0e496f /documentation/ref-manual/ref-variables.rst | |
parent | d313d972bf592de77f2af13cb3fc4226247cb1a1 (diff) | |
download | poky-292598164a304a3da3288e6fb8963f13045d1e7f.tar.gz |
sphinx: ref-manual links fixes and many other cleanups to import
(From yocto-docs rev: d079e418d5a81610e1f06a7a6ca45dd040c1402e)
Signed-off-by: Richard Purdie <richard.purdie@linuxfoundation.org>
Diffstat (limited to 'documentation/ref-manual/ref-variables.rst')
-rw-r--r-- | documentation/ref-manual/ref-variables.rst | 5621 |
1 files changed, 3292 insertions, 2329 deletions
diff --git a/documentation/ref-manual/ref-variables.rst b/documentation/ref-manual/ref-variables.rst index 54a892576b..625a37c158 100644 --- a/documentation/ref-manual/ref-variables.rst +++ b/documentation/ref-manual/ref-variables.rst | |||
@@ -21,74 +21,86 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
21 | ABIEXTENSION | 21 | ABIEXTENSION |
22 | Extension to the Application Binary Interface (ABI) field of the GNU | 22 | Extension to the Application Binary Interface (ABI) field of the GNU |
23 | canonical architecture name (e.g. "eabi"). | 23 | canonical architecture name (e.g. "eabi"). |
24 | 24 | ||
25 | ABI extensions are set in the machine include files. For example, the | 25 | ABI extensions are set in the machine include files. For example, the |
26 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/arm/arch-arm.inc`` file sets the | 26 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/arm/arch-arm.inc`` file sets the |
27 | following extension: ABIEXTENSION = "eabi" | 27 | following extension: |
28 | 28 | :: | |
29 | |||
30 | ABIEXTENSION = "eabi" | ||
31 | |||
29 | ALLOW_EMPTY | 32 | ALLOW_EMPTY |
30 | Specifies whether to produce an output package even if it is empty. | 33 | Specifies whether to produce an output package even if it is empty. |
31 | By default, BitBake does not produce empty packages. This default | 34 | By default, BitBake does not produce empty packages. This default |
32 | behavior can cause issues when there is an | 35 | behavior can cause issues when there is an |
33 | :term:`RDEPENDS` or some other hard runtime | 36 | :term:`RDEPENDS` or some other hard runtime |
34 | requirement on the existence of the package. | 37 | requirement on the existence of the package. |
35 | 38 | ||
36 | Like all package-controlling variables, you must always use them in | 39 | Like all package-controlling variables, you must always use them in |
37 | conjunction with a package name override, as in: ALLOW_EMPTY_${PN} = | 40 | conjunction with a package name override, as in: |
38 | "1" ALLOW_EMPTY_${PN}-dev = "1" ALLOW_EMPTY_${PN}-staticdev = "1" | 41 | :: |
39 | 42 | ||
43 | ALLOW_EMPTY_${PN} = "1" | ||
44 | ALLOW_EMPTY_${PN}-dev = "1" | ||
45 | ALLOW_EMPTY_${PN}-staticdev = "1" | ||
46 | |||
40 | ALTERNATIVE | 47 | ALTERNATIVE |
41 | Lists commands in a package that need an alternative binary naming | 48 | Lists commands in a package that need an alternative binary naming |
42 | scheme. Sometimes the same command is provided in multiple packages. | 49 | scheme. Sometimes the same command is provided in multiple packages. |
43 | When this occurs, the OpenEmbedded build system needs to use the | 50 | When this occurs, the OpenEmbedded build system needs to use the |
44 | alternatives system to create a different binary naming scheme so the | 51 | alternatives system to create a different binary naming scheme so the |
45 | commands can co-exist. | 52 | commands can co-exist. |
46 | 53 | ||
47 | To use the variable, list out the package's commands that also exist | 54 | To use the variable, list out the package's commands that also exist |
48 | as part of another package. For example, if the ``busybox`` package | 55 | as part of another package. For example, if the ``busybox`` package |
49 | has four commands that also exist as part of another package, you | 56 | has four commands that also exist as part of another package, you |
50 | identify them as follows: ALTERNATIVE_busybox = "sh sed test bracket" | 57 | identify them as follows: |
58 | :: | ||
59 | |||
60 | ALTERNATIVE_busybox = "sh sed test bracket" | ||
61 | |||
51 | For more information on the alternatives system, see the | 62 | For more information on the alternatives system, see the |
52 | ":ref:`update-alternatives.bbclass <ref-classes-update-alternatives>`" | 63 | ":ref:`update-alternatives.bbclass <ref-classes-update-alternatives>`" |
53 | section. | 64 | section. |
54 | 65 | ||
55 | ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME | 66 | ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME |
56 | Used by the alternatives system to map duplicated commands to actual | 67 | Used by the alternatives system to map duplicated commands to actual |
57 | locations. For example, if the ``bracket`` command provided by the | 68 | locations. For example, if the ``bracket`` command provided by the |
58 | ``busybox`` package is duplicated through another package, you must | 69 | ``busybox`` package is duplicated through another package, you must |
59 | use the ``ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME`` variable to specify the actual | 70 | use the ``ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME`` variable to specify the actual |
60 | location: ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME[bracket] = "/usr/bin/[" | 71 | location: |
61 | 72 | :: | |
73 | |||
74 | ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME[bracket] = "/usr/bin/[" | ||
75 | |||
62 | In this example, the binary for the ``bracket`` command (i.e. ``[``) | 76 | In this example, the binary for the ``bracket`` command (i.e. ``[``) |
63 | from the ``busybox`` package resides in ``/usr/bin/``. | 77 | from the ``busybox`` package resides in ``/usr/bin/``. |
64 | 78 | ||
65 | .. note:: | 79 | .. note:: |
66 | 80 | ||
67 | If | 81 | If ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME is not defined, it defaults to ${bindir}/ name. |
68 | ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME | 82 | |
69 | is not defined, it defaults to | ||
70 | ${bindir}/ | ||
71 | name | ||
72 | . | ||
73 | |||
74 | For more information on the alternatives system, see the | 83 | For more information on the alternatives system, see the |
75 | ":ref:`update-alternatives.bbclass <ref-classes-update-alternatives>`" | 84 | ":ref:`update-alternatives.bbclass <ref-classes-update-alternatives>`" |
76 | section. | 85 | section. |
77 | 86 | ||
78 | ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY | 87 | ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY |
79 | Used by the alternatives system to create default priorities for | 88 | Used by the alternatives system to create default priorities for |
80 | duplicated commands. You can use the variable to create a single | 89 | duplicated commands. You can use the variable to create a single |
81 | default regardless of the command name or package, a default for | 90 | default regardless of the command name or package, a default for |
82 | specific duplicated commands regardless of the package, or a default | 91 | specific duplicated commands regardless of the package, or a default |
83 | for specific commands tied to particular packages. Here are the | 92 | for specific commands tied to particular packages. Here are the |
84 | available syntax forms: ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY = "priority" | 93 | available syntax forms: |
85 | ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY[name] = "priority" | 94 | :: |
86 | ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY_pkg[name] = "priority" | 95 | |
87 | 96 | ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY = "priority" | |
97 | ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY[name] = "priority" | ||
98 | ALTERNATIVE_PRIORITY_pkg[name] = "priority" | ||
99 | |||
88 | For more information on the alternatives system, see the | 100 | For more information on the alternatives system, see the |
89 | ":ref:`update-alternatives.bbclass <ref-classes-update-alternatives>`" | 101 | ":ref:`update-alternatives.bbclass <ref-classes-update-alternatives>`" |
90 | section. | 102 | section. |
91 | 103 | ||
92 | ALTERNATIVE_TARGET | 104 | ALTERNATIVE_TARGET |
93 | Used by the alternatives system to create default link locations for | 105 | Used by the alternatives system to create default link locations for |
94 | duplicated commands. You can use the variable to create a single | 106 | duplicated commands. You can use the variable to create a single |
@@ -96,105 +108,115 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
96 | command name or package, a default for specific duplicated commands | 108 | command name or package, a default for specific duplicated commands |
97 | regardless of the package, or a default for specific commands tied to | 109 | regardless of the package, or a default for specific commands tied to |
98 | particular packages. Here are the available syntax forms: | 110 | particular packages. Here are the available syntax forms: |
99 | ALTERNATIVE_TARGET = "target" ALTERNATIVE_TARGET[name] = "target" | 111 | :: |
100 | ALTERNATIVE_TARGET_pkg[name] = "target" | 112 | |
101 | 113 | ALTERNATIVE_TARGET = "target" | |
114 | ALTERNATIVE_TARGET[name] = "target" | ||
115 | ALTERNATIVE_TARGET_pkg[name] = "target" | ||
116 | |||
102 | .. note:: | 117 | .. note:: |
103 | 118 | ||
104 | If ``ALTERNATIVE_TARGET`` is not defined, it inherits the value | 119 | If ``ALTERNATIVE_TARGET`` is not defined, it inherits the value |
105 | from the | 120 | from the :term:`ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME` variable. |
106 | :term:`ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME` | 121 | |
107 | variable. | ||
108 | |||
109 | If ``ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME`` and ``ALTERNATIVE_TARGET`` are the | 122 | If ``ALTERNATIVE_LINK_NAME`` and ``ALTERNATIVE_TARGET`` are the |
110 | same, the target for ``ALTERNATIVE_TARGET`` has "``.{BPN}``" | 123 | same, the target for ``ALTERNATIVE_TARGET`` has "``.{BPN}``" |
111 | appended to it. | 124 | appended to it. |
112 | 125 | ||
113 | Finally, if the file referenced has not been renamed, the | 126 | Finally, if the file referenced has not been renamed, the |
114 | alternatives system will rename it to avoid the need to rename | 127 | alternatives system will rename it to avoid the need to rename |
115 | alternative files in the :ref:`ref-tasks-install` | 128 | alternative files in the :ref:`ref-tasks-install` |
116 | task while retaining support for the command if necessary. | 129 | task while retaining support for the command if necessary. |
117 | 130 | ||
118 | For more information on the alternatives system, see the | 131 | For more information on the alternatives system, see the |
119 | ":ref:`update-alternatives.bbclass <ref-classes-update-alternatives>`" | 132 | ":ref:`update-alternatives.bbclass <ref-classes-update-alternatives>`" |
120 | section. | 133 | section. |
121 | 134 | ||
122 | APPEND | 135 | APPEND |
123 | An override list of append strings for each target specified with | 136 | An override list of append strings for each target specified with |
124 | :term:`LABELS`. | 137 | :term:`LABELS`. |
125 | 138 | ||
126 | See the :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more | 139 | See the :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more |
127 | information on how this variable is used. | 140 | information on how this variable is used. |
128 | 141 | ||
129 | AR | 142 | AR |
130 | The minimal command and arguments used to run ``ar``. | 143 | The minimal command and arguments used to run ``ar``. |
131 | 144 | ||
132 | ARCHIVER_MODE | 145 | ARCHIVER_MODE |
133 | When used with the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class, | 146 | When used with the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class, |
134 | determines the type of information used to create a released archive. | 147 | determines the type of information used to create a released archive. |
135 | You can use this variable to create archives of patched source, | 148 | You can use this variable to create archives of patched source, |
136 | original source, configured source, and so forth by employing the | 149 | original source, configured source, and so forth by employing the |
137 | following variable flags (varflags): ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = "original" | 150 | following variable flags (varflags): |
138 | # Uses original (unpacked) source # files. ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = | 151 | :: |
139 | "patched" # Uses patched source files. This is # the default. | 152 | |
140 | ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = "configured" # Uses configured source files. | 153 | ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = "original" # Uses original (unpacked) source files. |
141 | ARCHIVER_MODE[diff] = "1" # Uses patches between do_unpack and # | 154 | ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = "patched" # Uses patched source files. This is the default. |
142 | do_patch. ARCHIVER_MODE[diff-exclude] ?= "file file ..." # Lists | 155 | ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = "configured" # Uses configured source files. |
143 | files and directories to # exclude from diff. ARCHIVER_MODE[dumpdata] | 156 | ARCHIVER_MODE[diff] = "1" # Uses patches between do_unpack and do_patch. |
144 | = "1" # Uses environment data. ARCHIVER_MODE[recipe] = "1" # Uses | 157 | ARCHIVER_MODE[diff-exclude] ?= "file file ..." # Lists files and directories to exclude from diff. |
145 | recipe and include files. ARCHIVER_MODE[srpm] = "1" # Uses RPM | 158 | ARCHIVER_MODE[dumpdata] = "1" # Uses environment data. |
146 | package files. For information on how the variable works, see the | 159 | ARCHIVER_MODE[recipe] = "1" # Uses recipe and include files. |
160 | ARCHIVER_MODE[srpm] = "1" # Uses RPM package files. | ||
161 | |||
162 | For information on how the variable works, see the | ||
147 | ``meta/classes/archiver.bbclass`` file in the :term:`Source Directory`. | 163 | ``meta/classes/archiver.bbclass`` file in the :term:`Source Directory`. |
148 | 164 | ||
149 | AS | 165 | AS |
150 | Minimal command and arguments needed to run the assembler. | 166 | Minimal command and arguments needed to run the assembler. |
151 | 167 | ||
152 | ASSUME_PROVIDED | 168 | ASSUME_PROVIDED |
153 | Lists recipe names (:term:`PN` values) BitBake does not | 169 | Lists recipe names (:term:`PN` values) BitBake does not |
154 | attempt to build. Instead, BitBake assumes these recipes have already | 170 | attempt to build. Instead, BitBake assumes these recipes have already |
155 | been built. | 171 | been built. |
156 | 172 | ||
157 | In OpenEmbedded-Core, ``ASSUME_PROVIDED`` mostly specifies native | 173 | In OpenEmbedded-Core, ``ASSUME_PROVIDED`` mostly specifies native |
158 | tools that should not be built. An example is ``git-native``, which | 174 | tools that should not be built. An example is ``git-native``, which |
159 | when specified, allows for the Git binary from the host to be used | 175 | when specified, allows for the Git binary from the host to be used |
160 | rather than building ``git-native``. | 176 | rather than building ``git-native``. |
161 | 177 | ||
162 | ASSUME_SHLIBS | 178 | ASSUME_SHLIBS |
163 | Provides additional ``shlibs`` provider mapping information, which | 179 | Provides additional ``shlibs`` provider mapping information, which |
164 | adds to or overwrites the information provided automatically by the | 180 | adds to or overwrites the information provided automatically by the |
165 | system. Separate multiple entries using spaces. | 181 | system. Separate multiple entries using spaces. |
166 | 182 | ||
167 | As an example, use the following form to add an ``shlib`` provider of | 183 | As an example, use the following form to add an ``shlib`` provider of |
168 | shlibname in packagename with the optional version: | 184 | shlibname in packagename with the optional version: |
169 | shlibname:packagename[_version] | 185 | :: |
170 | 186 | ||
187 | shlibname:packagename[_version] | ||
188 | |||
171 | Here is an example that adds a shared library named ``libEGL.so.1`` | 189 | Here is an example that adds a shared library named ``libEGL.so.1`` |
172 | as being provided by the ``libegl-implementation`` package: | 190 | as being provided by the ``libegl-implementation`` package: |
173 | ASSUME_SHLIBS = "libEGL.so.1:libegl-implementation" | 191 | :: |
174 | 192 | ||
193 | ASSUME_SHLIBS = "libEGL.so.1:libegl-implementation" | ||
194 | |||
175 | AUTHOR | 195 | AUTHOR |
176 | The email address used to contact the original author or authors in | 196 | The email address used to contact the original author or authors in |
177 | order to send patches and forward bugs. | 197 | order to send patches and forward bugs. |
178 | 198 | ||
179 | AUTO_LIBNAME_PKGS | 199 | AUTO_LIBNAME_PKGS |
180 | When the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class is inherited, | 200 | When the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class is inherited, |
181 | which is the default behavior, ``AUTO_LIBNAME_PKGS`` specifies which | 201 | which is the default behavior, ``AUTO_LIBNAME_PKGS`` specifies which |
182 | packages should be checked for libraries and renamed according to | 202 | packages should be checked for libraries and renamed according to |
183 | Debian library package naming. | 203 | Debian library package naming. |
184 | 204 | ||
185 | The default value is "${PACKAGES}", which causes the debian class to | 205 | The default value is "${PACKAGES}", which causes the debian class to |
186 | act on all packages that are explicitly generated by the recipe. | 206 | act on all packages that are explicitly generated by the recipe. |
187 | 207 | ||
188 | AUTO_SYSLINUXMENU | 208 | AUTO_SYSLINUXMENU |
189 | Enables creating an automatic menu for the syslinux bootloader. You | 209 | Enables creating an automatic menu for the syslinux bootloader. You |
190 | must set this variable in your recipe. The | 210 | must set this variable in your recipe. The |
191 | :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class checks this variable. | 211 | :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class checks this variable. |
192 | 212 | ||
193 | AUTOREV | 213 | AUTOREV |
194 | When ``SRCREV`` is set to the value of this variable, it specifies to | 214 | When ``SRCREV`` is set to the value of this variable, it specifies to |
195 | use the latest source revision in the repository. Here is an example: | 215 | use the latest source revision in the repository. Here is an example: |
196 | SRCREV = "${AUTOREV}" | 216 | :: |
197 | 217 | ||
218 | SRCREV = "${AUTOREV}" | ||
219 | |||
198 | If you use the previous statement to retrieve the latest version of | 220 | If you use the previous statement to retrieve the latest version of |
199 | software, you need to be sure :term:`PV` contains | 221 | software, you need to be sure :term:`PV` contains |
200 | ``${``\ :term:`SRCPV`\ ``}``. For example, suppose you | 222 | ``${``\ :term:`SRCPV`\ ``}``. For example, suppose you |
@@ -203,19 +225,18 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
203 | statement. In this example, ``${SRCPV}`` does not automatically get | 225 | statement. In this example, ``${SRCPV}`` does not automatically get |
204 | into ``PV``. Consequently, you need to change ``PV`` in your recipe | 226 | into ``PV``. Consequently, you need to change ``PV`` in your recipe |
205 | so that it does contain ``${SRCPV}``. | 227 | so that it does contain ``${SRCPV}``. |
206 | 228 | ||
207 | For more information see the "`Automatically Incrementing a Binary | 229 | For more information see the |
208 | Package Revision | 230 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:automatically incrementing a package version number`" |
209 | Number <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#automatically-incrementing-a-binary-package-revision-number>`__" | ||
210 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 231 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
211 | 232 | ||
212 | AVAILABLE_LICENSES | 233 | AVAILABLE_LICENSES |
213 | List of licenses found in the directories specified by | 234 | List of licenses found in the directories specified by |
214 | :term:`COMMON_LICENSE_DIR` and | 235 | :term:`COMMON_LICENSE_DIR` and |
215 | :term:`LICENSE_PATH`. | 236 | :term:`LICENSE_PATH`. |
216 | 237 | ||
217 | .. note:: | 238 | .. note:: |
218 | 239 | ||
219 | It is assumed that all changes to | 240 | It is assumed that all changes to |
220 | COMMON_LICENSE_DIR | 241 | COMMON_LICENSE_DIR |
221 | and | 242 | and |
@@ -225,106 +246,113 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
225 | is defined (in | 246 | is defined (in |
226 | license.bbclass | 247 | license.bbclass |
227 | ). | 248 | ). |
228 | 249 | ||
229 | AVAILTUNES | 250 | AVAILTUNES |
230 | The list of defined CPU and Application Binary Interface (ABI) | 251 | The list of defined CPU and Application Binary Interface (ABI) |
231 | tunings (i.e. "tunes") available for use by the OpenEmbedded build | 252 | tunings (i.e. "tunes") available for use by the OpenEmbedded build |
232 | system. | 253 | system. |
233 | 254 | ||
234 | The list simply presents the tunes that are available. Not all tunes | 255 | The list simply presents the tunes that are available. Not all tunes |
235 | may be compatible with a particular machine configuration, or with | 256 | may be compatible with a particular machine configuration, or with |
236 | each other in a | 257 | each other in a |
237 | `Multilib <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#combining-multiple-versions-library-files-into-one-image>`__ | 258 | :ref:`Multilib <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:combining multiple versions of library files into one image>` |
238 | configuration. | 259 | configuration. |
239 | 260 | ||
240 | To add a tune to the list, be sure to append it with spaces using the | 261 | To add a tune to the list, be sure to append it with spaces using the |
241 | "+=" BitBake operator. Do not simply replace the list by using the | 262 | "+=" BitBake operator. Do not simply replace the list by using the |
242 | "=" operator. See the | 263 | "=" operator. See the |
243 | ":ref:`Basic Syntax <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:basic syntax>`" section in the BitBake | 264 | ":ref:`Basic Syntax <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:basic syntax>`" section in the BitBake |
244 | User Manual for more information. | 265 | User Manual for more information. |
245 | 266 | ||
246 | B | 267 | B |
247 | The directory within the :term:`Build Directory` in | 268 | The directory within the :term:`Build Directory` in |
248 | which the OpenEmbedded build system places generated objects during a | 269 | which the OpenEmbedded build system places generated objects during a |
249 | recipe's build process. By default, this directory is the same as the | 270 | recipe's build process. By default, this directory is the same as the |
250 | :term:`S` directory, which is defined as: S = | 271 | :term:`S` directory, which is defined as: |
251 | "${WORKDIR}/${BP}" | 272 | :: |
252 | 273 | ||
274 | S = "${WORKDIR}/${BP}" | ||
275 | |||
253 | You can separate the (``S``) directory and the directory pointed to | 276 | You can separate the (``S``) directory and the directory pointed to |
254 | by the ``B`` variable. Most Autotools-based recipes support | 277 | by the ``B`` variable. Most Autotools-based recipes support |
255 | separating these directories. The build system defaults to using | 278 | separating these directories. The build system defaults to using |
256 | separate directories for ``gcc`` and some kernel recipes. | 279 | separate directories for ``gcc`` and some kernel recipes. |
257 | 280 | ||
258 | BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS | 281 | BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS |
259 | Lists "recommended-only" packages to not install. Recommended-only | 282 | Lists "recommended-only" packages to not install. Recommended-only |
260 | packages are packages installed only through the | 283 | packages are packages installed only through the |
261 | :term:`RRECOMMENDS` variable. You can prevent any | 284 | :term:`RRECOMMENDS` variable. You can prevent any |
262 | of these "recommended" packages from being installed by listing them | 285 | of these "recommended" packages from being installed by listing them |
263 | with the ``BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS`` variable: BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS = | 286 | with the ``BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS`` variable: |
264 | "package_name package_name package_name ..." | 287 | :: |
265 | 288 | ||
289 | BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS = "package_name package_name package_name ..." | ||
290 | |||
266 | You can set this variable globally in your ``local.conf`` file or you | 291 | You can set this variable globally in your ``local.conf`` file or you |
267 | can attach it to a specific image recipe by using the recipe name | 292 | can attach it to a specific image recipe by using the recipe name |
268 | override: BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS_pn-target_image = "package_name" | 293 | override: |
269 | 294 | :: | |
295 | |||
296 | BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS_pn-target_image = "package_name" | ||
297 | |||
270 | It is important to realize that if you choose to not install packages | 298 | It is important to realize that if you choose to not install packages |
271 | using this variable and some other packages are dependent on them | 299 | using this variable and some other packages are dependent on them |
272 | (i.e. listed in a recipe's :term:`RDEPENDS` | 300 | (i.e. listed in a recipe's :term:`RDEPENDS` |
273 | variable), the OpenEmbedded build system ignores your request and | 301 | variable), the OpenEmbedded build system ignores your request and |
274 | will install the packages to avoid dependency errors. | 302 | will install the packages to avoid dependency errors. |
275 | 303 | ||
276 | Support for this variable exists only when using the IPK and RPM | 304 | Support for this variable exists only when using the IPK and RPM |
277 | packaging backend. Support does not exist for DEB. | 305 | packaging backend. Support does not exist for DEB. |
278 | 306 | ||
279 | See the :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS` and the | 307 | See the :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS` and the |
280 | :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE` variables for related | 308 | :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE` variables for related |
281 | information. | 309 | information. |
282 | 310 | ||
283 | BASE_LIB | 311 | BASE_LIB |
284 | The library directory name for the CPU or Application Binary | 312 | The library directory name for the CPU or Application Binary |
285 | Interface (ABI) tune. The ``BASE_LIB`` applies only in the Multilib | 313 | Interface (ABI) tune. The ``BASE_LIB`` applies only in the Multilib |
286 | context. See the "`Combining Multiple Versions of Library Files into | 314 | context. See the ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:combining multiple versions of library files into one image`" |
287 | One | ||
288 | Image <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#combining-multiple-versions-library-files-into-one-image>`__" | ||
289 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for information | 315 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for information |
290 | on Multilib. | 316 | on Multilib. |
291 | 317 | ||
292 | The ``BASE_LIB`` variable is defined in the machine include files in | 318 | The ``BASE_LIB`` variable is defined in the machine include files in |
293 | the :term:`Source Directory`. If Multilib is not | 319 | the :term:`Source Directory`. If Multilib is not |
294 | being used, the value defaults to "lib". | 320 | being used, the value defaults to "lib". |
295 | 321 | ||
296 | BASE_WORKDIR | 322 | BASE_WORKDIR |
297 | Points to the base of the work directory for all recipes. The default | 323 | Points to the base of the work directory for all recipes. The default |
298 | value is "${TMPDIR}/work". | 324 | value is "${TMPDIR}/work". |
299 | 325 | ||
300 | BB_ALLOWED_NETWORKS | 326 | BB_ALLOWED_NETWORKS |
301 | Specifies a space-delimited list of hosts that the fetcher is allowed | 327 | Specifies a space-delimited list of hosts that the fetcher is allowed |
302 | to use to obtain the required source code. Following are | 328 | to use to obtain the required source code. Following are |
303 | considerations surrounding this variable: | 329 | considerations surrounding this variable: |
304 | 330 | ||
305 | - This host list is only used if ``BB_NO_NETWORK`` is either not set | 331 | - This host list is only used if ``BB_NO_NETWORK`` is either not set |
306 | or set to "0". | 332 | or set to "0". |
307 | 333 | ||
308 | - Limited support for wildcard matching against the beginning of | 334 | - Limited support for wildcard matching against the beginning of |
309 | host names exists. For example, the following setting matches | 335 | host names exists. For example, the following setting matches |
310 | ``git.gnu.org``, ``ftp.gnu.org``, and ``foo.git.gnu.org``. | 336 | ``git.gnu.org``, ``ftp.gnu.org``, and ``foo.git.gnu.org``. |
311 | BB_ALLOWED_NETWORKS = "*.gnu.org" | 337 | :: |
312 | 338 | ||
339 | BB_ALLOWED_NETWORKS = "*.gnu.org" | ||
340 | |||
313 | .. note:: | 341 | .. note:: |
314 | 342 | ||
315 | The use of the "``*``" character only works at the beginning of | 343 | The use of the "``*``" character only works at the beginning of |
316 | a host name and it must be isolated from the remainder of the | 344 | a host name and it must be isolated from the remainder of the |
317 | host name. You cannot use the wildcard character in any other | 345 | host name. You cannot use the wildcard character in any other |
318 | location of the name or combined with the front part of the | 346 | location of the name or combined with the front part of the |
319 | name. | 347 | name. |
320 | 348 | ||
321 | For example, ``*.foo.bar`` is supported, while ``*aa.foo.bar`` | 349 | For example, ``*.foo.bar`` is supported, while ``*aa.foo.bar`` |
322 | is not. | 350 | is not. |
323 | 351 | ||
324 | - Mirrors not in the host list are skipped and logged in debug. | 352 | - Mirrors not in the host list are skipped and logged in debug. |
325 | 353 | ||
326 | - Attempts to access networks not in the host list cause a failure. | 354 | - Attempts to access networks not in the host list cause a failure. |
327 | 355 | ||
328 | Using ``BB_ALLOWED_NETWORKS`` in conjunction with | 356 | Using ``BB_ALLOWED_NETWORKS`` in conjunction with |
329 | :term:`PREMIRRORS` is very useful. Adding the host | 357 | :term:`PREMIRRORS` is very useful. Adding the host |
330 | you want to use to ``PREMIRRORS`` results in the source code being | 358 | you want to use to ``PREMIRRORS`` results in the source code being |
@@ -333,7 +361,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
333 | statement. This is because the fetcher does not attempt to use the | 361 | statement. This is because the fetcher does not attempt to use the |
334 | host listed in ``SRC_URI`` after a successful fetch from the | 362 | host listed in ``SRC_URI`` after a successful fetch from the |
335 | ``PREMIRRORS`` occurs. | 363 | ``PREMIRRORS`` occurs. |
336 | 364 | ||
337 | BB_DANGLINGAPPENDS_WARNONLY | 365 | BB_DANGLINGAPPENDS_WARNONLY |
338 | Defines how BitBake handles situations where an append file | 366 | Defines how BitBake handles situations where an append file |
339 | (``.bbappend``) has no corresponding recipe file (``.bb``). This | 367 | (``.bbappend``) has no corresponding recipe file (``.bb``). This |
@@ -341,42 +369,69 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
341 | bumps a recipe version and the old recipe no longer exists and the | 369 | bumps a recipe version and the old recipe no longer exists and the |
342 | other layer has not been updated to the new version of the recipe | 370 | other layer has not been updated to the new version of the recipe |
343 | yet). | 371 | yet). |
344 | 372 | ||
345 | The default fatal behavior is safest because it is the sane reaction | 373 | The default fatal behavior is safest because it is the sane reaction |
346 | given something is out of sync. It is important to realize when your | 374 | given something is out of sync. It is important to realize when your |
347 | changes are no longer being applied. | 375 | changes are no longer being applied. |
348 | 376 | ||
349 | You can change the default behavior by setting this variable to "1", | 377 | You can change the default behavior by setting this variable to "1", |
350 | "yes", or "true" in your ``local.conf`` file, which is located in the | 378 | "yes", or "true" in your ``local.conf`` file, which is located in the |
351 | :term:`Build Directory`: Here is an example: | 379 | :term:`Build Directory`: Here is an example: |
352 | BB_DANGLINGAPPENDS_WARNONLY = "1" | 380 | :: |
353 | 381 | ||
382 | BB_DANGLINGAPPENDS_WARNONLY = "1" | ||
383 | |||
354 | BB_DISKMON_DIRS | 384 | BB_DISKMON_DIRS |
355 | Monitors disk space and available inodes during the build and allows | 385 | Monitors disk space and available inodes during the build and allows |
356 | you to control the build based on these parameters. | 386 | you to control the build based on these parameters. |
357 | 387 | ||
358 | Disk space monitoring is disabled by default. To enable monitoring, | 388 | Disk space monitoring is disabled by default. To enable monitoring, |
359 | add the ``BB_DISKMON_DIRS`` variable to your ``conf/local.conf`` file | 389 | add the ``BB_DISKMON_DIRS`` variable to your ``conf/local.conf`` file |
360 | found in the :term:`Build Directory`. Use the | 390 | found in the :term:`Build Directory`. Use the |
361 | following form: BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "action,dir,threshold [...]" where: | 391 | following form: |
362 | action is: ABORT: Immediately abort the build when a threshold is | 392 | :: |
363 | broken. STOPTASKS: Stop the build after the currently executing tasks | 393 | |
364 | have finished when a threshold is broken. WARN: Issue a warning but | 394 | BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "action,dir,threshold [...]" |
365 | continue the build when a threshold is broken. Subsequent warnings | 395 | |
366 | are issued as defined by the BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL variable, which | 396 | where: |
367 | must be defined in the conf/local.conf file. dir is: Any directory | 397 | |
368 | you choose. You can specify one or more directories to monitor by | 398 | action is: |
369 | separating the groupings with a space. If two directories are on the | 399 | ABORT: Immediately abort the build when |
370 | same device, only the first directory is monitored. threshold is: | 400 | a threshold is broken. |
371 | Either the minimum available disk space, the minimum number of free | 401 | STOPTASKS: Stop the build after the currently |
372 | inodes, or both. You must specify at least one. To omit one or the | 402 | executing tasks have finished when |
373 | other, simply omit the value. Specify the threshold using G, M, K for | 403 | a threshold is broken. |
374 | Gbytes, Mbytes, and Kbytes, respectively. If you do not specify G, M, | 404 | WARN: Issue a warning but continue the |
375 | or K, Kbytes is assumed by default. Do not use GB, MB, or KB. | 405 | build when a threshold is broken. |
376 | 406 | Subsequent warnings are issued as | |
377 | Here are some examples: BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "ABORT,${TMPDIR},1G,100K | 407 | defined by the BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL |
378 | WARN,${SSTATE_DIR},1G,100K" BB_DISKMON_DIRS = | 408 | variable, which must be defined in |
379 | "STOPTASKS,${TMPDIR},1G" BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "ABORT,${TMPDIR},,100K" | 409 | the conf/local.conf file. |
410 | |||
411 | dir is: | ||
412 | Any directory you choose. You can specify one or | ||
413 | more directories to monitor by separating the | ||
414 | groupings with a space. If two directories are | ||
415 | on the same device, only the first directory | ||
416 | is monitored. | ||
417 | |||
418 | threshold is: | ||
419 | Either the minimum available disk space, | ||
420 | the minimum number of free inodes, or | ||
421 | both. You must specify at least one. To | ||
422 | omit one or the other, simply omit the value. | ||
423 | Specify the threshold using G, M, K for Gbytes, | ||
424 | Mbytes, and Kbytes, respectively. If you do | ||
425 | not specify G, M, or K, Kbytes is assumed by | ||
426 | default. Do not use GB, MB, or KB. | ||
427 | |||
428 | Here are some examples: | ||
429 | :: | ||
430 | |||
431 | BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "ABORT,${TMPDIR},1G,100K WARN,${SSTATE_DIR},1G,100K" | ||
432 | BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "STOPTASKS,${TMPDIR},1G" | ||
433 | BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "ABORT,${TMPDIR},,100K" | ||
434 | |||
380 | The first example works only if you also provide the | 435 | The first example works only if you also provide the |
381 | :term:`BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL` | 436 | :term:`BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL` |
382 | variable in the ``conf/local.conf``. This example causes the build | 437 | variable in the ``conf/local.conf``. This example causes the build |
@@ -388,64 +443,85 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
388 | of free inodes drops below 100 Kbytes. Subsequent warnings are issued | 443 | of free inodes drops below 100 Kbytes. Subsequent warnings are issued |
389 | during intervals as defined by the ``BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL`` | 444 | during intervals as defined by the ``BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL`` |
390 | variable. | 445 | variable. |
391 | 446 | ||
392 | The second example stops the build after all currently executing | 447 | The second example stops the build after all currently executing |
393 | tasks complete when the minimum disk space in the ``${TMPDIR}`` | 448 | tasks complete when the minimum disk space in the ``${TMPDIR}`` |
394 | directory drops below 1 Gbyte. No disk monitoring occurs for the free | 449 | directory drops below 1 Gbyte. No disk monitoring occurs for the free |
395 | inodes in this case. | 450 | inodes in this case. |
396 | 451 | ||
397 | The final example immediately aborts the build when the number of | 452 | The final example immediately aborts the build when the number of |
398 | free inodes in the ``${TMPDIR}`` directory drops below 100 Kbytes. No | 453 | free inodes in the ``${TMPDIR}`` directory drops below 100 Kbytes. No |
399 | disk space monitoring for the directory itself occurs in this case. | 454 | disk space monitoring for the directory itself occurs in this case. |
400 | 455 | ||
401 | BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL | 456 | BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL |
402 | Defines the disk space and free inode warning intervals. To set these | 457 | Defines the disk space and free inode warning intervals. To set these |
403 | intervals, define the variable in your ``conf/local.conf`` file in | 458 | intervals, define the variable in your ``conf/local.conf`` file in |
404 | the :term:`Build Directory`. | 459 | the :term:`Build Directory`. |
405 | 460 | ||
406 | If you are going to use the ``BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL`` variable, you | 461 | If you are going to use the ``BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL`` variable, you |
407 | must also use the :term:`BB_DISKMON_DIRS` | 462 | must also use the :term:`BB_DISKMON_DIRS` |
408 | variable and define its action as "WARN". During the build, | 463 | variable and define its action as "WARN". During the build, |
409 | subsequent warnings are issued each time disk space or number of free | 464 | subsequent warnings are issued each time disk space or number of free |
410 | inodes further reduces by the respective interval. | 465 | inodes further reduces by the respective interval. |
411 | 466 | ||
412 | If you do not provide a ``BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL`` variable and you | 467 | If you do not provide a ``BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL`` variable and you |
413 | do use ``BB_DISKMON_DIRS`` with the "WARN" action, the disk | 468 | do use ``BB_DISKMON_DIRS`` with the "WARN" action, the disk |
414 | monitoring interval defaults to the following: | 469 | monitoring interval defaults to the following: |
415 | BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL = "50M,5K" | 470 | :: |
416 | 471 | ||
472 | BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL = "50M,5K" | ||
473 | |||
417 | When specifying the variable in your configuration file, use the | 474 | When specifying the variable in your configuration file, use the |
418 | following form: BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL = | 475 | following form: |
419 | "disk_space_interval,disk_inode_interval" where: disk_space_interval | 476 | :: |
420 | is: An interval of memory expressed in either G, M, or K for Gbytes, | 477 | |
421 | Mbytes, or Kbytes, respectively. You cannot use GB, MB, or KB. | 478 | BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL = "disk_space_interval,disk_inode_interval" |
422 | disk_inode_interval is: An interval of free inodes expressed in | 479 | |
423 | either G, M, or K for Gbytes, Mbytes, or Kbytes, respectively. You | 480 | where: |
424 | cannot use GB, MB, or KB. | 481 | |
425 | 482 | disk_space_interval is: | |
426 | Here is an example: BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "WARN,${SSTATE_DIR},1G,100K" | 483 | An interval of memory expressed in either |
427 | BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL = "50M,5K" These variables cause the | 484 | G, M, or K for Gbytes, Mbytes, or Kbytes, |
485 | respectively. You cannot use GB, MB, or KB. | ||
486 | |||
487 | disk_inode_interval is: | ||
488 | An interval of free inodes expressed in either | ||
489 | G, M, or K for Gbytes, Mbytes, or Kbytes, | ||
490 | respectively. You cannot use GB, MB, or KB. | ||
491 | |||
492 | Here is an example: | ||
493 | :: | ||
494 | |||
495 | BB_DISKMON_DIRS = "WARN,${SSTATE_DIR},1G,100K" | ||
496 | BB_DISKMON_WARNINTERVAL = "50M,5K" | ||
497 | |||
498 | These variables cause the | ||
428 | OpenEmbedded build system to issue subsequent warnings each time the | 499 | OpenEmbedded build system to issue subsequent warnings each time the |
429 | available disk space further reduces by 50 Mbytes or the number of | 500 | available disk space further reduces by 50 Mbytes or the number of |
430 | free inodes further reduces by 5 Kbytes in the ``${SSTATE_DIR}`` | 501 | free inodes further reduces by 5 Kbytes in the ``${SSTATE_DIR}`` |
431 | directory. Subsequent warnings based on the interval occur each time | 502 | directory. Subsequent warnings based on the interval occur each time |
432 | a respective interval is reached beyond the initial warning (i.e. 1 | 503 | a respective interval is reached beyond the initial warning (i.e. 1 |
433 | Gbytes and 100 Kbytes). | 504 | Gbytes and 100 Kbytes). |
434 | 505 | ||
435 | BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS | 506 | BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS |
436 | Causes tarballs of the source control repositories (e.g. Git | 507 | Causes tarballs of the source control repositories (e.g. Git |
437 | repositories), including metadata, to be placed in the | 508 | repositories), including metadata, to be placed in the |
438 | :term:`DL_DIR` directory. | 509 | :term:`DL_DIR` directory. |
439 | 510 | ||
440 | For performance reasons, creating and placing tarballs of these | 511 | For performance reasons, creating and placing tarballs of these |
441 | repositories is not the default action by the OpenEmbedded build | 512 | repositories is not the default action by the OpenEmbedded build |
442 | system. BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS = "1" Set this variable in your | 513 | system. |
514 | :: | ||
515 | |||
516 | BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS = "1" | ||
517 | |||
518 | Set this variable in your | ||
443 | ``local.conf`` file in the :term:`Build Directory`. | 519 | ``local.conf`` file in the :term:`Build Directory`. |
444 | 520 | ||
445 | Once you have the tarballs containing your source files, you can | 521 | Once you have the tarballs containing your source files, you can |
446 | clean up your ``DL_DIR`` directory by deleting any Git or other | 522 | clean up your ``DL_DIR`` directory by deleting any Git or other |
447 | source control work directories. | 523 | source control work directories. |
448 | 524 | ||
449 | BB_NUMBER_THREADS | 525 | BB_NUMBER_THREADS |
450 | The maximum number of tasks BitBake should run in parallel at any one | 526 | The maximum number of tasks BitBake should run in parallel at any one |
451 | time. The OpenEmbedded build system automatically configures this | 527 | time. The OpenEmbedded build system automatically configures this |
@@ -453,27 +529,31 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
453 | example, a system with a dual core processor that also uses | 529 | example, a system with a dual core processor that also uses |
454 | hyper-threading causes the ``BB_NUMBER_THREADS`` variable to default | 530 | hyper-threading causes the ``BB_NUMBER_THREADS`` variable to default |
455 | to "4". | 531 | to "4". |
456 | 532 | ||
457 | For single socket systems (i.e. one CPU), you should not have to | 533 | For single socket systems (i.e. one CPU), you should not have to |
458 | override this variable to gain optimal parallelism during builds. | 534 | override this variable to gain optimal parallelism during builds. |
459 | However, if you have very large systems that employ multiple physical | 535 | However, if you have very large systems that employ multiple physical |
460 | CPUs, you might want to make sure the ``BB_NUMBER_THREADS`` variable | 536 | CPUs, you might want to make sure the ``BB_NUMBER_THREADS`` variable |
461 | is not set higher than "20". | 537 | is not set higher than "20". |
462 | 538 | ||
463 | For more information on speeding up builds, see the "`Speeding Up a | 539 | For more information on speeding up builds, see the |
464 | Build <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#speeding-up-a-build>`__" section in the | 540 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:speeding up a build`" |
465 | Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 541 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
466 | 542 | ||
467 | BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT | 543 | BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT |
468 | Specifies the time (in seconds) after which to unload the BitBake | 544 | Specifies the time (in seconds) after which to unload the BitBake |
469 | server due to inactivity. Set ``BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT`` to determine how | 545 | server due to inactivity. Set ``BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT`` to determine how |
470 | long the BitBake server stays resident between invocations. | 546 | long the BitBake server stays resident between invocations. |
471 | 547 | ||
472 | For example, the following statement in your ``local.conf`` file | 548 | For example, the following statement in your ``local.conf`` file |
473 | instructs the server to be unloaded after 20 seconds of inactivity: | 549 | instructs the server to be unloaded after 20 seconds of inactivity: |
474 | BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT = "20" If you want the server to never be unloaded, | 550 | :: |
551 | |||
552 | BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT = "20" | ||
553 | |||
554 | If you want the server to never be unloaded, | ||
475 | set ``BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT`` to "-1". | 555 | set ``BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT`` to "-1". |
476 | 556 | ||
477 | BBCLASSEXTEND | 557 | BBCLASSEXTEND |
478 | Allows you to extend a recipe so that it builds variants of the | 558 | Allows you to extend a recipe so that it builds variants of the |
479 | software. Common variants for recipes exist such as "natives" like | 559 | software. Common variants for recipes exist such as "natives" like |
@@ -483,40 +563,42 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
483 | :term:`MACHINE`; "nativesdk", which targets the SDK | 563 | :term:`MACHINE`; "nativesdk", which targets the SDK |
484 | machine instead of ``MACHINE``; and "mulitlibs" in the form | 564 | machine instead of ``MACHINE``; and "mulitlibs" in the form |
485 | "``multilib:``\ multilib_name". | 565 | "``multilib:``\ multilib_name". |
486 | 566 | ||
487 | To build a different variant of the recipe with a minimal amount of | 567 | To build a different variant of the recipe with a minimal amount of |
488 | code, it usually is as simple as adding the following to your recipe: | 568 | code, it usually is as simple as adding the following to your recipe: |
489 | BBCLASSEXTEND =+ "native nativesdk" BBCLASSEXTEND =+ | 569 | :: |
490 | "multilib:multilib_name" | 570 | |
491 | 571 | BBCLASSEXTEND =+ "native nativesdk" | |
572 | BBCLASSEXTEND =+ "multilib:multilib_name" | ||
573 | |||
492 | .. note:: | 574 | .. note:: |
493 | 575 | ||
494 | Internally, the ``BBCLASSEXTEND`` mechanism generates recipe | 576 | Internally, the ``BBCLASSEXTEND`` mechanism generates recipe |
495 | variants by rewriting variable values and applying overrides such | 577 | variants by rewriting variable values and applying overrides such |
496 | as ``_class-native``. For example, to generate a native version of | 578 | as ``_class-native``. For example, to generate a native version of |
497 | a recipe, a :term:`DEPENDS` on "foo" is rewritten | 579 | a recipe, a :term:`DEPENDS` on "foo" is rewritten |
498 | to a ``DEPENDS`` on "foo-native". | 580 | to a ``DEPENDS`` on "foo-native". |
499 | 581 | ||
500 | Even when using ``BBCLASSEXTEND``, the recipe is only parsed once. | 582 | Even when using ``BBCLASSEXTEND``, the recipe is only parsed once. |
501 | Parsing once adds some limitations. For example, it is not | 583 | Parsing once adds some limitations. For example, it is not |
502 | possible to include a different file depending on the variant, | 584 | possible to include a different file depending on the variant, |
503 | since ``include`` statements are processed when the recipe is | 585 | since ``include`` statements are processed when the recipe is |
504 | parsed. | 586 | parsed. |
505 | 587 | ||
506 | BBFILE_COLLECTIONS | 588 | BBFILE_COLLECTIONS |
507 | Lists the names of configured layers. These names are used to find | 589 | Lists the names of configured layers. These names are used to find |
508 | the other ``BBFILE_*`` variables. Typically, each layer will append | 590 | the other ``BBFILE_*`` variables. Typically, each layer will append |
509 | its name to this variable in its ``conf/layer.conf`` file. | 591 | its name to this variable in its ``conf/layer.conf`` file. |
510 | 592 | ||
511 | BBFILE_PATTERN | 593 | BBFILE_PATTERN |
512 | Variable that expands to match files from | 594 | Variable that expands to match files from |
513 | :term:`BBFILES` in a particular layer. This variable | 595 | :term:`BBFILES` in a particular layer. This variable |
514 | is used in the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be suffixed with the | 596 | is used in the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be suffixed with the |
515 | name of the specific layer (e.g. ``BBFILE_PATTERN_emenlow``). | 597 | name of the specific layer (e.g. ``BBFILE_PATTERN_emenlow``). |
516 | 598 | ||
517 | BBFILE_PRIORITY | 599 | BBFILE_PRIORITY |
518 | Assigns the priority for recipe files in each layer. | 600 | Assigns the priority for recipe files in each layer. |
519 | 601 | ||
520 | This variable is useful in situations where the same recipe appears | 602 | This variable is useful in situations where the same recipe appears |
521 | in more than one layer. Setting this variable allows you to | 603 | in more than one layer. Setting this variable allows you to |
522 | prioritize a layer against other layers that contain the same recipe | 604 | prioritize a layer against other layers that contain the same recipe |
@@ -526,7 +608,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
526 | example, a layer that has a recipe with a higher ``PV`` value but for | 608 | example, a layer that has a recipe with a higher ``PV`` value but for |
527 | which the ``BBFILE_PRIORITY`` is set to have a lower precedence still | 609 | which the ``BBFILE_PRIORITY`` is set to have a lower precedence still |
528 | has a lower precedence. | 610 | has a lower precedence. |
529 | 611 | ||
530 | A larger value for the ``BBFILE_PRIORITY`` variable results in a | 612 | A larger value for the ``BBFILE_PRIORITY`` variable results in a |
531 | higher precedence. For example, the value 6 has a higher precedence | 613 | higher precedence. For example, the value 6 has a higher precedence |
532 | than the value 5. If not specified, the ``BBFILE_PRIORITY`` variable | 614 | than the value 5. If not specified, the ``BBFILE_PRIORITY`` variable |
@@ -534,116 +616,136 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
534 | for more information. The default priority, if unspecified for a | 616 | for more information. The default priority, if unspecified for a |
535 | layer with no dependencies, is the lowest defined priority + 1 (or 1 | 617 | layer with no dependencies, is the lowest defined priority + 1 (or 1 |
536 | if no priorities are defined). | 618 | if no priorities are defined). |
537 | 619 | ||
538 | .. tip:: | 620 | .. tip:: |
539 | 621 | ||
540 | You can use the command | 622 | You can use the command |
541 | bitbake-layers show-layers | 623 | bitbake-layers show-layers |
542 | to list all configured layers along with their priorities. | 624 | to list all configured layers along with their priorities. |
543 | 625 | ||
544 | BBFILES | 626 | BBFILES |
545 | A space-separated list of recipe files BitBake uses to build | 627 | A space-separated list of recipe files BitBake uses to build |
546 | software. | 628 | software. |
547 | 629 | ||
548 | When specifying recipe files, you can pattern match using Python's | 630 | When specifying recipe files, you can pattern match using Python's |
549 | ```glob`https://docs.python.org/3/library/glob.html syntax. | 631 | `glob <https://docs.python.org/3/library/glob.html>`_ syntax. |
550 | For details on the syntax, see the documentation by following the | 632 | For details on the syntax, see the documentation by following the |
551 | previous link. | 633 | previous link. |
552 | 634 | ||
553 | BBFILES_DYNAMIC | 635 | BBFILES_DYNAMIC |
554 | Activates content when identified layers are present. You identify | 636 | Activates content when identified layers are present. You identify |
555 | the layers by the collections that the layers define. | 637 | the layers by the collections that the layers define. |
556 | 638 | ||
557 | Use the ``BBFILES_DYNAMIC`` variable to avoid ``.bbappend`` files | 639 | Use the ``BBFILES_DYNAMIC`` variable to avoid ``.bbappend`` files |
558 | whose corresponding ``.bb`` file is in a layer that attempts to | 640 | whose corresponding ``.bb`` file is in a layer that attempts to |
559 | modify other layers through ``.bbappend`` but does not want to | 641 | modify other layers through ``.bbappend`` but does not want to |
560 | introduce a hard dependency on those other layers. | 642 | introduce a hard dependency on those other layers. |
561 | 643 | ||
562 | Use the following form for ``BBFILES_DYNAMIC``: | 644 | Use the following form for ``BBFILES_DYNAMIC``: |
563 | collection_name:filename_pattern The following example identifies two | 645 | collection_name:filename_pattern The following example identifies two |
564 | collection names and two filename patterns: BBFILES_DYNAMIC += " \\ | 646 | collection names and two filename patterns: |
565 | clang-layer:${LAYERDIR}/bbappends/meta-clang/*/*/*.bbappend \\ | 647 | :: |
566 | core:${LAYERDIR}/bbappends/openembedded-core/meta/*/*/*.bbappend \\ " | 648 | |
649 | BBFILES_DYNAMIC += " \ | ||
650 | clang-layer:${LAYERDIR}/bbappends/meta-clang/*/*/*.bbappend \ | ||
651 | core:${LAYERDIR}/bbappends/openembedded-core/meta/*/*/*.bbappend \ | ||
652 | " | ||
653 | |||
567 | This next example shows an error message that occurs because invalid | 654 | This next example shows an error message that occurs because invalid |
568 | entries are found, which cause parsing to abort: ERROR: | 655 | entries are found, which cause parsing to abort: |
569 | BBFILES_DYNAMIC entries must be of the form <collection | 656 | :: |
570 | name>:<filename pattern>, not: | 657 | |
571 | /work/my-layer/bbappends/meta-security-isafw/*/*/*.bbappend | 658 | ERROR: BBFILES_DYNAMIC entries must be of the form <collection name>:<filename pattern>, not: |
572 | /work/my-layer/bbappends/openembedded-core/meta/*/*/*.bbappend | 659 | /work/my-layer/bbappends/meta-security-isafw/*/*/*.bbappend |
573 | 660 | /work/my-layer/bbappends/openembedded-core/meta/*/*/*.bbappend | |
661 | |||
574 | BBINCLUDELOGS | 662 | BBINCLUDELOGS |
575 | Variable that controls how BitBake displays logs on build failure. | 663 | Variable that controls how BitBake displays logs on build failure. |
576 | 664 | ||
577 | BBINCLUDELOGS_LINES | 665 | BBINCLUDELOGS_LINES |
578 | If :term:`BBINCLUDELOGS` is set, specifies the | 666 | If :term:`BBINCLUDELOGS` is set, specifies the |
579 | maximum number of lines from the task log file to print when | 667 | maximum number of lines from the task log file to print when |
580 | reporting a failed task. If you do not set ``BBINCLUDELOGS_LINES``, | 668 | reporting a failed task. If you do not set ``BBINCLUDELOGS_LINES``, |
581 | the entire log is printed. | 669 | the entire log is printed. |
582 | 670 | ||
583 | BBLAYERS | 671 | BBLAYERS |
584 | Lists the layers to enable during the build. This variable is defined | 672 | Lists the layers to enable during the build. This variable is defined |
585 | in the ``bblayers.conf`` configuration file in the :term:`Build Directory`. | 673 | in the ``bblayers.conf`` configuration file in the :term:`Build Directory`. |
586 | Here is an example: BBLAYERS = " \\ | 674 | Here is an example: |
587 | /home/scottrif/poky/meta \\ /home/scottrif/poky/meta-poky \\ | 675 | :: |
588 | /home/scottrif/poky/meta-yocto-bsp \\ | 676 | |
589 | /home/scottrif/poky/meta-mykernel \\ " | 677 | BBLAYERS = " \ |
590 | 678 | /home/scottrif/poky/meta \ /home/scottrif/poky/meta-poky \ | |
679 | /home/scottrif/poky/meta-yocto-bsp \ | ||
680 | /home/scottrif/poky/meta-mykernel \ | ||
681 | " | ||
682 | |||
591 | This example enables four layers, one of which is a custom, | 683 | This example enables four layers, one of which is a custom, |
592 | user-defined layer named ``meta-mykernel``. | 684 | user-defined layer named ``meta-mykernel``. |
593 | 685 | ||
594 | BBMASK | 686 | BBMASK |
595 | Prevents BitBake from processing recipes and recipe append files. | 687 | Prevents BitBake from processing recipes and recipe append files. |
596 | 688 | ||
597 | You can use the ``BBMASK`` variable to "hide" these ``.bb`` and | 689 | You can use the ``BBMASK`` variable to "hide" these ``.bb`` and |
598 | ``.bbappend`` files. BitBake ignores any recipe or recipe append | 690 | ``.bbappend`` files. BitBake ignores any recipe or recipe append |
599 | files that match any of the expressions. It is as if BitBake does not | 691 | files that match any of the expressions. It is as if BitBake does not |
600 | see them at all. Consequently, matching files are not parsed or | 692 | see them at all. Consequently, matching files are not parsed or |
601 | otherwise used by BitBake. | 693 | otherwise used by BitBake. |
602 | 694 | ||
603 | The values you provide are passed to Python's regular expression | 695 | The values you provide are passed to Python's regular expression |
604 | compiler. Consequently, the syntax follows Python's Regular | 696 | compiler. Consequently, the syntax follows Python's Regular |
605 | Expression (re) syntax. The expressions are compared against the full | 697 | Expression (re) syntax. The expressions are compared against the full |
606 | paths to the files. For complete syntax information, see Python's | 698 | paths to the files. For complete syntax information, see Python's |
607 | documentation at http://docs.python.org/3/library/re.html#re. | 699 | documentation at http://docs.python.org/3/library/re.html#re. |
608 | 700 | ||
609 | The following example uses a complete regular expression to tell | 701 | The following example uses a complete regular expression to tell |
610 | BitBake to ignore all recipe and recipe append files in the | 702 | BitBake to ignore all recipe and recipe append files in the |
611 | ``meta-ti/recipes-misc/`` directory: BBMASK = "meta-ti/recipes-misc/" | 703 | ``meta-ti/recipes-misc/`` directory: |
704 | :: | ||
705 | |||
706 | BBMASK = "meta-ti/recipes-misc/" | ||
707 | |||
612 | If you want to mask out multiple directories or recipes, you can | 708 | If you want to mask out multiple directories or recipes, you can |
613 | specify multiple regular expression fragments. This next example | 709 | specify multiple regular expression fragments. This next example |
614 | masks out multiple directories and individual recipes: BBMASK += | 710 | masks out multiple directories and individual recipes: :: |
615 | "/meta-ti/recipes-misc/ meta-ti/recipes-ti/packagegroup/" BBMASK += | 711 | |
616 | "/meta-oe/recipes-support/" BBMASK += "/meta-foo/.*/openldap" BBMASK | 712 | BBMASK += "/meta-ti/recipes-misc/ meta-ti/recipes-ti/packagegroup/" |
617 | += "opencv.*\.bbappend" BBMASK += "lzma" | 713 | BBMASK += "/meta-oe/recipes-support/" |
618 | 714 | BBMASK += "/meta-foo/.*/openldap" | |
715 | BBMASK += "opencv.*\.bbappend" | ||
716 | BBMASK += "lzma" | ||
717 | |||
619 | .. note:: | 718 | .. note:: |
620 | 719 | ||
621 | When specifying a directory name, use the trailing slash character | 720 | When specifying a directory name, use the trailing slash character |
622 | to ensure you match just that directory name. | 721 | to ensure you match just that directory name. |
623 | 722 | ||
624 | BBMULTICONFIG | 723 | BBMULTICONFIG |
625 | Specifies each additional separate configuration when you are | 724 | Specifies each additional separate configuration when you are |
626 | building targets with multiple configurations. Use this variable in | 725 | building targets with multiple configurations. Use this variable in |
627 | your ``conf/local.conf`` configuration file. Specify a | 726 | your ``conf/local.conf`` configuration file. Specify a |
628 | multiconfigname for each configuration file you are using. For | 727 | multiconfigname for each configuration file you are using. For |
629 | example, the following line specifies three configuration files: | 728 | example, the following line specifies three configuration files: |
630 | BBMULTICONFIG = "configA configB configC" Each configuration file you | 729 | :: |
730 | |||
731 | BBMULTICONFIG = "configA configB configC" | ||
732 | |||
733 | Each configuration file you | ||
631 | use must reside in the :term:`Build Directory` | 734 | use must reside in the :term:`Build Directory` |
632 | ``conf/multiconfig`` directory (e.g. | 735 | ``conf/multiconfig`` directory (e.g. |
633 | build_directory\ ``/conf/multiconfig/configA.conf``). | 736 | build_directory\ ``/conf/multiconfig/configA.conf``). |
634 | 737 | ||
635 | For information on how to use ``BBMULTICONFIG`` in an environment | 738 | For information on how to use ``BBMULTICONFIG`` in an environment |
636 | that supports building targets with multiple configurations, see the | 739 | that supports building targets with multiple configurations, see the |
637 | "`Building Images for Multiple Targets Using Multiple | 740 | ":ref:`dev-building-images-for-multiple-targets-using-multiple-configurations`" |
638 | Configurations <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#dev-building-images-for-multiple-targets-using-multiple-configurations>`__" | ||
639 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 741 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
640 | 742 | ||
641 | BBPATH | 743 | BBPATH |
642 | Used by BitBake to locate ``.bbclass`` and configuration files. This | 744 | Used by BitBake to locate ``.bbclass`` and configuration files. This |
643 | variable is analogous to the ``PATH`` variable. | 745 | variable is analogous to the ``PATH`` variable. |
644 | 746 | ||
645 | .. note:: | 747 | .. note:: |
646 | 748 | ||
647 | If you run BitBake from a directory outside of the | 749 | If you run BitBake from a directory outside of the |
648 | Build Directory | 750 | Build Directory |
649 | , you must be sure to set | 751 | , you must be sure to set |
@@ -651,24 +753,27 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
651 | to point to the Build Directory. Set the variable as you would any | 753 | to point to the Build Directory. Set the variable as you would any |
652 | environment variable and then run BitBake: | 754 | environment variable and then run BitBake: |
653 | :: | 755 | :: |
654 | 756 | ||
655 | $ BBPATH = "build_directory" | 757 | $ BBPATH = "build_directory" |
656 | $ export BBPATH | 758 | $ export BBPATH |
657 | $ bitbake target | 759 | $ bitbake target |
658 | 760 | ||
659 | 761 | ||
660 | BBSERVER | 762 | BBSERVER |
661 | If defined in the BitBake environment, ``BBSERVER`` points to the | 763 | If defined in the BitBake environment, ``BBSERVER`` points to the |
662 | BitBake remote server. | 764 | BitBake remote server. |
663 | 765 | ||
664 | Use the following format to export the variable to the BitBake | 766 | Use the following format to export the variable to the BitBake |
665 | environment: export BBSERVER=localhost:$port | 767 | environment: |
666 | 768 | :: | |
769 | |||
770 | export BBSERVER=localhost:$port | ||
771 | |||
667 | By default, ``BBSERVER`` also appears in | 772 | By default, ``BBSERVER`` also appears in |
668 | :term:`bitbake:BB_HASHBASE_WHITELIST`. | 773 | :term:`bitbake:BB_HASHBASE_WHITELIST`. |
669 | Consequently, ``BBSERVER`` is excluded from checksum and dependency | 774 | Consequently, ``BBSERVER`` is excluded from checksum and dependency |
670 | data. | 775 | data. |
671 | 776 | ||
672 | BINCONFIG | 777 | BINCONFIG |
673 | When inheriting the | 778 | When inheriting the |
674 | :ref:`binconfig-disabled <ref-classes-binconfig-disabled>` class, | 779 | :ref:`binconfig-disabled <ref-classes-binconfig-disabled>` class, |
@@ -677,11 +782,13 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
677 | ``binconfig-disabled`` class will modify the specified scripts to | 782 | ``binconfig-disabled`` class will modify the specified scripts to |
678 | return an error so that calls to them can be easily found and | 783 | return an error so that calls to them can be easily found and |
679 | replaced. | 784 | replaced. |
680 | 785 | ||
681 | To add multiple scripts, separate them by spaces. Here is an example | 786 | To add multiple scripts, separate them by spaces. Here is an example |
682 | from the ``libpng`` recipe: BINCONFIG = "${bindir}/libpng-config | 787 | from the ``libpng`` recipe: |
683 | ${bindir}/libpng16-config" | 788 | :: |
684 | 789 | ||
790 | BINCONFIG = "${bindir}/libpng-config ${bindir}/libpng16-config" | ||
791 | |||
685 | BINCONFIG_GLOB | 792 | BINCONFIG_GLOB |
686 | When inheriting the :ref:`binconfig <ref-classes-binconfig>` class, | 793 | When inheriting the :ref:`binconfig <ref-classes-binconfig>` class, |
687 | this variable specifies a wildcard for configuration scripts that | 794 | this variable specifies a wildcard for configuration scripts that |
@@ -689,9 +796,9 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
689 | been set up during compilation so that they are correct for use when | 796 | been set up during compilation so that they are correct for use when |
690 | installed into the sysroot and called by the build processes of other | 797 | installed into the sysroot and called by the build processes of other |
691 | recipes. | 798 | recipes. |
692 | 799 | ||
693 | .. note:: | 800 | .. note:: |
694 | 801 | ||
695 | The | 802 | The |
696 | BINCONFIG_GLOB | 803 | BINCONFIG_GLOB |
697 | variable uses | 804 | variable uses |
@@ -702,18 +809,21 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
702 | and | 809 | and |
703 | glob | 810 | glob |
704 | . | 811 | . |
705 | 812 | ||
706 | For more information on how this variable works, see | 813 | For more information on how this variable works, see |
707 | ``meta/classes/binconfig.bbclass`` in the :term:`Source Directory`. | 814 | ``meta/classes/binconfig.bbclass`` in the :term:`Source Directory`. |
708 | You can also find general | 815 | You can also find general |
709 | information on the class in the | 816 | information on the class in the |
710 | ":ref:`binconfig.bbclass <ref-classes-binconfig>`" section. | 817 | ":ref:`binconfig.bbclass <ref-classes-binconfig>`" section. |
711 | 818 | ||
712 | BP | 819 | BP |
713 | The base recipe name and version but without any special recipe name | 820 | The base recipe name and version but without any special recipe name |
714 | suffix (i.e. ``-native``, ``lib64-``, and so forth). ``BP`` is | 821 | suffix (i.e. ``-native``, ``lib64-``, and so forth). ``BP`` is |
715 | comprised of the following: ${BPN}-${PV} | 822 | comprised of the following: |
716 | 823 | :: | |
824 | |||
825 | ${BPN}-${PV} | ||
826 | |||
717 | BPN | 827 | BPN |
718 | This variable is a version of the :term:`PN` variable with | 828 | This variable is a version of the :term:`PN` variable with |
719 | common prefixes and suffixes removed, such as ``nativesdk-``, | 829 | common prefixes and suffixes removed, such as ``nativesdk-``, |
@@ -722,115 +832,115 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
722 | :term:`MLPREFIX` and | 832 | :term:`MLPREFIX` and |
723 | :term:`SPECIAL_PKGSUFFIX` variables, | 833 | :term:`SPECIAL_PKGSUFFIX` variables, |
724 | respectively. | 834 | respectively. |
725 | 835 | ||
726 | BUGTRACKER | 836 | BUGTRACKER |
727 | Specifies a URL for an upstream bug tracking website for a recipe. | 837 | Specifies a URL for an upstream bug tracking website for a recipe. |
728 | The OpenEmbedded build system does not use this variable. Rather, the | 838 | The OpenEmbedded build system does not use this variable. Rather, the |
729 | variable is a useful pointer in case a bug in the software being | 839 | variable is a useful pointer in case a bug in the software being |
730 | built needs to be manually reported. | 840 | built needs to be manually reported. |
731 | 841 | ||
732 | BUILD_ARCH | 842 | BUILD_ARCH |
733 | Specifies the architecture of the build host (e.g. ``i686``). The | 843 | Specifies the architecture of the build host (e.g. ``i686``). The |
734 | OpenEmbedded build system sets the value of ``BUILD_ARCH`` from the | 844 | OpenEmbedded build system sets the value of ``BUILD_ARCH`` from the |
735 | machine name reported by the ``uname`` command. | 845 | machine name reported by the ``uname`` command. |
736 | 846 | ||
737 | BUILD_AS_ARCH | 847 | BUILD_AS_ARCH |
738 | Specifies the architecture-specific assembler flags for the build | 848 | Specifies the architecture-specific assembler flags for the build |
739 | host. By default, the value of ``BUILD_AS_ARCH`` is empty. | 849 | host. By default, the value of ``BUILD_AS_ARCH`` is empty. |
740 | 850 | ||
741 | BUILD_CC_ARCH | 851 | BUILD_CC_ARCH |
742 | Specifies the architecture-specific C compiler flags for the build | 852 | Specifies the architecture-specific C compiler flags for the build |
743 | host. By default, the value of ``BUILD_CC_ARCH`` is empty. | 853 | host. By default, the value of ``BUILD_CC_ARCH`` is empty. |
744 | 854 | ||
745 | BUILD_CCLD | 855 | BUILD_CCLD |
746 | Specifies the linker command to be used for the build host when the C | 856 | Specifies the linker command to be used for the build host when the C |
747 | compiler is being used as the linker. By default, ``BUILD_CCLD`` | 857 | compiler is being used as the linker. By default, ``BUILD_CCLD`` |
748 | points to GCC and passes as arguments the value of | 858 | points to GCC and passes as arguments the value of |
749 | :term:`BUILD_CC_ARCH`, assuming | 859 | :term:`BUILD_CC_ARCH`, assuming |
750 | ``BUILD_CC_ARCH`` is set. | 860 | ``BUILD_CC_ARCH`` is set. |
751 | 861 | ||
752 | BUILD_CFLAGS | 862 | BUILD_CFLAGS |
753 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler when building for the | 863 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler when building for the |
754 | build host. When building in the ``-native`` context, | 864 | build host. When building in the ``-native`` context, |
755 | :term:`CFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable by | 865 | :term:`CFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable by |
756 | default. | 866 | default. |
757 | 867 | ||
758 | BUILD_CPPFLAGS | 868 | BUILD_CPPFLAGS |
759 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C preprocessor (i.e. to both the C | 869 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C preprocessor (i.e. to both the C |
760 | and the C++ compilers) when building for the build host. When | 870 | and the C++ compilers) when building for the build host. When |
761 | building in the ``-native`` context, :term:`CPPFLAGS` | 871 | building in the ``-native`` context, :term:`CPPFLAGS` |
762 | is set to the value of this variable by default. | 872 | is set to the value of this variable by default. |
763 | 873 | ||
764 | BUILD_CXXFLAGS | 874 | BUILD_CXXFLAGS |
765 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler when building for the | 875 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler when building for the |
766 | build host. When building in the ``-native`` context, | 876 | build host. When building in the ``-native`` context, |
767 | :term:`CXXFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable | 877 | :term:`CXXFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable |
768 | by default. | 878 | by default. |
769 | 879 | ||
770 | BUILD_FC | 880 | BUILD_FC |
771 | Specifies the Fortran compiler command for the build host. By | 881 | Specifies the Fortran compiler command for the build host. By |
772 | default, ``BUILD_FC`` points to Gfortran and passes as arguments the | 882 | default, ``BUILD_FC`` points to Gfortran and passes as arguments the |
773 | value of :term:`BUILD_CC_ARCH`, assuming | 883 | value of :term:`BUILD_CC_ARCH`, assuming |
774 | ``BUILD_CC_ARCH`` is set. | 884 | ``BUILD_CC_ARCH`` is set. |
775 | 885 | ||
776 | BUILD_LD | 886 | BUILD_LD |
777 | Specifies the linker command for the build host. By default, | 887 | Specifies the linker command for the build host. By default, |
778 | ``BUILD_LD`` points to the GNU linker (ld) and passes as arguments | 888 | ``BUILD_LD`` points to the GNU linker (ld) and passes as arguments |
779 | the value of :term:`BUILD_LD_ARCH`, assuming | 889 | the value of :term:`BUILD_LD_ARCH`, assuming |
780 | ``BUILD_LD_ARCH`` is set. | 890 | ``BUILD_LD_ARCH`` is set. |
781 | 891 | ||
782 | BUILD_LD_ARCH | 892 | BUILD_LD_ARCH |
783 | Specifies architecture-specific linker flags for the build host. By | 893 | Specifies architecture-specific linker flags for the build host. By |
784 | default, the value of ``BUILD_LD_ARCH`` is empty. | 894 | default, the value of ``BUILD_LD_ARCH`` is empty. |
785 | 895 | ||
786 | BUILD_LDFLAGS | 896 | BUILD_LDFLAGS |
787 | Specifies the flags to pass to the linker when building for the build | 897 | Specifies the flags to pass to the linker when building for the build |
788 | host. When building in the ``-native`` context, | 898 | host. When building in the ``-native`` context, |
789 | :term:`LDFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable | 899 | :term:`LDFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable |
790 | by default. | 900 | by default. |
791 | 901 | ||
792 | BUILD_OPTIMIZATION | 902 | BUILD_OPTIMIZATION |
793 | Specifies the optimization flags passed to the C compiler when | 903 | Specifies the optimization flags passed to the C compiler when |
794 | building for the build host or the SDK. The flags are passed through | 904 | building for the build host or the SDK. The flags are passed through |
795 | the :term:`BUILD_CFLAGS` and | 905 | the :term:`BUILD_CFLAGS` and |
796 | :term:`BUILDSDK_CFLAGS` default values. | 906 | :term:`BUILDSDK_CFLAGS` default values. |
797 | 907 | ||
798 | The default value of the ``BUILD_OPTIMIZATION`` variable is "-O2 | 908 | The default value of the ``BUILD_OPTIMIZATION`` variable is "-O2 |
799 | -pipe". | 909 | -pipe". |
800 | 910 | ||
801 | BUILD_OS | 911 | BUILD_OS |
802 | Specifies the operating system in use on the build host (e.g. | 912 | Specifies the operating system in use on the build host (e.g. |
803 | "linux"). The OpenEmbedded build system sets the value of | 913 | "linux"). The OpenEmbedded build system sets the value of |
804 | ``BUILD_OS`` from the OS reported by the ``uname`` command - the | 914 | ``BUILD_OS`` from the OS reported by the ``uname`` command - the |
805 | first word, converted to lower-case characters. | 915 | first word, converted to lower-case characters. |
806 | 916 | ||
807 | BUILD_PREFIX | 917 | BUILD_PREFIX |
808 | The toolchain binary prefix used for native recipes. The OpenEmbedded | 918 | The toolchain binary prefix used for native recipes. The OpenEmbedded |
809 | build system uses the ``BUILD_PREFIX`` value to set the | 919 | build system uses the ``BUILD_PREFIX`` value to set the |
810 | :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` when building for | 920 | :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` when building for |
811 | ``native`` recipes. | 921 | ``native`` recipes. |
812 | 922 | ||
813 | BUILD_STRIP | 923 | BUILD_STRIP |
814 | Specifies the command to be used to strip debugging symbols from | 924 | Specifies the command to be used to strip debugging symbols from |
815 | binaries produced for the build host. By default, ``BUILD_STRIP`` | 925 | binaries produced for the build host. By default, ``BUILD_STRIP`` |
816 | points to | 926 | points to |
817 | ``${``\ :term:`BUILD_PREFIX`\ ``}strip``. | 927 | ``${``\ :term:`BUILD_PREFIX`\ ``}strip``. |
818 | 928 | ||
819 | BUILD_SYS | 929 | BUILD_SYS |
820 | Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating | 930 | Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating |
821 | system, to use when building for the build host (i.e. when building | 931 | system, to use when building for the build host (i.e. when building |
822 | ``native`` recipes). | 932 | ``native`` recipes). |
823 | 933 | ||
824 | The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based | 934 | The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based |
825 | on :term:`BUILD_ARCH`, | 935 | on :term:`BUILD_ARCH`, |
826 | :term:`BUILD_VENDOR`, and | 936 | :term:`BUILD_VENDOR`, and |
827 | :term:`BUILD_OS`. You do not need to set the | 937 | :term:`BUILD_OS`. You do not need to set the |
828 | ``BUILD_SYS`` variable yourself. | 938 | ``BUILD_SYS`` variable yourself. |
829 | 939 | ||
830 | BUILD_VENDOR | 940 | BUILD_VENDOR |
831 | Specifies the vendor name to use when building for the build host. | 941 | Specifies the vendor name to use when building for the build host. |
832 | The default value is an empty string (""). | 942 | The default value is an empty string (""). |
833 | 943 | ||
834 | BUILDDIR | 944 | BUILDDIR |
835 | Points to the location of the :term:`Build Directory`. | 945 | Points to the location of the :term:`Build Directory`. |
836 | You can define this directory indirectly through the | 946 | You can define this directory indirectly through the |
@@ -838,7 +948,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
838 | Directory path when you run the script. If you run the script and do | 948 | Directory path when you run the script. If you run the script and do |
839 | not provide a Build Directory path, the ``BUILDDIR`` defaults to | 949 | not provide a Build Directory path, the ``BUILDDIR`` defaults to |
840 | ``build`` in the current directory. | 950 | ``build`` in the current directory. |
841 | 951 | ||
842 | BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT | 952 | BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT |
843 | When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` | 953 | When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` |
844 | class, this variable specifies whether or not to commit the build | 954 | class, this variable specifies whether or not to commit the build |
@@ -848,60 +958,70 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
848 | top-level subdirectory of the build history output (images, packages, | 958 | top-level subdirectory of the build history output (images, packages, |
849 | and sdk). If you want to track changes to build history over time, | 959 | and sdk). If you want to track changes to build history over time, |
850 | you should set this value to "1". | 960 | you should set this value to "1". |
851 | 961 | ||
852 | By default, the ``buildhistory`` class does not commit the build | 962 | By default, the ``buildhistory`` class does not commit the build |
853 | history output in a local Git repository: BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT ?= "0" | 963 | history output in a local Git repository: |
854 | 964 | :: | |
965 | |||
966 | BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT ?= "0" | ||
967 | |||
855 | BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR | 968 | BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR |
856 | When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` | 969 | When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` |
857 | class, this variable specifies the author to use for each Git commit. | 970 | class, this variable specifies the author to use for each Git commit. |
858 | In order for the ``BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR`` variable to work, the | 971 | In order for the ``BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR`` variable to work, the |
859 | :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT` variable must | 972 | :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT` variable must |
860 | be set to "1". | 973 | be set to "1". |
861 | 974 | ||
862 | Git requires that the value you provide for the | 975 | Git requires that the value you provide for the |
863 | ``BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR`` variable takes the form of "name | 976 | ``BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR`` variable takes the form of "name |
864 | email@host". Providing an email address or host that is not valid | 977 | email@host". Providing an email address or host that is not valid |
865 | does not produce an error. | 978 | does not produce an error. |
866 | 979 | ||
867 | By default, the ``buildhistory`` class sets the variable as follows: | 980 | By default, the ``buildhistory`` class sets the variable as follows: |
868 | BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR ?= "buildhistory <buildhistory@${DISTRO}>" | 981 | :: |
869 | 982 | ||
983 | BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT_AUTHOR ?= "buildhistory <buildhistory@${DISTRO}>" | ||
984 | |||
870 | BUILDHISTORY_DIR | 985 | BUILDHISTORY_DIR |
871 | When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` | 986 | When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` |
872 | class, this variable specifies the directory in which build history | 987 | class, this variable specifies the directory in which build history |
873 | information is kept. For more information on how the variable works, | 988 | information is kept. For more information on how the variable works, |
874 | see the ``buildhistory.class``. | 989 | see the ``buildhistory.class``. |
875 | 990 | ||
876 | By default, the ``buildhistory`` class sets the directory as follows: | 991 | By default, the ``buildhistory`` class sets the directory as follows: |
877 | BUILDHISTORY_DIR ?= "${TOPDIR}/buildhistory" | 992 | :: |
878 | 993 | ||
994 | BUILDHISTORY_DIR ?= "${TOPDIR}/buildhistory" | ||
995 | |||
879 | BUILDHISTORY_FEATURES | 996 | BUILDHISTORY_FEATURES |
880 | When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` | 997 | When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` |
881 | class, this variable specifies the build history features to be | 998 | class, this variable specifies the build history features to be |
882 | enabled. For more information on how build history works, see the | 999 | enabled. For more information on how build history works, see the |
883 | "`Maintaining Build Output | 1000 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:maintaining build output quality`" |
884 | Quality <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#maintaining-build-output-quality>`__" | ||
885 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 1001 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
886 | 1002 | ||
887 | You can specify these features in the form of a space-separated list: | 1003 | You can specify these features in the form of a space-separated list: |
888 | 1004 | ||
889 | - *image:* Analysis of the contents of images, which includes the | 1005 | - *image:* Analysis of the contents of images, which includes the |
890 | list of installed packages among other things. | 1006 | list of installed packages among other things. |
891 | 1007 | ||
892 | - *package:* Analysis of the contents of individual packages. | 1008 | - *package:* Analysis of the contents of individual packages. |
893 | 1009 | ||
894 | - *sdk:* Analysis of the contents of the software development kit | 1010 | - *sdk:* Analysis of the contents of the software development kit |
895 | (SDK). | 1011 | (SDK). |
896 | 1012 | ||
897 | - *task:* Save output file signatures for `shared | 1013 | - *task:* Save output file signatures for |
898 | state <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#shared-state-cache>`__ (sstate) tasks. | 1014 | :ref:`shared state <overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:shared state cache>` |
1015 | (sstate) tasks. | ||
899 | This saves one file per task and lists the SHA-256 checksums for | 1016 | This saves one file per task and lists the SHA-256 checksums for |
900 | each file staged (i.e. the output of the task). | 1017 | each file staged (i.e. the output of the task). |
901 | 1018 | ||
902 | By default, the ``buildhistory`` class enables the following | 1019 | By default, the ``buildhistory`` class enables the following |
903 | features: BUILDHISTORY_FEATURES ?= "image package sdk" | 1020 | features: |
904 | 1021 | :: | |
1022 | |||
1023 | BUILDHISTORY_FEATURES ?= "image package sdk" | ||
1024 | |||
905 | BUILDHISTORY_IMAGE_FILES | 1025 | BUILDHISTORY_IMAGE_FILES |
906 | When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` | 1026 | When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` |
907 | class, this variable specifies a list of paths to files copied from | 1027 | class, this variable specifies a list of paths to files copied from |
@@ -912,10 +1032,13 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
912 | changes in user and group entries. You can modify the list to include | 1032 | changes in user and group entries. You can modify the list to include |
913 | any file. Specifying an invalid path does not produce an error. | 1033 | any file. Specifying an invalid path does not produce an error. |
914 | Consequently, you can include files that might not always be present. | 1034 | Consequently, you can include files that might not always be present. |
915 | 1035 | ||
916 | By default, the ``buildhistory`` class provides paths to the | 1036 | By default, the ``buildhistory`` class provides paths to the |
917 | following files: BUILDHISTORY_IMAGE_FILES ?= "/etc/passwd /etc/group" | 1037 | following files: |
918 | 1038 | :: | |
1039 | |||
1040 | BUILDHISTORY_IMAGE_FILES ?= "/etc/passwd /etc/group" | ||
1041 | |||
919 | BUILDHISTORY_PUSH_REPO | 1042 | BUILDHISTORY_PUSH_REPO |
920 | When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` | 1043 | When inheriting the :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>` |
921 | class, this variable optionally specifies a remote repository to | 1044 | class, this variable optionally specifies a remote repository to |
@@ -923,81 +1046,83 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
923 | ``BUILDHISTORY_PUSH_REPO`` to work, | 1046 | ``BUILDHISTORY_PUSH_REPO`` to work, |
924 | :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT` must be set to | 1047 | :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT` must be set to |
925 | "1". | 1048 | "1". |
926 | 1049 | ||
927 | The repository should correspond to a remote address that specifies a | 1050 | The repository should correspond to a remote address that specifies a |
928 | repository as understood by Git, or alternatively to a remote name | 1051 | repository as understood by Git, or alternatively to a remote name |
929 | that you have set up manually using ``git remote`` within the local | 1052 | that you have set up manually using ``git remote`` within the local |
930 | repository. | 1053 | repository. |
931 | 1054 | ||
932 | By default, the ``buildhistory`` class sets the variable as follows: | 1055 | By default, the ``buildhistory`` class sets the variable as follows: |
933 | BUILDHISTORY_PUSH_REPO ?= "" | 1056 | :: |
934 | 1057 | ||
1058 | BUILDHISTORY_PUSH_REPO ?= "" | ||
1059 | |||
935 | BUILDSDK_CFLAGS | 1060 | BUILDSDK_CFLAGS |
936 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler when building for the | 1061 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler when building for the |
937 | SDK. When building in the ``nativesdk-`` context, | 1062 | SDK. When building in the ``nativesdk-`` context, |
938 | :term:`CFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable by | 1063 | :term:`CFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable by |
939 | default. | 1064 | default. |
940 | 1065 | ||
941 | BUILDSDK_CPPFLAGS | 1066 | BUILDSDK_CPPFLAGS |
942 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C pre-processor (i.e. to both the | 1067 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C pre-processor (i.e. to both the |
943 | C and the C++ compilers) when building for the SDK. When building in | 1068 | C and the C++ compilers) when building for the SDK. When building in |
944 | the ``nativesdk-`` context, :term:`CPPFLAGS` is set | 1069 | the ``nativesdk-`` context, :term:`CPPFLAGS` is set |
945 | to the value of this variable by default. | 1070 | to the value of this variable by default. |
946 | 1071 | ||
947 | BUILDSDK_CXXFLAGS | 1072 | BUILDSDK_CXXFLAGS |
948 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler when building for the | 1073 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler when building for the |
949 | SDK. When building in the ``nativesdk-`` context, | 1074 | SDK. When building in the ``nativesdk-`` context, |
950 | :term:`CXXFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable | 1075 | :term:`CXXFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable |
951 | by default. | 1076 | by default. |
952 | 1077 | ||
953 | BUILDSDK_LDFLAGS | 1078 | BUILDSDK_LDFLAGS |
954 | Specifies the flags to pass to the linker when building for the SDK. | 1079 | Specifies the flags to pass to the linker when building for the SDK. |
955 | When building in the ``nativesdk-`` context, | 1080 | When building in the ``nativesdk-`` context, |
956 | :term:`LDFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable | 1081 | :term:`LDFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable |
957 | by default. | 1082 | by default. |
958 | 1083 | ||
959 | BUILDSTATS_BASE | 1084 | BUILDSTATS_BASE |
960 | Points to the location of the directory that holds build statistics | 1085 | Points to the location of the directory that holds build statistics |
961 | when you use and enable the | 1086 | when you use and enable the |
962 | :ref:`buildstats <ref-classes-buildstats>` class. The | 1087 | :ref:`buildstats <ref-classes-buildstats>` class. The |
963 | ``BUILDSTATS_BASE`` directory defaults to | 1088 | ``BUILDSTATS_BASE`` directory defaults to |
964 | ``${``\ :term:`TMPDIR`\ ``}/buildstats/``. | 1089 | ``${``\ :term:`TMPDIR`\ ``}/buildstats/``. |
965 | 1090 | ||
966 | BUSYBOX_SPLIT_SUID | 1091 | BUSYBOX_SPLIT_SUID |
967 | For the BusyBox recipe, specifies whether to split the output | 1092 | For the BusyBox recipe, specifies whether to split the output |
968 | executable file into two parts: one for features that require | 1093 | executable file into two parts: one for features that require |
969 | ``setuid root``, and one for the remaining features (i.e. those that | 1094 | ``setuid root``, and one for the remaining features (i.e. those that |
970 | do not require ``setuid root``). | 1095 | do not require ``setuid root``). |
971 | 1096 | ||
972 | The ``BUSYBOX_SPLIT_SUID`` variable defaults to "1", which results in | 1097 | The ``BUSYBOX_SPLIT_SUID`` variable defaults to "1", which results in |
973 | splitting the output executable file. Set the variable to "0" to get | 1098 | splitting the output executable file. Set the variable to "0" to get |
974 | a single output executable file. | 1099 | a single output executable file. |
975 | 1100 | ||
976 | CACHE | 1101 | CACHE |
977 | Specifies the directory BitBake uses to store a cache of the | 1102 | Specifies the directory BitBake uses to store a cache of the |
978 | :term:`Metadata` so it does not need to be parsed every time | 1103 | :term:`Metadata` so it does not need to be parsed every time |
979 | BitBake is started. | 1104 | BitBake is started. |
980 | 1105 | ||
981 | CC | 1106 | CC |
982 | The minimal command and arguments used to run the C compiler. | 1107 | The minimal command and arguments used to run the C compiler. |
983 | 1108 | ||
984 | CFLAGS | 1109 | CFLAGS |
985 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler. This variable is | 1110 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler. This variable is |
986 | exported to an environment variable and thus made visible to the | 1111 | exported to an environment variable and thus made visible to the |
987 | software being built during the compilation step. | 1112 | software being built during the compilation step. |
988 | 1113 | ||
989 | Default initialization for ``CFLAGS`` varies depending on what is | 1114 | Default initialization for ``CFLAGS`` varies depending on what is |
990 | being built: | 1115 | being built: |
991 | 1116 | ||
992 | - :term:`TARGET_CFLAGS` when building for the | 1117 | - :term:`TARGET_CFLAGS` when building for the |
993 | target | 1118 | target |
994 | 1119 | ||
995 | - :term:`BUILD_CFLAGS` when building for the | 1120 | - :term:`BUILD_CFLAGS` when building for the |
996 | build host (i.e. ``-native``) | 1121 | build host (i.e. ``-native``) |
997 | 1122 | ||
998 | - :term:`BUILDSDK_CFLAGS` when building for | 1123 | - :term:`BUILDSDK_CFLAGS` when building for |
999 | an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``) | 1124 | an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``) |
1000 | 1125 | ||
1001 | CLASSOVERRIDE | 1126 | CLASSOVERRIDE |
1002 | An internal variable specifying the special class override that | 1127 | An internal variable specifying the special class override that |
1003 | should currently apply (e.g. "class-target", "class-native", and so | 1128 | should currently apply (e.g. "class-target", "class-native", and so |
@@ -1005,31 +1130,41 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1005 | :ref:`native <ref-classes-native>`, | 1130 | :ref:`native <ref-classes-native>`, |
1006 | :ref:`nativesdk <ref-classes-nativesdk>`, and so forth) set the | 1131 | :ref:`nativesdk <ref-classes-nativesdk>`, and so forth) set the |
1007 | variable to appropriate values. | 1132 | variable to appropriate values. |
1008 | 1133 | ||
1009 | .. note:: | 1134 | .. note:: |
1010 | 1135 | ||
1011 | CLASSOVERRIDE | 1136 | CLASSOVERRIDE |
1012 | gets its default "class-target" value from the | 1137 | gets its default "class-target" value from the |
1013 | bitbake.conf | 1138 | bitbake.conf |
1014 | file. | 1139 | file. |
1015 | 1140 | ||
1016 | As an example, the following override allows you to install extra | 1141 | As an example, the following override allows you to install extra |
1017 | files, but only when building for the target: | 1142 | files, but only when building for the target: |
1018 | do_install_append_class-target() { install my-extra-file | 1143 | :: |
1019 | ${D}${sysconfdir} } Here is an example where ``FOO`` is set to | 1144 | |
1145 | do_install_append_class-target() { | ||
1146 | install my-extra-file ${D}${sysconfdir} | ||
1147 | } | ||
1148 | |||
1149 | Here is an example where ``FOO`` is set to | ||
1020 | "native" when building for the build host, and to "other" when not | 1150 | "native" when building for the build host, and to "other" when not |
1021 | building for the build host: FOO_class-native = "native" FOO = | 1151 | building for the build host: |
1022 | "other" The underlying mechanism behind ``CLASSOVERRIDE`` is simply | 1152 | :: |
1153 | |||
1154 | FOO_class-native = "native" | ||
1155 | FOO = "other" | ||
1156 | |||
1157 | The underlying mechanism behind ``CLASSOVERRIDE`` is simply | ||
1023 | that it is included in the default value of | 1158 | that it is included in the default value of |
1024 | :term:`OVERRIDES`. | 1159 | :term:`OVERRIDES`. |
1025 | 1160 | ||
1026 | CLEANBROKEN | 1161 | CLEANBROKEN |
1027 | If set to "1" within a recipe, ``CLEANBROKEN`` specifies that the | 1162 | If set to "1" within a recipe, ``CLEANBROKEN`` specifies that the |
1028 | ``make clean`` command does not work for the software being built. | 1163 | ``make clean`` command does not work for the software being built. |
1029 | Consequently, the OpenEmbedded build system will not try to run | 1164 | Consequently, the OpenEmbedded build system will not try to run |
1030 | ``make clean`` during the :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` | 1165 | ``make clean`` during the :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` |
1031 | task, which is the default behavior. | 1166 | task, which is the default behavior. |
1032 | 1167 | ||
1033 | COMBINED_FEATURES | 1168 | COMBINED_FEATURES |
1034 | Provides a list of hardware features that are enabled in both | 1169 | Provides a list of hardware features that are enabled in both |
1035 | :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES` and | 1170 | :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES` and |
@@ -1039,12 +1174,12 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1039 | "bluetooth" feature requires hardware support but should also be | 1174 | "bluetooth" feature requires hardware support but should also be |
1040 | optional at the distribution level, in case the hardware supports | 1175 | optional at the distribution level, in case the hardware supports |
1041 | Bluetooth but you do not ever intend to use it. | 1176 | Bluetooth but you do not ever intend to use it. |
1042 | 1177 | ||
1043 | COMMON_LICENSE_DIR | 1178 | COMMON_LICENSE_DIR |
1044 | Points to ``meta/files/common-licenses`` in the | 1179 | Points to ``meta/files/common-licenses`` in the |
1045 | :term:`Source Directory`, which is where generic license | 1180 | :term:`Source Directory`, which is where generic license |
1046 | files reside. | 1181 | files reside. |
1047 | 1182 | ||
1048 | COMPATIBLE_HOST | 1183 | COMPATIBLE_HOST |
1049 | A regular expression that resolves to one or more hosts (when the | 1184 | A regular expression that resolves to one or more hosts (when the |
1050 | recipe is native) or one or more targets (when the recipe is | 1185 | recipe is native) or one or more targets (when the recipe is |
@@ -1055,7 +1190,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1055 | particularly useful with kernels. The variable also helps to increase | 1190 | particularly useful with kernels. The variable also helps to increase |
1056 | parsing speed since the build system skips parsing recipes not | 1191 | parsing speed since the build system skips parsing recipes not |
1057 | compatible with the current system. | 1192 | compatible with the current system. |
1058 | 1193 | ||
1059 | COMPATIBLE_MACHINE | 1194 | COMPATIBLE_MACHINE |
1060 | A regular expression that resolves to one or more target machines | 1195 | A regular expression that resolves to one or more target machines |
1061 | with which a recipe is compatible. The regular expression is matched | 1196 | with which a recipe is compatible. The regular expression is matched |
@@ -1065,14 +1200,14 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1065 | useful with kernels. The variable also helps to increase parsing | 1200 | useful with kernels. The variable also helps to increase parsing |
1066 | speed since the build system skips parsing recipes not compatible | 1201 | speed since the build system skips parsing recipes not compatible |
1067 | with the current machine. | 1202 | with the current machine. |
1068 | 1203 | ||
1069 | COMPLEMENTARY_GLOB | 1204 | COMPLEMENTARY_GLOB |
1070 | Defines wildcards to match when installing a list of complementary | 1205 | Defines wildcards to match when installing a list of complementary |
1071 | packages for all the packages explicitly (or implicitly) installed in | 1206 | packages for all the packages explicitly (or implicitly) installed in |
1072 | an image. | 1207 | an image. |
1073 | 1208 | ||
1074 | .. note:: | 1209 | .. note:: |
1075 | 1210 | ||
1076 | The | 1211 | The |
1077 | COMPLEMENTARY_GLOB | 1212 | COMPLEMENTARY_GLOB |
1078 | variable uses Unix filename pattern matching ( | 1213 | variable uses Unix filename pattern matching ( |
@@ -1080,33 +1215,36 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1080 | ), which is similar to the Unix style pathname pattern expansion ( | 1215 | ), which is similar to the Unix style pathname pattern expansion ( |
1081 | glob | 1216 | glob |
1082 | ). | 1217 | ). |
1083 | 1218 | ||
1084 | The resulting list of complementary packages is associated with an | 1219 | The resulting list of complementary packages is associated with an |
1085 | item that can be added to | 1220 | item that can be added to |
1086 | :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`. An example usage of | 1221 | :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`. An example usage of |
1087 | this is the "dev-pkgs" item that when added to ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` | 1222 | this is the "dev-pkgs" item that when added to ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` |
1088 | will install -dev packages (containing headers and other development | 1223 | will install -dev packages (containing headers and other development |
1089 | files) for every package in the image. | 1224 | files) for every package in the image. |
1090 | 1225 | ||
1091 | To add a new feature item pointing to a wildcard, use a variable flag | 1226 | To add a new feature item pointing to a wildcard, use a variable flag |
1092 | to specify the feature item name and use the value to specify the | 1227 | to specify the feature item name and use the value to specify the |
1093 | wildcard. Here is an example: COMPLEMENTARY_GLOB[dev-pkgs] = '*-dev' | 1228 | wildcard. Here is an example: |
1094 | 1229 | :: | |
1230 | |||
1231 | COMPLEMENTARY_GLOB[dev-pkgs] = '*-dev' | ||
1232 | |||
1095 | COMPONENTS_DIR | 1233 | COMPONENTS_DIR |
1096 | Stores sysroot components for each recipe. The OpenEmbedded build | 1234 | Stores sysroot components for each recipe. The OpenEmbedded build |
1097 | system uses ``COMPONENTS_DIR`` when constructing recipe-specific | 1235 | system uses ``COMPONENTS_DIR`` when constructing recipe-specific |
1098 | sysroots for other recipes. | 1236 | sysroots for other recipes. |
1099 | 1237 | ||
1100 | The default is | 1238 | The default is |
1101 | "``${``\ :term:`STAGING_DIR`\ ``}-components``." | 1239 | "``${``\ :term:`STAGING_DIR`\ ``}-components``." |
1102 | (i.e. | 1240 | (i.e. |
1103 | "``${``\ :term:`TMPDIR`\ ``}/sysroots-components``"). | 1241 | "``${``\ :term:`TMPDIR`\ ``}/sysroots-components``"). |
1104 | 1242 | ||
1105 | CONF_VERSION | 1243 | CONF_VERSION |
1106 | Tracks the version of the local configuration file (i.e. | 1244 | Tracks the version of the local configuration file (i.e. |
1107 | ``local.conf``). The value for ``CONF_VERSION`` increments each time | 1245 | ``local.conf``). The value for ``CONF_VERSION`` increments each time |
1108 | ``build/conf/`` compatibility changes. | 1246 | ``build/conf/`` compatibility changes. |
1109 | 1247 | ||
1110 | CONFFILES | 1248 | CONFFILES |
1111 | Identifies editable or configurable files that are part of a package. | 1249 | Identifies editable or configurable files that are part of a package. |
1112 | If the Package Management System (PMS) is being used to update | 1250 | If the Package Management System (PMS) is being used to update |
@@ -1117,12 +1255,15 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1117 | as part of the package update process. You can use the ``CONFFILES`` | 1255 | as part of the package update process. You can use the ``CONFFILES`` |
1118 | variable to list the files in the package that you wish to prevent | 1256 | variable to list the files in the package that you wish to prevent |
1119 | the PMS from overwriting during this update process. | 1257 | the PMS from overwriting during this update process. |
1120 | 1258 | ||
1121 | To use the ``CONFFILES`` variable, provide a package name override | 1259 | To use the ``CONFFILES`` variable, provide a package name override |
1122 | that identifies the resulting package. Then, provide a | 1260 | that identifies the resulting package. Then, provide a |
1123 | space-separated list of files. Here is an example: CONFFILES_${PN} += | 1261 | space-separated list of files. Here is an example: |
1124 | "${sysconfdir}/file1 \\ ${sysconfdir}/file2 ${sysconfdir}/file3" | 1262 | :: |
1125 | 1263 | ||
1264 | CONFFILES_${PN} += "${sysconfdir}/file1 \ | ||
1265 | ${sysconfdir}/file2 ${sysconfdir}/file3" | ||
1266 | |||
1126 | A relationship exists between the ``CONFFILES`` and ``FILES`` | 1267 | A relationship exists between the ``CONFFILES`` and ``FILES`` |
1127 | variables. The files listed within ``CONFFILES`` must be a subset of | 1268 | variables. The files listed within ``CONFFILES`` must be a subset of |
1128 | the files listed within ``FILES``. Because the configuration files | 1269 | the files listed within ``FILES``. Because the configuration files |
@@ -1130,9 +1271,9 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1130 | the PMS will not overwrite them, it makes sense that the files must | 1271 | the PMS will not overwrite them, it makes sense that the files must |
1131 | already be included as part of the package through the ``FILES`` | 1272 | already be included as part of the package through the ``FILES`` |
1132 | variable. | 1273 | variable. |
1133 | 1274 | ||
1134 | .. note:: | 1275 | .. note:: |
1135 | 1276 | ||
1136 | When specifying paths as part of the | 1277 | When specifying paths as part of the |
1137 | CONFFILES | 1278 | CONFFILES |
1138 | variable, it is good practice to use appropriate path variables. | 1279 | variable, it is good practice to use appropriate path variables. |
@@ -1149,13 +1290,13 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1149 | file in the | 1290 | file in the |
1150 | Source Directory | 1291 | Source Directory |
1151 | . | 1292 | . |
1152 | 1293 | ||
1153 | CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE | 1294 | CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE |
1154 | Identifies the initial RAM filesystem (initramfs) source files. The | 1295 | Identifies the initial RAM filesystem (initramfs) source files. The |
1155 | OpenEmbedded build system receives and uses this kernel Kconfig | 1296 | OpenEmbedded build system receives and uses this kernel Kconfig |
1156 | variable as an environment variable. By default, the variable is set | 1297 | variable as an environment variable. By default, the variable is set |
1157 | to null (""). | 1298 | to null (""). |
1158 | 1299 | ||
1159 | The ``CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE`` can be either a single cpio archive | 1300 | The ``CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE`` can be either a single cpio archive |
1160 | with a ``.cpio`` suffix or a space-separated list of directories and | 1301 | with a ``.cpio`` suffix or a space-separated list of directories and |
1161 | files for building the initramfs image. A cpio archive should contain | 1302 | files for building the initramfs image. A cpio archive should contain |
@@ -1163,23 +1304,22 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1163 | should contain a filesystem layout to be included in the initramfs | 1304 | should contain a filesystem layout to be included in the initramfs |
1164 | image. Files should contain entries according to the format described | 1305 | image. Files should contain entries according to the format described |
1165 | by the ``usr/gen_init_cpio`` program in the kernel tree. | 1306 | by the ``usr/gen_init_cpio`` program in the kernel tree. |
1166 | 1307 | ||
1167 | If you specify multiple directories and files, the initramfs image | 1308 | If you specify multiple directories and files, the initramfs image |
1168 | will be the aggregate of all of them. | 1309 | will be the aggregate of all of them. |
1169 | 1310 | ||
1170 | For information on creating an initramfs, see the "`Building an | 1311 | For information on creating an initramfs, see the |
1171 | Initial RAM Filesystem (initramfs) | 1312 | ":ref:`building-an-initramfs-image`" section |
1172 | Image <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#building-an-initramfs-image>`__" section | ||
1173 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 1313 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
1174 | 1314 | ||
1175 | CONFIG_SITE | 1315 | CONFIG_SITE |
1176 | A list of files that contains ``autoconf`` test results relevant to | 1316 | A list of files that contains ``autoconf`` test results relevant to |
1177 | the current build. This variable is used by the Autotools utilities | 1317 | the current build. This variable is used by the Autotools utilities |
1178 | when running ``configure``. | 1318 | when running ``configure``. |
1179 | 1319 | ||
1180 | CONFIGURE_FLAGS | 1320 | CONFIGURE_FLAGS |
1181 | The minimal arguments for GNU configure. | 1321 | The minimal arguments for GNU configure. |
1182 | 1322 | ||
1183 | CONFLICT_DISTRO_FEATURES | 1323 | CONFLICT_DISTRO_FEATURES |
1184 | When inheriting the | 1324 | When inheriting the |
1185 | :ref:`distro_features_check <ref-classes-distro_features_check>` | 1325 | :ref:`distro_features_check <ref-classes-distro_features_check>` |
@@ -1188,7 +1328,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1188 | ``CONFLICT_DISTRO_FEATURES`` variable lists a feature that also | 1328 | ``CONFLICT_DISTRO_FEATURES`` variable lists a feature that also |
1189 | appears in ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` within the current configuration, an | 1329 | appears in ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` within the current configuration, an |
1190 | error occurs and the build stops. | 1330 | error occurs and the build stops. |
1191 | 1331 | ||
1192 | COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE | 1332 | COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE |
1193 | A space-separated list of licenses to exclude from the source | 1333 | A space-separated list of licenses to exclude from the source |
1194 | archived by the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. In | 1334 | archived by the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. In |
@@ -1196,32 +1336,32 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1196 | :term:`LICENSE` value is in the value of | 1336 | :term:`LICENSE` value is in the value of |
1197 | ``COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE``, then its source is not archived by the | 1337 | ``COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE``, then its source is not archived by the |
1198 | class. | 1338 | class. |
1199 | 1339 | ||
1200 | .. note:: | 1340 | .. note:: |
1201 | 1341 | ||
1202 | The | 1342 | The |
1203 | COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE | 1343 | COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE |
1204 | variable takes precedence over the | 1344 | variable takes precedence over the |
1205 | COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE | 1345 | COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE |
1206 | variable. | 1346 | variable. |
1207 | 1347 | ||
1208 | The default value, which is "CLOSED Proprietary", for | 1348 | The default value, which is "CLOSED Proprietary", for |
1209 | ``COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE`` is set by the | 1349 | ``COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE`` is set by the |
1210 | :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` class, which | 1350 | :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` class, which |
1211 | is inherited by the ``archiver`` class. | 1351 | is inherited by the ``archiver`` class. |
1212 | 1352 | ||
1213 | COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE | 1353 | COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE |
1214 | A space-separated list of licenses to include in the source archived | 1354 | A space-separated list of licenses to include in the source archived |
1215 | by the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. In other | 1355 | by the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. In other |
1216 | words, if a license in a recipe's :term:`LICENSE` | 1356 | words, if a license in a recipe's :term:`LICENSE` |
1217 | value is in the value of ``COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE``, then its | 1357 | value is in the value of ``COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE``, then its |
1218 | source is archived by the class. | 1358 | source is archived by the class. |
1219 | 1359 | ||
1220 | The default value is set by the | 1360 | The default value is set by the |
1221 | :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` class, which | 1361 | :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` class, which |
1222 | is inherited by the ``archiver`` class. The default value includes | 1362 | is inherited by the ``archiver`` class. The default value includes |
1223 | "GPL*", "LGPL*", and "AGPL*". | 1363 | "GPL*", "LGPL*", and "AGPL*". |
1224 | 1364 | ||
1225 | COPYLEFT_PN_EXCLUDE | 1365 | COPYLEFT_PN_EXCLUDE |
1226 | A list of recipes to exclude in the source archived by the | 1366 | A list of recipes to exclude in the source archived by the |
1227 | :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. The | 1367 | :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. The |
@@ -1230,12 +1370,12 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1230 | :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE` and | 1370 | :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE` and |
1231 | :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE` | 1371 | :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE` |
1232 | variables, respectively. | 1372 | variables, respectively. |
1233 | 1373 | ||
1234 | The default value, which is "" indicating to not explicitly exclude | 1374 | The default value, which is "" indicating to not explicitly exclude |
1235 | any recipes by name, for ``COPYLEFT_PN_EXCLUDE`` is set by the | 1375 | any recipes by name, for ``COPYLEFT_PN_EXCLUDE`` is set by the |
1236 | :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` class, which | 1376 | :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` class, which |
1237 | is inherited by the ``archiver`` class. | 1377 | is inherited by the ``archiver`` class. |
1238 | 1378 | ||
1239 | COPYLEFT_PN_INCLUDE | 1379 | COPYLEFT_PN_INCLUDE |
1240 | A list of recipes to include in the source archived by the | 1380 | A list of recipes to include in the source archived by the |
1241 | :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. The | 1381 | :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. The |
@@ -1244,22 +1384,22 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1244 | :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE` and | 1384 | :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_INCLUDE` and |
1245 | :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE` | 1385 | :term:`COPYLEFT_LICENSE_EXCLUDE` |
1246 | variables, respectively. | 1386 | variables, respectively. |
1247 | 1387 | ||
1248 | The default value, which is "" indicating to not explicitly include | 1388 | The default value, which is "" indicating to not explicitly include |
1249 | any recipes by name, for ``COPYLEFT_PN_INCLUDE`` is set by the | 1389 | any recipes by name, for ``COPYLEFT_PN_INCLUDE`` is set by the |
1250 | :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` class, which | 1390 | :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` class, which |
1251 | is inherited by the ``archiver`` class. | 1391 | is inherited by the ``archiver`` class. |
1252 | 1392 | ||
1253 | COPYLEFT_RECIPE_TYPES | 1393 | COPYLEFT_RECIPE_TYPES |
1254 | A space-separated list of recipe types to include in the source | 1394 | A space-separated list of recipe types to include in the source |
1255 | archived by the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. | 1395 | archived by the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class. |
1256 | Recipe types are ``target``, ``native``, ``nativesdk``, ``cross``, | 1396 | Recipe types are ``target``, ``native``, ``nativesdk``, ``cross``, |
1257 | ``crosssdk``, and ``cross-canadian``. | 1397 | ``crosssdk``, and ``cross-canadian``. |
1258 | 1398 | ||
1259 | The default value, which is "target*", for ``COPYLEFT_RECIPE_TYPES`` | 1399 | The default value, which is "target*", for ``COPYLEFT_RECIPE_TYPES`` |
1260 | is set by the :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` | 1400 | is set by the :ref:`copyleft_filter <ref-classes-copyleft_filter>` |
1261 | class, which is inherited by the ``archiver`` class. | 1401 | class, which is inherited by the ``archiver`` class. |
1262 | 1402 | ||
1263 | COPY_LIC_DIRS | 1403 | COPY_LIC_DIRS |
1264 | If set to "1" along with the | 1404 | If set to "1" along with the |
1265 | :term:`COPY_LIC_MANIFEST` variable, the | 1405 | :term:`COPY_LIC_MANIFEST` variable, the |
@@ -1267,9 +1407,9 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1267 | which are located in ``/usr/share/common-licenses``, for each | 1407 | which are located in ``/usr/share/common-licenses``, for each |
1268 | package. The license files are placed in directories within the image | 1408 | package. The license files are placed in directories within the image |
1269 | itself during build time. | 1409 | itself during build time. |
1270 | 1410 | ||
1271 | .. note:: | 1411 | .. note:: |
1272 | 1412 | ||
1273 | The | 1413 | The |
1274 | COPY_LIC_DIRS | 1414 | COPY_LIC_DIRS |
1275 | does not offer a path for adding licenses for newly installed | 1415 | does not offer a path for adding licenses for newly installed |
@@ -1280,15 +1420,15 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1280 | Providing License Text | 1420 | Providing License Text |
1281 | " section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for | 1421 | " section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for |
1282 | information on providing license text. | 1422 | information on providing license text. |
1283 | 1423 | ||
1284 | COPY_LIC_MANIFEST | 1424 | COPY_LIC_MANIFEST |
1285 | If set to "1", the OpenEmbedded build system copies the license | 1425 | If set to "1", the OpenEmbedded build system copies the license |
1286 | manifest for the image to | 1426 | manifest for the image to |
1287 | ``/usr/share/common-licenses/license.manifest`` within the image | 1427 | ``/usr/share/common-licenses/license.manifest`` within the image |
1288 | itself during build time. | 1428 | itself during build time. |
1289 | 1429 | ||
1290 | .. note:: | 1430 | .. note:: |
1291 | 1431 | ||
1292 | The | 1432 | The |
1293 | COPY_LIC_MANIFEST | 1433 | COPY_LIC_MANIFEST |
1294 | does not offer a path for adding licenses for newly installed | 1434 | does not offer a path for adding licenses for newly installed |
@@ -1299,177 +1439,190 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1299 | Providing License Text | 1439 | Providing License Text |
1300 | " section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for | 1440 | " section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for |
1301 | information on providing license text. | 1441 | information on providing license text. |
1302 | 1442 | ||
1303 | CORE_IMAGE_EXTRA_INSTALL | 1443 | CORE_IMAGE_EXTRA_INSTALL |
1304 | Specifies the list of packages to be added to the image. You should | 1444 | Specifies the list of packages to be added to the image. You should |
1305 | only set this variable in the ``local.conf`` configuration file found | 1445 | only set this variable in the ``local.conf`` configuration file found |
1306 | in the :term:`Build Directory`. | 1446 | in the :term:`Build Directory`. |
1307 | 1447 | ||
1308 | This variable replaces ``POKY_EXTRA_INSTALL``, which is no longer | 1448 | This variable replaces ``POKY_EXTRA_INSTALL``, which is no longer |
1309 | supported. | 1449 | supported. |
1310 | 1450 | ||
1311 | COREBASE | 1451 | COREBASE |
1312 | Specifies the parent directory of the OpenEmbedded-Core Metadata | 1452 | Specifies the parent directory of the OpenEmbedded-Core Metadata |
1313 | layer (i.e. ``meta``). | 1453 | layer (i.e. ``meta``). |
1314 | 1454 | ||
1315 | It is an important distinction that ``COREBASE`` points to the parent | 1455 | It is an important distinction that ``COREBASE`` points to the parent |
1316 | of this layer and not the layer itself. Consider an example where you | 1456 | of this layer and not the layer itself. Consider an example where you |
1317 | have cloned the Poky Git repository and retained the ``poky`` name | 1457 | have cloned the Poky Git repository and retained the ``poky`` name |
1318 | for your local copy of the repository. In this case, ``COREBASE`` | 1458 | for your local copy of the repository. In this case, ``COREBASE`` |
1319 | points to the ``poky`` folder because it is the parent directory of | 1459 | points to the ``poky`` folder because it is the parent directory of |
1320 | the ``poky/meta`` layer. | 1460 | the ``poky/meta`` layer. |
1321 | 1461 | ||
1322 | COREBASE_FILES | 1462 | COREBASE_FILES |
1323 | Lists files from the :term:`COREBASE` directory that | 1463 | Lists files from the :term:`COREBASE` directory that |
1324 | should be copied other than the layers listed in the | 1464 | should be copied other than the layers listed in the |
1325 | ``bblayers.conf`` file. The ``COREBASE_FILES`` variable exists for | 1465 | ``bblayers.conf`` file. The ``COREBASE_FILES`` variable exists for |
1326 | the purpose of copying metadata from the OpenEmbedded build system | 1466 | the purpose of copying metadata from the OpenEmbedded build system |
1327 | into the extensible SDK. | 1467 | into the extensible SDK. |
1328 | 1468 | ||
1329 | Explicitly listing files in ``COREBASE`` is needed because it | 1469 | Explicitly listing files in ``COREBASE`` is needed because it |
1330 | typically contains build directories and other files that should not | 1470 | typically contains build directories and other files that should not |
1331 | normally be copied into the extensible SDK. Consequently, the value | 1471 | normally be copied into the extensible SDK. Consequently, the value |
1332 | of ``COREBASE_FILES`` is used in order to only copy the files that | 1472 | of ``COREBASE_FILES`` is used in order to only copy the files that |
1333 | are actually needed. | 1473 | are actually needed. |
1334 | 1474 | ||
1335 | CPP | 1475 | CPP |
1336 | The minimal command and arguments used to run the C preprocessor. | 1476 | The minimal command and arguments used to run the C preprocessor. |
1337 | 1477 | ||
1338 | CPPFLAGS | 1478 | CPPFLAGS |
1339 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C pre-processor (i.e. to both the | 1479 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C pre-processor (i.e. to both the |
1340 | C and the C++ compilers). This variable is exported to an environment | 1480 | C and the C++ compilers). This variable is exported to an environment |
1341 | variable and thus made visible to the software being built during the | 1481 | variable and thus made visible to the software being built during the |
1342 | compilation step. | 1482 | compilation step. |
1343 | 1483 | ||
1344 | Default initialization for ``CPPFLAGS`` varies depending on what is | 1484 | Default initialization for ``CPPFLAGS`` varies depending on what is |
1345 | being built: | 1485 | being built: |
1346 | 1486 | ||
1347 | - :term:`TARGET_CPPFLAGS` when building for | 1487 | - :term:`TARGET_CPPFLAGS` when building for |
1348 | the target | 1488 | the target |
1349 | 1489 | ||
1350 | - :term:`BUILD_CPPFLAGS` when building for the | 1490 | - :term:`BUILD_CPPFLAGS` when building for the |
1351 | build host (i.e. ``-native``) | 1491 | build host (i.e. ``-native``) |
1352 | 1492 | ||
1353 | - :term:`BUILDSDK_CPPFLAGS` when building | 1493 | - :term:`BUILDSDK_CPPFLAGS` when building |
1354 | for an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``) | 1494 | for an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``) |
1355 | 1495 | ||
1356 | CROSS_COMPILE | 1496 | CROSS_COMPILE |
1357 | The toolchain binary prefix for the target tools. The | 1497 | The toolchain binary prefix for the target tools. The |
1358 | ``CROSS_COMPILE`` variable is the same as the | 1498 | ``CROSS_COMPILE`` variable is the same as the |
1359 | :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` variable. | 1499 | :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` variable. |
1360 | 1500 | ||
1361 | .. note:: | 1501 | .. note:: |
1362 | 1502 | ||
1363 | The OpenEmbedded build system sets the | 1503 | The OpenEmbedded build system sets the |
1364 | CROSS_COMPILE | 1504 | CROSS_COMPILE |
1365 | variable only in certain contexts (e.g. when building for kernel | 1505 | variable only in certain contexts (e.g. when building for kernel |
1366 | and kernel module recipes). | 1506 | and kernel module recipes). |
1367 | 1507 | ||
1368 | CVSDIR | 1508 | CVSDIR |
1369 | The directory in which files checked out under the CVS system are | 1509 | The directory in which files checked out under the CVS system are |
1370 | stored. | 1510 | stored. |
1371 | 1511 | ||
1372 | CXX | 1512 | CXX |
1373 | The minimal command and arguments used to run the C++ compiler. | 1513 | The minimal command and arguments used to run the C++ compiler. |
1374 | 1514 | ||
1375 | CXXFLAGS | 1515 | CXXFLAGS |
1376 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler. This variable is | 1516 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler. This variable is |
1377 | exported to an environment variable and thus made visible to the | 1517 | exported to an environment variable and thus made visible to the |
1378 | software being built during the compilation step. | 1518 | software being built during the compilation step. |
1379 | 1519 | ||
1380 | Default initialization for ``CXXFLAGS`` varies depending on what is | 1520 | Default initialization for ``CXXFLAGS`` varies depending on what is |
1381 | being built: | 1521 | being built: |
1382 | 1522 | ||
1383 | - :term:`TARGET_CXXFLAGS` when building for | 1523 | - :term:`TARGET_CXXFLAGS` when building for |
1384 | the target | 1524 | the target |
1385 | 1525 | ||
1386 | - :term:`BUILD_CXXFLAGS` when building for the | 1526 | - :term:`BUILD_CXXFLAGS` when building for the |
1387 | build host (i.e. ``-native``) | 1527 | build host (i.e. ``-native``) |
1388 | 1528 | ||
1389 | - :term:`BUILDSDK_CXXFLAGS` when building | 1529 | - :term:`BUILDSDK_CXXFLAGS` when building |
1390 | for an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``) | 1530 | for an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``) |
1391 | 1531 | ||
1392 | D | 1532 | D |
1393 | The destination directory. The location in the :term:`Build Directory` | 1533 | The destination directory. The location in the :term:`Build Directory` |
1394 | where components are installed by the | 1534 | where components are installed by the |
1395 | :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task. This location defaults | 1535 | :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task. This location defaults |
1396 | to: ${WORKDIR}/image | 1536 | to: |
1397 | 1537 | :: | |
1538 | |||
1539 | ${WORKDIR}/image | ||
1540 | |||
1398 | .. note:: | 1541 | .. note:: |
1399 | 1542 | ||
1400 | Tasks that read from or write to this directory should run under | 1543 | Tasks that read from or write to this directory should run under |
1401 | fakeroot | 1544 | fakeroot |
1402 | . | 1545 | . |
1403 | 1546 | ||
1404 | DATE | 1547 | DATE |
1405 | The date the build was started. Dates appear using the year, month, | 1548 | The date the build was started. Dates appear using the year, month, |
1406 | and day (YMD) format (e.g. "20150209" for February 9th, 2015). | 1549 | and day (YMD) format (e.g. "20150209" for February 9th, 2015). |
1407 | 1550 | ||
1408 | DATETIME | 1551 | DATETIME |
1409 | The date and time on which the current build started. The format is | 1552 | The date and time on which the current build started. The format is |
1410 | suitable for timestamps. | 1553 | suitable for timestamps. |
1411 | 1554 | ||
1412 | DEBIAN_NOAUTONAME | 1555 | DEBIAN_NOAUTONAME |
1413 | When the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class is inherited, | 1556 | When the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class is inherited, |
1414 | which is the default behavior, ``DEBIAN_NOAUTONAME`` specifies a | 1557 | which is the default behavior, ``DEBIAN_NOAUTONAME`` specifies a |
1415 | particular package should not be renamed according to Debian library | 1558 | particular package should not be renamed according to Debian library |
1416 | package naming. You must use the package name as an override when you | 1559 | package naming. You must use the package name as an override when you |
1417 | set this variable. Here is an example from the ``fontconfig`` recipe: | 1560 | set this variable. Here is an example from the ``fontconfig`` recipe: |
1418 | DEBIAN_NOAUTONAME_fontconfig-utils = "1" | 1561 | :: |
1419 | 1562 | ||
1563 | DEBIAN_NOAUTONAME_fontconfig-utils = "1" | ||
1564 | |||
1420 | DEBIANNAME | 1565 | DEBIANNAME |
1421 | When the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class is inherited, | 1566 | When the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class is inherited, |
1422 | which is the default behavior, ``DEBIANNAME`` allows you to override | 1567 | which is the default behavior, ``DEBIANNAME`` allows you to override |
1423 | the library name for an individual package. Overriding the library | 1568 | the library name for an individual package. Overriding the library |
1424 | name in these cases is rare. You must use the package name as an | 1569 | name in these cases is rare. You must use the package name as an |
1425 | override when you set this variable. Here is an example from the | 1570 | override when you set this variable. Here is an example from the |
1426 | ``dbus`` recipe: DEBIANNAME_${PN} = "dbus-1" | 1571 | ``dbus`` recipe: |
1427 | 1572 | :: | |
1573 | |||
1574 | DEBIANNAME_${PN} = "dbus-1" | ||
1575 | |||
1428 | DEBUG_BUILD | 1576 | DEBUG_BUILD |
1429 | Specifies to build packages with debugging information. This | 1577 | Specifies to build packages with debugging information. This |
1430 | influences the value of the ``SELECTED_OPTIMIZATION`` variable. | 1578 | influences the value of the ``SELECTED_OPTIMIZATION`` variable. |
1431 | 1579 | ||
1432 | DEBUG_OPTIMIZATION | 1580 | DEBUG_OPTIMIZATION |
1433 | The options to pass in ``TARGET_CFLAGS`` and ``CFLAGS`` when | 1581 | The options to pass in ``TARGET_CFLAGS`` and ``CFLAGS`` when |
1434 | compiling a system for debugging. This variable defaults to "-O | 1582 | compiling a system for debugging. This variable defaults to "-O |
1435 | -fno-omit-frame-pointer ${DEBUG_FLAGS} -pipe". | 1583 | -fno-omit-frame-pointer ${DEBUG_FLAGS} -pipe". |
1436 | 1584 | ||
1437 | DEFAULT_PREFERENCE | 1585 | DEFAULT_PREFERENCE |
1438 | Specifies a weak bias for recipe selection priority. | 1586 | Specifies a weak bias for recipe selection priority. |
1439 | 1587 | ||
1440 | The most common usage of this is variable is to set it to "-1" within | 1588 | The most common usage of this is variable is to set it to "-1" within |
1441 | a recipe for a development version of a piece of software. Using the | 1589 | a recipe for a development version of a piece of software. Using the |
1442 | variable in this way causes the stable version of the recipe to build | 1590 | variable in this way causes the stable version of the recipe to build |
1443 | by default in the absence of ``PREFERRED_VERSION`` being used to | 1591 | by default in the absence of ``PREFERRED_VERSION`` being used to |
1444 | build the development version. | 1592 | build the development version. |
1445 | 1593 | ||
1446 | .. note:: | 1594 | .. note:: |
1447 | 1595 | ||
1448 | The bias provided by | 1596 | The bias provided by |
1449 | DEFAULT_PREFERENCE | 1597 | DEFAULT_PREFERENCE |
1450 | is weak and is overridden by | 1598 | is weak and is overridden by |
1451 | BBFILE_PRIORITY | 1599 | BBFILE_PRIORITY |
1452 | if that variable is different between two layers that contain | 1600 | if that variable is different between two layers that contain |
1453 | different versions of the same recipe. | 1601 | different versions of the same recipe. |
1454 | 1602 | ||
1455 | DEFAULTTUNE | 1603 | DEFAULTTUNE |
1456 | The default CPU and Application Binary Interface (ABI) tunings (i.e. | 1604 | The default CPU and Application Binary Interface (ABI) tunings (i.e. |
1457 | the "tune") used by the OpenEmbedded build system. The | 1605 | the "tune") used by the OpenEmbedded build system. The |
1458 | ``DEFAULTTUNE`` helps define | 1606 | ``DEFAULTTUNE`` helps define |
1459 | :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. | 1607 | :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. |
1460 | 1608 | ||
1461 | The default tune is either implicitly or explicitly set by the | 1609 | The default tune is either implicitly or explicitly set by the |
1462 | machine (:term:`MACHINE`). However, you can override | 1610 | machine (:term:`MACHINE`). However, you can override |
1463 | the setting using available tunes as defined with | 1611 | the setting using available tunes as defined with |
1464 | :term:`AVAILTUNES`. | 1612 | :term:`AVAILTUNES`. |
1465 | 1613 | ||
1466 | DEPENDS | 1614 | DEPENDS |
1467 | Lists a recipe's build-time dependencies. These are dependencies on | 1615 | Lists a recipe's build-time dependencies. These are dependencies on |
1468 | other recipes whose contents (e.g. headers and shared libraries) are | 1616 | other recipes whose contents (e.g. headers and shared libraries) are |
1469 | needed by the recipe at build time. | 1617 | needed by the recipe at build time. |
1470 | 1618 | ||
1471 | As an example, consider a recipe ``foo`` that contains the following | 1619 | As an example, consider a recipe ``foo`` that contains the following |
1472 | assignment: DEPENDS = "bar" The practical effect of the previous | 1620 | assignment: |
1621 | :: | ||
1622 | |||
1623 | DEPENDS = "bar" | ||
1624 | |||
1625 | The practical effect of the previous | ||
1473 | assignment is that all files installed by bar will be available in | 1626 | assignment is that all files installed by bar will be available in |
1474 | the appropriate staging sysroot, given by the | 1627 | the appropriate staging sysroot, given by the |
1475 | :term:`STAGING_DIR* <STAGING_DIR>` variables, by the time the | 1628 | :term:`STAGING_DIR* <STAGING_DIR>` variables, by the time the |
@@ -1479,23 +1632,28 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1479 | each recipe listed in ``DEPENDS``, through a | 1632 | each recipe listed in ``DEPENDS``, through a |
1480 | ``[``\ :ref:`deptask <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:variable flags>`\ ``]`` | 1633 | ``[``\ :ref:`deptask <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:variable flags>`\ ``]`` |
1481 | declaration in the :ref:`base <ref-classes-base>` class. | 1634 | declaration in the :ref:`base <ref-classes-base>` class. |
1482 | 1635 | ||
1483 | .. note:: | 1636 | .. note:: |
1484 | 1637 | ||
1485 | It seldom is necessary to reference, for example, | 1638 | It seldom is necessary to reference, for example, |
1486 | STAGING_DIR_HOST | 1639 | STAGING_DIR_HOST |
1487 | explicitly. The standard classes and build-related variables are | 1640 | explicitly. The standard classes and build-related variables are |
1488 | configured to automatically use the appropriate staging sysroots. | 1641 | configured to automatically use the appropriate staging sysroots. |
1489 | 1642 | ||
1490 | As another example, ``DEPENDS`` can also be used to add utilities | 1643 | As another example, ``DEPENDS`` can also be used to add utilities |
1491 | that run on the build machine during the build. For example, a recipe | 1644 | that run on the build machine during the build. For example, a recipe |
1492 | that makes use of a code generator built by the recipe ``codegen`` | 1645 | that makes use of a code generator built by the recipe ``codegen`` |
1493 | might have the following: DEPENDS = "codegen-native" For more | 1646 | might have the following: |
1647 | :: | ||
1648 | |||
1649 | DEPENDS = "codegen-native" | ||
1650 | |||
1651 | For more | ||
1494 | information, see the :ref:`native <ref-classes-native>` class and | 1652 | information, see the :ref:`native <ref-classes-native>` class and |
1495 | the :term:`EXTRANATIVEPATH` variable. | 1653 | the :term:`EXTRANATIVEPATH` variable. |
1496 | 1654 | ||
1497 | .. note:: | 1655 | .. note:: |
1498 | 1656 | ||
1499 | - ``DEPENDS`` is a list of recipe names. Or, to be more precise, | 1657 | - ``DEPENDS`` is a list of recipe names. Or, to be more precise, |
1500 | it is a list of :term:`PROVIDES` names, which | 1658 | it is a list of :term:`PROVIDES` names, which |
1501 | usually match recipe names. Putting a package name such as | 1659 | usually match recipe names. Putting a package name such as |
@@ -1503,16 +1661,15 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1503 | instead, as this will put files from all the packages that make | 1661 | instead, as this will put files from all the packages that make |
1504 | up ``foo``, which includes those from ``foo-dev``, into the | 1662 | up ``foo``, which includes those from ``foo-dev``, into the |
1505 | sysroot. | 1663 | sysroot. |
1506 | 1664 | ||
1507 | - One recipe having another recipe in ``DEPENDS`` does not by | 1665 | - One recipe having another recipe in ``DEPENDS`` does not by |
1508 | itself add any runtime dependencies between the packages | 1666 | itself add any runtime dependencies between the packages |
1509 | produced by the two recipes. However, as explained in the | 1667 | produced by the two recipes. However, as explained in the |
1510 | "`Automatically Added Runtime | 1668 | ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`" |
1511 | Dependencies <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#automatically-added-runtime-dependencies>`__" | ||
1512 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual, | 1669 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual, |
1513 | runtime dependencies will often be added automatically, meaning | 1670 | runtime dependencies will often be added automatically, meaning |
1514 | ``DEPENDS`` alone is sufficient for most recipes. | 1671 | ``DEPENDS`` alone is sufficient for most recipes. |
1515 | 1672 | ||
1516 | - Counterintuitively, ``DEPENDS`` is often necessary even for | 1673 | - Counterintuitively, ``DEPENDS`` is often necessary even for |
1517 | recipes that install precompiled components. For example, if | 1674 | recipes that install precompiled components. For example, if |
1518 | ``libfoo`` is a precompiled library that links against | 1675 | ``libfoo`` is a precompiled library that links against |
@@ -1521,50 +1678,51 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1521 | Without a ``DEPENDS`` from the recipe that installs ``libfoo`` | 1678 | Without a ``DEPENDS`` from the recipe that installs ``libfoo`` |
1522 | to the recipe that installs ``libbar``, other recipes might | 1679 | to the recipe that installs ``libbar``, other recipes might |
1523 | fail to link against ``libfoo``. | 1680 | fail to link against ``libfoo``. |
1524 | 1681 | ||
1525 | For information on runtime dependencies, see the | 1682 | For information on runtime dependencies, see the |
1526 | :term:`RDEPENDS` variable. You can also see the | 1683 | :term:`RDEPENDS` variable. You can also see the |
1527 | ":ref:`Tasks <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:tasks>`" and | 1684 | ":ref:`Tasks <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:tasks>`" and |
1528 | ":ref:`Dependencies <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-execution:dependencies>`" sections in the | 1685 | ":ref:`Dependencies <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-execution:dependencies>`" sections in the |
1529 | BitBake User Manual for additional information on tasks and | 1686 | BitBake User Manual for additional information on tasks and |
1530 | dependencies. | 1687 | dependencies. |
1531 | 1688 | ||
1532 | DEPLOY_DIR | 1689 | DEPLOY_DIR |
1533 | Points to the general area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to | 1690 | Points to the general area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to |
1534 | place images, packages, SDKs, and other output files that are ready | 1691 | place images, packages, SDKs, and other output files that are ready |
1535 | to be used outside of the build system. By default, this directory | 1692 | to be used outside of the build system. By default, this directory |
1536 | resides within the :term:`Build Directory` as | 1693 | resides within the :term:`Build Directory` as |
1537 | ``${TMPDIR}/deploy``. | 1694 | ``${TMPDIR}/deploy``. |
1538 | 1695 | ||
1539 | For more information on the structure of the Build Directory, see | 1696 | For more information on the structure of the Build Directory, see |
1540 | "`The Build Directory - ``build/`` <#structure-build>`__" section. | 1697 | ":ref:`ref-manual/ref-structure:the build directory - \`\`build/\`\``" section. |
1541 | For more detail on the contents of the ``deploy`` directory, see the | 1698 | For more detail on the contents of the ``deploy`` directory, see the |
1542 | "`Images <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#images-dev-environment>`__", "`Package | 1699 | ":ref:`Images <images-dev-environment>`", ":ref:`Package |
1543 | Feeds <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#package-feeds-dev-environment>`__", and | 1700 | Feeds <package-feeds-dev-environment>`", and |
1544 | "`Application Development | 1701 | ":ref:`sdk-dev-environment`" sections all in the |
1545 | SDK <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#sdk-dev-environment>`__" sections all in the | ||
1546 | Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. | 1702 | Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. |
1547 | 1703 | ||
1548 | DEPLOY_DIR_DEB | 1704 | DEPLOY_DIR_DEB |
1549 | Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place | 1705 | Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place |
1550 | Debian packages that are ready to be used outside of the build | 1706 | Debian packages that are ready to be used outside of the build |
1551 | system. This variable applies only when | 1707 | system. This variable applies only when |
1552 | :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains | 1708 | :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains |
1553 | "package_deb". | 1709 | "package_deb". |
1554 | 1710 | ||
1555 | The BitBake configuration file initially defines the | 1711 | The BitBake configuration file initially defines the |
1556 | ``DEPLOY_DIR_DEB`` variable as a sub-folder of | 1712 | ``DEPLOY_DIR_DEB`` variable as a sub-folder of |
1557 | :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`: DEPLOY_DIR_DEB = | 1713 | :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`: |
1558 | "${DEPLOY_DIR}/deb" | 1714 | :: |
1559 | 1715 | ||
1716 | DEPLOY_DIR_DEB = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/deb" | ||
1717 | |||
1560 | The :ref:`package_deb <ref-classes-package_deb>` class uses the | 1718 | The :ref:`package_deb <ref-classes-package_deb>` class uses the |
1561 | ``DEPLOY_DIR_DEB`` variable to make sure the | 1719 | ``DEPLOY_DIR_DEB`` variable to make sure the |
1562 | :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_deb` task | 1720 | :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_deb` task |
1563 | writes Debian packages into the appropriate folder. For more | 1721 | writes Debian packages into the appropriate folder. For more |
1564 | information on how packaging works, see the "`Package | 1722 | information on how packaging works, see the ":ref:`Package |
1565 | Feeds <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#package-feeds-dev-environment>`__" section | 1723 | Feeds <package-feeds-dev-environment>`" section |
1566 | in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. | 1724 | in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. |
1567 | 1725 | ||
1568 | DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE | 1726 | DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE |
1569 | Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place | 1727 | Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place |
1570 | images and other associated output files that are ready to be | 1728 | images and other associated output files that are ready to be |
@@ -1572,120 +1730,130 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1572 | as it contains the ``${MACHINE}`` name. By default, this directory | 1730 | as it contains the ``${MACHINE}`` name. By default, this directory |
1573 | resides within the :term:`Build Directory` as | 1731 | resides within the :term:`Build Directory` as |
1574 | ``${DEPLOY_DIR}/images/${MACHINE}/``. | 1732 | ``${DEPLOY_DIR}/images/${MACHINE}/``. |
1575 | 1733 | ||
1576 | For more information on the structure of the Build Directory, see | 1734 | For more information on the structure of the Build Directory, see |
1577 | "`The Build Directory - ``build/`` <#structure-build>`__" section. | 1735 | ":ref:`ref-manual/ref-structure:the build directory - \`\`build/\`\``" section. |
1578 | For more detail on the contents of the ``deploy`` directory, see the | 1736 | For more detail on the contents of the ``deploy`` directory, see the |
1579 | "`Images <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#images-dev-environment>`__" and | 1737 | ":ref:`Images <images-dev-environment>`" and |
1580 | "`Application Development | 1738 | ":ref:`sdk-dev-environment`" sections both in |
1581 | SDK <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#sdk-dev-environment>`__" sections both in | ||
1582 | the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. | 1739 | the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. |
1583 | 1740 | ||
1584 | DEPLOY_DIR_IPK | 1741 | DEPLOY_DIR_IPK |
1585 | Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place | 1742 | Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place |
1586 | IPK packages that are ready to be used outside of the build system. | 1743 | IPK packages that are ready to be used outside of the build system. |
1587 | This variable applies only when | 1744 | This variable applies only when |
1588 | :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains | 1745 | :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains |
1589 | "package_ipk". | 1746 | "package_ipk". |
1590 | 1747 | ||
1591 | The BitBake configuration file initially defines this variable as a | 1748 | The BitBake configuration file initially defines this variable as a |
1592 | sub-folder of :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`: DEPLOY_DIR_IPK = | 1749 | sub-folder of :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`: |
1593 | "${DEPLOY_DIR}/ipk" | 1750 | :: |
1594 | 1751 | ||
1752 | DEPLOY_DIR_IPK = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/ipk" | ||
1753 | |||
1595 | The :ref:`package_ipk <ref-classes-package_ipk>` class uses the | 1754 | The :ref:`package_ipk <ref-classes-package_ipk>` class uses the |
1596 | ``DEPLOY_DIR_IPK`` variable to make sure the | 1755 | ``DEPLOY_DIR_IPK`` variable to make sure the |
1597 | :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_ipk` task | 1756 | :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_ipk` task |
1598 | writes IPK packages into the appropriate folder. For more information | 1757 | writes IPK packages into the appropriate folder. For more information |
1599 | on how packaging works, see the "`Package | 1758 | on how packaging works, see the ":ref:`Package |
1600 | Feeds <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#package-feeds-dev-environment>`__" section | 1759 | Feeds <package-feeds-dev-environment>`" section |
1601 | in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. | 1760 | in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. |
1602 | 1761 | ||
1603 | DEPLOY_DIR_RPM | 1762 | DEPLOY_DIR_RPM |
1604 | Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place | 1763 | Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place |
1605 | RPM packages that are ready to be used outside of the build system. | 1764 | RPM packages that are ready to be used outside of the build system. |
1606 | This variable applies only when | 1765 | This variable applies only when |
1607 | :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains | 1766 | :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains |
1608 | "package_rpm". | 1767 | "package_rpm". |
1609 | 1768 | ||
1610 | The BitBake configuration file initially defines this variable as a | 1769 | The BitBake configuration file initially defines this variable as a |
1611 | sub-folder of :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`: DEPLOY_DIR_RPM = | 1770 | sub-folder of :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`: |
1612 | "${DEPLOY_DIR}/rpm" | 1771 | :: |
1613 | 1772 | ||
1773 | DEPLOY_DIR_RPM = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/rpm" | ||
1774 | |||
1614 | The :ref:`package_rpm <ref-classes-package_rpm>` class uses the | 1775 | The :ref:`package_rpm <ref-classes-package_rpm>` class uses the |
1615 | ``DEPLOY_DIR_RPM`` variable to make sure the | 1776 | ``DEPLOY_DIR_RPM`` variable to make sure the |
1616 | :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_rpm` task | 1777 | :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_rpm` task |
1617 | writes RPM packages into the appropriate folder. For more information | 1778 | writes RPM packages into the appropriate folder. For more information |
1618 | on how packaging works, see the "`Package | 1779 | on how packaging works, see the ":ref:`Package |
1619 | Feeds <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#package-feeds-dev-environment>`__" section | 1780 | Feeds <package-feeds-dev-environment>`" section |
1620 | in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. | 1781 | in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. |
1621 | 1782 | ||
1622 | DEPLOY_DIR_TAR | 1783 | DEPLOY_DIR_TAR |
1623 | Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place | 1784 | Points to the area that the OpenEmbedded build system uses to place |
1624 | tarballs that are ready to be used outside of the build system. This | 1785 | tarballs that are ready to be used outside of the build system. This |
1625 | variable applies only when | 1786 | variable applies only when |
1626 | :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains | 1787 | :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` contains |
1627 | "package_tar". | 1788 | "package_tar". |
1628 | 1789 | ||
1629 | The BitBake configuration file initially defines this variable as a | 1790 | The BitBake configuration file initially defines this variable as a |
1630 | sub-folder of :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`: DEPLOY_DIR_TAR = | 1791 | sub-folder of :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`: |
1631 | "${DEPLOY_DIR}/tar" | 1792 | :: |
1632 | 1793 | ||
1794 | DEPLOY_DIR_TAR = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/tar" | ||
1795 | |||
1633 | The :ref:`package_tar <ref-classes-package_tar>` class uses the | 1796 | The :ref:`package_tar <ref-classes-package_tar>` class uses the |
1634 | ``DEPLOY_DIR_TAR`` variable to make sure the | 1797 | ``DEPLOY_DIR_TAR`` variable to make sure the |
1635 | :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_tar` task | 1798 | :ref:`ref-tasks-package_write_tar` task |
1636 | writes TAR packages into the appropriate folder. For more information | 1799 | writes TAR packages into the appropriate folder. For more information |
1637 | on how packaging works, see the "`Package | 1800 | on how packaging works, see the ":ref:`Package |
1638 | Feeds <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#package-feeds-dev-environment>`__" section | 1801 | Feeds <package-feeds-dev-environment>`" section |
1639 | in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. | 1802 | in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. |
1640 | 1803 | ||
1641 | DEPLOYDIR | 1804 | DEPLOYDIR |
1642 | When inheriting the :ref:`deploy <ref-classes-deploy>` class, the | 1805 | When inheriting the :ref:`deploy <ref-classes-deploy>` class, the |
1643 | ``DEPLOYDIR`` points to a temporary work area for deployed files that | 1806 | ``DEPLOYDIR`` points to a temporary work area for deployed files that |
1644 | is set in the ``deploy`` class as follows: DEPLOYDIR = | 1807 | is set in the ``deploy`` class as follows: |
1645 | "${WORKDIR}/deploy-${:term:`PN`}" | 1808 | :: |
1646 | 1809 | ||
1810 | DEPLOYDIR = "${WORKDIR}/deploy-${:term:`PN`}" | ||
1811 | |||
1647 | Recipes inheriting the ``deploy`` class should copy files to be | 1812 | Recipes inheriting the ``deploy`` class should copy files to be |
1648 | deployed into ``DEPLOYDIR``, and the class will take care of copying | 1813 | deployed into ``DEPLOYDIR``, and the class will take care of copying |
1649 | them into :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE` | 1814 | them into :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE` |
1650 | afterwards. | 1815 | afterwards. |
1651 | 1816 | ||
1652 | DESCRIPTION | 1817 | DESCRIPTION |
1653 | The package description used by package managers. If not set, | 1818 | The package description used by package managers. If not set, |
1654 | ``DESCRIPTION`` takes the value of the :term:`SUMMARY` | 1819 | ``DESCRIPTION`` takes the value of the :term:`SUMMARY` |
1655 | variable. | 1820 | variable. |
1656 | 1821 | ||
1657 | DISTRO | 1822 | DISTRO |
1658 | The short name of the distribution. For information on the long name | 1823 | The short name of the distribution. For information on the long name |
1659 | of the distribution, see the :term:`DISTRO_NAME` | 1824 | of the distribution, see the :term:`DISTRO_NAME` |
1660 | variable. | 1825 | variable. |
1661 | 1826 | ||
1662 | The ``DISTRO`` variable corresponds to a distribution configuration | 1827 | The ``DISTRO`` variable corresponds to a distribution configuration |
1663 | file whose root name is the same as the variable's argument and whose | 1828 | file whose root name is the same as the variable's argument and whose |
1664 | filename extension is ``.conf``. For example, the distribution | 1829 | filename extension is ``.conf``. For example, the distribution |
1665 | configuration file for the Poky distribution is named ``poky.conf`` | 1830 | configuration file for the Poky distribution is named ``poky.conf`` |
1666 | and resides in the ``meta-poky/conf/distro`` directory of the | 1831 | and resides in the ``meta-poky/conf/distro`` directory of the |
1667 | :term:`Source Directory`. | 1832 | :term:`Source Directory`. |
1668 | 1833 | ||
1669 | Within that ``poky.conf`` file, the ``DISTRO`` variable is set as | 1834 | Within that ``poky.conf`` file, the ``DISTRO`` variable is set as |
1670 | follows: DISTRO = "poky" | 1835 | follows: |
1671 | 1836 | :: | |
1837 | |||
1838 | DISTRO = "poky" | ||
1839 | |||
1672 | Distribution configuration files are located in a ``conf/distro`` | 1840 | Distribution configuration files are located in a ``conf/distro`` |
1673 | directory within the :term:`Metadata` that contains the | 1841 | directory within the :term:`Metadata` that contains the |
1674 | distribution configuration. The value for ``DISTRO`` must not contain | 1842 | distribution configuration. The value for ``DISTRO`` must not contain |
1675 | spaces, and is typically all lower-case. | 1843 | spaces, and is typically all lower-case. |
1676 | 1844 | ||
1677 | .. note:: | 1845 | .. note:: |
1678 | 1846 | ||
1679 | If the | 1847 | If the |
1680 | DISTRO | 1848 | DISTRO |
1681 | variable is blank, a set of default configurations are used, which | 1849 | variable is blank, a set of default configurations are used, which |
1682 | are specified within | 1850 | are specified within |
1683 | meta/conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf | 1851 | meta/conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf |
1684 | also in the Source Directory. | 1852 | also in the Source Directory. |
1685 | 1853 | ||
1686 | DISTRO_CODENAME | 1854 | DISTRO_CODENAME |
1687 | Specifies a codename for the distribution being built. | 1855 | Specifies a codename for the distribution being built. |
1688 | 1856 | ||
1689 | DISTRO_EXTRA_RDEPENDS | 1857 | DISTRO_EXTRA_RDEPENDS |
1690 | Specifies a list of distro-specific packages to add to all images. | 1858 | Specifies a list of distro-specific packages to add to all images. |
1691 | This variable takes affect through ``packagegroup-base`` so the | 1859 | This variable takes affect through ``packagegroup-base`` so the |
@@ -1693,18 +1861,18 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1693 | include ``packagegroup-base``. You can use this variable to keep | 1861 | include ``packagegroup-base``. You can use this variable to keep |
1694 | distro policy out of generic images. As with all other distro | 1862 | distro policy out of generic images. As with all other distro |
1695 | variables, you set this variable in the distro ``.conf`` file. | 1863 | variables, you set this variable in the distro ``.conf`` file. |
1696 | 1864 | ||
1697 | DISTRO_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS | 1865 | DISTRO_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS |
1698 | Specifies a list of distro-specific packages to add to all images if | 1866 | Specifies a list of distro-specific packages to add to all images if |
1699 | the packages exist. The packages might not exist or be empty (e.g. | 1867 | the packages exist. The packages might not exist or be empty (e.g. |
1700 | kernel modules). The list of packages are automatically installed but | 1868 | kernel modules). The list of packages are automatically installed but |
1701 | you can remove them. | 1869 | you can remove them. |
1702 | 1870 | ||
1703 | DISTRO_FEATURES | 1871 | DISTRO_FEATURES |
1704 | The software support you want in your distribution for various | 1872 | The software support you want in your distribution for various |
1705 | features. You define your distribution features in the distribution | 1873 | features. You define your distribution features in the distribution |
1706 | configuration file. | 1874 | configuration file. |
1707 | 1875 | ||
1708 | In most cases, the presence or absence of a feature in | 1876 | In most cases, the presence or absence of a feature in |
1709 | ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` is translated to the appropriate option supplied | 1877 | ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` is translated to the appropriate option supplied |
1710 | to the configure script during the | 1878 | to the configure script during the |
@@ -1713,41 +1881,43 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1713 | ``DISTRO_FEATURES``, causes every piece of software built for the | 1881 | ``DISTRO_FEATURES``, causes every piece of software built for the |
1714 | target that can optionally support X11 to have its X11 support | 1882 | target that can optionally support X11 to have its X11 support |
1715 | enabled. | 1883 | enabled. |
1716 | 1884 | ||
1717 | Two more examples are Bluetooth and NFS support. For a more complete | 1885 | Two more examples are Bluetooth and NFS support. For a more complete |
1718 | list of features that ships with the Yocto Project and that you can | 1886 | list of features that ships with the Yocto Project and that you can |
1719 | provide with this variable, see the "`Distro | 1887 | provide with this variable, see the "`Distro |
1720 | Features <#ref-features-distro>`__" section. | 1888 | Features <#ref-features-distro>`__" section. |
1721 | 1889 | ||
1722 | DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL | 1890 | DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL |
1723 | Features to be added to ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` if not also present in | 1891 | Features to be added to ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` if not also present in |
1724 | ``DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED``. | 1892 | ``DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED``. |
1725 | 1893 | ||
1726 | This variable is set in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file. It is | 1894 | This variable is set in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file. It is |
1727 | not intended to be user-configurable. It is best to just reference | 1895 | not intended to be user-configurable. It is best to just reference |
1728 | the variable to see which distro features are being backfilled for | 1896 | the variable to see which distro features are being backfilled for |
1729 | all distro configurations. See the "`Feature | 1897 | all distro configurations. See the "`Feature |
1730 | Backfilling <#ref-features-backfill>`__" section for more | 1898 | Backfilling <#ref-features-backfill>`__" section for more |
1731 | information. | 1899 | information. |
1732 | 1900 | ||
1733 | DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED | 1901 | DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED |
1734 | Features from ``DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL`` that should not be | 1902 | Features from ``DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL`` that should not be |
1735 | backfilled (i.e. added to ``DISTRO_FEATURES``) during the build. See | 1903 | backfilled (i.e. added to ``DISTRO_FEATURES``) during the build. See |
1736 | the "`Feature Backfilling <#ref-features-backfill>`__" section for | 1904 | the "`Feature Backfilling <#ref-features-backfill>`__" section for |
1737 | more information. | 1905 | more information. |
1738 | 1906 | ||
1739 | DISTRO_FEATURES_DEFAULT | 1907 | DISTRO_FEATURES_DEFAULT |
1740 | A convenience variable that gives you the default list of distro | 1908 | A convenience variable that gives you the default list of distro |
1741 | features with the exception of any features specific to the C library | 1909 | features with the exception of any features specific to the C library |
1742 | (``libc``). | 1910 | (``libc``). |
1743 | 1911 | ||
1744 | When creating a custom distribution, you might find it useful to be | 1912 | When creating a custom distribution, you might find it useful to be |
1745 | able to reuse the default | 1913 | able to reuse the default |
1746 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` options without the | 1914 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` options without the |
1747 | need to write out the full set. Here is an example that uses | 1915 | need to write out the full set. Here is an example that uses |
1748 | ``DISTRO_FEATURES_DEFAULT`` from a custom distro configuration file: | 1916 | ``DISTRO_FEATURES_DEFAULT`` from a custom distro configuration file: |
1749 | DISTRO_FEATURES ?= "${DISTRO_FEATURES_DEFAULT} myfeature" | 1917 | :: |
1750 | 1918 | ||
1919 | DISTRO_FEATURES ?= "${DISTRO_FEATURES_DEFAULT} myfeature" | ||
1920 | |||
1751 | DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVE | 1921 | DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVE |
1752 | Specifies a list of features that if present in the target | 1922 | Specifies a list of features that if present in the target |
1753 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` value should be | 1923 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` value should be |
@@ -1755,7 +1925,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1755 | variable is used in addition to the features filtered using the | 1925 | variable is used in addition to the features filtered using the |
1756 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVE` | 1926 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVE` |
1757 | variable. | 1927 | variable. |
1758 | 1928 | ||
1759 | DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVESDK | 1929 | DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVESDK |
1760 | Specifies a list of features that if present in the target | 1930 | Specifies a list of features that if present in the target |
1761 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` value should be | 1931 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` value should be |
@@ -1763,7 +1933,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1763 | variable is used in addition to the features filtered using the | 1933 | variable is used in addition to the features filtered using the |
1764 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVESDK` | 1934 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVESDK` |
1765 | variable. | 1935 | variable. |
1766 | 1936 | ||
1767 | DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVE | 1937 | DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVE |
1768 | Specifies a list of features that should be included in | 1938 | Specifies a list of features that should be included in |
1769 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` when building native | 1939 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` when building native |
@@ -1771,7 +1941,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1771 | using the | 1941 | using the |
1772 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVE` | 1942 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVE` |
1773 | variable. | 1943 | variable. |
1774 | 1944 | ||
1775 | DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVESDK | 1945 | DISTRO_FEATURES_NATIVESDK |
1776 | Specifies a list of features that should be included in | 1946 | Specifies a list of features that should be included in |
1777 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` when building | 1947 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` when building |
@@ -1779,49 +1949,52 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1779 | filtered using the | 1949 | filtered using the |
1780 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVESDK` | 1950 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_FILTER_NATIVESDK` |
1781 | variable. | 1951 | variable. |
1782 | 1952 | ||
1783 | DISTRO_NAME | 1953 | DISTRO_NAME |
1784 | The long name of the distribution. For information on the short name | 1954 | The long name of the distribution. For information on the short name |
1785 | of the distribution, see the :term:`DISTRO` variable. | 1955 | of the distribution, see the :term:`DISTRO` variable. |
1786 | 1956 | ||
1787 | The ``DISTRO_NAME`` variable corresponds to a distribution | 1957 | The ``DISTRO_NAME`` variable corresponds to a distribution |
1788 | configuration file whose root name is the same as the variable's | 1958 | configuration file whose root name is the same as the variable's |
1789 | argument and whose filename extension is ``.conf``. For example, the | 1959 | argument and whose filename extension is ``.conf``. For example, the |
1790 | distribution configuration file for the Poky distribution is named | 1960 | distribution configuration file for the Poky distribution is named |
1791 | ``poky.conf`` and resides in the ``meta-poky/conf/distro`` directory | 1961 | ``poky.conf`` and resides in the ``meta-poky/conf/distro`` directory |
1792 | of the :term:`Source Directory`. | 1962 | of the :term:`Source Directory`. |
1793 | 1963 | ||
1794 | Within that ``poky.conf`` file, the ``DISTRO_NAME`` variable is set | 1964 | Within that ``poky.conf`` file, the ``DISTRO_NAME`` variable is set |
1795 | as follows: DISTRO_NAME = "Poky (Yocto Project Reference Distro)" | 1965 | as follows: |
1796 | 1966 | :: | |
1967 | |||
1968 | DISTRO_NAME = "Poky (Yocto Project Reference Distro)" | ||
1969 | |||
1797 | Distribution configuration files are located in a ``conf/distro`` | 1970 | Distribution configuration files are located in a ``conf/distro`` |
1798 | directory within the :term:`Metadata` that contains the | 1971 | directory within the :term:`Metadata` that contains the |
1799 | distribution configuration. | 1972 | distribution configuration. |
1800 | 1973 | ||
1801 | .. note:: | 1974 | .. note:: |
1802 | 1975 | ||
1803 | If the | 1976 | If the |
1804 | DISTRO_NAME | 1977 | DISTRO_NAME |
1805 | variable is blank, a set of default configurations are used, which | 1978 | variable is blank, a set of default configurations are used, which |
1806 | are specified within | 1979 | are specified within |
1807 | meta/conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf | 1980 | meta/conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf |
1808 | also in the Source Directory. | 1981 | also in the Source Directory. |
1809 | 1982 | ||
1810 | DISTRO_VERSION | 1983 | DISTRO_VERSION |
1811 | The version of the distribution. | 1984 | The version of the distribution. |
1812 | 1985 | ||
1813 | DISTROOVERRIDES | 1986 | DISTROOVERRIDES |
1814 | A colon-separated list of overrides specific to the current | 1987 | A colon-separated list of overrides specific to the current |
1815 | distribution. By default, this list includes the value of | 1988 | distribution. By default, this list includes the value of |
1816 | :term:`DISTRO`. | 1989 | :term:`DISTRO`. |
1817 | 1990 | ||
1818 | You can extend ``DISTROOVERRIDES`` to add extra overrides that should | 1991 | You can extend ``DISTROOVERRIDES`` to add extra overrides that should |
1819 | apply to the distribution. | 1992 | apply to the distribution. |
1820 | 1993 | ||
1821 | The underlying mechanism behind ``DISTROOVERRIDES`` is simply that it | 1994 | The underlying mechanism behind ``DISTROOVERRIDES`` is simply that it |
1822 | is included in the default value of | 1995 | is included in the default value of |
1823 | :term:`OVERRIDES`. | 1996 | :term:`OVERRIDES`. |
1824 | 1997 | ||
1825 | DL_DIR | 1998 | DL_DIR |
1826 | The central download directory used by the build process to store | 1999 | The central download directory used by the build process to store |
1827 | downloads. By default, ``DL_DIR`` gets files suitable for mirroring | 2000 | downloads. By default, ``DL_DIR`` gets files suitable for mirroring |
@@ -1829,25 +2002,29 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1829 | repositories, use the | 2002 | repositories, use the |
1830 | :term:`BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS` | 2003 | :term:`BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS` |
1831 | variable. | 2004 | variable. |
1832 | 2005 | ||
1833 | You can set this directory by defining the ``DL_DIR`` variable in the | 2006 | You can set this directory by defining the ``DL_DIR`` variable in the |
1834 | ``conf/local.conf`` file. This directory is self-maintaining and you | 2007 | ``conf/local.conf`` file. This directory is self-maintaining and you |
1835 | should not have to touch it. By default, the directory is | 2008 | should not have to touch it. By default, the directory is |
1836 | ``downloads`` in the :term:`Build Directory`. #DL_DIR | 2009 | ``downloads`` in the :term:`Build Directory`. |
1837 | ?= "${TOPDIR}/downloads" To specify a different download directory, | 2010 | :: |
2011 | |||
2012 | #DL_DIR ?= "${TOPDIR}/downloads" | ||
2013 | |||
2014 | To specify a different download directory, | ||
1838 | simply remove the comment from the line and provide your directory. | 2015 | simply remove the comment from the line and provide your directory. |
1839 | 2016 | ||
1840 | During a first build, the system downloads many different source code | 2017 | During a first build, the system downloads many different source code |
1841 | tarballs from various upstream projects. Downloading can take a | 2018 | tarballs from various upstream projects. Downloading can take a |
1842 | while, particularly if your network connection is slow. Tarballs are | 2019 | while, particularly if your network connection is slow. Tarballs are |
1843 | all stored in the directory defined by ``DL_DIR`` and the build | 2020 | all stored in the directory defined by ``DL_DIR`` and the build |
1844 | system looks there first to find source tarballs. | 2021 | system looks there first to find source tarballs. |
1845 | 2022 | ||
1846 | .. note:: | 2023 | .. note:: |
1847 | 2024 | ||
1848 | When wiping and rebuilding, you can preserve this directory to | 2025 | When wiping and rebuilding, you can preserve this directory to |
1849 | speed up this part of subsequent builds. | 2026 | speed up this part of subsequent builds. |
1850 | 2027 | ||
1851 | You can safely share this directory between multiple builds on the | 2028 | You can safely share this directory between multiple builds on the |
1852 | same development machine. For additional information on how the build | 2029 | same development machine. For additional information on how the build |
1853 | process gets source files when working behind a firewall or proxy | 2030 | process gets source files when working behind a firewall or proxy |
@@ -1856,58 +2033,61 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1856 | chapter. You can also refer to the | 2033 | chapter. You can also refer to the |
1857 | ":yocto_wiki:`Working Behind a Network Proxy </wiki/Working_Behind_a_Network_Proxy>`" | 2034 | ":yocto_wiki:`Working Behind a Network Proxy </wiki/Working_Behind_a_Network_Proxy>`" |
1858 | Wiki page. | 2035 | Wiki page. |
1859 | 2036 | ||
1860 | DOC_COMPRESS | 2037 | DOC_COMPRESS |
1861 | When inheriting the :ref:`compress_doc <ref-classes-compress_doc>` | 2038 | When inheriting the :ref:`compress_doc <ref-classes-compress_doc>` |
1862 | class, this variable sets the compression policy used when the | 2039 | class, this variable sets the compression policy used when the |
1863 | OpenEmbedded build system compresses man pages and info pages. By | 2040 | OpenEmbedded build system compresses man pages and info pages. By |
1864 | default, the compression method used is gz (gzip). Other policies | 2041 | default, the compression method used is gz (gzip). Other policies |
1865 | available are xz and bz2. | 2042 | available are xz and bz2. |
1866 | 2043 | ||
1867 | For information on policies and on how to use this variable, see the | 2044 | For information on policies and on how to use this variable, see the |
1868 | comments in the ``meta/classes/compress_doc.bbclass`` file. | 2045 | comments in the ``meta/classes/compress_doc.bbclass`` file. |
1869 | 2046 | ||
1870 | EFI_PROVIDER | 2047 | EFI_PROVIDER |
1871 | When building bootable images (i.e. where ``hddimg``, ``iso``, or | 2048 | When building bootable images (i.e. where ``hddimg``, ``iso``, or |
1872 | ``wic.vmdk`` is in :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`), the | 2049 | ``wic.vmdk`` is in :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`), the |
1873 | ``EFI_PROVIDER`` variable specifies the EFI bootloader to use. The | 2050 | ``EFI_PROVIDER`` variable specifies the EFI bootloader to use. The |
1874 | default is "grub-efi", but "systemd-boot" can be used instead. | 2051 | default is "grub-efi", but "systemd-boot" can be used instead. |
1875 | 2052 | ||
1876 | See the :ref:`systemd-boot <ref-classes-systemd-boot>` and | 2053 | See the :ref:`systemd-boot <ref-classes-systemd-boot>` and |
1877 | :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` classes for more | 2054 | :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` classes for more |
1878 | information. | 2055 | information. |
1879 | 2056 | ||
1880 | ENABLE_BINARY_LOCALE_GENERATION | 2057 | ENABLE_BINARY_LOCALE_GENERATION |
1881 | Variable that controls which locales for ``glibc`` are generated | 2058 | Variable that controls which locales for ``glibc`` are generated |
1882 | during the build (useful if the target device has 64Mbytes of RAM or | 2059 | during the build (useful if the target device has 64Mbytes of RAM or |
1883 | less). | 2060 | less). |
1884 | 2061 | ||
1885 | ERR_REPORT_DIR | 2062 | ERR_REPORT_DIR |
1886 | When used with the :ref:`report-error <ref-classes-report-error>` | 2063 | When used with the :ref:`report-error <ref-classes-report-error>` |
1887 | class, specifies the path used for storing the debug files created by | 2064 | class, specifies the path used for storing the debug files created by |
1888 | the `error reporting | 2065 | the :ref:`error reporting |
1889 | tool <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#using-the-error-reporting-tool>`__, which | 2066 | tool <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:using the error reporting tool>`, which |
1890 | allows you to submit build errors you encounter to a central | 2067 | allows you to submit build errors you encounter to a central |
1891 | database. By default, the value of this variable is | 2068 | database. By default, the value of this variable is |
1892 | ``${``\ :term:`LOG_DIR`\ ``}/error-report``. | 2069 | ``${``\ :term:`LOG_DIR`\ ``}/error-report``. |
1893 | 2070 | ||
1894 | You can set ``ERR_REPORT_DIR`` to the path you want the error | 2071 | You can set ``ERR_REPORT_DIR`` to the path you want the error |
1895 | reporting tool to store the debug files as follows in your | 2072 | reporting tool to store the debug files as follows in your |
1896 | ``local.conf`` file: ERR_REPORT_DIR = "path" | 2073 | ``local.conf`` file: |
1897 | 2074 | :: | |
2075 | |||
2076 | ERR_REPORT_DIR = "path" | ||
2077 | |||
1898 | ERROR_QA | 2078 | ERROR_QA |
1899 | Specifies the quality assurance checks whose failures are reported as | 2079 | Specifies the quality assurance checks whose failures are reported as |
1900 | errors by the OpenEmbedded build system. You set this variable in | 2080 | errors by the OpenEmbedded build system. You set this variable in |
1901 | your distribution configuration file. For a list of the checks you | 2081 | your distribution configuration file. For a list of the checks you |
1902 | can control with this variable, see the | 2082 | can control with this variable, see the |
1903 | ":ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`" section. | 2083 | ":ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`" section. |
1904 | 2084 | ||
1905 | EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS | 2085 | EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS |
1906 | Triggers the OpenEmbedded build system's shared libraries resolver to | 2086 | Triggers the OpenEmbedded build system's shared libraries resolver to |
1907 | exclude an entire package when scanning for shared libraries. | 2087 | exclude an entire package when scanning for shared libraries. |
1908 | 2088 | ||
1909 | .. note:: | 2089 | .. note:: |
1910 | 2090 | ||
1911 | The shared libraries resolver's functionality results in part from | 2091 | The shared libraries resolver's functionality results in part from |
1912 | the internal function | 2092 | the internal function |
1913 | package_do_shlibs | 2093 | package_do_shlibs |
@@ -1915,25 +2095,28 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1915 | do_package | 2095 | do_package |
1916 | task. You should be aware that the shared libraries resolver might | 2096 | task. You should be aware that the shared libraries resolver might |
1917 | implicitly define some dependencies between packages. | 2097 | implicitly define some dependencies between packages. |
1918 | 2098 | ||
1919 | The ``EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS`` variable is similar to the | 2099 | The ``EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS`` variable is similar to the |
1920 | :term:`PRIVATE_LIBS` variable, which excludes a | 2100 | :term:`PRIVATE_LIBS` variable, which excludes a |
1921 | package's particular libraries only and not the whole package. | 2101 | package's particular libraries only and not the whole package. |
1922 | 2102 | ||
1923 | Use the ``EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS`` variable by setting it to "1" for a | 2103 | Use the ``EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS`` variable by setting it to "1" for a |
1924 | particular package: EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS = "1" | 2104 | particular package: |
1925 | 2105 | :: | |
2106 | |||
2107 | EXCLUDE_FROM_SHLIBS = "1" | ||
2108 | |||
1926 | EXCLUDE_FROM_WORLD | 2109 | EXCLUDE_FROM_WORLD |
1927 | Directs BitBake to exclude a recipe from world builds (i.e. | 2110 | Directs BitBake to exclude a recipe from world builds (i.e. |
1928 | ``bitbake world``). During world builds, BitBake locates, parses and | 2111 | ``bitbake world``). During world builds, BitBake locates, parses and |
1929 | builds all recipes found in every layer exposed in the | 2112 | builds all recipes found in every layer exposed in the |
1930 | ``bblayers.conf`` configuration file. | 2113 | ``bblayers.conf`` configuration file. |
1931 | 2114 | ||
1932 | To exclude a recipe from a world build using this variable, set the | 2115 | To exclude a recipe from a world build using this variable, set the |
1933 | variable to "1" in the recipe. | 2116 | variable to "1" in the recipe. |
1934 | 2117 | ||
1935 | .. note:: | 2118 | .. note:: |
1936 | 2119 | ||
1937 | Recipes added to | 2120 | Recipes added to |
1938 | EXCLUDE_FROM_WORLD | 2121 | EXCLUDE_FROM_WORLD |
1939 | may still be built during a world build in order to satisfy | 2122 | may still be built during a world build in order to satisfy |
@@ -1941,52 +2124,53 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1941 | EXCLUDE_FROM_WORLD | 2124 | EXCLUDE_FROM_WORLD |
1942 | only ensures that the recipe is not explicitly added to the list | 2125 | only ensures that the recipe is not explicitly added to the list |
1943 | of build targets in a world build. | 2126 | of build targets in a world build. |
1944 | 2127 | ||
1945 | EXTENDPE | 2128 | EXTENDPE |
1946 | Used with file and pathnames to create a prefix for a recipe's | 2129 | Used with file and pathnames to create a prefix for a recipe's |
1947 | version based on the recipe's :term:`PE` value. If ``PE`` | 2130 | version based on the recipe's :term:`PE` value. If ``PE`` |
1948 | is set and greater than zero for a recipe, ``EXTENDPE`` becomes that | 2131 | is set and greater than zero for a recipe, ``EXTENDPE`` becomes that |
1949 | value (e.g if ``PE`` is equal to "1" then ``EXTENDPE`` becomes "1_"). | 2132 | value (e.g if ``PE`` is equal to "1" then ``EXTENDPE`` becomes "1"). |
1950 | If a recipe's ``PE`` is not set (the default) or is equal to zero, | 2133 | If a recipe's ``PE`` is not set (the default) or is equal to zero, |
1951 | ``EXTENDPE`` becomes "". | 2134 | ``EXTENDPE`` becomes "". |
1952 | 2135 | ||
1953 | See the :term:`STAMP` variable for an example. | 2136 | See the :term:`STAMP` variable for an example. |
1954 | 2137 | ||
1955 | EXTENDPKGV | 2138 | EXTENDPKGV |
1956 | The full package version specification as it appears on the final | 2139 | The full package version specification as it appears on the final |
1957 | packages produced by a recipe. The variable's value is normally used | 2140 | packages produced by a recipe. The variable's value is normally used |
1958 | to fix a runtime dependency to the exact same version of another | 2141 | to fix a runtime dependency to the exact same version of another |
1959 | package in the same recipe: RDEPENDS_${PN}-additional-module = "${PN} | 2142 | package in the same recipe: |
1960 | (= ${EXTENDPKGV})" | 2143 | :: |
1961 | 2144 | ||
2145 | RDEPENDS_${PN}-additional-module = "${PN} (= ${EXTENDPKGV})" | ||
2146 | |||
1962 | The dependency relationships are intended to force the package | 2147 | The dependency relationships are intended to force the package |
1963 | manager to upgrade these types of packages in lock-step. | 2148 | manager to upgrade these types of packages in lock-step. |
1964 | 2149 | ||
1965 | EXTERNAL_KERNEL_TOOLS | 2150 | EXTERNAL_KERNEL_TOOLS |
1966 | When set, the ``EXTERNAL_KERNEL_TOOLS`` variable indicates that these | 2151 | When set, the ``EXTERNAL_KERNEL_TOOLS`` variable indicates that these |
1967 | tools are not in the source tree. | 2152 | tools are not in the source tree. |
1968 | 2153 | ||
1969 | When kernel tools are available in the tree, they are preferred over | 2154 | When kernel tools are available in the tree, they are preferred over |
1970 | any externally installed tools. Setting the ``EXTERNAL_KERNEL_TOOLS`` | 2155 | any externally installed tools. Setting the ``EXTERNAL_KERNEL_TOOLS`` |
1971 | variable tells the OpenEmbedded build system to prefer the installed | 2156 | variable tells the OpenEmbedded build system to prefer the installed |
1972 | external tools. See the | 2157 | external tools. See the |
1973 | :ref:`kernel-yocto <ref-classes-kernel-yocto>` class in | 2158 | :ref:`kernel-yocto <ref-classes-kernel-yocto>` class in |
1974 | ``meta/classes`` to see how the variable is used. | 2159 | ``meta/classes`` to see how the variable is used. |
1975 | 2160 | ||
1976 | EXTERNALSRC | 2161 | EXTERNALSRC |
1977 | When inheriting the :ref:`externalsrc <ref-classes-externalsrc>` | 2162 | When inheriting the :ref:`externalsrc <ref-classes-externalsrc>` |
1978 | class, this variable points to the source tree, which is outside of | 2163 | class, this variable points to the source tree, which is outside of |
1979 | the OpenEmbedded build system. When set, this variable sets the | 2164 | the OpenEmbedded build system. When set, this variable sets the |
1980 | :term:`S` variable, which is what the OpenEmbedded build | 2165 | :term:`S` variable, which is what the OpenEmbedded build |
1981 | system uses to locate unpacked recipe source code. | 2166 | system uses to locate unpacked recipe source code. |
1982 | 2167 | ||
1983 | For more information on ``externalsrc.bbclass``, see the | 2168 | For more information on ``externalsrc.bbclass``, see the |
1984 | ":ref:`externalsrc.bbclass <ref-classes-externalsrc>`" section. You | 2169 | ":ref:`externalsrc.bbclass <ref-classes-externalsrc>`" section. You |
1985 | can also find information on how to use this variable in the | 2170 | can also find information on how to use this variable in the |
1986 | "`Building Software from an External | 2171 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:building software from an external source`" |
1987 | Source <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#building-software-from-an-external-source>`__" | ||
1988 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 2172 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
1989 | 2173 | ||
1990 | EXTERNALSRC_BUILD | 2174 | EXTERNALSRC_BUILD |
1991 | When inheriting the :ref:`externalsrc <ref-classes-externalsrc>` | 2175 | When inheriting the :ref:`externalsrc <ref-classes-externalsrc>` |
1992 | class, this variable points to the directory in which the recipe's | 2176 | class, this variable points to the directory in which the recipe's |
@@ -1994,121 +2178,124 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
1994 | system. When set, this variable sets the :term:`B` variable, | 2178 | system. When set, this variable sets the :term:`B` variable, |
1995 | which is what the OpenEmbedded build system uses to locate the Build | 2179 | which is what the OpenEmbedded build system uses to locate the Build |
1996 | Directory. | 2180 | Directory. |
1997 | 2181 | ||
1998 | For more information on ``externalsrc.bbclass``, see the | 2182 | For more information on ``externalsrc.bbclass``, see the |
1999 | ":ref:`externalsrc.bbclass <ref-classes-externalsrc>`" section. You | 2183 | ":ref:`externalsrc.bbclass <ref-classes-externalsrc>`" section. You |
2000 | can also find information on how to use this variable in the | 2184 | can also find information on how to use this variable in the |
2001 | "`Building Software from an External | 2185 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:building software from an external source`" |
2002 | Source <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#building-software-from-an-external-source>`__" | ||
2003 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 2186 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
2004 | 2187 | ||
2005 | EXTRA_AUTORECONF | 2188 | EXTRA_AUTORECONF |
2006 | For recipes inheriting the :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` | 2189 | For recipes inheriting the :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` |
2007 | class, you can use ``EXTRA_AUTORECONF`` to specify extra options to | 2190 | class, you can use ``EXTRA_AUTORECONF`` to specify extra options to |
2008 | pass to the ``autoreconf`` command that is executed during the | 2191 | pass to the ``autoreconf`` command that is executed during the |
2009 | :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task. | 2192 | :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task. |
2010 | 2193 | ||
2011 | The default value is "--exclude=autopoint". | 2194 | The default value is "--exclude=autopoint". |
2012 | 2195 | ||
2013 | EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES | 2196 | EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES |
2014 | A list of additional features to include in an image. When listing | 2197 | A list of additional features to include in an image. When listing |
2015 | more than one feature, separate them with a space. | 2198 | more than one feature, separate them with a space. |
2016 | 2199 | ||
2017 | Typically, you configure this variable in your ``local.conf`` file, | 2200 | Typically, you configure this variable in your ``local.conf`` file, |
2018 | which is found in the :term:`Build Directory`. | 2201 | which is found in the :term:`Build Directory`. |
2019 | Although you can use this variable from within a recipe, best | 2202 | Although you can use this variable from within a recipe, best |
2020 | practices dictate that you do not. | 2203 | practices dictate that you do not. |
2021 | 2204 | ||
2022 | .. note:: | 2205 | .. note:: |
2023 | 2206 | ||
2024 | To enable primary features from within the image recipe, use the | 2207 | To enable primary features from within the image recipe, use the |
2025 | IMAGE_FEATURES | 2208 | IMAGE_FEATURES |
2026 | variable. | 2209 | variable. |
2027 | 2210 | ||
2028 | Here are some examples of features you can add: "dbg-pkgs" - Adds | 2211 | Here are some examples of features you can add: |
2029 | -dbg packages for all installed packages including symbol information | 2212 | |
2030 | for debugging and profiling. "debug-tweaks" - Makes an image suitable | 2213 | - "dbg-pkgs" - Adds -dbg packages for all installed packages including |
2031 | for debugging. For example, allows root logins without passwords and | 2214 | symbol information for debugging and profiling. |
2032 | enables post-installation logging. See the 'allow-empty-password' and | 2215 | |
2033 | 'post-install-logging' features in the "`Image | 2216 | - "debug-tweaks" - Makes an image suitable for debugging. For example, allows root logins without passwords and |
2034 | Features <#ref-features-image>`__" section for more information. | 2217 | enables post-installation logging. See the 'allow-empty-password' and |
2035 | "dev-pkgs" - Adds -dev packages for all installed packages. This is | 2218 | 'post-install-logging' features in the "`Image |
2036 | useful if you want to develop against the libraries in the image. | 2219 | Features <#ref-features-image>`__" section for more information. |
2037 | "read-only-rootfs" - Creates an image whose root filesystem is | 2220 | - "dev-pkgs" - Adds -dev packages for all installed packages. This is |
2038 | read-only. See the "`Creating a Read-Only Root | 2221 | useful if you want to develop against the libraries in the image. |
2039 | Filesystem <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#creating-a-read-only-root-filesystem>`__" | 2222 | - "read-only-rootfs" - Creates an image whose root filesystem is |
2040 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more | 2223 | read-only. See the |
2041 | information "tools-debug" - Adds debugging tools such as gdb and | 2224 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:creating a read-only root filesystem`" |
2042 | strace. "tools-sdk" - Adds development tools such as gcc, make, | 2225 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more |
2043 | pkgconfig and so forth. "tools-testapps" - Adds useful testing tools | 2226 | information |
2044 | such as ts_print, aplay, arecord and so forth. | 2227 | - "tools-debug" - Adds debugging tools such as gdb and strace. |
2045 | 2228 | - "tools-sdk" - Adds development tools such as gcc, make, | |
2229 | pkgconfig and so forth. | ||
2230 | - "tools-testapps" - Adds useful testing tools | ||
2231 | such as ts_print, aplay, arecord and so forth. | ||
2232 | |||
2046 | For a complete list of image features that ships with the Yocto | 2233 | For a complete list of image features that ships with the Yocto |
2047 | Project, see the "`Image Features <#ref-features-image>`__" section. | 2234 | Project, see the "`Image Features <#ref-features-image>`__" section. |
2048 | 2235 | ||
2049 | For an example that shows how to customize your image by using this | 2236 | For an example that shows how to customize your image by using this |
2050 | variable, see the "`Customizing Images Using Custom | 2237 | variable, see the ":ref:`usingpoky-extend-customimage-imagefeatures`" |
2051 | ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` and | ||
2052 | ``EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#usingpoky-extend-customimage-imagefeatures>`__" | ||
2053 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 2238 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
2054 | 2239 | ||
2055 | EXTRA_IMAGECMD | 2240 | EXTRA_IMAGECMD |
2056 | Specifies additional options for the image creation command that has | 2241 | Specifies additional options for the image creation command that has |
2057 | been specified in :term:`IMAGE_CMD`. When setting | 2242 | been specified in :term:`IMAGE_CMD`. When setting |
2058 | this variable, use an override for the associated image type. Here is | 2243 | this variable, use an override for the associated image type. Here is |
2059 | an example: EXTRA_IMAGECMD_ext3 ?= "-i 4096" | 2244 | an example: |
2060 | 2245 | :: | |
2246 | |||
2247 | EXTRA_IMAGECMD_ext3 ?= "-i 4096" | ||
2248 | |||
2061 | EXTRA_IMAGEDEPENDS | 2249 | EXTRA_IMAGEDEPENDS |
2062 | A list of recipes to build that do not provide packages for | 2250 | A list of recipes to build that do not provide packages for |
2063 | installing into the root filesystem. | 2251 | installing into the root filesystem. |
2064 | 2252 | ||
2065 | Sometimes a recipe is required to build the final image but is not | 2253 | Sometimes a recipe is required to build the final image but is not |
2066 | needed in the root filesystem. You can use the ``EXTRA_IMAGEDEPENDS`` | 2254 | needed in the root filesystem. You can use the ``EXTRA_IMAGEDEPENDS`` |
2067 | variable to list these recipes and thus specify the dependencies. A | 2255 | variable to list these recipes and thus specify the dependencies. A |
2068 | typical example is a required bootloader in a machine configuration. | 2256 | typical example is a required bootloader in a machine configuration. |
2069 | 2257 | ||
2070 | .. note:: | 2258 | .. note:: |
2071 | 2259 | ||
2072 | To add packages to the root filesystem, see the various | 2260 | To add packages to the root filesystem, see the various |
2073 | \* | 2261 | \*RDEPENDS and \*RRECOMMENDS |
2074 | RDEPENDS | ||
2075 | and | ||
2076 | \* | ||
2077 | RRECOMMENDS | ||
2078 | variables. | 2262 | variables. |
2079 | 2263 | ||
2080 | EXTRANATIVEPATH | 2264 | EXTRANATIVEPATH |
2081 | A list of subdirectories of | 2265 | A list of subdirectories of |
2082 | ``${``\ :term:`STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE`\ ``}`` | 2266 | ``${``\ :term:`STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE`\ ``}`` |
2083 | added to the beginning of the environment variable ``PATH``. As an | 2267 | added to the beginning of the environment variable ``PATH``. As an |
2084 | example, the following prepends | 2268 | example, the following prepends |
2085 | "${STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE}/foo:${STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE}/bar:" to | 2269 | "${STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE}/foo:${STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE}/bar:" to |
2086 | ``PATH``: EXTRANATIVEPATH = "foo bar" | 2270 | ``PATH``: |
2087 | 2271 | :: | |
2272 | |||
2273 | EXTRANATIVEPATH = "foo bar" | ||
2274 | |||
2088 | EXTRA_OECMAKE | 2275 | EXTRA_OECMAKE |
2089 | Additional `CMake <https://cmake.org/overview/>`__ options. See the | 2276 | Additional `CMake <https://cmake.org/overview/>`__ options. See the |
2090 | :ref:`cmake <ref-classes-cmake>` class for additional information. | 2277 | :ref:`cmake <ref-classes-cmake>` class for additional information. |
2091 | 2278 | ||
2092 | EXTRA_OECONF | 2279 | EXTRA_OECONF |
2093 | Additional ``configure`` script options. See | 2280 | Additional ``configure`` script options. See |
2094 | :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS` for | 2281 | :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS` for |
2095 | additional information on passing configure script options. | 2282 | additional information on passing configure script options. |
2096 | 2283 | ||
2097 | EXTRA_OEMAKE | 2284 | EXTRA_OEMAKE |
2098 | Additional GNU ``make`` options. | 2285 | Additional GNU ``make`` options. |
2099 | 2286 | ||
2100 | Because the ``EXTRA_OEMAKE`` defaults to "", you need to set the | 2287 | Because the ``EXTRA_OEMAKE`` defaults to "", you need to set the |
2101 | variable to specify any required GNU options. | 2288 | variable to specify any required GNU options. |
2102 | 2289 | ||
2103 | :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` and | 2290 | :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` and |
2104 | :term:`PARALLEL_MAKEINST` also make use of | 2291 | :term:`PARALLEL_MAKEINST` also make use of |
2105 | ``EXTRA_OEMAKE`` to pass the required flags. | 2292 | ``EXTRA_OEMAKE`` to pass the required flags. |
2106 | 2293 | ||
2107 | EXTRA_OESCONS | 2294 | EXTRA_OESCONS |
2108 | When inheriting the :ref:`scons <ref-classes-scons>` class, this | 2295 | When inheriting the :ref:`scons <ref-classes-scons>` class, this |
2109 | variable specifies additional configuration options you want to pass | 2296 | variable specifies additional configuration options you want to pass |
2110 | to the ``scons`` command line. | 2297 | to the ``scons`` command line. |
2111 | 2298 | ||
2112 | EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS | 2299 | EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS |
2113 | When inheriting the :ref:`extrausers <ref-classes-extrausers>` | 2300 | When inheriting the :ref:`extrausers <ref-classes-extrausers>` |
2114 | class, this variable provides image level user and group operations. | 2301 | class, this variable provides image level user and group operations. |
@@ -2116,26 +2303,35 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2116 | configuration as compared to using the | 2303 | configuration as compared to using the |
2117 | :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class, which ties user and | 2304 | :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class, which ties user and |
2118 | group configurations to a specific recipe. | 2305 | group configurations to a specific recipe. |
2119 | 2306 | ||
2120 | The set list of commands you can configure using the | 2307 | The set list of commands you can configure using the |
2121 | ``EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS`` is shown in the ``extrausers`` class. These | 2308 | ``EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS`` is shown in the ``extrausers`` class. These |
2122 | commands map to the normal Unix commands of the same names: # | 2309 | commands map to the normal Unix commands of the same names: |
2123 | EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS = "\\ # useradd -p '' tester; \\ # groupadd | 2310 | :: |
2124 | developers; \\ # userdel nobody; \\ # groupdel -g video; \\ # | 2311 | |
2125 | groupmod -g 1020 developers; \\ # usermod -s /bin/sh tester; \\ # " | 2312 | # EXTRA_USERS_PARAMS = "\ |
2126 | 2313 | # useradd -p '' tester; \ | |
2314 | # groupadd developers; \ | ||
2315 | # userdel nobody; \ | ||
2316 | # groupdel -g video; \ | ||
2317 | # groupmod -g 1020 developers; \ | ||
2318 | # usermod -s /bin/sh tester; \ | ||
2319 | # " | ||
2320 | |||
2127 | FEATURE_PACKAGES | 2321 | FEATURE_PACKAGES |
2128 | Defines one or more packages to include in an image when a specific | 2322 | Defines one or more packages to include in an image when a specific |
2129 | item is included in :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`. | 2323 | item is included in :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`. |
2130 | When setting the value, ``FEATURE_PACKAGES`` should have the name of | 2324 | When setting the value, ``FEATURE_PACKAGES`` should have the name of |
2131 | the feature item as an override. Here is an example: | 2325 | the feature item as an override. Here is an example: |
2132 | FEATURE_PACKAGES_widget = "package1 package2" | 2326 | :: |
2133 | 2327 | ||
2328 | FEATURE_PACKAGES_widget = "package1 package2" | ||
2329 | |||
2134 | In this example, if "widget" were added to ``IMAGE_FEATURES``, | 2330 | In this example, if "widget" were added to ``IMAGE_FEATURES``, |
2135 | package1 and package2 would be included in the image. | 2331 | package1 and package2 would be included in the image. |
2136 | 2332 | ||
2137 | .. note:: | 2333 | .. note:: |
2138 | 2334 | ||
2139 | Packages installed by features defined through | 2335 | Packages installed by features defined through |
2140 | FEATURE_PACKAGES | 2336 | FEATURE_PACKAGES |
2141 | are often package groups. While similarly named, you should not | 2337 | are often package groups. While similarly named, you should not |
@@ -2143,40 +2339,46 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2143 | FEATURE_PACKAGES | 2339 | FEATURE_PACKAGES |
2144 | variable with package groups, which are discussed elsewhere in the | 2340 | variable with package groups, which are discussed elsewhere in the |
2145 | documentation. | 2341 | documentation. |
2146 | 2342 | ||
2147 | FEED_DEPLOYDIR_BASE_URI | 2343 | FEED_DEPLOYDIR_BASE_URI |
2148 | Points to the base URL of the server and location within the | 2344 | Points to the base URL of the server and location within the |
2149 | document-root that provides the metadata and packages required by | 2345 | document-root that provides the metadata and packages required by |
2150 | OPKG to support runtime package management of IPK packages. You set | 2346 | OPKG to support runtime package management of IPK packages. You set |
2151 | this variable in your ``local.conf`` file. | 2347 | this variable in your ``local.conf`` file. |
2152 | 2348 | ||
2153 | Consider the following example: FEED_DEPLOYDIR_BASE_URI = | 2349 | Consider the following example: |
2154 | "http://192.168.7.1/BOARD-dir" This example assumes you are serving | 2350 | :: |
2351 | |||
2352 | FEED_DEPLOYDIR_BASE_URI = "http://192.168.7.1/BOARD-dir" | ||
2353 | |||
2354 | This example assumes you are serving | ||
2155 | your packages over HTTP and your databases are located in a directory | 2355 | your packages over HTTP and your databases are located in a directory |
2156 | named ``BOARD-dir``, which is underneath your HTTP server's | 2356 | named ``BOARD-dir``, which is underneath your HTTP server's |
2157 | document-root. In this case, the OpenEmbedded build system generates | 2357 | document-root. In this case, the OpenEmbedded build system generates |
2158 | a set of configuration files for you in your target that work with | 2358 | a set of configuration files for you in your target that work with |
2159 | the feed. | 2359 | the feed. |
2160 | 2360 | ||
2161 | FILES | 2361 | FILES |
2162 | The list of files and directories that are placed in a package. The | 2362 | The list of files and directories that are placed in a package. The |
2163 | :term:`PACKAGES` variable lists the packages | 2363 | :term:`PACKAGES` variable lists the packages |
2164 | generated by a recipe. | 2364 | generated by a recipe. |
2165 | 2365 | ||
2166 | To use the ``FILES`` variable, provide a package name override that | 2366 | To use the ``FILES`` variable, provide a package name override that |
2167 | identifies the resulting package. Then, provide a space-separated | 2367 | identifies the resulting package. Then, provide a space-separated |
2168 | list of files or paths that identify the files you want included as | 2368 | list of files or paths that identify the files you want included as |
2169 | part of the resulting package. Here is an example: FILES_${PN} += | 2369 | part of the resulting package. Here is an example: |
2170 | "${bindir}/mydir1 ${bindir}/mydir2/myfile" | 2370 | :: |
2171 | 2371 | ||
2372 | FILES_${PN} += "${bindir}/mydir1 ${bindir}/mydir2/myfile" | ||
2373 | |||
2172 | .. note:: | 2374 | .. note:: |
2173 | 2375 | ||
2174 | - When specifying files or paths, you can pattern match using | 2376 | - When specifying files or paths, you can pattern match using |
2175 | Python's | 2377 | Python's |
2176 | ```glob`https://docs.python.org/2/library/glob.html | 2378 | `glob <https://docs.python.org/3/library/glob.html>`_ |
2177 | syntax. For details on the syntax, see the documentation by | 2379 | syntax. For details on the syntax, see the documentation by |
2178 | following the previous link. | 2380 | following the previous link. |
2179 | 2381 | ||
2180 | - When specifying paths as part of the ``FILES`` variable, it is | 2382 | - When specifying paths as part of the ``FILES`` variable, it is |
2181 | good practice to use appropriate path variables. For example, | 2383 | good practice to use appropriate path variables. For example, |
2182 | use ``${sysconfdir}`` rather than ``/etc``, or ``${bindir}`` | 2384 | use ``${sysconfdir}`` rather than ``/etc``, or ``${bindir}`` |
@@ -2185,24 +2387,26 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2185 | the :term:`Source Directory`. You will also | 2387 | the :term:`Source Directory`. You will also |
2186 | find the default values of the various ``FILES_*`` variables in | 2388 | find the default values of the various ``FILES_*`` variables in |
2187 | this file. | 2389 | this file. |
2188 | 2390 | ||
2189 | If some of the files you provide with the ``FILES`` variable are | 2391 | If some of the files you provide with the ``FILES`` variable are |
2190 | editable and you know they should not be overwritten during the | 2392 | editable and you know they should not be overwritten during the |
2191 | package update process by the Package Management System (PMS), you | 2393 | package update process by the Package Management System (PMS), you |
2192 | can identify these files so that the PMS will not overwrite them. See | 2394 | can identify these files so that the PMS will not overwrite them. See |
2193 | the :term:`CONFFILES` variable for information on | 2395 | the :term:`CONFFILES` variable for information on |
2194 | how to identify these files to the PMS. | 2396 | how to identify these files to the PMS. |
2195 | 2397 | ||
2196 | FILES_SOLIBSDEV | 2398 | FILES_SOLIBSDEV |
2197 | Defines the file specification to match | 2399 | Defines the file specification to match |
2198 | :term:`SOLIBSDEV`. In other words, | 2400 | :term:`SOLIBSDEV`. In other words, |
2199 | ``FILES_SOLIBSDEV`` defines the full path name of the development | 2401 | ``FILES_SOLIBSDEV`` defines the full path name of the development |
2200 | symbolic link (symlink) for shared libraries on the target platform. | 2402 | symbolic link (symlink) for shared libraries on the target platform. |
2201 | 2403 | ||
2202 | The following statement from the ``bitbake.conf`` shows how it is | 2404 | The following statement from the ``bitbake.conf`` shows how it is |
2203 | set: FILES_SOLIBSDEV ?= "${base_libdir}/lib*${SOLIBSDEV} | 2405 | set: |
2204 | ${libdir}/lib*${SOLIBSDEV}" | 2406 | :: |
2205 | 2407 | ||
2408 | FILES_SOLIBSDEV ?= "${base_libdir}/lib*${SOLIBSDEV} ${libdir}/lib*${SOLIBSDEV}" | ||
2409 | |||
2206 | FILESEXTRAPATHS | 2410 | FILESEXTRAPATHS |
2207 | Extends the search path the OpenEmbedded build system uses when | 2411 | Extends the search path the OpenEmbedded build system uses when |
2208 | looking for files and patches as it processes recipes and append | 2412 | looking for files and patches as it processes recipes and append |
@@ -2210,58 +2414,71 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2210 | are initially defined by the :term:`FILESPATH` | 2414 | are initially defined by the :term:`FILESPATH` |
2211 | variable. You can extend ``FILESPATH`` variable by using | 2415 | variable. You can extend ``FILESPATH`` variable by using |
2212 | ``FILESEXTRAPATHS``. | 2416 | ``FILESEXTRAPATHS``. |
2213 | 2417 | ||
2214 | Best practices dictate that you accomplish this by using | 2418 | Best practices dictate that you accomplish this by using |
2215 | ``FILESEXTRAPATHS`` from within a ``.bbappend`` file and that you | 2419 | ``FILESEXTRAPATHS`` from within a ``.bbappend`` file and that you |
2216 | prepend paths as follows: FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend := | 2420 | prepend paths as follows: |
2217 | "${THISDIR}/${PN}:" In the above example, the build system first | 2421 | :: |
2422 | |||
2423 | FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend := "${THISDIR}/${PN}:" | ||
2424 | |||
2425 | In the above example, the build system first | ||
2218 | looks for files in a directory that has the same name as the | 2426 | looks for files in a directory that has the same name as the |
2219 | corresponding append file. | 2427 | corresponding append file. |
2220 | 2428 | ||
2221 | .. note:: | 2429 | .. note:: |
2222 | 2430 | ||
2223 | When extending ``FILESEXTRAPATHS``, be sure to use the immediate | 2431 | When extending ``FILESEXTRAPATHS``, be sure to use the immediate |
2224 | expansion (``:=``) operator. Immediate expansion makes sure that | 2432 | expansion (``:=``) operator. Immediate expansion makes sure that |
2225 | BitBake evaluates :term:`THISDIR` at the time the | 2433 | BitBake evaluates :term:`THISDIR` at the time the |
2226 | directive is encountered rather than at some later time when | 2434 | directive is encountered rather than at some later time when |
2227 | expansion might result in a directory that does not contain the | 2435 | expansion might result in a directory that does not contain the |
2228 | files you need. | 2436 | files you need. |
2229 | 2437 | ||
2230 | Also, include the trailing separating colon character if you are | 2438 | Also, include the trailing separating colon character if you are |
2231 | prepending. The trailing colon character is necessary because you | 2439 | prepending. The trailing colon character is necessary because you |
2232 | are directing BitBake to extend the path by prepending directories | 2440 | are directing BitBake to extend the path by prepending directories |
2233 | to the search path. | 2441 | to the search path. |
2234 | 2442 | ||
2235 | Here is another common use: FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend := | 2443 | Here is another common use: |
2236 | "${THISDIR}/files:" In this example, the build system extends the | 2444 | :: |
2445 | |||
2446 | FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend := "${THISDIR}/files:" | ||
2447 | |||
2448 | In this example, the build system extends the | ||
2237 | ``FILESPATH`` variable to include a directory named ``files`` that is | 2449 | ``FILESPATH`` variable to include a directory named ``files`` that is |
2238 | in the same directory as the corresponding append file. | 2450 | in the same directory as the corresponding append file. |
2239 | 2451 | ||
2240 | This next example specifically adds three paths: | 2452 | This next example specifically adds three paths: |
2241 | FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend := "path_1:path_2:path_3:" | 2453 | :: |
2242 | 2454 | ||
2455 | FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend := "path_1:path_2:path_3:" | ||
2456 | |||
2243 | A final example shows how you can extend the search path and include | 2457 | A final example shows how you can extend the search path and include |
2244 | a :term:`MACHINE`-specific override, which is useful | 2458 | a :term:`MACHINE`-specific override, which is useful |
2245 | in a BSP layer: FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend_intel-x86-common := | 2459 | in a BSP layer: |
2246 | "${THISDIR}/${PN}:" The previous statement appears in the | 2460 | :: |
2247 | ``linux-yocto-dev.bbappend`` file, which is found in the Yocto | 2461 | |
2248 | Project `Source | 2462 | FILESEXTRAPATHS_prepend_intel-x86-common := "${THISDIR}/${PN}:" |
2249 | Repositories <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#source-repositories>`__ in | 2463 | |
2464 | The previous statement appears in the | ||
2465 | ``linux-yocto-dev.bbappend`` file, which is found in the | ||
2466 | :ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-development-environment:yocto project source repositories` in | ||
2250 | ``meta-intel/common/recipes-kernel/linux``. Here, the machine | 2467 | ``meta-intel/common/recipes-kernel/linux``. Here, the machine |
2251 | override is a special :term:`PACKAGE_ARCH` | 2468 | override is a special :term:`PACKAGE_ARCH` |
2252 | definition for multiple ``meta-intel`` machines. | 2469 | definition for multiple ``meta-intel`` machines. |
2253 | 2470 | ||
2254 | .. note:: | 2471 | .. note:: |
2255 | 2472 | ||
2256 | For a layer that supports a single BSP, the override could just be | 2473 | For a layer that supports a single BSP, the override could just be |
2257 | the value of | 2474 | the value of |
2258 | MACHINE | 2475 | MACHINE |
2259 | . | 2476 | . |
2260 | 2477 | ||
2261 | By prepending paths in ``.bbappend`` files, you allow multiple append | 2478 | By prepending paths in ``.bbappend`` files, you allow multiple append |
2262 | files that reside in different layers but are used for the same | 2479 | files that reside in different layers but are used for the same |
2263 | recipe to correctly extend the path. | 2480 | recipe to correctly extend the path. |
2264 | 2481 | ||
2265 | FILESOVERRIDES | 2482 | FILESOVERRIDES |
2266 | A subset of :term:`OVERRIDES` used by the | 2483 | A subset of :term:`OVERRIDES` used by the |
2267 | OpenEmbedded build system for creating | 2484 | OpenEmbedded build system for creating |
@@ -2273,53 +2490,63 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2273 | are handled in the | 2490 | are handled in the |
2274 | ":ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:conditional syntax (overrides)`" | 2491 | ":ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:conditional syntax (overrides)`" |
2275 | section of the BitBake User Manual. | 2492 | section of the BitBake User Manual. |
2276 | 2493 | ||
2277 | By default, the ``FILESOVERRIDES`` variable is defined as: | 2494 | By default, the ``FILESOVERRIDES`` variable is defined as: |
2278 | FILESOVERRIDES = | 2495 | :: |
2279 | "${TRANSLATED_TARGET_ARCH}:${MACHINEOVERRIDES}:${DISTROOVERRIDES}" | 2496 | |
2280 | 2497 | FILESOVERRIDES = "${TRANSLATED_TARGET_ARCH}:${MACHINEOVERRIDES}:${DISTROOVERRIDES}" | |
2498 | |||
2281 | .. note:: | 2499 | .. note:: |
2282 | 2500 | ||
2283 | Do not hand-edit the | 2501 | Do not hand-edit the |
2284 | FILESOVERRIDES | 2502 | FILESOVERRIDES |
2285 | variable. The values match up with expected overrides and are used | 2503 | variable. The values match up with expected overrides and are used |
2286 | in an expected manner by the build system. | 2504 | in an expected manner by the build system. |
2287 | 2505 | ||
2288 | FILESPATH | 2506 | FILESPATH |
2289 | The default set of directories the OpenEmbedded build system uses | 2507 | The default set of directories the OpenEmbedded build system uses |
2290 | when searching for patches and files. | 2508 | when searching for patches and files. |
2291 | 2509 | ||
2292 | During the build process, BitBake searches each directory in | 2510 | During the build process, BitBake searches each directory in |
2293 | ``FILESPATH`` in the specified order when looking for files and | 2511 | ``FILESPATH`` in the specified order when looking for files and |
2294 | patches specified by each ``file://`` URI in a recipe's | 2512 | patches specified by each ``file://`` URI in a recipe's |
2295 | :term:`SRC_URI` statements. | 2513 | :term:`SRC_URI` statements. |
2296 | 2514 | ||
2297 | The default value for the ``FILESPATH`` variable is defined in the | 2515 | The default value for the ``FILESPATH`` variable is defined in the |
2298 | ``base.bbclass`` class found in ``meta/classes`` in the | 2516 | ``base.bbclass`` class found in ``meta/classes`` in the |
2299 | :term:`Source Directory`: FILESPATH = | 2517 | :term:`Source Directory`: |
2300 | "${@base_set_filespath(["${FILE_DIRNAME}/${BP}", \\ | 2518 | :: |
2301 | "${FILE_DIRNAME}/${BPN}", "${FILE_DIRNAME}/files"], d)}" The | 2519 | |
2520 | FILESPATH = "${@base_set_filespath(["${FILE_DIRNAME}/${BP}", \ | ||
2521 | "${FILE_DIRNAME}/${BPN}", "${FILE_DIRNAME}/files"], d)}" | ||
2522 | |||
2523 | The | ||
2302 | ``FILESPATH`` variable is automatically extended using the overrides | 2524 | ``FILESPATH`` variable is automatically extended using the overrides |
2303 | from the :term:`FILESOVERRIDES` variable. | 2525 | from the :term:`FILESOVERRIDES` variable. |
2304 | 2526 | ||
2305 | .. note:: | 2527 | .. note:: |
2306 | 2528 | ||
2307 | - Do not hand-edit the ``FILESPATH`` variable. If you want the | 2529 | - Do not hand-edit the ``FILESPATH`` variable. If you want the |
2308 | build system to look in directories other than the defaults, | 2530 | build system to look in directories other than the defaults, |
2309 | extend the ``FILESPATH`` variable by using the | 2531 | extend the ``FILESPATH`` variable by using the |
2310 | :term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS` variable. | 2532 | :term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS` variable. |
2311 | 2533 | ||
2312 | - Be aware that the default ``FILESPATH`` directories do not map | 2534 | - Be aware that the default ``FILESPATH`` directories do not map |
2313 | to directories in custom layers where append files | 2535 | to directories in custom layers where append files |
2314 | (``.bbappend``) are used. If you want the build system to find | 2536 | (``.bbappend``) are used. If you want the build system to find |
2315 | patches or files that reside with your append files, you need | 2537 | patches or files that reside with your append files, you need |
2316 | to extend the ``FILESPATH`` variable by using the | 2538 | to extend the ``FILESPATH`` variable by using the |
2317 | ``FILESEXTRAPATHS`` variable. | 2539 | ``FILESEXTRAPATHS`` variable. |
2318 | 2540 | ||
2319 | You can take advantage of this searching behavior in useful ways. For | 2541 | You can take advantage of this searching behavior in useful ways. For |
2320 | example, consider a case where the following directory structure | 2542 | example, consider a case where the following directory structure |
2321 | exists for general and machine-specific configurations: | 2543 | exists for general and machine-specific configurations: |
2322 | files/defconfig files/MACHINEA/defconfig files/MACHINEB/defconfig | 2544 | :: |
2545 | |||
2546 | files/defconfig | ||
2547 | files/MACHINEA/defconfig | ||
2548 | files/MACHINEB/defconfig | ||
2549 | |||
2323 | Also in the example, the ``SRC_URI`` statement contains | 2550 | Also in the example, the ``SRC_URI`` statement contains |
2324 | "file://defconfig". Given this scenario, you can set | 2551 | "file://defconfig". Given this scenario, you can set |
2325 | :term:`MACHINE` to "MACHINEA" and cause the build | 2552 | :term:`MACHINE` to "MACHINEA" and cause the build |
@@ -2327,37 +2554,37 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2327 | "MACHINEB" and the build system uses files from ``files/MACHINEB``. | 2554 | "MACHINEB" and the build system uses files from ``files/MACHINEB``. |
2328 | Finally, for any machine other than "MACHINEA" and "MACHINEB", the | 2555 | Finally, for any machine other than "MACHINEA" and "MACHINEB", the |
2329 | build system uses files from ``files/defconfig``. | 2556 | build system uses files from ``files/defconfig``. |
2330 | 2557 | ||
2331 | You can find out more about the patching process in the | 2558 | You can find out more about the patching process in the |
2332 | "`Patching <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#patching-dev-environment>`__" section | 2559 | ":ref:`patching-dev-environment`" section |
2333 | in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual and the "`Patching | 2560 | in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual and the |
2334 | Code <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#new-recipe-patching-code>`__" section in | 2561 | ":ref:`new-recipe-patching-code`" section in |
2335 | the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. See the | 2562 | the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. See the |
2336 | :ref:`ref-tasks-patch` task as well. | 2563 | :ref:`ref-tasks-patch` task as well. |
2337 | 2564 | ||
2338 | FILESYSTEM_PERMS_TABLES | 2565 | FILESYSTEM_PERMS_TABLES |
2339 | Allows you to define your own file permissions settings table as part | 2566 | Allows you to define your own file permissions settings table as part |
2340 | of your configuration for the packaging process. For example, suppose | 2567 | of your configuration for the packaging process. For example, suppose |
2341 | you need a consistent set of custom permissions for a set of groups | 2568 | you need a consistent set of custom permissions for a set of groups |
2342 | and users across an entire work project. It is best to do this in the | 2569 | and users across an entire work project. It is best to do this in the |
2343 | packages themselves but this is not always possible. | 2570 | packages themselves but this is not always possible. |
2344 | 2571 | ||
2345 | By default, the OpenEmbedded build system uses the ``fs-perms.txt``, | 2572 | By default, the OpenEmbedded build system uses the ``fs-perms.txt``, |
2346 | which is located in the ``meta/files`` folder in the :term:`Source Directory`. | 2573 | which is located in the ``meta/files`` folder in the :term:`Source Directory`. |
2347 | If you create your own file | 2574 | If you create your own file |
2348 | permissions setting table, you should place it in your layer or the | 2575 | permissions setting table, you should place it in your layer or the |
2349 | distro's layer. | 2576 | distro's layer. |
2350 | 2577 | ||
2351 | You define the ``FILESYSTEM_PERMS_TABLES`` variable in the | 2578 | You define the ``FILESYSTEM_PERMS_TABLES`` variable in the |
2352 | ``conf/local.conf`` file, which is found in the :term:`Build Directory`, | 2579 | ``conf/local.conf`` file, which is found in the :term:`Build Directory`, |
2353 | to point to your custom | 2580 | to point to your custom |
2354 | ``fs-perms.txt``. You can specify more than a single file permissions | 2581 | ``fs-perms.txt``. You can specify more than a single file permissions |
2355 | setting table. The paths you specify to these files must be defined | 2582 | setting table. The paths you specify to these files must be defined |
2356 | within the :term:`BBPATH` variable. | 2583 | within the :term:`BBPATH` variable. |
2357 | 2584 | ||
2358 | For guidance on how to create your own file permissions settings | 2585 | For guidance on how to create your own file permissions settings |
2359 | table file, examine the existing ``fs-perms.txt``. | 2586 | table file, examine the existing ``fs-perms.txt``. |
2360 | 2587 | ||
2361 | FIT_HASH_ALG | 2588 | FIT_HASH_ALG |
2362 | Specifies the hash algorithm used in creating the FIT Image. For e.g. sha256. | 2589 | Specifies the hash algorithm used in creating the FIT Image. For e.g. sha256. |
2363 | 2590 | ||
@@ -2369,7 +2596,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2369 | When inheriting the :ref:`fontcache <ref-classes-fontcache>` class, | 2596 | When inheriting the :ref:`fontcache <ref-classes-fontcache>` class, |
2370 | this variable specifies the runtime dependencies for font packages. | 2597 | this variable specifies the runtime dependencies for font packages. |
2371 | By default, the ``FONT_EXTRA_RDEPENDS`` is set to "fontconfig-utils". | 2598 | By default, the ``FONT_EXTRA_RDEPENDS`` is set to "fontconfig-utils". |
2372 | 2599 | ||
2373 | FONT_PACKAGES | 2600 | FONT_PACKAGES |
2374 | When inheriting the :ref:`fontcache <ref-classes-fontcache>` class, | 2601 | When inheriting the :ref:`fontcache <ref-classes-fontcache>` class, |
2375 | this variable identifies packages containing font files that need to | 2602 | this variable identifies packages containing font files that need to |
@@ -2377,168 +2604,189 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2377 | that fonts are in the recipe's main package (i.e. | 2604 | that fonts are in the recipe's main package (i.e. |
2378 | ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``). Use this variable if fonts you | 2605 | ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``). Use this variable if fonts you |
2379 | need are in a package other than that main package. | 2606 | need are in a package other than that main package. |
2380 | 2607 | ||
2381 | FORCE_RO_REMOVE | 2608 | FORCE_RO_REMOVE |
2382 | Forces the removal of the packages listed in ``ROOTFS_RO_UNNEEDED`` | 2609 | Forces the removal of the packages listed in ``ROOTFS_RO_UNNEEDED`` |
2383 | during the generation of the root filesystem. | 2610 | during the generation of the root filesystem. |
2384 | 2611 | ||
2385 | Set the variable to "1" to force the removal of these packages. | 2612 | Set the variable to "1" to force the removal of these packages. |
2386 | 2613 | ||
2387 | FULL_OPTIMIZATION | 2614 | FULL_OPTIMIZATION |
2388 | The options to pass in ``TARGET_CFLAGS`` and ``CFLAGS`` when | 2615 | The options to pass in ``TARGET_CFLAGS`` and ``CFLAGS`` when |
2389 | compiling an optimized system. This variable defaults to "-O2 -pipe | 2616 | compiling an optimized system. This variable defaults to "-O2 -pipe |
2390 | ${DEBUG_FLAGS}". | 2617 | ${DEBUG_FLAGS}". |
2391 | 2618 | ||
2392 | GCCPIE | 2619 | GCCPIE |
2393 | Enables Position Independent Executables (PIE) within the GNU C | 2620 | Enables Position Independent Executables (PIE) within the GNU C |
2394 | Compiler (GCC). Enabling PIE in the GCC makes Return Oriented | 2621 | Compiler (GCC). Enabling PIE in the GCC makes Return Oriented |
2395 | Programming (ROP) attacks much more difficult to execute. | 2622 | Programming (ROP) attacks much more difficult to execute. |
2396 | 2623 | ||
2397 | By default the ``security_flags.inc`` file enables PIE by setting the | 2624 | By default the ``security_flags.inc`` file enables PIE by setting the |
2398 | variable as follows: GCCPIE ?= "--enable-default-pie" | 2625 | variable as follows: |
2399 | 2626 | :: | |
2627 | |||
2628 | GCCPIE ?= "--enable-default-pie" | ||
2629 | |||
2400 | GCCVERSION | 2630 | GCCVERSION |
2401 | Specifies the default version of the GNU C Compiler (GCC) used for | 2631 | Specifies the default version of the GNU C Compiler (GCC) used for |
2402 | compilation. By default, ``GCCVERSION`` is set to "8.x" in the | 2632 | compilation. By default, ``GCCVERSION`` is set to "8.x" in the |
2403 | ``meta/conf/distro/include/tcmode-default.inc`` include file: | 2633 | ``meta/conf/distro/include/tcmode-default.inc`` include file: |
2404 | GCCVERSION ?= "8.%" You can override this value by setting it in a | 2634 | :: |
2635 | |||
2636 | GCCVERSION ?= "8.%" | ||
2637 | |||
2638 | You can override this value by setting it in a | ||
2405 | configuration file such as the ``local.conf``. | 2639 | configuration file such as the ``local.conf``. |
2406 | 2640 | ||
2407 | GDB | 2641 | GDB |
2408 | The minimal command and arguments to run the GNU Debugger. | 2642 | The minimal command and arguments to run the GNU Debugger. |
2409 | 2643 | ||
2410 | GITDIR | 2644 | GITDIR |
2411 | The directory in which a local copy of a Git repository is stored | 2645 | The directory in which a local copy of a Git repository is stored |
2412 | when it is cloned. | 2646 | when it is cloned. |
2413 | 2647 | ||
2414 | GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES | 2648 | GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES |
2415 | Specifies the list of GLIBC locales to generate should you not wish | 2649 | Specifies the list of GLIBC locales to generate should you not wish |
2416 | to generate all LIBC locals, which can be time consuming. | 2650 | to generate all LIBC locals, which can be time consuming. |
2417 | 2651 | ||
2418 | .. note:: | 2652 | .. note:: |
2419 | 2653 | ||
2420 | If you specifically remove the locale | 2654 | If you specifically remove the locale |
2421 | en_US.UTF-8 | 2655 | en_US.UTF-8 |
2422 | , you must set | 2656 | , you must set |
2423 | IMAGE_LINGUAS | 2657 | IMAGE_LINGUAS |
2424 | appropriately. | 2658 | appropriately. |
2425 | 2659 | ||
2426 | You can set ``GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES`` in your ``local.conf`` file. | 2660 | You can set ``GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES`` in your ``local.conf`` file. |
2427 | By default, all locales are generated. GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES = | 2661 | By default, all locales are generated. |
2428 | "en_GB.UTF-8 en_US.UTF-8" | 2662 | :: |
2429 | 2663 | ||
2664 | GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES = "en_GB.UTF-8 en_US.UTF-8" | ||
2665 | |||
2430 | GROUPADD_PARAM | 2666 | GROUPADD_PARAM |
2431 | When inheriting the :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class, | 2667 | When inheriting the :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class, |
2432 | this variable specifies for a package what parameters should be | 2668 | this variable specifies for a package what parameters should be |
2433 | passed to the ``groupadd`` command if you wish to add a group to the | 2669 | passed to the ``groupadd`` command if you wish to add a group to the |
2434 | system when the package is installed. | 2670 | system when the package is installed. |
2435 | 2671 | ||
2436 | Here is an example from the ``dbus`` recipe: GROUPADD_PARAM_${PN} = | 2672 | Here is an example from the ``dbus`` recipe: |
2437 | "-r netdev" For information on the standard Linux shell command | 2673 | :: |
2674 | |||
2675 | GROUPADD_PARAM_${PN} = "-r netdev" | ||
2676 | |||
2677 | For information on the standard Linux shell command | ||
2438 | ``groupadd``, see http://linux.die.net/man/8/groupadd. | 2678 | ``groupadd``, see http://linux.die.net/man/8/groupadd. |
2439 | 2679 | ||
2440 | GROUPMEMS_PARAM | 2680 | GROUPMEMS_PARAM |
2441 | When inheriting the :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class, | 2681 | When inheriting the :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class, |
2442 | this variable specifies for a package what parameters should be | 2682 | this variable specifies for a package what parameters should be |
2443 | passed to the ``groupmems`` command if you wish to modify the members | 2683 | passed to the ``groupmems`` command if you wish to modify the members |
2444 | of a group when the package is installed. | 2684 | of a group when the package is installed. |
2445 | 2685 | ||
2446 | For information on the standard Linux shell command ``groupmems``, | 2686 | For information on the standard Linux shell command ``groupmems``, |
2447 | see http://linux.die.net/man/8/groupmems. | 2687 | see http://linux.die.net/man/8/groupmems. |
2448 | 2688 | ||
2449 | GRUB_GFXSERIAL | 2689 | GRUB_GFXSERIAL |
2450 | Configures the GNU GRand Unified Bootloader (GRUB) to have graphics | 2690 | Configures the GNU GRand Unified Bootloader (GRUB) to have graphics |
2451 | and serial in the boot menu. Set this variable to "1" in your | 2691 | and serial in the boot menu. Set this variable to "1" in your |
2452 | ``local.conf`` or distribution configuration file to enable graphics | 2692 | ``local.conf`` or distribution configuration file to enable graphics |
2453 | and serial in the menu. | 2693 | and serial in the menu. |
2454 | 2694 | ||
2455 | See the :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more | 2695 | See the :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more |
2456 | information on how this variable is used. | 2696 | information on how this variable is used. |
2457 | 2697 | ||
2458 | GRUB_OPTS | 2698 | GRUB_OPTS |
2459 | Additional options to add to the GNU GRand Unified Bootloader (GRUB) | 2699 | Additional options to add to the GNU GRand Unified Bootloader (GRUB) |
2460 | configuration. Use a semi-colon character (``;``) to separate | 2700 | configuration. Use a semi-colon character (``;``) to separate |
2461 | multiple options. | 2701 | multiple options. |
2462 | 2702 | ||
2463 | The ``GRUB_OPTS`` variable is optional. See the | 2703 | The ``GRUB_OPTS`` variable is optional. See the |
2464 | :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more information | 2704 | :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more information |
2465 | on how this variable is used. | 2705 | on how this variable is used. |
2466 | 2706 | ||
2467 | GRUB_TIMEOUT | 2707 | GRUB_TIMEOUT |
2468 | Specifies the timeout before executing the default ``LABEL`` in the | 2708 | Specifies the timeout before executing the default ``LABEL`` in the |
2469 | GNU GRand Unified Bootloader (GRUB). | 2709 | GNU GRand Unified Bootloader (GRUB). |
2470 | 2710 | ||
2471 | The ``GRUB_TIMEOUT`` variable is optional. See the | 2711 | The ``GRUB_TIMEOUT`` variable is optional. See the |
2472 | :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more information | 2712 | :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more information |
2473 | on how this variable is used. | 2713 | on how this variable is used. |
2474 | 2714 | ||
2475 | GTKIMMODULES_PACKAGES | 2715 | GTKIMMODULES_PACKAGES |
2476 | When inheriting the | 2716 | When inheriting the |
2477 | :ref:`gtk-immodules-cache <ref-classes-gtk-immodules-cache>` class, | 2717 | :ref:`gtk-immodules-cache <ref-classes-gtk-immodules-cache>` class, |
2478 | this variable specifies the packages that contain the GTK+ input | 2718 | this variable specifies the packages that contain the GTK+ input |
2479 | method modules being installed when the modules are in packages other | 2719 | method modules being installed when the modules are in packages other |
2480 | than the main package. | 2720 | than the main package. |
2481 | 2721 | ||
2482 | HOMEPAGE | 2722 | HOMEPAGE |
2483 | Website where more information about the software the recipe is | 2723 | Website where more information about the software the recipe is |
2484 | building can be found. | 2724 | building can be found. |
2485 | 2725 | ||
2486 | HOST_ARCH | 2726 | HOST_ARCH |
2487 | The name of the target architecture, which is normally the same as | 2727 | The name of the target architecture, which is normally the same as |
2488 | :term:`TARGET_ARCH`. The OpenEmbedded build system | 2728 | :term:`TARGET_ARCH`. The OpenEmbedded build system |
2489 | supports many architectures. Here is an example list of architectures | 2729 | supports many architectures. Here is an example list of architectures |
2490 | supported. This list is by no means complete as the architecture is | 2730 | supported. This list is by no means complete as the architecture is |
2491 | configurable: arm i586 x86_64 powerpc powerpc64 mips mipsel | 2731 | configurable: |
2492 | 2732 | ||
2733 | - arm | ||
2734 | - i586 | ||
2735 | - x86_64 | ||
2736 | - powerpc | ||
2737 | - powerpc64 | ||
2738 | - mips | ||
2739 | - mipsel | ||
2740 | |||
2493 | HOST_CC_ARCH | 2741 | HOST_CC_ARCH |
2494 | Specifies architecture-specific compiler flags that are passed to the | 2742 | Specifies architecture-specific compiler flags that are passed to the |
2495 | C compiler. | 2743 | C compiler. |
2496 | 2744 | ||
2497 | Default initialization for ``HOST_CC_ARCH`` varies depending on what | 2745 | Default initialization for ``HOST_CC_ARCH`` varies depending on what |
2498 | is being built: | 2746 | is being built: |
2499 | 2747 | ||
2500 | - :term:`TARGET_CC_ARCH` when building for the | 2748 | - :term:`TARGET_CC_ARCH` when building for the |
2501 | target | 2749 | target |
2502 | 2750 | ||
2503 | - ``BUILD_CC_ARCH`` when building for the build host (i.e. | 2751 | - ``BUILD_CC_ARCH`` when building for the build host (i.e. |
2504 | ``-native``) | 2752 | ``-native``) |
2505 | 2753 | ||
2506 | - ``BUILDSDK_CC_ARCH`` when building for an SDK (i.e. | 2754 | - ``BUILDSDK_CC_ARCH`` when building for an SDK (i.e. |
2507 | ``nativesdk-``) | 2755 | ``nativesdk-``) |
2508 | 2756 | ||
2509 | HOST_OS | 2757 | HOST_OS |
2510 | Specifies the name of the target operating system, which is normally | 2758 | Specifies the name of the target operating system, which is normally |
2511 | the same as the :term:`TARGET_OS`. The variable can | 2759 | the same as the :term:`TARGET_OS`. The variable can |
2512 | be set to "linux" for ``glibc``-based systems and to "linux-musl" for | 2760 | be set to "linux" for ``glibc``-based systems and to "linux-musl" for |
2513 | ``musl``. For ARM/EABI targets, there are also "linux-gnueabi" and | 2761 | ``musl``. For ARM/EABI targets, there are also "linux-gnueabi" and |
2514 | "linux-musleabi" values possible. | 2762 | "linux-musleabi" values possible. |
2515 | 2763 | ||
2516 | HOST_PREFIX | 2764 | HOST_PREFIX |
2517 | Specifies the prefix for the cross-compile toolchain. ``HOST_PREFIX`` | 2765 | Specifies the prefix for the cross-compile toolchain. ``HOST_PREFIX`` |
2518 | is normally the same as :term:`TARGET_PREFIX`. | 2766 | is normally the same as :term:`TARGET_PREFIX`. |
2519 | 2767 | ||
2520 | HOST_SYS | 2768 | HOST_SYS |
2521 | Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating | 2769 | Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating |
2522 | system, for which the build is occurring in the context of the | 2770 | system, for which the build is occurring in the context of the |
2523 | current recipe. | 2771 | current recipe. |
2524 | 2772 | ||
2525 | The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based | 2773 | The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based |
2526 | on :term:`HOST_ARCH`, | 2774 | on :term:`HOST_ARCH`, |
2527 | :term:`HOST_VENDOR`, and | 2775 | :term:`HOST_VENDOR`, and |
2528 | :term:`HOST_OS` variables. | 2776 | :term:`HOST_OS` variables. |
2529 | 2777 | ||
2530 | .. note:: | 2778 | .. note:: |
2531 | 2779 | ||
2532 | You do not need to set the variable yourself. | 2780 | You do not need to set the variable yourself. |
2533 | 2781 | ||
2534 | Consider these two examples: | 2782 | Consider these two examples: |
2535 | 2783 | ||
2536 | - Given a native recipe on a 32-bit x86 machine running Linux, the | 2784 | - Given a native recipe on a 32-bit x86 machine running Linux, the |
2537 | value is "i686-linux". | 2785 | value is "i686-linux". |
2538 | 2786 | ||
2539 | - Given a recipe being built for a little-endian MIPS target running | 2787 | - Given a recipe being built for a little-endian MIPS target running |
2540 | Linux, the value might be "mipsel-linux". | 2788 | Linux, the value might be "mipsel-linux". |
2541 | 2789 | ||
2542 | HOSTTOOLS | 2790 | HOSTTOOLS |
2543 | A space-separated list (filter) of tools on the build host that | 2791 | A space-separated list (filter) of tools on the build host that |
2544 | should be allowed to be called from within build tasks. Using this | 2792 | should be allowed to be called from within build tasks. Using this |
@@ -2546,10 +2794,10 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2546 | specified in the value of ``HOSTTOOLS`` is not found on the build | 2794 | specified in the value of ``HOSTTOOLS`` is not found on the build |
2547 | host, the OpenEmbedded build system produces an error and the build | 2795 | host, the OpenEmbedded build system produces an error and the build |
2548 | is not started. | 2796 | is not started. |
2549 | 2797 | ||
2550 | For additional information, see | 2798 | For additional information, see |
2551 | :term:`HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL`. | 2799 | :term:`HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL`. |
2552 | 2800 | ||
2553 | HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL | 2801 | HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL |
2554 | A space-separated list (filter) of tools on the build host that | 2802 | A space-separated list (filter) of tools on the build host that |
2555 | should be allowed to be called from within build tasks. Using this | 2803 | should be allowed to be called from within build tasks. Using this |
@@ -2558,44 +2806,51 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2558 | does not produce an error if a tool specified in the value of | 2806 | does not produce an error if a tool specified in the value of |
2559 | ``HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL`` is not found on the build host. Thus, you can | 2807 | ``HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL`` is not found on the build host. Thus, you can |
2560 | use ``HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL`` to filter optional host tools. | 2808 | use ``HOSTTOOLS_NONFATAL`` to filter optional host tools. |
2561 | 2809 | ||
2562 | HOST_VENDOR | 2810 | HOST_VENDOR |
2563 | Specifies the name of the vendor. ``HOST_VENDOR`` is normally the | 2811 | Specifies the name of the vendor. ``HOST_VENDOR`` is normally the |
2564 | same as :term:`TARGET_VENDOR`. | 2812 | same as :term:`TARGET_VENDOR`. |
2565 | 2813 | ||
2566 | ICECC_DISABLED | 2814 | ICECC_DISABLED |
2567 | Disables or enables the ``icecc`` (Icecream) function. For more | 2815 | Disables or enables the ``icecc`` (Icecream) function. For more |
2568 | information on this function and best practices for using this | 2816 | information on this function and best practices for using this |
2569 | variable, see the ":ref:`icecc.bbclass <ref-classes-icecc>`" | 2817 | variable, see the ":ref:`icecc.bbclass <ref-classes-icecc>`" |
2570 | section. | 2818 | section. |
2571 | 2819 | ||
2572 | Setting this variable to "1" in your ``local.conf`` disables the | 2820 | Setting this variable to "1" in your ``local.conf`` disables the |
2573 | function: ICECC_DISABLED ??= "1" To enable the function, set the | 2821 | function: |
2574 | variable as follows: ICECC_DISABLED = "" | 2822 | :: |
2575 | 2823 | ||
2824 | ICECC_DISABLED ??= "1" | ||
2825 | |||
2826 | To enable the function, set the variable as follows: | ||
2827 | :: | ||
2828 | |||
2829 | ICECC_DISABLED = "" | ||
2830 | |||
2576 | ICECC_ENV_EXEC | 2831 | ICECC_ENV_EXEC |
2577 | Points to the ``icecc-create-env`` script that you provide. This | 2832 | Points to the ``icecc-create-env`` script that you provide. This |
2578 | variable is used by the :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class. You | 2833 | variable is used by the :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class. You |
2579 | set this variable in your ``local.conf`` file. | 2834 | set this variable in your ``local.conf`` file. |
2580 | 2835 | ||
2581 | If you do not point to a script that you provide, the OpenEmbedded | 2836 | If you do not point to a script that you provide, the OpenEmbedded |
2582 | build system uses the default script provided by the | 2837 | build system uses the default script provided by the |
2583 | ``icecc-create-env.bb`` recipe, which is a modified version and not | 2838 | ``icecc-create-env.bb`` recipe, which is a modified version and not |
2584 | the one that comes with ``icecc``. | 2839 | the one that comes with ``icecc``. |
2585 | 2840 | ||
2586 | ICECC_PARALLEL_MAKE | 2841 | ICECC_PARALLEL_MAKE |
2587 | Extra options passed to the ``make`` command during the | 2842 | Extra options passed to the ``make`` command during the |
2588 | :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task that specify parallel | 2843 | :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task that specify parallel |
2589 | compilation. This variable usually takes the form of "-j x", where x | 2844 | compilation. This variable usually takes the form of "-j x", where x |
2590 | represents the maximum number of parallel threads ``make`` can run. | 2845 | represents the maximum number of parallel threads ``make`` can run. |
2591 | 2846 | ||
2592 | .. note:: | 2847 | .. note:: |
2593 | 2848 | ||
2594 | The options passed affect builds on all enabled machines on the | 2849 | The options passed affect builds on all enabled machines on the |
2595 | network, which are machines running the | 2850 | network, which are machines running the |
2596 | iceccd | 2851 | iceccd |
2597 | daemon. | 2852 | daemon. |
2598 | 2853 | ||
2599 | If your enabled machines support multiple cores, coming up with the | 2854 | If your enabled machines support multiple cores, coming up with the |
2600 | maximum number of parallel threads that gives you the best | 2855 | maximum number of parallel threads that gives you the best |
2601 | performance could take some experimentation since machine speed, | 2856 | performance could take some experimentation since machine speed, |
@@ -2604,37 +2859,37 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2604 | :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable, there is no | 2859 | :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable, there is no |
2605 | rule-of-thumb for setting ``ICECC_PARALLEL_MAKE`` to achieve optimal | 2860 | rule-of-thumb for setting ``ICECC_PARALLEL_MAKE`` to achieve optimal |
2606 | performance. | 2861 | performance. |
2607 | 2862 | ||
2608 | If you do not set ``ICECC_PARALLEL_MAKE``, the build system does not | 2863 | If you do not set ``ICECC_PARALLEL_MAKE``, the build system does not |
2609 | use it (i.e. the system does not detect and assign the number of | 2864 | use it (i.e. the system does not detect and assign the number of |
2610 | cores as is done with ``PARALLEL_MAKE``). | 2865 | cores as is done with ``PARALLEL_MAKE``). |
2611 | 2866 | ||
2612 | ICECC_PATH | 2867 | ICECC_PATH |
2613 | The location of the ``icecc`` binary. You can set this variable in | 2868 | The location of the ``icecc`` binary. You can set this variable in |
2614 | your ``local.conf`` file. If your ``local.conf`` file does not define | 2869 | your ``local.conf`` file. If your ``local.conf`` file does not define |
2615 | this variable, the :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class attempts | 2870 | this variable, the :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class attempts |
2616 | to define it by locating ``icecc`` using ``which``. | 2871 | to define it by locating ``icecc`` using ``which``. |
2617 | 2872 | ||
2618 | ICECC_USER_CLASS_BL | 2873 | ICECC_USER_CLASS_BL |
2619 | Identifies user classes that you do not want the Icecream distributed | 2874 | Identifies user classes that you do not want the Icecream distributed |
2620 | compile support to consider. This variable is used by the | 2875 | compile support to consider. This variable is used by the |
2621 | :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class. You set this variable in | 2876 | :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class. You set this variable in |
2622 | your ``local.conf`` file. | 2877 | your ``local.conf`` file. |
2623 | 2878 | ||
2624 | When you list classes using this variable, you are "blacklisting" | 2879 | When you list classes using this variable, you are "blacklisting" |
2625 | them from distributed compilation across remote hosts. Any classes | 2880 | them from distributed compilation across remote hosts. Any classes |
2626 | you list will be distributed and compiled locally. | 2881 | you list will be distributed and compiled locally. |
2627 | 2882 | ||
2628 | ICECC_USER_PACKAGE_BL | 2883 | ICECC_USER_PACKAGE_BL |
2629 | Identifies user recipes that you do not want the Icecream distributed | 2884 | Identifies user recipes that you do not want the Icecream distributed |
2630 | compile support to consider. This variable is used by the | 2885 | compile support to consider. This variable is used by the |
2631 | :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class. You set this variable in | 2886 | :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class. You set this variable in |
2632 | your ``local.conf`` file. | 2887 | your ``local.conf`` file. |
2633 | 2888 | ||
2634 | When you list packages using this variable, you are "blacklisting" | 2889 | When you list packages using this variable, you are "blacklisting" |
2635 | them from distributed compilation across remote hosts. Any packages | 2890 | them from distributed compilation across remote hosts. Any packages |
2636 | you list will be distributed and compiled locally. | 2891 | you list will be distributed and compiled locally. |
2637 | 2892 | ||
2638 | ICECC_USER_PACKAGE_WL | 2893 | ICECC_USER_PACKAGE_WL |
2639 | Identifies user recipes that use an empty | 2894 | Identifies user recipes that use an empty |
2640 | :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable that you want to | 2895 | :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable that you want to |
@@ -2642,67 +2897,76 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2642 | distributed compile support. This variable is used by the | 2897 | distributed compile support. This variable is used by the |
2643 | :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class. You set this variable in | 2898 | :ref:`icecc <ref-classes-icecc>` class. You set this variable in |
2644 | your ``local.conf`` file. | 2899 | your ``local.conf`` file. |
2645 | 2900 | ||
2646 | IMAGE_BASENAME | 2901 | IMAGE_BASENAME |
2647 | The base name of image output files. This variable defaults to the | 2902 | The base name of image output files. This variable defaults to the |
2648 | recipe name (``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``). | 2903 | recipe name (``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``). |
2649 | 2904 | ||
2650 | IMAGE_BOOT_FILES | 2905 | IMAGE_BOOT_FILES |
2651 | A space-separated list of files installed into the boot partition | 2906 | A space-separated list of files installed into the boot partition |
2652 | when preparing an image using the Wic tool with the | 2907 | when preparing an image using the Wic tool with the |
2653 | ``bootimg-partition`` or ``bootimg-efi`` source plugin. By default, | 2908 | ``bootimg-partition`` or ``bootimg-efi`` source plugin. By default, |
2654 | the files are | 2909 | the files are |
2655 | installed under the same name as the source files. To change the | 2910 | installed under the same name as the source files. To change the |
2656 | installed name, separate it from the original name with a semi-colon | 2911 | installed name, separate it from the original name with a semi-colon |
2657 | (;). Source files need to be located in | 2912 | (;). Source files need to be located in |
2658 | :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE`. Here are two | 2913 | :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE`. Here are two |
2659 | examples: IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "u-boot.img uImage;kernel" | 2914 | examples: |
2660 | IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "u-boot.${UBOOT_SUFFIX} ${KERNEL_IMAGETYPE}" | 2915 | :: |
2661 | 2916 | ||
2917 | IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "u-boot.img uImage;kernel" | ||
2918 | IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "u-boot.${UBOOT_SUFFIX} ${KERNEL_IMAGETYPE}" | ||
2919 | |||
2662 | Alternatively, source files can be picked up using a glob pattern. In | 2920 | Alternatively, source files can be picked up using a glob pattern. In |
2663 | this case, the destination file must have the same name as the base | 2921 | this case, the destination file must have the same name as the base |
2664 | name of the source file path. To install files into a directory | 2922 | name of the source file path. To install files into a directory |
2665 | within the target location, pass its name after a semi-colon (;). | 2923 | within the target location, pass its name after a semi-colon (;). |
2666 | Here are two examples: IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "bcm2835-bootfiles/*" | 2924 | Here are two examples: |
2667 | IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "bcm2835-bootfiles/*;boot/" The first example | 2925 | :: |
2926 | |||
2927 | IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "bcm2835-bootfiles/*" | ||
2928 | IMAGE_BOOT_FILES = "bcm2835-bootfiles/*;boot/" | ||
2929 | |||
2930 | The first example | ||
2668 | installs all files from ``${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}/bcm2835-bootfiles`` | 2931 | installs all files from ``${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}/bcm2835-bootfiles`` |
2669 | into the root of the target partition. The second example installs | 2932 | into the root of the target partition. The second example installs |
2670 | the same files into a ``boot`` directory within the target partition. | 2933 | the same files into a ``boot`` directory within the target partition. |
2671 | 2934 | ||
2672 | You can find information on how to use the Wic tool in the "`Creating | 2935 | You can find information on how to use the Wic tool in the |
2673 | Partitioned Images Using | 2936 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:creating partitioned images using wic`" |
2674 | Wic <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#creating-partitioned-images-using-wic>`__" | ||
2675 | section of the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. Reference | 2937 | section of the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. Reference |
2676 | material for Wic is located in the "`OpenEmbedded Kickstart (.wks) | 2938 | material for Wic is located in the |
2677 | Reference <&YOCTO_DOCS_REF_URL;#ref-kickstart>`__" chapter. | 2939 | ":doc:`../ref-manual/ref-kickstart`" chapter. |
2678 | 2940 | ||
2679 | IMAGE_CLASSES | 2941 | IMAGE_CLASSES |
2680 | A list of classes that all images should inherit. You typically use | 2942 | A list of classes that all images should inherit. You typically use |
2681 | this variable to specify the list of classes that register the | 2943 | this variable to specify the list of classes that register the |
2682 | different types of images the OpenEmbedded build system creates. | 2944 | different types of images the OpenEmbedded build system creates. |
2683 | 2945 | ||
2684 | The default value for ``IMAGE_CLASSES`` is ``image_types``. You can | 2946 | The default value for ``IMAGE_CLASSES`` is ``image_types``. You can |
2685 | set this variable in your ``local.conf`` or in a distribution | 2947 | set this variable in your ``local.conf`` or in a distribution |
2686 | configuration file. | 2948 | configuration file. |
2687 | 2949 | ||
2688 | For more information, see ``meta/classes/image_types.bbclass`` in the | 2950 | For more information, see ``meta/classes/image_types.bbclass`` in the |
2689 | :term:`Source Directory`. | 2951 | :term:`Source Directory`. |
2690 | 2952 | ||
2691 | IMAGE_CMD | 2953 | IMAGE_CMD |
2692 | Specifies the command to create the image file for a specific image | 2954 | Specifies the command to create the image file for a specific image |
2693 | type, which corresponds to the value set set in | 2955 | type, which corresponds to the value set set in |
2694 | :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`, (e.g. ``ext3``, | 2956 | :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`, (e.g. ``ext3``, |
2695 | ``btrfs``, and so forth). When setting this variable, you should use | 2957 | ``btrfs``, and so forth). When setting this variable, you should use |
2696 | an override for the associated type. Here is an example: | 2958 | an override for the associated type. Here is an example: |
2697 | IMAGE_CMD_jffs2 = "mkfs.jffs2 --root=${IMAGE_ROOTFS} \\ --faketime | 2959 | :: |
2698 | --output=${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}/${IMAGE_NAME}.rootfs.jffs2 \\ | 2960 | |
2699 | ${EXTRA_IMAGECMD}" | 2961 | IMAGE_CMD_jffs2 = "mkfs.jffs2 --root=${IMAGE_ROOTFS} \ |
2700 | 2962 | --faketime --output=${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}/${IMAGE_NAME}.rootfs.jffs2 \ | |
2963 | ${EXTRA_IMAGECMD}" | ||
2964 | |||
2701 | You typically do not need to set this variable unless you are adding | 2965 | You typically do not need to set this variable unless you are adding |
2702 | support for a new image type. For more examples on how to set this | 2966 | support for a new image type. For more examples on how to set this |
2703 | variable, see the :ref:`image_types <ref-classes-image_types>` | 2967 | variable, see the :ref:`image_types <ref-classes-image_types>` |
2704 | class file, which is ``meta/classes/image_types.bbclass``. | 2968 | class file, which is ``meta/classes/image_types.bbclass``. |
2705 | 2969 | ||
2706 | IMAGE_DEVICE_TABLES | 2970 | IMAGE_DEVICE_TABLES |
2707 | Specifies one or more files that contain custom device tables that | 2971 | Specifies one or more files that contain custom device tables that |
2708 | are passed to the ``makedevs`` command as part of creating an image. | 2972 | are passed to the ``makedevs`` command as part of creating an image. |
@@ -2712,55 +2976,55 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2712 | :term:`BBPATH`. For details on how you should write | 2976 | :term:`BBPATH`. For details on how you should write |
2713 | device table files, see ``meta/files/device_table-minimal.txt`` as an | 2977 | device table files, see ``meta/files/device_table-minimal.txt`` as an |
2714 | example. | 2978 | example. |
2715 | 2979 | ||
2716 | IMAGE_FEATURES | 2980 | IMAGE_FEATURES |
2717 | The primary list of features to include in an image. Typically, you | 2981 | The primary list of features to include in an image. Typically, you |
2718 | configure this variable in an image recipe. Although you can use this | 2982 | configure this variable in an image recipe. Although you can use this |
2719 | variable from your ``local.conf`` file, which is found in the | 2983 | variable from your ``local.conf`` file, which is found in the |
2720 | :term:`Build Directory`, best practices dictate that you do | 2984 | :term:`Build Directory`, best practices dictate that you do |
2721 | not. | 2985 | not. |
2722 | 2986 | ||
2723 | .. note:: | 2987 | .. note:: |
2724 | 2988 | ||
2725 | To enable extra features from outside the image recipe, use the | 2989 | To enable extra features from outside the image recipe, use the |
2726 | EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES | 2990 | EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES |
2727 | variable. | 2991 | variable. |
2728 | 2992 | ||
2729 | For a list of image features that ships with the Yocto Project, see | 2993 | For a list of image features that ships with the Yocto Project, see |
2730 | the "`Image Features <#ref-features-image>`__" section. | 2994 | the "`Image Features <#ref-features-image>`__" section. |
2731 | 2995 | ||
2732 | For an example that shows how to customize your image by using this | 2996 | For an example that shows how to customize your image by using this |
2733 | variable, see the "`Customizing Images Using Custom | 2997 | variable, see the ":ref:`usingpoky-extend-customimage-imagefeatures`" |
2734 | ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` and | ||
2735 | ``EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#usingpoky-extend-customimage-imagefeatures>`__" | ||
2736 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 2998 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
2737 | 2999 | ||
2738 | IMAGE_FSTYPES | 3000 | IMAGE_FSTYPES |
2739 | Specifies the formats the OpenEmbedded build system uses during the | 3001 | Specifies the formats the OpenEmbedded build system uses during the |
2740 | build when creating the root filesystem. For example, setting | 3002 | build when creating the root filesystem. For example, setting |
2741 | ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` as follows causes the build system to create root | 3003 | ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` as follows causes the build system to create root |
2742 | filesystems using two formats: ``.ext3`` and ``.tar.bz2``: | 3004 | filesystems using two formats: ``.ext3`` and ``.tar.bz2``: |
2743 | IMAGE_FSTYPES = "ext3 tar.bz2" | 3005 | :: |
2744 | 3006 | ||
3007 | IMAGE_FSTYPES = "ext3 tar.bz2" | ||
3008 | |||
2745 | For the complete list of supported image formats from which you can | 3009 | For the complete list of supported image formats from which you can |
2746 | choose, see :term:`IMAGE_TYPES`. | 3010 | choose, see :term:`IMAGE_TYPES`. |
2747 | 3011 | ||
2748 | .. note:: | 3012 | .. note:: |
2749 | 3013 | ||
2750 | - If an image recipe uses the "inherit image" line and you are | 3014 | - If an image recipe uses the "inherit image" line and you are |
2751 | setting ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` inside the recipe, you must set | 3015 | setting ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` inside the recipe, you must set |
2752 | ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` prior to using the "inherit image" line. | 3016 | ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` prior to using the "inherit image" line. |
2753 | 3017 | ||
2754 | - Due to the way the OpenEmbedded build system processes this | 3018 | - Due to the way the OpenEmbedded build system processes this |
2755 | variable, you cannot update its contents by using ``_append`` | 3019 | variable, you cannot update its contents by using ``_append`` |
2756 | or ``_prepend``. You must use the ``+=`` operator to add one or | 3020 | or ``_prepend``. You must use the ``+=`` operator to add one or |
2757 | more options to the ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` variable. | 3021 | more options to the ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` variable. |
2758 | 3022 | ||
2759 | IMAGE_INSTALL | 3023 | IMAGE_INSTALL |
2760 | Used by recipes to specify the packages to install into an image | 3024 | Used by recipes to specify the packages to install into an image |
2761 | through the :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` class. Use the | 3025 | through the :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` class. Use the |
2762 | ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` variable with care to avoid ordering issues. | 3026 | ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` variable with care to avoid ordering issues. |
2763 | 3027 | ||
2764 | Image recipes set ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` to specify the packages to | 3028 | Image recipes set ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` to specify the packages to |
2765 | install into an image through ``image.bbclass``. Additionally, | 3029 | install into an image through ``image.bbclass``. Additionally, |
2766 | "helper" classes such as the | 3030 | "helper" classes such as the |
@@ -2768,14 +3032,18 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2768 | take lists used with ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` and turn them into | 3032 | take lists used with ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` and turn them into |
2769 | auto-generated entries in ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` in addition to its | 3033 | auto-generated entries in ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` in addition to its |
2770 | default contents. | 3034 | default contents. |
2771 | 3035 | ||
2772 | When you use this variable, it is best to use it as follows: | 3036 | When you use this variable, it is best to use it as follows: |
2773 | IMAGE_INSTALL_append = " package-name" Be sure to include the space | 3037 | :: |
3038 | |||
3039 | IMAGE_INSTALL_append = " package-name" | ||
3040 | |||
3041 | Be sure to include the space | ||
2774 | between the quotation character and the start of the package name or | 3042 | between the quotation character and the start of the package name or |
2775 | names. | 3043 | names. |
2776 | 3044 | ||
2777 | .. note:: | 3045 | .. note:: |
2778 | 3046 | ||
2779 | - When working with a | 3047 | - When working with a |
2780 | ```core-image-minimal-initramfs`` <#images-core-image-minimal-initramfs>`__ | 3048 | ```core-image-minimal-initramfs`` <#images-core-image-minimal-initramfs>`__ |
2781 | image, do not use the ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` variable to specify | 3049 | image, do not use the ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` variable to specify |
@@ -2783,11 +3051,10 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2783 | :term:`PACKAGE_INSTALL` variable, which | 3051 | :term:`PACKAGE_INSTALL` variable, which |
2784 | allows the initial RAM filesystem (initramfs) recipe to use a | 3052 | allows the initial RAM filesystem (initramfs) recipe to use a |
2785 | fixed set of packages and not be affected by ``IMAGE_INSTALL``. | 3053 | fixed set of packages and not be affected by ``IMAGE_INSTALL``. |
2786 | For information on creating an initramfs, see the "`Building an | 3054 | For information on creating an initramfs, see the |
2787 | Initial RAM Filesystem (initramfs) | 3055 | ":ref:`building-an-initramfs-image`" |
2788 | Image <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#building-an-initramfs-image>`__" | ||
2789 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 3056 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
2790 | 3057 | ||
2791 | - Using ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` with the | 3058 | - Using ``IMAGE_INSTALL`` with the |
2792 | :ref:`+= <bitbake:appending-and-prepending>` | 3059 | :ref:`+= <bitbake:appending-and-prepending>` |
2793 | BitBake operator within the ``/conf/local.conf`` file or from | 3060 | BitBake operator within the ``/conf/local.conf`` file or from |
@@ -2802,7 +3069,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2802 | within an image recipe may or may not succeed depending on the | 3069 | within an image recipe may or may not succeed depending on the |
2803 | specific situation. In both these cases, the behavior is | 3070 | specific situation. In both these cases, the behavior is |
2804 | contrary to how most users expect the ``+=`` operator to work. | 3071 | contrary to how most users expect the ``+=`` operator to work. |
2805 | 3072 | ||
2806 | IMAGE_LINGUAS | 3073 | IMAGE_LINGUAS |
2807 | Specifies the list of locales to install into the image during the | 3074 | Specifies the list of locales to install into the image during the |
2808 | root filesystem construction process. The OpenEmbedded build system | 3075 | root filesystem construction process. The OpenEmbedded build system |
@@ -2810,39 +3077,50 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2810 | into separate packages. Setting the ``IMAGE_LINGUAS`` variable | 3077 | into separate packages. Setting the ``IMAGE_LINGUAS`` variable |
2811 | ensures that any locale packages that correspond to packages already | 3078 | ensures that any locale packages that correspond to packages already |
2812 | selected for installation into the image are also installed. Here is | 3079 | selected for installation into the image are also installed. Here is |
2813 | an example: IMAGE_LINGUAS = "pt-br de-de" | 3080 | an example: |
2814 | 3081 | :: | |
3082 | |||
3083 | IMAGE_LINGUAS = "pt-br de-de" | ||
3084 | |||
2815 | In this example, the build system ensures any Brazilian Portuguese | 3085 | In this example, the build system ensures any Brazilian Portuguese |
2816 | and German locale files that correspond to packages in the image are | 3086 | and German locale files that correspond to packages in the image are |
2817 | installed (i.e. ``*-locale-pt-br`` and ``*-locale-de-de`` as well as | 3087 | installed (i.e. ``*-locale-pt-br`` and ``*-locale-de-de`` as well as |
2818 | ``*-locale-pt`` and ``*-locale-de``, since some software packages | 3088 | ``*-locale-pt`` and ``*-locale-de``, since some software packages |
2819 | only provide locale files by language and not by country-specific | 3089 | only provide locale files by language and not by country-specific |
2820 | language). | 3090 | language). |
2821 | 3091 | ||
2822 | See the :term:`GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES` | 3092 | See the :term:`GLIBC_GENERATE_LOCALES` |
2823 | variable for information on generating GLIBC locales. | 3093 | variable for information on generating GLIBC locales. |
2824 | 3094 | ||
2825 | IMAGE_MANIFEST | 3095 | IMAGE_MANIFEST |
2826 | The manifest file for the image. This file lists all the installed | 3096 | The manifest file for the image. This file lists all the installed |
2827 | packages that make up the image. The file contains package | 3097 | packages that make up the image. The file contains package |
2828 | information on a line-per-package basis as follows: packagename | 3098 | information on a line-per-package basis as follows: |
2829 | packagearch version | 3099 | :: |
2830 | 3100 | ||
3101 | packagename packagearch version | ||
3102 | |||
2831 | The :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` class defines the manifest | 3103 | The :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` class defines the manifest |
2832 | file as follows: IMAGE_MANIFEST = | 3104 | file as follows: |
2833 | "${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}/${IMAGE_NAME}.rootfs.manifest" The location is | 3105 | :: |
3106 | |||
3107 | IMAGE_MANIFEST ="${DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE}/${IMAGE_NAME}.rootfs.manifest" | ||
3108 | |||
3109 | The location is | ||
2834 | derived using the :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE` | 3110 | derived using the :term:`DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE` |
2835 | and :term:`IMAGE_NAME` variables. You can find | 3111 | and :term:`IMAGE_NAME` variables. You can find |
2836 | information on how the image is created in the "`Image | 3112 | information on how the image is created in the ":ref:`image-generation-dev-environment`" |
2837 | Generation <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#image-generation-dev-environment>`__" | ||
2838 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. | 3113 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. |
2839 | 3114 | ||
2840 | IMAGE_NAME | 3115 | IMAGE_NAME |
2841 | The name of the output image files minus the extension. This variable | 3116 | The name of the output image files minus the extension. This variable |
2842 | is derived using the :term:`IMAGE_BASENAME`, | 3117 | is derived using the :term:`IMAGE_BASENAME`, |
2843 | :term:`MACHINE`, and :term:`DATETIME` | 3118 | :term:`MACHINE`, and :term:`DATETIME` |
2844 | variables: IMAGE_NAME = "${IMAGE_BASENAME}-${MACHINE}-${DATETIME}" | 3119 | variables: |
2845 | 3120 | :: | |
3121 | |||
3122 | IMAGE_NAME = "${IMAGE_BASENAME}-${MACHINE}-${DATETIME}" | ||
3123 | |||
2846 | IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR | 3124 | IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR |
2847 | Defines a multiplier that the build system applies to the initial | 3125 | Defines a multiplier that the build system applies to the initial |
2848 | image size for cases when the multiplier times the returned disk | 3126 | image size for cases when the multiplier times the returned disk |
@@ -2858,18 +3136,20 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2858 | not produce an image with all the theoretical free disk space. See | 3136 | not produce an image with all the theoretical free disk space. See |
2859 | ``IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE`` for information on how the build system | 3137 | ``IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE`` for information on how the build system |
2860 | determines the overall image size. | 3138 | determines the overall image size. |
2861 | 3139 | ||
2862 | The default 30% free disk space typically gives the image enough room | 3140 | The default 30% free disk space typically gives the image enough room |
2863 | to boot and allows for basic post installs while still leaving a | 3141 | to boot and allows for basic post installs while still leaving a |
2864 | small amount of free disk space. If 30% free space is inadequate, you | 3142 | small amount of free disk space. If 30% free space is inadequate, you |
2865 | can increase the default value. For example, the following setting | 3143 | can increase the default value. For example, the following setting |
2866 | gives you 50% free space added to the image: IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR = | 3144 | gives you 50% free space added to the image: |
2867 | "1.5" | 3145 | :: |
2868 | 3146 | ||
3147 | IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR = "1.5" | ||
3148 | |||
2869 | Alternatively, you can ensure a specific amount of free disk space is | 3149 | Alternatively, you can ensure a specific amount of free disk space is |
2870 | added to the image by using the ``IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE`` | 3150 | added to the image by using the ``IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE`` |
2871 | variable. | 3151 | variable. |
2872 | 3152 | ||
2873 | IMAGE_PKGTYPE | 3153 | IMAGE_PKGTYPE |
2874 | Defines the package type (i.e. DEB, RPM, IPK, or TAR) used by the | 3154 | Defines the package type (i.e. DEB, RPM, IPK, or TAR) used by the |
2875 | OpenEmbedded build system. The variable is defined appropriately by | 3155 | OpenEmbedded build system. The variable is defined appropriately by |
@@ -2877,84 +3157,92 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2877 | :ref:`package_rpm <ref-classes-package_rpm>`, | 3157 | :ref:`package_rpm <ref-classes-package_rpm>`, |
2878 | :ref:`package_ipk <ref-classes-package_ipk>`, or | 3158 | :ref:`package_ipk <ref-classes-package_ipk>`, or |
2879 | :ref:`package_tar <ref-classes-package_tar>` class. | 3159 | :ref:`package_tar <ref-classes-package_tar>` class. |
2880 | 3160 | ||
2881 | .. note:: | 3161 | .. note:: |
2882 | 3162 | ||
2883 | The | 3163 | The |
2884 | package_tar | 3164 | package_tar |
2885 | class is broken and is not supported. It is recommended that you | 3165 | class is broken and is not supported. It is recommended that you |
2886 | do not use it. | 3166 | do not use it. |
2887 | 3167 | ||
2888 | The :ref:`populate_sdk_* <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` and | 3168 | The :ref:`populate_sdk_* <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` and |
2889 | :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` classes use the ``IMAGE_PKGTYPE`` | 3169 | :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` classes use the ``IMAGE_PKGTYPE`` |
2890 | for packaging up images and SDKs. | 3170 | for packaging up images and SDKs. |
2891 | 3171 | ||
2892 | You should not set the ``IMAGE_PKGTYPE`` manually. Rather, the | 3172 | You should not set the ``IMAGE_PKGTYPE`` manually. Rather, the |
2893 | variable is set indirectly through the appropriate | 3173 | variable is set indirectly through the appropriate |
2894 | :ref:`package_* <ref-classes-package>` class using the | 3174 | :ref:`package_* <ref-classes-package>` class using the |
2895 | :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` variable. The | 3175 | :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` variable. The |
2896 | OpenEmbedded build system uses the first package type (e.g. DEB, RPM, | 3176 | OpenEmbedded build system uses the first package type (e.g. DEB, RPM, |
2897 | or IPK) that appears with the variable | 3177 | or IPK) that appears with the variable |
2898 | 3178 | ||
2899 | .. note:: | 3179 | .. note:: |
2900 | 3180 | ||
2901 | Files using the | 3181 | Files using the |
2902 | .tar | 3182 | .tar |
2903 | format are never used as a substitute packaging format for DEB, | 3183 | format are never used as a substitute packaging format for DEB, |
2904 | RPM, and IPK formatted files for your image or SDK. | 3184 | RPM, and IPK formatted files for your image or SDK. |
2905 | 3185 | ||
2906 | IMAGE_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND | 3186 | IMAGE_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND |
2907 | Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build | 3187 | Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build |
2908 | system creates the final image output files. You can specify | 3188 | system creates the final image output files. You can specify |
2909 | functions separated by semicolons: IMAGE_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND += | 3189 | functions separated by semicolons: |
2910 | "function; ... " | 3190 | :: |
2911 | 3191 | ||
3192 | IMAGE_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND += "function; ... " | ||
3193 | |||
2912 | If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within the | 3194 | If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within the |
2913 | function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the | 3195 | function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the |
2914 | directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the | 3196 | directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the |
2915 | :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more | 3197 | :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more |
2916 | information. | 3198 | information. |
2917 | 3199 | ||
2918 | IMAGE_PREPROCESS_COMMAND | 3200 | IMAGE_PREPROCESS_COMMAND |
2919 | Specifies a list of functions to call before the OpenEmbedded build | 3201 | Specifies a list of functions to call before the OpenEmbedded build |
2920 | system creates the final image output files. You can specify | 3202 | system creates the final image output files. You can specify |
2921 | functions separated by semicolons: IMAGE_PREPROCESS_COMMAND += | 3203 | functions separated by semicolons: |
2922 | "function; ... " | 3204 | :: |
2923 | 3205 | ||
3206 | IMAGE_PREPROCESS_COMMAND += "function; ... " | ||
3207 | |||
2924 | If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within the | 3208 | If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within the |
2925 | function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the | 3209 | function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the |
2926 | directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the | 3210 | directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the |
2927 | :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more | 3211 | :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more |
2928 | information. | 3212 | information. |
2929 | 3213 | ||
2930 | IMAGE_ROOTFS | 3214 | IMAGE_ROOTFS |
2931 | The location of the root filesystem while it is under construction | 3215 | The location of the root filesystem while it is under construction |
2932 | (i.e. during the :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task). This | 3216 | (i.e. during the :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task). This |
2933 | variable is not configurable. Do not change it. | 3217 | variable is not configurable. Do not change it. |
2934 | 3218 | ||
2935 | IMAGE_ROOTFS_ALIGNMENT | 3219 | IMAGE_ROOTFS_ALIGNMENT |
2936 | Specifies the alignment for the output image file in Kbytes. If the | 3220 | Specifies the alignment for the output image file in Kbytes. If the |
2937 | size of the image is not a multiple of this value, then the size is | 3221 | size of the image is not a multiple of this value, then the size is |
2938 | rounded up to the nearest multiple of the value. The default value is | 3222 | rounded up to the nearest multiple of the value. The default value is |
2939 | "1". See :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE` for | 3223 | "1". See :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE` for |
2940 | additional information. | 3224 | additional information. |
2941 | 3225 | ||
2942 | IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE | 3226 | IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE |
2943 | Defines additional free disk space created in the image in Kbytes. By | 3227 | Defines additional free disk space created in the image in Kbytes. By |
2944 | default, this variable is set to "0". This free disk space is added | 3228 | default, this variable is set to "0". This free disk space is added |
2945 | to the image after the build system determines the image size as | 3229 | to the image after the build system determines the image size as |
2946 | described in ``IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE``. | 3230 | described in ``IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE``. |
2947 | 3231 | ||
2948 | This variable is particularly useful when you want to ensure that a | 3232 | This variable is particularly useful when you want to ensure that a |
2949 | specific amount of free disk space is available on a device after an | 3233 | specific amount of free disk space is available on a device after an |
2950 | image is installed and running. For example, to be sure 5 Gbytes of | 3234 | image is installed and running. For example, to be sure 5 Gbytes of |
2951 | free disk space is available, set the variable as follows: | 3235 | free disk space is available, set the variable as follows: |
2952 | IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE = "5242880" | 3236 | :: |
2953 | 3237 | ||
3238 | IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE = "5242880" | ||
3239 | |||
2954 | For example, the Yocto Project Build Appliance specifically requests | 3240 | For example, the Yocto Project Build Appliance specifically requests |
2955 | 40 Gbytes of extra space with the line: IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE = | 3241 | 40 Gbytes of extra space with the line: |
2956 | "41943040" | 3242 | :: |
2957 | 3243 | ||
3244 | IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE = "41943040" | ||
3245 | |||
2958 | IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE | 3246 | IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE |
2959 | Defines the size in Kbytes for the generated image. The OpenEmbedded | 3247 | Defines the size in Kbytes for the generated image. The OpenEmbedded |
2960 | build system determines the final size for the generated image using | 3248 | build system determines the final size for the generated image using |
@@ -2962,45 +3250,87 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
2962 | the generated image, a requested size for the image, and requested | 3250 | the generated image, a requested size for the image, and requested |
2963 | additional free disk space to be added to the image. Programatically, | 3251 | additional free disk space to be added to the image. Programatically, |
2964 | the build system determines the final size of the generated image as | 3252 | the build system determines the final size of the generated image as |
2965 | follows: if (image-du \* overhead) < rootfs-size: | 3253 | follows: |
2966 | internal-rootfs-size = rootfs-size + xspace else: | 3254 | :: |
2967 | internal-rootfs-size = (image-du \* overhead) + xspace where: | 3255 | |
2968 | image-du = Returned value of the du command on the image. overhead = | 3256 | if (image-du * overhead) < rootfs-size: |
2969 | IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR rootfs-size = IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE | 3257 | internal-rootfs-size = rootfs-size + xspace |
2970 | internal-rootfs-size = Initial root filesystem size before any | 3258 | else: |
2971 | modifications. xspace = IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE | 3259 | internal-rootfs-size = (image-du * overhead) + xspace |
2972 | 3260 | where: | |
3261 | image-du = Returned value of the du command on the image. | ||
3262 | overhead = IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR | ||
3263 | rootfs-size = IMAGE_ROOTFS_SIZE | ||
3264 | internal-rootfs-size = Initial root filesystem size before any modifications. | ||
3265 | xspace = IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE | ||
3266 | |||
2973 | See the :term:`IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR` | 3267 | See the :term:`IMAGE_OVERHEAD_FACTOR` |
2974 | and :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE` | 3268 | and :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS_EXTRA_SPACE` |
2975 | variables for related information. | 3269 | variables for related information. |
2976 | 3270 | ||
2977 | IMAGE_TYPEDEP | 3271 | IMAGE_TYPEDEP |
2978 | Specifies a dependency from one image type on another. Here is an | 3272 | Specifies a dependency from one image type on another. Here is an |
2979 | example from the :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` class: | 3273 | example from the :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` class: |
2980 | IMAGE_TYPEDEP_live = "ext3" | 3274 | :: |
2981 | 3275 | ||
3276 | IMAGE_TYPEDEP_live = "ext3" | ||
3277 | |||
2982 | In the previous example, the variable ensures that when "live" is | 3278 | In the previous example, the variable ensures that when "live" is |
2983 | listed with the :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` variable, | 3279 | listed with the :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` variable, |
2984 | the OpenEmbedded build system produces an ``ext3`` image first since | 3280 | the OpenEmbedded build system produces an ``ext3`` image first since |
2985 | one of the components of the live image is an ``ext3`` formatted | 3281 | one of the components of the live image is an ``ext3`` formatted |
2986 | partition containing the root filesystem. | 3282 | partition containing the root filesystem. |
2987 | 3283 | ||
2988 | IMAGE_TYPES | 3284 | IMAGE_TYPES |
2989 | Specifies the complete list of supported image types by default: | 3285 | Specifies the complete list of supported image types by default: |
2990 | btrfs container cpio cpio.gz cpio.lz4 cpio.lzma cpio.xz cramfs ext2 | 3286 | |
2991 | ext2.bz2 ext2.gz ext2.lzma ext3 ext3.gz ext4 ext4.gz f2fs hddimg iso | 3287 | - btrfs |
2992 | jffs2 jffs2.sum multiubi squashfs squashfs-lz4 squashfs-lzo | 3288 | - container |
2993 | squashfs-xz tar tar.bz2 tar.gz tar.lz4 tar.xz tar.zst ubi ubifs wic | 3289 | - cpio |
2994 | wic.bz2 wic.gz wic.lzma | 3290 | - cpio.gz |
2995 | 3291 | - cpio.lz4 | |
3292 | - cpio.lzma | ||
3293 | - cpio.xz | ||
3294 | - cramfs | ||
3295 | - ext2 | ||
3296 | - ext2.bz2 | ||
3297 | - ext2.gz | ||
3298 | - ext2.lzma | ||
3299 | - ext3 | ||
3300 | - ext3.gz | ||
3301 | - ext4 | ||
3302 | - ext4.gz | ||
3303 | - f2fs | ||
3304 | - hddimg | ||
3305 | - iso | ||
3306 | - jffs2 | ||
3307 | - jffs2.sum | ||
3308 | - multiubi | ||
3309 | - squashfs | ||
3310 | - squashfs-lz4 | ||
3311 | - squashfs-lzo | ||
3312 | - squashfs-xz | ||
3313 | - tar | ||
3314 | - tar.bz2 | ||
3315 | - tar.gz | ||
3316 | - tar.lz4 | ||
3317 | - tar.xz | ||
3318 | - tar.zst | ||
3319 | - ubi | ||
3320 | - ubifs | ||
3321 | - wic | ||
3322 | - wic.bz2 | ||
3323 | - wic.gz | ||
3324 | - wic.lzma | ||
3325 | |||
2996 | For more information about these types of images, see | 3326 | For more information about these types of images, see |
2997 | ``meta/classes/image_types*.bbclass`` in the :term:`Source Directory`. | 3327 | ``meta/classes/image_types*.bbclass`` in the :term:`Source Directory`. |
2998 | 3328 | ||
2999 | INC_PR | 3329 | INC_PR |
3000 | Helps define the recipe revision for recipes that share a common | 3330 | Helps define the recipe revision for recipes that share a common |
3001 | ``include`` file. You can think of this variable as part of the | 3331 | ``include`` file. You can think of this variable as part of the |
3002 | recipe revision as set from within an include file. | 3332 | recipe revision as set from within an include file. |
3003 | 3333 | ||
3004 | Suppose, for example, you have a set of recipes that are used across | 3334 | Suppose, for example, you have a set of recipes that are used across |
3005 | several projects. And, within each of those recipes the revision (its | 3335 | several projects. And, within each of those recipes the revision (its |
3006 | :term:`PR` value) is set accordingly. In this case, when | 3336 | :term:`PR` value) is set accordingly. In this case, when |
@@ -3009,49 +3339,53 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3009 | updated version of the recipe. In this scenario, it can get | 3339 | updated version of the recipe. In this scenario, it can get |
3010 | complicated when recipes that are used in many places and provide | 3340 | complicated when recipes that are used in many places and provide |
3011 | common functionality are upgraded to a new revision. | 3341 | common functionality are upgraded to a new revision. |
3012 | 3342 | ||
3013 | A more efficient way of dealing with this situation is to set the | 3343 | A more efficient way of dealing with this situation is to set the |
3014 | ``INC_PR`` variable inside the ``include`` files that the recipes | 3344 | ``INC_PR`` variable inside the ``include`` files that the recipes |
3015 | share and then expand the ``INC_PR`` variable within the recipes to | 3345 | share and then expand the ``INC_PR`` variable within the recipes to |
3016 | help define the recipe revision. | 3346 | help define the recipe revision. |
3017 | 3347 | ||
3018 | The following provides an example that shows how to use the | 3348 | The following provides an example that shows how to use the |
3019 | ``INC_PR`` variable given a common ``include`` file that defines the | 3349 | ``INC_PR`` variable given a common ``include`` file that defines the |
3020 | variable. Once the variable is defined in the ``include`` file, you | 3350 | variable. Once the variable is defined in the ``include`` file, you |
3021 | can use the variable to set the ``PR`` values in each recipe. You | 3351 | can use the variable to set the ``PR`` values in each recipe. You |
3022 | will notice that when you set a recipe's ``PR`` you can provide more | 3352 | will notice that when you set a recipe's ``PR`` you can provide more |
3023 | granular revisioning by appending values to the ``INC_PR`` variable: | 3353 | granular revisioning by appending values to the ``INC_PR`` variable: |
3024 | recipes-graphics/xorg-font/xorg-font-common.inc:INC_PR = "r2" | 3354 | :: |
3025 | recipes-graphics/xorg-font/encodings_1.0.4.bb:PR = "${INC_PR}.1" | 3355 | |
3026 | recipes-graphics/xorg-font/font-util_1.3.0.bb:PR = "${INC_PR}.0" | 3356 | recipes-graphics/xorg-font/xorg-font-common.inc:INC_PR = "r2" |
3027 | recipes-graphics/xorg-font/font-alias_1.0.3.bb:PR = "${INC_PR}.3" The | 3357 | recipes-graphics/xorg-font/encodings_1.0.4.bb:PR = "${INC_PR}.1" |
3358 | recipes-graphics/xorg-font/font-util_1.3.0.bb:PR = "${INC_PR}.0" | ||
3359 | recipes-graphics/xorg-font/font-alias_1.0.3.bb:PR = "${INC_PR}.3" | ||
3360 | |||
3361 | The | ||
3028 | first line of the example establishes the baseline revision to be | 3362 | first line of the example establishes the baseline revision to be |
3029 | used for all recipes that use the ``include`` file. The remaining | 3363 | used for all recipes that use the ``include`` file. The remaining |
3030 | lines in the example are from individual recipes and show how the | 3364 | lines in the example are from individual recipes and show how the |
3031 | ``PR`` value is set. | 3365 | ``PR`` value is set. |
3032 | 3366 | ||
3033 | INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE | 3367 | INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE |
3034 | Specifies a space-separated list of license names (as they would | 3368 | Specifies a space-separated list of license names (as they would |
3035 | appear in :term:`LICENSE`) that should be excluded | 3369 | appear in :term:`LICENSE`) that should be excluded |
3036 | from the build. Recipes that provide no alternatives to listed | 3370 | from the build. Recipes that provide no alternatives to listed |
3037 | incompatible licenses are not built. Packages that are individually | 3371 | incompatible licenses are not built. Packages that are individually |
3038 | licensed with the specified incompatible licenses will be deleted. | 3372 | licensed with the specified incompatible licenses will be deleted. |
3039 | 3373 | ||
3040 | .. note:: | 3374 | .. note:: |
3041 | 3375 | ||
3042 | This functionality is only regularly tested using the following | 3376 | This functionality is only regularly tested using the following |
3043 | setting: | 3377 | setting: |
3044 | :: | 3378 | :: |
3045 | 3379 | ||
3046 | INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE = "GPL-3.0 LGPL-3.0 AGPL-3.0" | 3380 | INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE = "GPL-3.0 LGPL-3.0 AGPL-3.0" |
3047 | 3381 | ||
3048 | 3382 | ||
3049 | Although you can use other settings, you might be required to | 3383 | Although you can use other settings, you might be required to |
3050 | remove dependencies on or provide alternatives to components that | 3384 | remove dependencies on or provide alternatives to components that |
3051 | are required to produce a functional system image. | 3385 | are required to produce a functional system image. |
3052 | 3386 | ||
3053 | .. note:: | 3387 | .. note:: |
3054 | 3388 | ||
3055 | It is possible to define a list of licenses that are allowed to be | 3389 | It is possible to define a list of licenses that are allowed to be |
3056 | used instead of the licenses that are excluded. To do this, define | 3390 | used instead of the licenses that are excluded. To do this, define |
3057 | a variable | 3391 | a variable |
@@ -3060,10 +3394,10 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3060 | INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE | 3394 | INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE |
3061 | as: | 3395 | as: |
3062 | :: | 3396 | :: |
3063 | 3397 | ||
3064 | INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE = "${@' '.join(sorted(set(d.getVar('AVAILABLE_LICENSES').split()) - set(d.getVar('COMPATIBLE_LICENSES').split())))}" | 3398 | INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE = "${@' '.join(sorted(set(d.getVar('AVAILABLE_LICENSES').split()) - set(d.getVar('COMPATIBLE_LICENSES').split())))}" |
3065 | 3399 | ||
3066 | 3400 | ||
3067 | This will result in | 3401 | This will result in |
3068 | INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE | 3402 | INCOMPATIBLE_LICENSE |
3069 | containing the names of all licences from | 3403 | containing the names of all licences from |
@@ -3071,34 +3405,36 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3071 | except the ones specified in | 3405 | except the ones specified in |
3072 | COMPATIBLE_LICENSES | 3406 | COMPATIBLE_LICENSES |
3073 | , thus only allowing the latter licences to be used. | 3407 | , thus only allowing the latter licences to be used. |
3074 | 3408 | ||
3075 | INHERIT | 3409 | INHERIT |
3076 | Causes the named class or classes to be inherited globally. Anonymous | 3410 | Causes the named class or classes to be inherited globally. Anonymous |
3077 | functions in the class or classes are not executed for the base | 3411 | functions in the class or classes are not executed for the base |
3078 | configuration and in each individual recipe. The OpenEmbedded build | 3412 | configuration and in each individual recipe. The OpenEmbedded build |
3079 | system ignores changes to ``INHERIT`` in individual recipes. | 3413 | system ignores changes to ``INHERIT`` in individual recipes. |
3080 | 3414 | ||
3081 | For more information on ``INHERIT``, see the | 3415 | For more information on ``INHERIT``, see the |
3082 | :ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:\`\`inherit\`\` configuration directive`" | 3416 | :ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:\`\`inherit\`\` configuration directive`" |
3083 | section in the Bitbake User Manual. | 3417 | section in the Bitbake User Manual. |
3084 | 3418 | ||
3085 | INHERIT_DISTRO | 3419 | INHERIT_DISTRO |
3086 | Lists classes that will be inherited at the distribution level. It is | 3420 | Lists classes that will be inherited at the distribution level. It is |
3087 | unlikely that you want to edit this variable. | 3421 | unlikely that you want to edit this variable. |
3088 | 3422 | ||
3089 | The default value of the variable is set as follows in the | 3423 | The default value of the variable is set as follows in the |
3090 | ``meta/conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf`` file: INHERIT_DISTRO ?= | 3424 | ``meta/conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf`` file: |
3091 | "debian devshell sstate license" | 3425 | :: |
3092 | 3426 | ||
3427 | INHERIT_DISTRO ?= "debian devshell sstate license" | ||
3428 | |||
3093 | INHIBIT_DEFAULT_DEPS | 3429 | INHIBIT_DEFAULT_DEPS |
3094 | Prevents the default dependencies, namely the C compiler and standard | 3430 | Prevents the default dependencies, namely the C compiler and standard |
3095 | C library (libc), from being added to :term:`DEPENDS`. | 3431 | C library (libc), from being added to :term:`DEPENDS`. |
3096 | This variable is usually used within recipes that do not require any | 3432 | This variable is usually used within recipes that do not require any |
3097 | compilation using the C compiler. | 3433 | compilation using the C compiler. |
3098 | 3434 | ||
3099 | Set the variable to "1" to prevent the default dependencies from | 3435 | Set the variable to "1" to prevent the default dependencies from |
3100 | being added. | 3436 | being added. |
3101 | 3437 | ||
3102 | INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT | 3438 | INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT |
3103 | Prevents the OpenEmbedded build system from splitting out debug | 3439 | Prevents the OpenEmbedded build system from splitting out debug |
3104 | information during packaging. By default, the build system splits out | 3440 | information during packaging. By default, the build system splits out |
@@ -3107,37 +3443,40 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3107 | how debug information is split out, see the | 3443 | how debug information is split out, see the |
3108 | :term:`PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT_STYLE` | 3444 | :term:`PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT_STYLE` |
3109 | variable. | 3445 | variable. |
3110 | 3446 | ||
3111 | To prevent the build system from splitting out debug information | 3447 | To prevent the build system from splitting out debug information |
3112 | during packaging, set the ``INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT`` variable as | 3448 | during packaging, set the ``INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT`` variable as |
3113 | follows: INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT = "1" | 3449 | follows: |
3114 | 3450 | :: | |
3451 | |||
3452 | INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT = "1" | ||
3453 | |||
3115 | INHIBIT_PACKAGE_STRIP | 3454 | INHIBIT_PACKAGE_STRIP |
3116 | If set to "1", causes the build to not strip binaries in resulting | 3455 | If set to "1", causes the build to not strip binaries in resulting |
3117 | packages and prevents the ``-dbg`` package from containing the source | 3456 | packages and prevents the ``-dbg`` package from containing the source |
3118 | files. | 3457 | files. |
3119 | 3458 | ||
3120 | By default, the OpenEmbedded build system strips binaries and puts | 3459 | By default, the OpenEmbedded build system strips binaries and puts |
3121 | the debugging symbols into ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}-dbg``. | 3460 | the debugging symbols into ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}-dbg``. |
3122 | Consequently, you should not set ``INHIBIT_PACKAGE_STRIP`` when you | 3461 | Consequently, you should not set ``INHIBIT_PACKAGE_STRIP`` when you |
3123 | plan to debug in general. | 3462 | plan to debug in general. |
3124 | 3463 | ||
3125 | INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP | 3464 | INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP |
3126 | If set to "1", causes the build to not strip binaries in the | 3465 | If set to "1", causes the build to not strip binaries in the |
3127 | resulting sysroot. | 3466 | resulting sysroot. |
3128 | 3467 | ||
3129 | By default, the OpenEmbedded build system strips binaries in the | 3468 | By default, the OpenEmbedded build system strips binaries in the |
3130 | resulting sysroot. When you specifically set the | 3469 | resulting sysroot. When you specifically set the |
3131 | ``INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP`` variable to "1" in your recipe, you inhibit | 3470 | ``INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP`` variable to "1" in your recipe, you inhibit |
3132 | this stripping. | 3471 | this stripping. |
3133 | 3472 | ||
3134 | If you want to use this variable, include the | 3473 | If you want to use this variable, include the |
3135 | :ref:`staging <ref-classes-staging>` class. This class uses a | 3474 | :ref:`staging <ref-classes-staging>` class. This class uses a |
3136 | ``sys_strip()`` function to test for the variable and acts | 3475 | ``sys_strip()`` function to test for the variable and acts |
3137 | accordingly. | 3476 | accordingly. |
3138 | 3477 | ||
3139 | .. note:: | 3478 | .. note:: |
3140 | 3479 | ||
3141 | Use of the | 3480 | Use of the |
3142 | INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP | 3481 | INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP |
3143 | variable occurs in rare and special circumstances. For example, | 3482 | variable occurs in rare and special circumstances. For example, |
@@ -3145,20 +3484,20 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3145 | GCC toolchain. Furthermore, even if the toolchain's binaries are | 3484 | GCC toolchain. Furthermore, even if the toolchain's binaries are |
3146 | strippable, other files exist that are needed for the build that | 3485 | strippable, other files exist that are needed for the build that |
3147 | are not strippable. | 3486 | are not strippable. |
3148 | 3487 | ||
3149 | INITRAMFS_FSTYPES | 3488 | INITRAMFS_FSTYPES |
3150 | Defines the format for the output image of an initial RAM filesystem | 3489 | Defines the format for the output image of an initial RAM filesystem |
3151 | (initramfs), which is used during boot. Supported formats are the | 3490 | (initramfs), which is used during boot. Supported formats are the |
3152 | same as those supported by the | 3491 | same as those supported by the |
3153 | :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` variable. | 3492 | :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` variable. |
3154 | 3493 | ||
3155 | The default value of this variable, which is set in the | 3494 | The default value of this variable, which is set in the |
3156 | ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file in the | 3495 | ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file in the |
3157 | :term:`Source Directory`, is "cpio.gz". The Linux kernel's | 3496 | :term:`Source Directory`, is "cpio.gz". The Linux kernel's |
3158 | initramfs mechanism, as opposed to the initial RAM filesystem | 3497 | initramfs mechanism, as opposed to the initial RAM filesystem |
3159 | `initrd <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Initrd>`__ mechanism, expects | 3498 | `initrd <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Initrd>`__ mechanism, expects |
3160 | an optionally compressed cpio archive. | 3499 | an optionally compressed cpio archive. |
3161 | 3500 | ||
3162 | INITRAMFS_IMAGE | 3501 | INITRAMFS_IMAGE |
3163 | Specifies the :term:`PROVIDES` name of an image | 3502 | Specifies the :term:`PROVIDES` name of an image |
3164 | recipe that is used to build an initial RAM filesystem (initramfs) | 3503 | recipe that is used to build an initial RAM filesystem (initramfs) |
@@ -3168,13 +3507,13 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3168 | initramfs image recipe you provide should set | 3507 | initramfs image recipe you provide should set |
3169 | :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` to | 3508 | :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` to |
3170 | :term:`INITRAMFS_FSTYPES`. | 3509 | :term:`INITRAMFS_FSTYPES`. |
3171 | 3510 | ||
3172 | An initramfs image provides a temporary root filesystem used for | 3511 | An initramfs image provides a temporary root filesystem used for |
3173 | early system initialization (e.g. loading of modules needed to locate | 3512 | early system initialization (e.g. loading of modules needed to locate |
3174 | and mount the "real" root filesystem). | 3513 | and mount the "real" root filesystem). |
3175 | 3514 | ||
3176 | .. note:: | 3515 | .. note:: |
3177 | 3516 | ||
3178 | See the | 3517 | See the |
3179 | meta/recipes-core/images/core-image-minimal-initramfs.bb | 3518 | meta/recipes-core/images/core-image-minimal-initramfs.bb |
3180 | recipe in the | 3519 | recipe in the |
@@ -3183,24 +3522,23 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3183 | the one built to provide the initramfs image, set | 3522 | the one built to provide the initramfs image, set |
3184 | INITRAMFS_IMAGE | 3523 | INITRAMFS_IMAGE |
3185 | to "core-image-minimal-initramfs". | 3524 | to "core-image-minimal-initramfs". |
3186 | 3525 | ||
3187 | You can also find more information by referencing the | 3526 | You can also find more information by referencing the |
3188 | ``meta-poky/conf/local.conf.sample.extended`` configuration file in | 3527 | ``meta-poky/conf/local.conf.sample.extended`` configuration file in |
3189 | the Source Directory, the :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` class, | 3528 | the Source Directory, the :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>` class, |
3190 | and the :ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class to see how to use | 3529 | and the :ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class to see how to use |
3191 | the ``INITRAMFS_IMAGE`` variable. | 3530 | the ``INITRAMFS_IMAGE`` variable. |
3192 | 3531 | ||
3193 | If ``INITRAMFS_IMAGE`` is empty, which is the default, then no | 3532 | If ``INITRAMFS_IMAGE`` is empty, which is the default, then no |
3194 | initramfs image is built. | 3533 | initramfs image is built. |
3195 | 3534 | ||
3196 | For more information, you can also see the | 3535 | For more information, you can also see the |
3197 | :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE` | 3536 | :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE` |
3198 | variable, which allows the generated image to be bundled inside the | 3537 | variable, which allows the generated image to be bundled inside the |
3199 | kernel image. Additionally, for information on creating an initramfs | 3538 | kernel image. Additionally, for information on creating an initramfs |
3200 | image, see the "`Building an Initial RAM Filesystem (initramfs) | 3539 | image, see the ":ref:`building-an-initramfs-image`" section |
3201 | Image <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#building-an-initramfs-image>`__" section | ||
3202 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 3540 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
3203 | 3541 | ||
3204 | INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE | 3542 | INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE |
3205 | Controls whether or not the image recipe specified by | 3543 | Controls whether or not the image recipe specified by |
3206 | :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` is run through an | 3544 | :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` is run through an |
@@ -3211,152 +3549,181 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3211 | image. This makes use of the | 3549 | image. This makes use of the |
3212 | :term:`CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE` kernel | 3550 | :term:`CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE` kernel |
3213 | feature. | 3551 | feature. |
3214 | 3552 | ||
3215 | .. note:: | 3553 | .. note:: |
3216 | 3554 | ||
3217 | Using an extra compilation pass to bundle the initramfs avoids a | 3555 | Using an extra compilation pass to bundle the initramfs avoids a |
3218 | circular dependency between the kernel recipe and the initramfs | 3556 | circular dependency between the kernel recipe and the initramfs |
3219 | recipe should the initramfs include kernel modules. Should that be | 3557 | recipe should the initramfs include kernel modules. Should that be |
3220 | the case, the initramfs recipe depends on the kernel for the | 3558 | the case, the initramfs recipe depends on the kernel for the |
3221 | kernel modules, and the kernel depends on the initramfs recipe | 3559 | kernel modules, and the kernel depends on the initramfs recipe |
3222 | since the initramfs is bundled inside the kernel image. | 3560 | since the initramfs is bundled inside the kernel image. |
3223 | 3561 | ||
3224 | The combined binary is deposited into the ``tmp/deploy`` directory, | 3562 | The combined binary is deposited into the ``tmp/deploy`` directory, |
3225 | which is part of the :term:`Build Directory`. | 3563 | which is part of the :term:`Build Directory`. |
3226 | 3564 | ||
3227 | Setting the variable to "1" in a configuration file causes the | 3565 | Setting the variable to "1" in a configuration file causes the |
3228 | OpenEmbedded build system to generate a kernel image with the | 3566 | OpenEmbedded build system to generate a kernel image with the |
3229 | initramfs specified in ``INITRAMFS_IMAGE`` bundled within: | 3567 | initramfs specified in ``INITRAMFS_IMAGE`` bundled within: |
3230 | INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE = "1" By default, the | 3568 | :: |
3569 | |||
3570 | INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE = "1" | ||
3571 | |||
3572 | By default, the | ||
3231 | :ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class sets this variable to a | 3573 | :ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class sets this variable to a |
3232 | null string as follows: INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE ?= "" | 3574 | null string as follows: |
3233 | 3575 | :: | |
3576 | |||
3577 | INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE ?= "" | ||
3578 | |||
3234 | .. note:: | 3579 | .. note:: |
3235 | 3580 | ||
3236 | You must set the | 3581 | You must set the |
3237 | INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE | 3582 | INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE |
3238 | variable in a configuration file. You cannot set the variable in a | 3583 | variable in a configuration file. You cannot set the variable in a |
3239 | recipe file. | 3584 | recipe file. |
3240 | 3585 | ||
3241 | See the | 3586 | See the |
3242 | :yocto_git:`local.conf.sample.extended </cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/tree/meta-poky/conf/local.conf.sample.extended>` | 3587 | :yocto_git:`local.conf.sample.extended </cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/tree/meta-poky/conf/local.conf.sample.extended>` |
3243 | file for additional information. Also, for information on creating an | 3588 | file for additional information. Also, for information on creating an |
3244 | initramfs, see the "`Building an Initial RAM Filesystem (initramfs) | 3589 | initramfs, see the ":ref:`building-an-initramfs-image`" section |
3245 | Image <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#building-an-initramfs-image>`__" section | ||
3246 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 3590 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
3247 | 3591 | ||
3248 | INITRAMFS_LINK_NAME | 3592 | INITRAMFS_LINK_NAME |
3249 | The link name of the initial RAM filesystem image. This variable is | 3593 | The link name of the initial RAM filesystem image. This variable is |
3250 | set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as | 3594 | set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as |
3251 | follows: INITRAMFS_LINK_NAME ?= | 3595 | follows: |
3252 | "initramfs-${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" The value of the | 3596 | :: |
3597 | |||
3598 | INITRAMFS_LINK_NAME ?= "initramfs-${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" | ||
3599 | |||
3600 | The value of the | ||
3253 | ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the same | 3601 | ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the same |
3254 | file, has the following value: KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= | 3602 | file, has the following value: |
3255 | "${MACHINE}" | 3603 | :: |
3256 | 3604 | ||
3605 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}" | ||
3606 | |||
3257 | See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional | 3607 | See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional |
3258 | information. | 3608 | information. |
3259 | 3609 | ||
3260 | INITRAMFS_NAME | 3610 | INITRAMFS_NAME |
3261 | The base name of the initial RAM filesystem image. This variable is | 3611 | The base name of the initial RAM filesystem image. This variable is |
3262 | set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as | 3612 | set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as |
3263 | follows: INITRAMFS_NAME ?= "initramfs-${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" The | 3613 | follows: |
3264 | value of the :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` | 3614 | :: |
3615 | |||
3616 | INITRAMFS_NAME ?= "initramfs-${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" | ||
3617 | |||
3618 | The value of the :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` | ||
3265 | variable, which is set in the same file, has the following value: | 3619 | variable, which is set in the same file, has the following value: |
3266 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= | 3620 | :: |
3267 | "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" | 3621 | |
3268 | 3622 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" | |
3623 | |||
3269 | INITRD | 3624 | INITRD |
3270 | Indicates list of filesystem images to concatenate and use as an | 3625 | Indicates list of filesystem images to concatenate and use as an |
3271 | initial RAM disk (``initrd``). | 3626 | initial RAM disk (``initrd``). |
3272 | 3627 | ||
3273 | The ``INITRD`` variable is an optional variable used with the | 3628 | The ``INITRD`` variable is an optional variable used with the |
3274 | :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` class. | 3629 | :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` class. |
3275 | 3630 | ||
3276 | INITRD_IMAGE | 3631 | INITRD_IMAGE |
3277 | When building a "live" bootable image (i.e. when | 3632 | When building a "live" bootable image (i.e. when |
3278 | :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` contains "live"), | 3633 | :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` contains "live"), |
3279 | ``INITRD_IMAGE`` specifies the image recipe that should be built to | 3634 | ``INITRD_IMAGE`` specifies the image recipe that should be built to |
3280 | provide the initial RAM disk image. The default value is | 3635 | provide the initial RAM disk image. The default value is |
3281 | "core-image-minimal-initramfs". | 3636 | "core-image-minimal-initramfs". |
3282 | 3637 | ||
3283 | See the :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` class for more | 3638 | See the :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` class for more |
3284 | information. | 3639 | information. |
3285 | 3640 | ||
3286 | INITSCRIPT_NAME | 3641 | INITSCRIPT_NAME |
3287 | The filename of the initialization script as installed to | 3642 | The filename of the initialization script as installed to |
3288 | ``${sysconfdir}/init.d``. | 3643 | ``${sysconfdir}/init.d``. |
3289 | 3644 | ||
3290 | This variable is used in recipes when using ``update-rc.d.bbclass``. | 3645 | This variable is used in recipes when using ``update-rc.d.bbclass``. |
3291 | The variable is mandatory. | 3646 | The variable is mandatory. |
3292 | 3647 | ||
3293 | INITSCRIPT_PACKAGES | 3648 | INITSCRIPT_PACKAGES |
3294 | A list of the packages that contain initscripts. If multiple packages | 3649 | A list of the packages that contain initscripts. If multiple packages |
3295 | are specified, you need to append the package name to the other | 3650 | are specified, you need to append the package name to the other |
3296 | ``INITSCRIPT_*`` as an override. | 3651 | ``INITSCRIPT_*`` as an override. |
3297 | 3652 | ||
3298 | This variable is used in recipes when using ``update-rc.d.bbclass``. | 3653 | This variable is used in recipes when using ``update-rc.d.bbclass``. |
3299 | The variable is optional and defaults to the :term:`PN` | 3654 | The variable is optional and defaults to the :term:`PN` |
3300 | variable. | 3655 | variable. |
3301 | 3656 | ||
3302 | INITSCRIPT_PARAMS | 3657 | INITSCRIPT_PARAMS |
3303 | Specifies the options to pass to ``update-rc.d``. Here is an example: | 3658 | Specifies the options to pass to ``update-rc.d``. Here is an example: |
3304 | INITSCRIPT_PARAMS = "start 99 5 2 . stop 20 0 1 6 ." | 3659 | :: |
3305 | 3660 | ||
3661 | INITSCRIPT_PARAMS = "start 99 5 2 . stop 20 0 1 6 ." | ||
3662 | |||
3306 | In this example, the script has a runlevel of 99, starts the script | 3663 | In this example, the script has a runlevel of 99, starts the script |
3307 | in initlevels 2 and 5, and stops the script in levels 0, 1 and 6. | 3664 | in initlevels 2 and 5, and stops the script in levels 0, 1 and 6. |
3308 | 3665 | ||
3309 | The variable's default value is "defaults", which is set in the | 3666 | The variable's default value is "defaults", which is set in the |
3310 | :ref:`update-rc.d <ref-classes-update-rc.d>` class. | 3667 | :ref:`update-rc.d <ref-classes-update-rc.d>` class. |
3311 | 3668 | ||
3312 | The value in ``INITSCRIPT_PARAMS`` is passed through to the | 3669 | The value in ``INITSCRIPT_PARAMS`` is passed through to the |
3313 | ``update-rc.d`` command. For more information on valid parameters, | 3670 | ``update-rc.d`` command. For more information on valid parameters, |
3314 | please see the ``update-rc.d`` manual page at | 3671 | please see the ``update-rc.d`` manual page at |
3315 | http://www.tin.org/bin/man.cgi?section=8&topic=update-rc.d. | 3672 | http://www.tin.org/bin/man.cgi?section=8&topic=update-rc.d. |
3316 | 3673 | ||
3317 | INSANE_SKIP | 3674 | INSANE_SKIP |
3318 | Specifies the QA checks to skip for a specific package within a | 3675 | Specifies the QA checks to skip for a specific package within a |
3319 | recipe. For example, to skip the check for symbolic link ``.so`` | 3676 | recipe. For example, to skip the check for symbolic link ``.so`` |
3320 | files in the main package of a recipe, add the following to the | 3677 | files in the main package of a recipe, add the following to the |
3321 | recipe. The package name override must be used, which in this example | 3678 | recipe. The package name override must be used, which in this example |
3322 | is ``${PN}``: INSANE_SKIP_${PN} += "dev-so" | 3679 | is ``${PN}``: |
3323 | 3680 | :: | |
3681 | |||
3682 | INSANE_SKIP_${PN} += "dev-so" | ||
3683 | |||
3324 | See the ":ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`" section for a | 3684 | See the ":ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`" section for a |
3325 | list of the valid QA checks you can specify using this variable. | 3685 | list of the valid QA checks you can specify using this variable. |
3326 | 3686 | ||
3327 | INSTALL_TIMEZONE_FILE | 3687 | INSTALL_TIMEZONE_FILE |
3328 | By default, the ``tzdata`` recipe packages an ``/etc/timezone`` file. | 3688 | By default, the ``tzdata`` recipe packages an ``/etc/timezone`` file. |
3329 | Set the ``INSTALL_TIMEZONE_FILE`` variable to "0" at the | 3689 | Set the ``INSTALL_TIMEZONE_FILE`` variable to "0" at the |
3330 | configuration level to disable this behavior. | 3690 | configuration level to disable this behavior. |
3331 | 3691 | ||
3332 | IPK_FEED_URIS | 3692 | IPK_FEED_URIS |
3333 | When the IPK backend is in use and package management is enabled on | 3693 | When the IPK backend is in use and package management is enabled on |
3334 | the target, you can use this variable to set up ``opkg`` in the | 3694 | the target, you can use this variable to set up ``opkg`` in the |
3335 | target image to point to package feeds on a nominated server. Once | 3695 | target image to point to package feeds on a nominated server. Once |
3336 | the feed is established, you can perform installations or upgrades | 3696 | the feed is established, you can perform installations or upgrades |
3337 | using the package manager at runtime. | 3697 | using the package manager at runtime. |
3338 | 3698 | ||
3339 | KARCH | 3699 | KARCH |
3340 | Defines the kernel architecture used when assembling the | 3700 | Defines the kernel architecture used when assembling the |
3341 | configuration. Architectures supported for this release are: powerpc | 3701 | configuration. Architectures supported for this release are: |
3342 | i386 x86_64 arm qemu mips | 3702 | |
3343 | 3703 | - powerpc | |
3344 | You define the ``KARCH`` variable in the `BSP | 3704 | - i386 |
3345 | Descriptions <&YOCTO_DOCS_KERNEL_DEV_URL;#bsp-descriptions>`__. | 3705 | - x86_64 |
3346 | 3706 | - arm | |
3707 | - qemu | ||
3708 | - mips | ||
3709 | |||
3710 | You define the ``KARCH`` variable in the :ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-advanced:bsp descriptions`. | ||
3711 | |||
3347 | KBRANCH | 3712 | KBRANCH |
3348 | A regular expression used by the build process to explicitly identify | 3713 | A regular expression used by the build process to explicitly identify |
3349 | the kernel branch that is validated, patched, and configured during a | 3714 | the kernel branch that is validated, patched, and configured during a |
3350 | build. You must set this variable to ensure the exact kernel branch | 3715 | build. You must set this variable to ensure the exact kernel branch |
3351 | you want is being used by the build process. | 3716 | you want is being used by the build process. |
3352 | 3717 | ||
3353 | Values for this variable are set in the kernel's recipe file and the | 3718 | Values for this variable are set in the kernel's recipe file and the |
3354 | kernel's append file. For example, if you are using the | 3719 | kernel's append file. For example, if you are using the |
3355 | ``linux-yocto_4.12`` kernel, the kernel recipe file is the | 3720 | ``linux-yocto_4.12`` kernel, the kernel recipe file is the |
3356 | ``meta/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-yocto_4.12.bb`` file. ``KBRANCH`` | 3721 | ``meta/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-yocto_4.12.bb`` file. ``KBRANCH`` |
3357 | is set as follows in that kernel recipe file: KBRANCH ?= | 3722 | is set as follows in that kernel recipe file: |
3358 | "standard/base" | 3723 | :: |
3359 | 3724 | ||
3725 | KBRANCH ?= "standard/base" | ||
3726 | |||
3360 | This variable is also used from the kernel's append file to identify | 3727 | This variable is also used from the kernel's append file to identify |
3361 | the kernel branch specific to a particular machine or target | 3728 | the kernel branch specific to a particular machine or target |
3362 | hardware. Continuing with the previous kernel example, the kernel's | 3729 | hardware. Continuing with the previous kernel example, the kernel's |
@@ -3366,17 +3733,22 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3366 | machines (``meta-yocto-bsp``) is named | 3733 | machines (``meta-yocto-bsp``) is named |
3367 | ``meta-yocto-bsp/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-yocto_4.12.bbappend``. | 3734 | ``meta-yocto-bsp/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-yocto_4.12.bbappend``. |
3368 | Here are the related statements from that append file: | 3735 | Here are the related statements from that append file: |
3369 | KBRANCH_genericx86 = "standard/base" KBRANCH_genericx86-64 = | 3736 | :: |
3370 | "standard/base" KBRANCH_edgerouter = "standard/edgerouter" | 3737 | |
3371 | KBRANCH_beaglebone = "standard/beaglebone" The ``KBRANCH`` statements | 3738 | KBRANCH_genericx86 = "standard/base" |
3739 | KBRANCH_genericx86-64 = "standard/base" | ||
3740 | KBRANCH_edgerouter = "standard/edgerouter" | ||
3741 | KBRANCH_beaglebone = "standard/beaglebone" | ||
3742 | |||
3743 | The ``KBRANCH`` statements | ||
3372 | identify the kernel branch to use when building for each supported | 3744 | identify the kernel branch to use when building for each supported |
3373 | BSP. | 3745 | BSP. |
3374 | 3746 | ||
3375 | KBUILD_DEFCONFIG | 3747 | KBUILD_DEFCONFIG |
3376 | When used with the :ref:`kernel-yocto <ref-classes-kernel-yocto>` | 3748 | When used with the :ref:`kernel-yocto <ref-classes-kernel-yocto>` |
3377 | class, specifies an "in-tree" kernel configuration file for use | 3749 | class, specifies an "in-tree" kernel configuration file for use |
3378 | during a kernel build. | 3750 | during a kernel build. |
3379 | 3751 | ||
3380 | Typically, when using a ``defconfig`` to configure a kernel during a | 3752 | Typically, when using a ``defconfig`` to configure a kernel during a |
3381 | build, you place the file in your layer in the same manner as you | 3753 | build, you place the file in your layer in the same manner as you |
3382 | would place patch files and configuration fragment files (i.e. | 3754 | would place patch files and configuration fragment files (i.e. |
@@ -3385,46 +3757,53 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3385 | ``KBUILD_DEFCONFIG`` variable and append the | 3757 | ``KBUILD_DEFCONFIG`` variable and append the |
3386 | :term:`KMACHINE` variable to point to the | 3758 | :term:`KMACHINE` variable to point to the |
3387 | ``defconfig`` file. | 3759 | ``defconfig`` file. |
3388 | 3760 | ||
3389 | To use the variable, set it in the append file for your kernel recipe | 3761 | To use the variable, set it in the append file for your kernel recipe |
3390 | using the following form: KBUILD_DEFCONFIG_KMACHINE ?= defconfig_file | 3762 | using the following form: |
3763 | :: | ||
3764 | |||
3765 | KBUILD_DEFCONFIG_KMACHINE ?= defconfig_file | ||
3766 | |||
3391 | Here is an example from a "raspberrypi2" ``KMACHINE`` build that uses | 3767 | Here is an example from a "raspberrypi2" ``KMACHINE`` build that uses |
3392 | a ``defconfig`` file named "bcm2709_defconfig": | 3768 | a ``defconfig`` file named "bcm2709_defconfig": |
3393 | KBUILD_DEFCONFIG_raspberrypi2 = "bcm2709_defconfig" As an | 3769 | :: |
3394 | alternative, you can use the following within your append file: | 3770 | |
3395 | KBUILD_DEFCONFIG_pn-linux-yocto ?= defconfig_file For more | 3771 | KBUILD_DEFCONFIG_raspberrypi2 = "bcm2709_defconfig" |
3772 | |||
3773 | As an alternative, you can use the following within your append file: | ||
3774 | :: | ||
3775 | |||
3776 | KBUILD_DEFCONFIG_pn-linux-yocto ?= defconfig_file | ||
3777 | |||
3778 | For more | ||
3396 | information on how to use the ``KBUILD_DEFCONFIG`` variable, see the | 3779 | information on how to use the ``KBUILD_DEFCONFIG`` variable, see the |
3397 | "`Using an "In-Tree" ``defconfig`` | 3780 | ":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-common:using an "in-tree" \`\`defconfig\`\` file`" |
3398 | File <&YOCTO_DOCS_KERNEL_DEV_URL;#using-an-in-tree-defconfig-file>`__" | ||
3399 | section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual. | 3781 | section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual. |
3400 | 3782 | ||
3401 | KERNEL_ALT_IMAGETYPE | 3783 | KERNEL_ALT_IMAGETYPE |
3402 | Specifies an alternate kernel image type for creation in addition to | 3784 | Specifies an alternate kernel image type for creation in addition to |
3403 | the kernel image type specified using the | 3785 | the kernel image type specified using the |
3404 | :term:`KERNEL_IMAGETYPE` variable. | 3786 | :term:`KERNEL_IMAGETYPE` variable. |
3405 | 3787 | ||
3406 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME | 3788 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME |
3407 | Specifies the name of all of the build artifacts. You can change the | 3789 | Specifies the name of all of the build artifacts. You can change the |
3408 | name of the artifacts by changing the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME`` | 3790 | name of the artifacts by changing the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME`` |
3409 | variable. | 3791 | variable. |
3410 | 3792 | ||
3411 | The value of ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME``, which is set in the | 3793 | The value of ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME``, which is set in the |
3412 | ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file, has the | 3794 | ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file, has the |
3413 | following default value: KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= | 3795 | following default value: |
3414 | "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" | 3796 | :: |
3415 | 3797 | ||
3416 | See the :term:`PKGE`, :term:`PKGV`, | 3798 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" |
3417 | :term:`PKGR`, and :term:`MACHINE` | 3799 | |
3800 | See the :term:`PKGE`, :term:`PKGV`, :term:`PKGR`, and :term:`MACHINE` | ||
3418 | variables for additional information. | 3801 | variables for additional information. |
3419 | 3802 | ||
3420 | .. note:: | 3803 | .. note:: |
3421 | 3804 | ||
3422 | The | 3805 | The IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX variable is set to DATETIME. |
3423 | IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX | 3806 | |
3424 | variable is set to | ||
3425 | DATETIME | ||
3426 | . | ||
3427 | |||
3428 | KERNEL_CLASSES | 3807 | KERNEL_CLASSES |
3429 | A list of classes defining kernel image types that the | 3808 | A list of classes defining kernel image types that the |
3430 | :ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class should inherit. You | 3809 | :ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class should inherit. You |
@@ -3433,46 +3812,56 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3433 | resides in ``meta/classes/kernel-fitimage.bbclass``. You can register | 3812 | resides in ``meta/classes/kernel-fitimage.bbclass``. You can register |
3434 | custom kernel image types with the ``kernel`` class using this | 3813 | custom kernel image types with the ``kernel`` class using this |
3435 | variable. | 3814 | variable. |
3436 | 3815 | ||
3437 | KERNEL_DEVICETREE | 3816 | KERNEL_DEVICETREE |
3438 | Specifies the name of the generated Linux kernel device tree (i.e. | 3817 | Specifies the name of the generated Linux kernel device tree (i.e. |
3439 | the ``.dtb``) file. | 3818 | the ``.dtb``) file. |
3440 | 3819 | ||
3441 | .. note:: | 3820 | .. note:: |
3442 | 3821 | ||
3443 | Legacy support exists for specifying the full path to the device | 3822 | Legacy support exists for specifying the full path to the device |
3444 | tree. However, providing just the | 3823 | tree. However, providing just the .dtb file is preferred. |
3445 | .dtb | 3824 | |
3446 | file is preferred. | ||
3447 | |||
3448 | In order to use this variable, the | 3825 | In order to use this variable, the |
3449 | :ref:`kernel-devicetree <ref-classes-kernel-devicetree>` class must | 3826 | :ref:`kernel-devicetree <ref-classes-kernel-devicetree>` class must |
3450 | be inherited. | 3827 | be inherited. |
3451 | 3828 | ||
3452 | KERNEL_DTB_LINK_NAME | 3829 | KERNEL_DTB_LINK_NAME |
3453 | The link name of the kernel device tree binary (DTB). This variable | 3830 | The link name of the kernel device tree binary (DTB). This variable |
3454 | is set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as | 3831 | is set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as |
3455 | follows: KERNEL_DTB_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" The | 3832 | follows: |
3833 | :: | ||
3834 | |||
3835 | KERNEL_DTB_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" | ||
3836 | |||
3837 | The | ||
3456 | value of the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in | 3838 | value of the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in |
3457 | the same file, has the following value: KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= | 3839 | the same file, has the following value: |
3458 | "${MACHINE}" | 3840 | :: |
3459 | 3841 | ||
3842 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}" | ||
3843 | |||
3460 | See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional | 3844 | See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional |
3461 | information. | 3845 | information. |
3462 | 3846 | ||
3463 | KERNEL_DTB_NAME | 3847 | KERNEL_DTB_NAME |
3464 | The base name of the kernel device tree binary (DTB). This variable | 3848 | The base name of the kernel device tree binary (DTB). This variable |
3465 | is set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as | 3849 | is set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as |
3466 | follows: KERNEL_DTB_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" The value of | 3850 | follows: |
3467 | the :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` | 3851 | :: |
3852 | |||
3853 | KERNEL_DTB_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" | ||
3854 | |||
3855 | The value of the :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` | ||
3468 | variable, which is set in the same file, has the following value: | 3856 | variable, which is set in the same file, has the following value: |
3469 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= | 3857 | :: |
3470 | "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" | 3858 | |
3471 | 3859 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" | |
3860 | |||
3472 | KERNEL_EXTRA_ARGS | 3861 | KERNEL_EXTRA_ARGS |
3473 | Specifies additional ``make`` command-line arguments the OpenEmbedded | 3862 | Specifies additional ``make`` command-line arguments the OpenEmbedded |
3474 | build system passes on when compiling the kernel. | 3863 | build system passes on when compiling the kernel. |
3475 | 3864 | ||
3476 | KERNEL_FEATURES | 3865 | KERNEL_FEATURES |
3477 | Includes additional kernel metadata. In the OpenEmbedded build | 3866 | Includes additional kernel metadata. In the OpenEmbedded build |
3478 | system, the default Board Support Packages (BSPs) | 3867 | system, the default Board Support Packages (BSPs) |
@@ -3481,158 +3870,184 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3481 | variables. You can use the ``KERNEL_FEATURES`` variable from within | 3870 | variables. You can use the ``KERNEL_FEATURES`` variable from within |
3482 | the kernel recipe or kernel append file to further add metadata for | 3871 | the kernel recipe or kernel append file to further add metadata for |
3483 | all BSPs or specific BSPs. | 3872 | all BSPs or specific BSPs. |
3484 | 3873 | ||
3485 | The metadata you add through this variable includes config fragments | 3874 | The metadata you add through this variable includes config fragments |
3486 | and features descriptions, which usually includes patches as well as | 3875 | and features descriptions, which usually includes patches as well as |
3487 | config fragments. You typically override the ``KERNEL_FEATURES`` | 3876 | config fragments. You typically override the ``KERNEL_FEATURES`` |
3488 | variable for a specific machine. In this way, you can provide | 3877 | variable for a specific machine. In this way, you can provide |
3489 | validated, but optional, sets of kernel configurations and features. | 3878 | validated, but optional, sets of kernel configurations and features. |
3490 | 3879 | ||
3491 | For example, the following example from the ``linux-yocto-rt_4.12`` | 3880 | For example, the following example from the ``linux-yocto-rt_4.12`` |
3492 | kernel recipe adds "netfilter" and "taskstats" features to all BSPs | 3881 | kernel recipe adds "netfilter" and "taskstats" features to all BSPs |
3493 | as well as "virtio" configurations to all QEMU machines. The last two | 3882 | as well as "virtio" configurations to all QEMU machines. The last two |
3494 | statements add specific configurations to targeted machine types: | 3883 | statements add specific configurations to targeted machine types: |
3495 | KERNEL_EXTRA_FEATURES ?= "features/netfilter/netfilter.scc | 3884 | :: |
3496 | features/taskstats/taskstats.scc" KERNEL_FEATURES_append = " | 3885 | |
3497 | ${KERNEL_EXTRA_FEATURES}" KERNEL_FEATURES_append_qemuall = " | 3886 | KERNEL_EXTRA_FEATURES ?= "features/netfilter/netfilter.scc features/taskstats/taskstats.scc" |
3498 | cfg/virtio.scc" KERNEL_FEATURES_append_qemux86 = " cfg/sound.scc | 3887 | KERNEL_FEATURES_append = "${KERNEL_EXTRA_FEATURES}" |
3499 | cfg/paravirt_kvm.scc" KERNEL_FEATURES_append_qemux86-64 = " | 3888 | KERNEL_FEATURES_append_qemuall = "cfg/virtio.scc" |
3500 | cfg/sound.scc" | 3889 | KERNEL_FEATURES_append_qemux86 = " cfg/sound.scc cfg/paravirt_kvm.scc" |
3501 | 3890 | KERNEL_FEATURES_append_qemux86-64 = "cfg/sound.scc" | |
3891 | |||
3502 | KERNEL_FIT_LINK_NAME | 3892 | KERNEL_FIT_LINK_NAME |
3503 | The link name of the kernel flattened image tree (FIT) image. This | 3893 | The link name of the kernel flattened image tree (FIT) image. This |
3504 | variable is set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` | 3894 | variable is set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` |
3505 | file as follows: KERNEL_FIT_LINK_NAME ?= | 3895 | file as follows: |
3506 | "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" The value of the | 3896 | :: |
3897 | |||
3898 | KERNEL_FIT_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" | ||
3899 | |||
3900 | The value of the | ||
3507 | ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the same | 3901 | ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the same |
3508 | file, has the following value: KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= | 3902 | file, has the following value: |
3509 | "${MACHINE}" | 3903 | :: |
3510 | 3904 | ||
3905 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}" | ||
3906 | |||
3511 | See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional | 3907 | See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional |
3512 | information. | 3908 | information. |
3513 | 3909 | ||
3514 | KERNEL_FIT_NAME | 3910 | KERNEL_FIT_NAME |
3515 | The base name of the kernel flattened image tree (FIT) image. This | 3911 | The base name of the kernel flattened image tree (FIT) image. This |
3516 | variable is set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` | 3912 | variable is set in the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` |
3517 | file as follows: KERNEL_FIT_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" The | 3913 | file as follows: |
3518 | value of the :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` | 3914 | :: |
3915 | |||
3916 | KERNEL_FIT_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" | ||
3917 | |||
3918 | The value of the :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` | ||
3519 | variable, which is set in the same file, has the following value: | 3919 | variable, which is set in the same file, has the following value: |
3520 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= | 3920 | :: |
3521 | "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" | 3921 | |
3522 | 3922 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" | |
3923 | |||
3523 | KERNEL_IMAGE_LINK_NAME | 3924 | KERNEL_IMAGE_LINK_NAME |
3524 | The link name for the kernel image. This variable is set in the | 3925 | The link name for the kernel image. This variable is set in the |
3525 | ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows: | 3926 | ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows: |
3526 | KERNEL_IMAGE_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" The value of | 3927 | :: |
3928 | |||
3929 | KERNEL_IMAGE_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" | ||
3930 | |||
3931 | The value of | ||
3527 | the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the same | 3932 | the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the same |
3528 | file, has the following value: KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= | 3933 | file, has the following value: |
3529 | "${MACHINE}" | 3934 | :: |
3530 | 3935 | ||
3936 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}" | ||
3937 | |||
3531 | See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional | 3938 | See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional |
3532 | information. | 3939 | information. |
3533 | 3940 | ||
3534 | KERNEL_IMAGE_MAXSIZE | 3941 | KERNEL_IMAGE_MAXSIZE |
3535 | Specifies the maximum size of the kernel image file in kilobytes. If | 3942 | Specifies the maximum size of the kernel image file in kilobytes. If |
3536 | ``KERNEL_IMAGE_MAXSIZE`` is set, the size of the kernel image file is | 3943 | ``KERNEL_IMAGE_MAXSIZE`` is set, the size of the kernel image file is |
3537 | checked against the set value during the | 3944 | checked against the set value during the |
3538 | :ref:`ref-tasks-sizecheck` task. The task fails if | 3945 | :ref:`ref-tasks-sizecheck` task. The task fails if |
3539 | the kernel image file is larger than the setting. | 3946 | the kernel image file is larger than the setting. |
3540 | 3947 | ||
3541 | ``KERNEL_IMAGE_MAXSIZE`` is useful for target devices that have a | 3948 | ``KERNEL_IMAGE_MAXSIZE`` is useful for target devices that have a |
3542 | limited amount of space in which the kernel image must be stored. | 3949 | limited amount of space in which the kernel image must be stored. |
3543 | 3950 | ||
3544 | By default, this variable is not set, which means the size of the | 3951 | By default, this variable is not set, which means the size of the |
3545 | kernel image is not checked. | 3952 | kernel image is not checked. |
3546 | 3953 | ||
3547 | KERNEL_IMAGE_NAME | 3954 | KERNEL_IMAGE_NAME |
3548 | The base name of the kernel image. This variable is set in the | 3955 | The base name of the kernel image. This variable is set in the |
3549 | ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows: | 3956 | ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows: |
3550 | KERNEL_IMAGE_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" The value of the | 3957 | :: |
3958 | |||
3959 | KERNEL_IMAGE_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" | ||
3960 | |||
3961 | The value of the | ||
3551 | :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` variable, | 3962 | :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` variable, |
3552 | which is set in the same file, has the following value: | 3963 | which is set in the same file, has the following value: |
3553 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= | 3964 | :: |
3554 | "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" | 3965 | |
3555 | 3966 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" | |
3967 | |||
3556 | KERNEL_IMAGETYPE | 3968 | KERNEL_IMAGETYPE |
3557 | The type of kernel to build for a device, usually set by the machine | 3969 | The type of kernel to build for a device, usually set by the machine |
3558 | configuration files and defaults to "zImage". This variable is used | 3970 | configuration files and defaults to "zImage". This variable is used |
3559 | when building the kernel and is passed to ``make`` as the target to | 3971 | when building the kernel and is passed to ``make`` as the target to |
3560 | build. | 3972 | build. |
3561 | 3973 | ||
3562 | If you want to build an alternate kernel image type, use the | 3974 | If you want to build an alternate kernel image type, use the |
3563 | :term:`KERNEL_ALT_IMAGETYPE` variable. | 3975 | :term:`KERNEL_ALT_IMAGETYPE` variable. |
3564 | 3976 | ||
3565 | KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD | 3977 | KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD |
3566 | Lists kernel modules that need to be auto-loaded during boot. | 3978 | Lists kernel modules that need to be auto-loaded during boot. |
3567 | 3979 | ||
3568 | .. note:: | 3980 | .. note:: |
3569 | 3981 | ||
3570 | This variable replaces the deprecated | 3982 | This variable replaces the deprecated |
3571 | module_autoload | 3983 | module_autoload |
3572 | variable. | 3984 | variable. |
3573 | 3985 | ||
3574 | You can use the ``KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD`` variable anywhere that it | 3986 | You can use the ``KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD`` variable anywhere that it |
3575 | can be recognized by the kernel recipe or by an out-of-tree kernel | 3987 | can be recognized by the kernel recipe or by an out-of-tree kernel |
3576 | module recipe (e.g. a machine configuration file, a distribution | 3988 | module recipe (e.g. a machine configuration file, a distribution |
3577 | configuration file, an append file for the recipe, or the recipe | 3989 | configuration file, an append file for the recipe, or the recipe |
3578 | itself). | 3990 | itself). |
3579 | 3991 | ||
3580 | Specify it as follows: KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD += "module_name1 | 3992 | Specify it as follows: |
3581 | module_name2 module_name3" | 3993 | :: |
3582 | 3994 | ||
3995 | KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD += "module_name1 module_name2 module_name3" | ||
3996 | |||
3583 | Including ``KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD`` causes the OpenEmbedded build | 3997 | Including ``KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD`` causes the OpenEmbedded build |
3584 | system to populate the ``/etc/modules-load.d/modname.conf`` file with | 3998 | system to populate the ``/etc/modules-load.d/modname.conf`` file with |
3585 | the list of modules to be auto-loaded on boot. The modules appear | 3999 | the list of modules to be auto-loaded on boot. The modules appear |
3586 | one-per-line in the file. Here is an example of the most common use | 4000 | one-per-line in the file. Here is an example of the most common use |
3587 | case: KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD += "module_name" | 4001 | case: |
3588 | 4002 | :: | |
4003 | |||
4004 | KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD += "module_name" | ||
4005 | |||
3589 | For information on how to populate the ``modname.conf`` file with | 4006 | For information on how to populate the ``modname.conf`` file with |
3590 | ``modprobe.d`` syntax lines, see the | 4007 | ``modprobe.d`` syntax lines, see the :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_PROBECONF` variable. |
3591 | :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_PROBECONF` | 4008 | |
3592 | variable. | ||
3593 | |||
3594 | KERNEL_MODULE_PROBECONF | 4009 | KERNEL_MODULE_PROBECONF |
3595 | Provides a list of modules for which the OpenEmbedded build system | 4010 | Provides a list of modules for which the OpenEmbedded build system |
3596 | expects to find ``module_conf_``\ modname values that specify | 4011 | expects to find ``module_conf_``\ modname values that specify |
3597 | configuration for each of the modules. For information on how to | 4012 | configuration for each of the modules. For information on how to |
3598 | provide those module configurations, see the | 4013 | provide those module configurations, see the |
3599 | :term:`module_conf_* <module_conf>` variable. | 4014 | :term:`module_conf_* <module_conf>` variable. |
3600 | 4015 | ||
3601 | KERNEL_PATH | 4016 | KERNEL_PATH |
3602 | The location of the kernel sources. This variable is set to the value | 4017 | The location of the kernel sources. This variable is set to the value |
3603 | of the :term:`STAGING_KERNEL_DIR` within | 4018 | of the :term:`STAGING_KERNEL_DIR` within |
3604 | the :ref:`module <ref-classes-module>` class. For information on | 4019 | the :ref:`module <ref-classes-module>` class. For information on |
3605 | how this variable is used, see the "`Incorporating Out-of-Tree | 4020 | how this variable is used, see the |
3606 | Modules <&YOCTO_DOCS_KERNEL_DEV_URL;#incorporating-out-of-tree-modules>`__" | 4021 | ":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-common:incorporating out-of-tree modules`" |
3607 | section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual. | 4022 | section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual. |
3608 | 4023 | ||
3609 | To help maximize compatibility with out-of-tree drivers used to build | 4024 | To help maximize compatibility with out-of-tree drivers used to build |
3610 | modules, the OpenEmbedded build system also recognizes and uses the | 4025 | modules, the OpenEmbedded build system also recognizes and uses the |
3611 | :term:`KERNEL_SRC` variable, which is identical to | 4026 | :term:`KERNEL_SRC` variable, which is identical to |
3612 | the ``KERNEL_PATH`` variable. Both variables are common variables | 4027 | the ``KERNEL_PATH`` variable. Both variables are common variables |
3613 | used by external Makefiles to point to the kernel source directory. | 4028 | used by external Makefiles to point to the kernel source directory. |
3614 | 4029 | ||
3615 | KERNEL_SRC | 4030 | KERNEL_SRC |
3616 | The location of the kernel sources. This variable is set to the value | 4031 | The location of the kernel sources. This variable is set to the value |
3617 | of the :term:`STAGING_KERNEL_DIR` within | 4032 | of the :term:`STAGING_KERNEL_DIR` within |
3618 | the :ref:`module <ref-classes-module>` class. For information on | 4033 | the :ref:`module <ref-classes-module>` class. For information on |
3619 | how this variable is used, see the "`Incorporating Out-of-Tree | 4034 | how this variable is used, see the |
3620 | Modules <&YOCTO_DOCS_KERNEL_DEV_URL;#incorporating-out-of-tree-modules>`__" | 4035 | ":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-common:incorporating out-of-tree modules`" |
3621 | section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual. | 4036 | section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual. |
3622 | 4037 | ||
3623 | To help maximize compatibility with out-of-tree drivers used to build | 4038 | To help maximize compatibility with out-of-tree drivers used to build |
3624 | modules, the OpenEmbedded build system also recognizes and uses the | 4039 | modules, the OpenEmbedded build system also recognizes and uses the |
3625 | :term:`KERNEL_PATH` variable, which is identical | 4040 | :term:`KERNEL_PATH` variable, which is identical |
3626 | to the ``KERNEL_SRC`` variable. Both variables are common variables | 4041 | to the ``KERNEL_SRC`` variable. Both variables are common variables |
3627 | used by external Makefiles to point to the kernel source directory. | 4042 | used by external Makefiles to point to the kernel source directory. |
3628 | 4043 | ||
3629 | KERNEL_VERSION | 4044 | KERNEL_VERSION |
3630 | Specifies the version of the kernel as extracted from ``version.h`` | 4045 | Specifies the version of the kernel as extracted from ``version.h`` |
3631 | or ``utsrelease.h`` within the kernel sources. Effects of setting | 4046 | or ``utsrelease.h`` within the kernel sources. Effects of setting |
3632 | this variable do not take affect until the kernel has been | 4047 | this variable do not take affect until the kernel has been |
3633 | configured. Consequently, attempting to refer to this variable in | 4048 | configured. Consequently, attempting to refer to this variable in |
3634 | contexts prior to configuration will not work. | 4049 | contexts prior to configuration will not work. |
3635 | 4050 | ||
3636 | KERNELDEPMODDEPEND | 4051 | KERNELDEPMODDEPEND |
3637 | Specifies whether the data referenced through | 4052 | Specifies whether the data referenced through |
3638 | :term:`PKGDATA_DIR` is needed or not. The | 4053 | :term:`PKGDATA_DIR` is needed or not. The |
@@ -3641,14 +4056,16 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3641 | use the data, set the ``KERNELDEPMODDEPEND`` variable in your | 4056 | use the data, set the ``KERNELDEPMODDEPEND`` variable in your |
3642 | ``initramfs`` recipe. Setting the variable there when the data is not | 4057 | ``initramfs`` recipe. Setting the variable there when the data is not |
3643 | needed avoids a potential dependency loop. | 4058 | needed avoids a potential dependency loop. |
3644 | 4059 | ||
3645 | KFEATURE_DESCRIPTION | 4060 | KFEATURE_DESCRIPTION |
3646 | Provides a short description of a configuration fragment. You use | 4061 | Provides a short description of a configuration fragment. You use |
3647 | this variable in the ``.scc`` file that describes a configuration | 4062 | this variable in the ``.scc`` file that describes a configuration |
3648 | fragment file. Here is the variable used in a file named ``smp.scc`` | 4063 | fragment file. Here is the variable used in a file named ``smp.scc`` |
3649 | to describe SMP being enabled: define KFEATURE_DESCRIPTION "Enable | 4064 | to describe SMP being enabled: |
3650 | SMP" | 4065 | :: |
3651 | 4066 | ||
4067 | define KFEATURE_DESCRIPTION "Enable SMP" | ||
4068 | |||
3652 | KMACHINE | 4069 | KMACHINE |
3653 | The machine as known by the kernel. Sometimes the machine name used | 4070 | The machine as known by the kernel. Sometimes the machine name used |
3654 | by the kernel does not match the machine name used by the | 4071 | by the kernel does not match the machine name used by the |
@@ -3658,77 +4075,86 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3658 | understands that machine as ``intel-core2-32``. For cases like these, | 4075 | understands that machine as ``intel-core2-32``. For cases like these, |
3659 | the ``KMACHINE`` variable maps the kernel machine name to the | 4076 | the ``KMACHINE`` variable maps the kernel machine name to the |
3660 | OpenEmbedded build system machine name. | 4077 | OpenEmbedded build system machine name. |
3661 | 4078 | ||
3662 | These mappings between different names occur in the Yocto Linux | 4079 | These mappings between different names occur in the Yocto Linux |
3663 | Kernel's ``meta`` branch. As an example take a look in the | 4080 | Kernel's ``meta`` branch. As an example take a look in the |
3664 | ``common/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-yocto_3.19.bbappend`` file: | 4081 | ``common/recipes-kernel/linux/linux-yocto_3.19.bbappend`` file: |
3665 | LINUX_VERSION_core2-32-intel-common = "3.19.0" | 4082 | :: |
3666 | COMPATIBLE_MACHINE_core2-32-intel-common = "${MACHINE}" | 4083 | |
3667 | SRCREV_meta_core2-32-intel-common = | 4084 | LINUX_VERSION_core2-32-intel-common = "3.19.0" |
3668 | "8897ef68b30e7426bc1d39895e71fb155d694974" | 4085 | COMPATIBLE_MACHINE_core2-32-intel-common = "${MACHINE}" |
3669 | SRCREV_machine_core2-32-intel-common = | 4086 | SRCREV_meta_core2-32-intel-common = "8897ef68b30e7426bc1d39895e71fb155d694974" |
3670 | "43b9eced9ba8a57add36af07736344dcc383f711" | 4087 | SRCREV_machine_core2-32-intel-common = "43b9eced9ba8a57add36af07736344dcc383f711" |
3671 | KMACHINE_core2-32-intel-common = "intel-core2-32" | 4088 | KMACHINE_core2-32-intel-common = "intel-core2-32" |
3672 | KBRANCH_core2-32-intel-common = "standard/base" | 4089 | KBRANCH_core2-32-intel-common = "standard/base" |
3673 | KERNEL_FEATURES_append_core2-32-intel-common = | 4090 | KERNEL_FEATURES_append_core2-32-intel-common = "${KERNEL_FEATURES_INTEL_COMMON}" |
3674 | "${KERNEL_FEATURES_INTEL_COMMON}" The ``KMACHINE`` statement says | 4091 | |
4092 | The ``KMACHINE`` statement says | ||
3675 | that the kernel understands the machine name as "intel-core2-32". | 4093 | that the kernel understands the machine name as "intel-core2-32". |
3676 | However, the OpenEmbedded build system understands the machine as | 4094 | However, the OpenEmbedded build system understands the machine as |
3677 | "core2-32-intel-common". | 4095 | "core2-32-intel-common". |
3678 | 4096 | ||
3679 | KTYPE | 4097 | KTYPE |
3680 | Defines the kernel type to be used in assembling the configuration. | 4098 | Defines the kernel type to be used in assembling the configuration. |
3681 | The linux-yocto recipes define "standard", "tiny", and "preempt-rt" | 4099 | The linux-yocto recipes define "standard", "tiny", and "preempt-rt" |
3682 | kernel types. See the "`Kernel | 4100 | kernel types. See the ":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-advanced:kernel types`" |
3683 | Types <&YOCTO_DOCS_KERNEL_DEV_URL;#kernel-types>`__" section in the | 4101 | section in the |
3684 | Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual for more information on | 4102 | Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual for more information on |
3685 | kernel types. | 4103 | kernel types. |
3686 | 4104 | ||
3687 | You define the ``KTYPE`` variable in the `BSP | 4105 | You define the ``KTYPE`` variable in the |
3688 | Descriptions <&YOCTO_DOCS_KERNEL_DEV_URL;#bsp-descriptions>`__. The | 4106 | :ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-advanced:bsp descriptions`. The |
3689 | value you use must match the value used for the | 4107 | value you use must match the value used for the |
3690 | :term:`LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE` value used by the | 4108 | :term:`LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE` value used by the |
3691 | kernel recipe. | 4109 | kernel recipe. |
3692 | 4110 | ||
3693 | LABELS | 4111 | LABELS |
3694 | Provides a list of targets for automatic configuration. | 4112 | Provides a list of targets for automatic configuration. |
3695 | 4113 | ||
3696 | See the :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more | 4114 | See the :ref:`grub-efi <ref-classes-grub-efi>` class for more |
3697 | information on how this variable is used. | 4115 | information on how this variable is used. |
3698 | 4116 | ||
3699 | LAYERDEPENDS | 4117 | LAYERDEPENDS |
3700 | Lists the layers, separated by spaces, on which this recipe depends. | 4118 | Lists the layers, separated by spaces, on which this recipe depends. |
3701 | Optionally, you can specify a specific layer version for a dependency | 4119 | Optionally, you can specify a specific layer version for a dependency |
3702 | by adding it to the end of the layer name. Here is an example: | 4120 | by adding it to the end of the layer name. Here is an example: |
3703 | LAYERDEPENDS_mylayer = "anotherlayer (=3)" In this previous example, | 4121 | :: |
4122 | |||
4123 | LAYERDEPENDS_mylayer = "anotherlayer (=3)" | ||
4124 | |||
4125 | In this previous example, | ||
3704 | version 3 of "anotherlayer" is compared against | 4126 | version 3 of "anotherlayer" is compared against |
3705 | :term:`LAYERVERSION`\ ``_anotherlayer``. | 4127 | :term:`LAYERVERSION`\ ``_anotherlayer``. |
3706 | 4128 | ||
3707 | An error is produced if any dependency is missing or the version | 4129 | An error is produced if any dependency is missing or the version |
3708 | numbers (if specified) do not match exactly. This variable is used in | 4130 | numbers (if specified) do not match exactly. This variable is used in |
3709 | the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be suffixed with the name of | 4131 | the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be suffixed with the name of |
3710 | the specific layer (e.g. ``LAYERDEPENDS_mylayer``). | 4132 | the specific layer (e.g. ``LAYERDEPENDS_mylayer``). |
3711 | 4133 | ||
3712 | LAYERDIR | 4134 | LAYERDIR |
3713 | When used inside the ``layer.conf`` configuration file, this variable | 4135 | When used inside the ``layer.conf`` configuration file, this variable |
3714 | provides the path of the current layer. This variable is not | 4136 | provides the path of the current layer. This variable is not |
3715 | available outside of ``layer.conf`` and references are expanded | 4137 | available outside of ``layer.conf`` and references are expanded |
3716 | immediately when parsing of the file completes. | 4138 | immediately when parsing of the file completes. |
3717 | 4139 | ||
3718 | LAYERRECOMMENDS | 4140 | LAYERRECOMMENDS |
3719 | Lists the layers, separated by spaces, recommended for use with this | 4141 | Lists the layers, separated by spaces, recommended for use with this |
3720 | layer. | 4142 | layer. |
3721 | 4143 | ||
3722 | Optionally, you can specify a specific layer version for a | 4144 | Optionally, you can specify a specific layer version for a |
3723 | recommendation by adding the version to the end of the layer name. | 4145 | recommendation by adding the version to the end of the layer name. |
3724 | Here is an example: LAYERRECOMMENDS_mylayer = "anotherlayer (=3)" In | 4146 | Here is an example: |
3725 | this previous example, version 3 of "anotherlayer" is compared | 4147 | :: |
4148 | |||
4149 | LAYERRECOMMENDS_mylayer = "anotherlayer (=3)" | ||
4150 | |||
4151 | In this previous example, version 3 of "anotherlayer" is compared | ||
3726 | against ``LAYERVERSION_anotherlayer``. | 4152 | against ``LAYERVERSION_anotherlayer``. |
3727 | 4153 | ||
3728 | This variable is used in the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be | 4154 | This variable is used in the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be |
3729 | suffixed with the name of the specific layer (e.g. | 4155 | suffixed with the name of the specific layer (e.g. |
3730 | ``LAYERRECOMMENDS_mylayer``). | 4156 | ``LAYERRECOMMENDS_mylayer``). |
3731 | 4157 | ||
3732 | LAYERSERIES_COMPAT | 4158 | LAYERSERIES_COMPAT |
3733 | Lists the versions of the :term:`OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)` for which | 4159 | Lists the versions of the :term:`OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)` for which |
3734 | a layer is compatible. Using the ``LAYERSERIES_COMPAT`` variable | 4160 | a layer is compatible. Using the ``LAYERSERIES_COMPAT`` variable |
@@ -3736,27 +4162,28 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3736 | layer and OE-Core can be expected to work. The variable gives the | 4162 | layer and OE-Core can be expected to work. The variable gives the |
3737 | system a way to detect when a layer has not been tested with new | 4163 | system a way to detect when a layer has not been tested with new |
3738 | releases of OE-Core (e.g. the layer is not maintained). | 4164 | releases of OE-Core (e.g. the layer is not maintained). |
3739 | 4165 | ||
3740 | To specify the OE-Core versions for which a layer is compatible, use | 4166 | To specify the OE-Core versions for which a layer is compatible, use |
3741 | this variable in your layer's ``conf/layer.conf`` configuration file. | 4167 | this variable in your layer's ``conf/layer.conf`` configuration file. |
3742 | For the list, use the Yocto Project | 4168 | For the list, use the Yocto Project |
3743 | :yocto_wiki:`Release Name </wiki/Releases>` (e.g. | 4169 | :yocto_wiki:`Release Name </wiki/Releases>` (e.g. |
3744 | DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP). To specify multiple OE-Core versions for the | 4170 | DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP). To specify multiple OE-Core versions for the |
3745 | layer, use a space-separated list: LAYERSERIES_COMPAT_layer_root_name | 4171 | layer, use a space-separated list: |
3746 | = "DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP_MINUS_ONE" | 4172 | :: |
3747 | 4173 | ||
4174 | LAYERSERIES_COMPAT_layer_root_name = "DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP_MINUS_ONE" | ||
4175 | |||
3748 | .. note:: | 4176 | .. note:: |
3749 | 4177 | ||
3750 | Setting | 4178 | Setting |
3751 | LAYERSERIES_COMPAT | 4179 | LAYERSERIES_COMPAT |
3752 | is required by the Yocto Project Compatible version 2 standard. | 4180 | is required by the Yocto Project Compatible version 2 standard. |
3753 | The OpenEmbedded build system produces a warning if the variable | 4181 | The OpenEmbedded build system produces a warning if the variable |
3754 | is not set for any given layer. | 4182 | is not set for any given layer. |
3755 | 4183 | ||
3756 | See the "`Creating Your Own | 4184 | See the ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:creating your own layer`" |
3757 | Layer <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#creating-your-own-layer>`__" section in | 4185 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
3758 | the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 4186 | |
3759 | |||
3760 | LAYERVERSION | 4187 | LAYERVERSION |
3761 | Optionally specifies the version of a layer as a single number. You | 4188 | Optionally specifies the version of a layer as a single number. You |
3762 | can use this within :term:`LAYERDEPENDS` for | 4189 | can use this within :term:`LAYERDEPENDS` for |
@@ -3764,90 +4191,98 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3764 | This variable is used in the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be | 4191 | This variable is used in the ``conf/layer.conf`` file and must be |
3765 | suffixed with the name of the specific layer (e.g. | 4192 | suffixed with the name of the specific layer (e.g. |
3766 | ``LAYERVERSION_mylayer``). | 4193 | ``LAYERVERSION_mylayer``). |
3767 | 4194 | ||
3768 | LD | 4195 | LD |
3769 | The minimal command and arguments used to run the linker. | 4196 | The minimal command and arguments used to run the linker. |
3770 | 4197 | ||
3771 | LDFLAGS | 4198 | LDFLAGS |
3772 | Specifies the flags to pass to the linker. This variable is exported | 4199 | Specifies the flags to pass to the linker. This variable is exported |
3773 | to an environment variable and thus made visible to the software | 4200 | to an environment variable and thus made visible to the software |
3774 | being built during the compilation step. | 4201 | being built during the compilation step. |
3775 | 4202 | ||
3776 | Default initialization for ``LDFLAGS`` varies depending on what is | 4203 | Default initialization for ``LDFLAGS`` varies depending on what is |
3777 | being built: | 4204 | being built: |
3778 | 4205 | ||
3779 | - :term:`TARGET_LDFLAGS` when building for the | 4206 | - :term:`TARGET_LDFLAGS` when building for the |
3780 | target | 4207 | target |
3781 | 4208 | ||
3782 | - :term:`BUILD_LDFLAGS` when building for the | 4209 | - :term:`BUILD_LDFLAGS` when building for the |
3783 | build host (i.e. ``-native``) | 4210 | build host (i.e. ``-native``) |
3784 | 4211 | ||
3785 | - :term:`BUILDSDK_LDFLAGS` when building for | 4212 | - :term:`BUILDSDK_LDFLAGS` when building for |
3786 | an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``) | 4213 | an SDK (i.e. ``nativesdk-``) |
3787 | 4214 | ||
3788 | LEAD_SONAME | 4215 | LEAD_SONAME |
3789 | Specifies the lead (or primary) compiled library file (i.e. ``.so``) | 4216 | Specifies the lead (or primary) compiled library file (i.e. ``.so``) |
3790 | that the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class applies its | 4217 | that the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class applies its |
3791 | naming policy to given a recipe that packages multiple libraries. | 4218 | naming policy to given a recipe that packages multiple libraries. |
3792 | 4219 | ||
3793 | This variable works in conjunction with the ``debian`` class. | 4220 | This variable works in conjunction with the ``debian`` class. |
3794 | 4221 | ||
3795 | LIC_FILES_CHKSUM | 4222 | LIC_FILES_CHKSUM |
3796 | Checksums of the license text in the recipe source code. | 4223 | Checksums of the license text in the recipe source code. |
3797 | 4224 | ||
3798 | This variable tracks changes in license text of the source code | 4225 | This variable tracks changes in license text of the source code |
3799 | files. If the license text is changed, it will trigger a build | 4226 | files. If the license text is changed, it will trigger a build |
3800 | failure, which gives the developer an opportunity to review any | 4227 | failure, which gives the developer an opportunity to review any |
3801 | license change. | 4228 | license change. |
3802 | 4229 | ||
3803 | This variable must be defined for all recipes (unless | 4230 | This variable must be defined for all recipes (unless |
3804 | :term:`LICENSE` is set to "CLOSED"). | 4231 | :term:`LICENSE` is set to "CLOSED"). |
3805 | 4232 | ||
3806 | For more information, see the "`Tracking License | 4233 | For more information, see the ":ref:`usingpoky-configuring-lic_files_chksum`" |
3807 | Changes <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#usingpoky-configuring-LIC_FILES_CHKSUM>`__" | ||
3808 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 4234 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
3809 | 4235 | ||
3810 | LICENSE | 4236 | LICENSE |
3811 | The list of source licenses for the recipe. Follow these rules: | 4237 | The list of source licenses for the recipe. Follow these rules: |
3812 | 4238 | ||
3813 | - Do not use spaces within individual license names. | 4239 | - Do not use spaces within individual license names. |
3814 | 4240 | ||
3815 | - Separate license names using \| (pipe) when there is a choice | 4241 | - Separate license names using \| (pipe) when there is a choice |
3816 | between licenses. | 4242 | between licenses. |
3817 | 4243 | ||
3818 | - Separate license names using & (ampersand) when multiple licenses | 4244 | - Separate license names using & (ampersand) when multiple licenses |
3819 | exist that cover different parts of the source. | 4245 | exist that cover different parts of the source. |
3820 | 4246 | ||
3821 | - You can use spaces between license names. | 4247 | - You can use spaces between license names. |
3822 | 4248 | ||
3823 | - For standard licenses, use the names of the files in | 4249 | - For standard licenses, use the names of the files in |
3824 | ``meta/files/common-licenses/`` or the | 4250 | ``meta/files/common-licenses/`` or the |
3825 | :term:`SPDXLICENSEMAP` flag names defined in | 4251 | :term:`SPDXLICENSEMAP` flag names defined in |
3826 | ``meta/conf/licenses.conf``. | 4252 | ``meta/conf/licenses.conf``. |
3827 | 4253 | ||
3828 | Here are some examples: LICENSE = "LGPLv2.1 \| GPLv3" LICENSE = | 4254 | Here are some examples: |
3829 | "MPL-1 & LGPLv2.1" LICENSE = "GPLv2+" The first example is from the | 4255 | :: |
4256 | |||
4257 | LICENSE = "LGPLv2.1 | GPLv3" | ||
4258 | LICENSE = "MPL-1 & LGPLv2.1" | ||
4259 | LICENSE = "GPLv2+" | ||
4260 | |||
4261 | The first example is from the | ||
3830 | recipes for Qt, which the user may choose to distribute under either | 4262 | recipes for Qt, which the user may choose to distribute under either |
3831 | the LGPL version 2.1 or GPL version 3. The second example is from | 4263 | the LGPL version 2.1 or GPL version 3. The second example is from |
3832 | Cairo where two licenses cover different parts of the source code. | 4264 | Cairo where two licenses cover different parts of the source code. |
3833 | The final example is from ``sysstat``, which presents a single | 4265 | The final example is from ``sysstat``, which presents a single |
3834 | license. | 4266 | license. |
3835 | 4267 | ||
3836 | You can also specify licenses on a per-package basis to handle | 4268 | You can also specify licenses on a per-package basis to handle |
3837 | situations where components of the output have different licenses. | 4269 | situations where components of the output have different licenses. |
3838 | For example, a piece of software whose code is licensed under GPLv2 | 4270 | For example, a piece of software whose code is licensed under GPLv2 |
3839 | but has accompanying documentation licensed under the GNU Free | 4271 | but has accompanying documentation licensed under the GNU Free |
3840 | Documentation License 1.2 could be specified as follows: LICENSE = | 4272 | Documentation License 1.2 could be specified as follows: |
3841 | "GFDL-1.2 & GPLv2" LICENSE_${PN} = "GPLv2" LICENSE_${PN}-doc = | 4273 | :: |
3842 | "GFDL-1.2" | 4274 | |
3843 | 4275 | LICENSE = "GFDL-1.2 & GPLv2" | |
4276 | LICENSE_${PN} = "GPLv2" | ||
4277 | LICENSE_${PN}-doc = "GFDL-1.2" | ||
4278 | |||
3844 | LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE | 4279 | LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE |
3845 | Setting ``LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE`` to "1" causes the OpenEmbedded | 4280 | Setting ``LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE`` to "1" causes the OpenEmbedded |
3846 | build system to create an extra package (i.e. | 4281 | build system to create an extra package (i.e. |
3847 | ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}-lic``) for each recipe and to add | 4282 | ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}-lic``) for each recipe and to add |
3848 | those packages to the | 4283 | those packages to the |
3849 | :term:`RRECOMMENDS`\ ``_${PN}``. | 4284 | :term:`RRECOMMENDS`\ ``_${PN}``. |
3850 | 4285 | ||
3851 | The ``${PN}-lic`` package installs a directory in | 4286 | The ``${PN}-lic`` package installs a directory in |
3852 | ``/usr/share/licenses`` named ``${PN}``, which is the recipe's base | 4287 | ``/usr/share/licenses`` named ``${PN}``, which is the recipe's base |
3853 | name, and installs files in that directory that contain license and | 4288 | name, and installs files in that directory that contain license and |
@@ -3857,124 +4292,149 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3857 | and copies of files marked in | 4292 | and copies of files marked in |
3858 | :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` as containing | 4293 | :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` as containing |
3859 | license text). | 4294 | license text). |
3860 | 4295 | ||
3861 | For related information on providing license text, see the | 4296 | For related information on providing license text, see the |
3862 | :term:`COPY_LIC_DIRS` variable, the | 4297 | :term:`COPY_LIC_DIRS` variable, the |
3863 | :term:`COPY_LIC_MANIFEST` variable, and the | 4298 | :term:`COPY_LIC_MANIFEST` variable, and the |
3864 | "`Providing License | 4299 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:providing license text`" |
3865 | Text <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#providing-license-text>`__" section in the | 4300 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
3866 | Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 4301 | |
3867 | |||
3868 | LICENSE_FLAGS | 4302 | LICENSE_FLAGS |
3869 | Specifies additional flags for a recipe you must whitelist through | 4303 | Specifies additional flags for a recipe you must whitelist through |
3870 | :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST` in | 4304 | :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST` in |
3871 | order to allow the recipe to be built. When providing multiple flags, | 4305 | order to allow the recipe to be built. When providing multiple flags, |
3872 | separate them with spaces. | 4306 | separate them with spaces. |
3873 | 4307 | ||
3874 | This value is independent of :term:`LICENSE` and is | 4308 | This value is independent of :term:`LICENSE` and is |
3875 | typically used to mark recipes that might require additional licenses | 4309 | typically used to mark recipes that might require additional licenses |
3876 | in order to be used in a commercial product. For more information, | 4310 | in order to be used in a commercial product. For more information, |
3877 | see the "`Enabling Commercially Licensed | 4311 | see the |
3878 | Recipes <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#enabling-commercially-licensed-recipes>`__" | 4312 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:enabling commercially licensed recipes`" |
3879 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 4313 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
3880 | 4314 | ||
3881 | LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST | 4315 | LICENSE_FLAGS_WHITELIST |
3882 | Lists license flags that when specified in | 4316 | Lists license flags that when specified in |
3883 | :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` within a recipe should not | 4317 | :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` within a recipe should not |
3884 | prevent that recipe from being built. This practice is otherwise | 4318 | prevent that recipe from being built. This practice is otherwise |
3885 | known as "whitelisting" license flags. For more information, see the | 4319 | known as "whitelisting" license flags. For more information, see the |
3886 | "`Enabling Commercially Licensed | 4320 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:enabling commercially licensed recipes`" |
3887 | Recipes <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#enabling-commercially-licensed-recipes>`__" | ||
3888 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 4321 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
3889 | 4322 | ||
3890 | LICENSE_PATH | 4323 | LICENSE_PATH |
3891 | Path to additional licenses used during the build. By default, the | 4324 | Path to additional licenses used during the build. By default, the |
3892 | OpenEmbedded build system uses ``COMMON_LICENSE_DIR`` to define the | 4325 | OpenEmbedded build system uses ``COMMON_LICENSE_DIR`` to define the |
3893 | directory that holds common license text used during the build. The | 4326 | directory that holds common license text used during the build. The |
3894 | ``LICENSE_PATH`` variable allows you to extend that location to other | 4327 | ``LICENSE_PATH`` variable allows you to extend that location to other |
3895 | areas that have additional licenses: LICENSE_PATH += | 4328 | areas that have additional licenses: |
3896 | "path-to-additional-common-licenses" | 4329 | :: |
3897 | 4330 | ||
4331 | LICENSE_PATH += "path-to-additional-common-licenses" | ||
4332 | |||
3898 | LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE | 4333 | LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE |
3899 | Defines the kernel type to be used in assembling the configuration. | 4334 | Defines the kernel type to be used in assembling the configuration. |
3900 | The linux-yocto recipes define "standard", "tiny", and "preempt-rt" | 4335 | The linux-yocto recipes define "standard", "tiny", and "preempt-rt" |
3901 | kernel types. See the "`Kernel | 4336 | kernel types. See the ":ref:`kernel-dev/kernel-dev-advanced:kernel types`" |
3902 | Types <&YOCTO_DOCS_KERNEL_DEV_URL;#kernel-types>`__" section in the | 4337 | section in the |
3903 | Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual for more information on | 4338 | Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual for more information on |
3904 | kernel types. | 4339 | kernel types. |
3905 | 4340 | ||
3906 | If you do not specify a ``LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE``, it defaults to | 4341 | If you do not specify a ``LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE``, it defaults to |
3907 | "standard". Together with :term:`KMACHINE`, the | 4342 | "standard". Together with :term:`KMACHINE`, the |
3908 | ``LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE`` variable defines the search arguments used by | 4343 | ``LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE`` variable defines the search arguments used by |
3909 | the kernel tools to find the appropriate description within the | 4344 | the kernel tools to find the appropriate description within the |
3910 | kernel :term:`Metadata` with which to build out the sources | 4345 | kernel :term:`Metadata` with which to build out the sources |
3911 | and configuration. | 4346 | and configuration. |
3912 | 4347 | ||
3913 | LINUX_VERSION | 4348 | LINUX_VERSION |
3914 | The Linux version from ``kernel.org`` on which the Linux kernel image | 4349 | The Linux version from ``kernel.org`` on which the Linux kernel image |
3915 | being built using the OpenEmbedded build system is based. You define | 4350 | being built using the OpenEmbedded build system is based. You define |
3916 | this variable in the kernel recipe. For example, the | 4351 | this variable in the kernel recipe. For example, the |
3917 | ``linux-yocto-3.4.bb`` kernel recipe found in | 4352 | ``linux-yocto-3.4.bb`` kernel recipe found in |
3918 | ``meta/recipes-kernel/linux`` defines the variables as follows: | 4353 | ``meta/recipes-kernel/linux`` defines the variables as follows: |
3919 | LINUX_VERSION ?= "3.4.24" | 4354 | :: |
3920 | 4355 | ||
4356 | LINUX_VERSION ?= "3.4.24" | ||
4357 | |||
3921 | The ``LINUX_VERSION`` variable is used to define :term:`PV` | 4358 | The ``LINUX_VERSION`` variable is used to define :term:`PV` |
3922 | for the recipe: PV = "${LINUX_VERSION}+git${SRCPV}" | 4359 | for the recipe: |
3923 | 4360 | :: | |
4361 | |||
4362 | PV = "${LINUX_VERSION}+git${SRCPV}" | ||
4363 | |||
3924 | LINUX_VERSION_EXTENSION | 4364 | LINUX_VERSION_EXTENSION |
3925 | A string extension compiled into the version string of the Linux | 4365 | A string extension compiled into the version string of the Linux |
3926 | kernel built with the OpenEmbedded build system. You define this | 4366 | kernel built with the OpenEmbedded build system. You define this |
3927 | variable in the kernel recipe. For example, the linux-yocto kernel | 4367 | variable in the kernel recipe. For example, the linux-yocto kernel |
3928 | recipes all define the variable as follows: LINUX_VERSION_EXTENSION | 4368 | recipes all define the variable as follows: |
3929 | ?= "-yocto-${:term:`LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE`}" | 4369 | :: |
3930 | 4370 | ||
4371 | LINUX_VERSION_EXTENSION ?= "-yocto-${LINUX_KERNEL_TYPE}" | ||
4372 | |||
3931 | Defining this variable essentially sets the Linux kernel | 4373 | Defining this variable essentially sets the Linux kernel |
3932 | configuration item ``CONFIG_LOCALVERSION``, which is visible through | 4374 | configuration item ``CONFIG_LOCALVERSION``, which is visible through |
3933 | the ``uname`` command. Here is an example that shows the extension | 4375 | the ``uname`` command. Here is an example that shows the extension |
3934 | assuming it was set as previously shown: $ uname -r 3.7.0-rc8-custom | 4376 | assuming it was set as previously shown: |
3935 | 4377 | :: | |
4378 | |||
4379 | $ uname -r | ||
4380 | 3.7.0-rc8-custom | ||
4381 | |||
3936 | LOG_DIR | 4382 | LOG_DIR |
3937 | Specifies the directory to which the OpenEmbedded build system writes | 4383 | Specifies the directory to which the OpenEmbedded build system writes |
3938 | overall log files. The default directory is ``${TMPDIR}/log``. | 4384 | overall log files. The default directory is ``${TMPDIR}/log``. |
3939 | 4385 | ||
3940 | For the directory containing logs specific to each task, see the | 4386 | For the directory containing logs specific to each task, see the |
3941 | :term:`T` variable. | 4387 | :term:`T` variable. |
3942 | 4388 | ||
3943 | MACHINE | 4389 | MACHINE |
3944 | Specifies the target device for which the image is built. You define | 4390 | Specifies the target device for which the image is built. You define |
3945 | ``MACHINE`` in the ``local.conf`` file found in the | 4391 | ``MACHINE`` in the ``local.conf`` file found in the |
3946 | :term:`Build Directory`. By default, ``MACHINE`` is set to | 4392 | :term:`Build Directory`. By default, ``MACHINE`` is set to |
3947 | "qemux86", which is an x86-based architecture machine to be emulated | 4393 | "qemux86", which is an x86-based architecture machine to be emulated |
3948 | using QEMU: MACHINE ?= "qemux86" | 4394 | using QEMU: |
3949 | 4395 | :: | |
4396 | |||
4397 | MACHINE ?= "qemux86" | ||
4398 | |||
3950 | The variable corresponds to a machine configuration file of the same | 4399 | The variable corresponds to a machine configuration file of the same |
3951 | name, through which machine-specific configurations are set. Thus, | 4400 | name, through which machine-specific configurations are set. Thus, |
3952 | when ``MACHINE`` is set to "qemux86" there exists the corresponding | 4401 | when ``MACHINE`` is set to "qemux86" there exists the corresponding |
3953 | ``qemux86.conf`` machine configuration file, which can be found in | 4402 | ``qemux86.conf`` machine configuration file, which can be found in |
3954 | the :term:`Source Directory` in | 4403 | the :term:`Source Directory` in |
3955 | ``meta/conf/machine``. | 4404 | ``meta/conf/machine``. |
3956 | 4405 | ||
3957 | The list of machines supported by the Yocto Project as shipped | 4406 | The list of machines supported by the Yocto Project as shipped |
3958 | include the following: MACHINE ?= "qemuarm" MACHINE ?= "qemuarm64" | 4407 | include the following: |
3959 | MACHINE ?= "qemumips" MACHINE ?= "qemumips64" MACHINE ?= "qemuppc" | 4408 | :: |
3960 | MACHINE ?= "qemux86" MACHINE ?= "qemux86-64" MACHINE ?= "genericx86" | 4409 | |
3961 | MACHINE ?= "genericx86-64" MACHINE ?= "beaglebone" MACHINE ?= | 4410 | MACHINE ?= "qemuarm" |
3962 | "edgerouter" The last five are Yocto Project reference hardware | 4411 | MACHINE ?= "qemuarm64" |
4412 | MACHINE ?= "qemumips" | ||
4413 | MACHINE ?= "qemumips64" | ||
4414 | MACHINE ?= "qemuppc" | ||
4415 | MACHINE ?= "qemux86" | ||
4416 | MACHINE ?= "qemux86-64" | ||
4417 | MACHINE ?= "genericx86" | ||
4418 | MACHINE ?= "genericx86-64" | ||
4419 | MACHINE ?= "beaglebone" | ||
4420 | MACHINE ?= "edgerouter" | ||
4421 | |||
4422 | The last five are Yocto Project reference hardware | ||
3963 | boards, which are provided in the ``meta-yocto-bsp`` layer. | 4423 | boards, which are provided in the ``meta-yocto-bsp`` layer. |
3964 | 4424 | ||
3965 | .. note:: | 4425 | .. note:: |
3966 | 4426 | ||
3967 | Adding additional Board Support Package (BSP) layers to your | 4427 | Adding additional Board Support Package (BSP) layers to your |
3968 | configuration adds new possible settings for | 4428 | configuration adds new possible settings for |
3969 | MACHINE | 4429 | MACHINE |
3970 | . | 4430 | . |
3971 | 4431 | ||
3972 | MACHINE_ARCH | 4432 | MACHINE_ARCH |
3973 | Specifies the name of the machine-specific architecture. This | 4433 | Specifies the name of the machine-specific architecture. This |
3974 | variable is set automatically from :term:`MACHINE` or | 4434 | variable is set automatically from :term:`MACHINE` or |
3975 | :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH`. You should not hand-edit | 4435 | :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH`. You should not hand-edit |
3976 | the ``MACHINE_ARCH`` variable. | 4436 | the ``MACHINE_ARCH`` variable. |
3977 | 4437 | ||
3978 | MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RDEPENDS | 4438 | MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RDEPENDS |
3979 | A list of required machine-specific packages to install as part of | 4439 | A list of required machine-specific packages to install as part of |
3980 | the image being built. The build process depends on these packages | 4440 | the image being built. The build process depends on these packages |
@@ -3983,19 +4443,21 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
3983 | The impact of this variable affects images based on | 4443 | The impact of this variable affects images based on |
3984 | ``packagegroup-core-boot``, including the ``core-image-minimal`` | 4444 | ``packagegroup-core-boot``, including the ``core-image-minimal`` |
3985 | image. | 4445 | image. |
3986 | 4446 | ||
3987 | This variable is similar to the | 4447 | This variable is similar to the |
3988 | ``MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS`` variable with the exception | 4448 | ``MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS`` variable with the exception |
3989 | that the image being built has a build dependency on the variable's | 4449 | that the image being built has a build dependency on the variable's |
3990 | list of packages. In other words, the image will not build if a file | 4450 | list of packages. In other words, the image will not build if a file |
3991 | in this list is not found. | 4451 | in this list is not found. |
3992 | 4452 | ||
3993 | As an example, suppose the machine for which you are building | 4453 | As an example, suppose the machine for which you are building |
3994 | requires ``example-init`` to be run during boot to initialize the | 4454 | requires ``example-init`` to be run during boot to initialize the |
3995 | hardware. In this case, you would use the following in the machine's | 4455 | hardware. In this case, you would use the following in the machine's |
3996 | ``.conf`` configuration file: MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RDEPENDS += | 4456 | ``.conf`` configuration file: |
3997 | "example-init" | 4457 | :: |
3998 | 4458 | ||
4459 | MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RDEPENDS += "example-init" | ||
4460 | |||
3999 | MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS | 4461 | MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS |
4000 | A list of recommended machine-specific packages to install as part of | 4462 | A list of recommended machine-specific packages to install as part of |
4001 | the image being built. The build process does not depend on these | 4463 | the image being built. The build process does not depend on these |
@@ -4004,7 +4466,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4004 | the machine to boot. The impact of this variable affects images based | 4466 | the machine to boot. The impact of this variable affects images based |
4005 | on ``packagegroup-core-boot``, including the ``core-image-minimal`` | 4467 | on ``packagegroup-core-boot``, including the ``core-image-minimal`` |
4006 | image. | 4468 | image. |
4007 | 4469 | ||
4008 | This variable is similar to the ``MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RDEPENDS`` | 4470 | This variable is similar to the ``MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RDEPENDS`` |
4009 | variable with the exception that the image being built does not have | 4471 | variable with the exception that the image being built does not have |
4010 | a build dependency on the variable's list of packages. In other | 4472 | a build dependency on the variable's list of packages. In other |
@@ -4013,7 +4475,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4013 | modules, whose functionality may be selected to be built into the | 4475 | modules, whose functionality may be selected to be built into the |
4014 | kernel rather than as a module, in which case a package will not be | 4476 | kernel rather than as a module, in which case a package will not be |
4015 | produced. | 4477 | produced. |
4016 | 4478 | ||
4017 | Consider an example where you have a custom kernel where a specific | 4479 | Consider an example where you have a custom kernel where a specific |
4018 | touchscreen driver is required for the machine to be usable. However, | 4480 | touchscreen driver is required for the machine to be usable. However, |
4019 | the driver can be built as a module or into the kernel depending on | 4481 | the driver can be built as a module or into the kernel depending on |
@@ -4024,10 +4486,12 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4024 | not fail due to the missing package. To accomplish this, assuming the | 4486 | not fail due to the missing package. To accomplish this, assuming the |
4025 | package for the module was called ``kernel-module-ab123``, you would | 4487 | package for the module was called ``kernel-module-ab123``, you would |
4026 | use the following in the machine's ``.conf`` configuration file: | 4488 | use the following in the machine's ``.conf`` configuration file: |
4027 | MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS += "kernel-module-ab123" | 4489 | :: |
4028 | 4490 | ||
4491 | MACHINE_ESSENTIAL_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS += "kernel-module-ab123" | ||
4492 | |||
4029 | .. note:: | 4493 | .. note:: |
4030 | 4494 | ||
4031 | In this example, the | 4495 | In this example, the |
4032 | kernel-module-ab123 | 4496 | kernel-module-ab123 |
4033 | recipe needs to explicitly set its | 4497 | recipe needs to explicitly set its |
@@ -4035,25 +4499,25 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4035 | variable to ensure that BitBake does not use the kernel recipe's | 4499 | variable to ensure that BitBake does not use the kernel recipe's |
4036 | PACKAGES_DYNAMIC | 4500 | PACKAGES_DYNAMIC |
4037 | variable to satisfy the dependency. | 4501 | variable to satisfy the dependency. |
4038 | 4502 | ||
4039 | Some examples of these machine essentials are flash, screen, | 4503 | Some examples of these machine essentials are flash, screen, |
4040 | keyboard, mouse, or touchscreen drivers (depending on the machine). | 4504 | keyboard, mouse, or touchscreen drivers (depending on the machine). |
4041 | 4505 | ||
4042 | MACHINE_EXTRA_RDEPENDS | 4506 | MACHINE_EXTRA_RDEPENDS |
4043 | A list of machine-specific packages to install as part of the image | 4507 | A list of machine-specific packages to install as part of the image |
4044 | being built that are not essential for the machine to boot. However, | 4508 | being built that are not essential for the machine to boot. However, |
4045 | the build process for more fully-featured images depends on the | 4509 | the build process for more fully-featured images depends on the |
4046 | packages being present. | 4510 | packages being present. |
4047 | 4511 | ||
4048 | This variable affects all images based on ``packagegroup-base``, | 4512 | This variable affects all images based on ``packagegroup-base``, |
4049 | which does not include the ``core-image-minimal`` or | 4513 | which does not include the ``core-image-minimal`` or |
4050 | ``core-image-full-cmdline`` images. | 4514 | ``core-image-full-cmdline`` images. |
4051 | 4515 | ||
4052 | The variable is similar to the ``MACHINE_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS`` variable | 4516 | The variable is similar to the ``MACHINE_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS`` variable |
4053 | with the exception that the image being built has a build dependency | 4517 | with the exception that the image being built has a build dependency |
4054 | on the variable's list of packages. In other words, the image will | 4518 | on the variable's list of packages. In other words, the image will |
4055 | not build if a file in this list is not found. | 4519 | not build if a file in this list is not found. |
4056 | 4520 | ||
4057 | An example is a machine that has WiFi capability but is not essential | 4521 | An example is a machine that has WiFi capability but is not essential |
4058 | for the machine to boot the image. However, if you are building a | 4522 | for the machine to boot the image. However, if you are building a |
4059 | more fully-featured image, you want to enable the WiFi. The package | 4523 | more fully-featured image, you want to enable the WiFi. The package |
@@ -4062,22 +4526,24 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4062 | finding the package. In this case, assuming the package for the | 4526 | finding the package. In this case, assuming the package for the |
4063 | firmware was called ``wifidriver-firmware``, you would use the | 4527 | firmware was called ``wifidriver-firmware``, you would use the |
4064 | following in the ``.conf`` file for the machine: | 4528 | following in the ``.conf`` file for the machine: |
4065 | MACHINE_EXTRA_RDEPENDS += "wifidriver-firmware" | 4529 | :: |
4066 | 4530 | ||
4531 | MACHINE_EXTRA_RDEPENDS += "wifidriver-firmware" | ||
4532 | |||
4067 | MACHINE_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS | 4533 | MACHINE_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS |
4068 | A list of machine-specific packages to install as part of the image | 4534 | A list of machine-specific packages to install as part of the image |
4069 | being built that are not essential for booting the machine. The image | 4535 | being built that are not essential for booting the machine. The image |
4070 | being built has no build dependency on this list of packages. | 4536 | being built has no build dependency on this list of packages. |
4071 | 4537 | ||
4072 | This variable affects only images based on ``packagegroup-base``, | 4538 | This variable affects only images based on ``packagegroup-base``, |
4073 | which does not include the ``core-image-minimal`` or | 4539 | which does not include the ``core-image-minimal`` or |
4074 | ``core-image-full-cmdline`` images. | 4540 | ``core-image-full-cmdline`` images. |
4075 | 4541 | ||
4076 | This variable is similar to the ``MACHINE_EXTRA_RDEPENDS`` variable | 4542 | This variable is similar to the ``MACHINE_EXTRA_RDEPENDS`` variable |
4077 | with the exception that the image being built does not have a build | 4543 | with the exception that the image being built does not have a build |
4078 | dependency on the variable's list of packages. In other words, the | 4544 | dependency on the variable's list of packages. In other words, the |
4079 | image will build if a file in this list is not found. | 4545 | image will build if a file in this list is not found. |
4080 | 4546 | ||
4081 | An example is a machine that has WiFi capability but is not essential | 4547 | An example is a machine that has WiFi capability but is not essential |
4082 | For the machine to boot the image. However, if you are building a | 4548 | For the machine to boot the image. However, if you are building a |
4083 | more fully-featured image, you want to enable WiFi. In this case, the | 4549 | more fully-featured image, you want to enable WiFi. In this case, the |
@@ -4087,8 +4553,10 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4087 | not being found. To accomplish this, assuming the package for the | 4553 | not being found. To accomplish this, assuming the package for the |
4088 | module was called ``kernel-module-examplewifi``, you would use the | 4554 | module was called ``kernel-module-examplewifi``, you would use the |
4089 | following in the ``.conf`` file for the machine: | 4555 | following in the ``.conf`` file for the machine: |
4090 | MACHINE_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS += "kernel-module-examplewifi" | 4556 | :: |
4091 | 4557 | ||
4558 | MACHINE_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS += "kernel-module-examplewifi" | ||
4559 | |||
4092 | MACHINE_FEATURES | 4560 | MACHINE_FEATURES |
4093 | Specifies the list of hardware features the | 4561 | Specifies the list of hardware features the |
4094 | :term:`MACHINE` is capable of supporting. For related | 4562 | :term:`MACHINE` is capable of supporting. For related |
@@ -4096,48 +4564,59 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4096 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`, | 4564 | :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`, |
4097 | :term:`COMBINED_FEATURES`, and | 4565 | :term:`COMBINED_FEATURES`, and |
4098 | :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` variables. | 4566 | :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` variables. |
4099 | 4567 | ||
4100 | For a list of hardware features supported by the Yocto Project as | 4568 | For a list of hardware features supported by the Yocto Project as |
4101 | shipped, see the "`Machine Features <#ref-features-machine>`__" | 4569 | shipped, see the "`Machine Features <#ref-features-machine>`__" |
4102 | section. | 4570 | section. |
4103 | 4571 | ||
4104 | MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL | 4572 | MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL |
4105 | Features to be added to ``MACHINE_FEATURES`` if not also present in | 4573 | Features to be added to ``MACHINE_FEATURES`` if not also present in |
4106 | ``MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED``. | 4574 | ``MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED``. |
4107 | 4575 | ||
4108 | This variable is set in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file. It is | 4576 | This variable is set in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` file. It is |
4109 | not intended to be user-configurable. It is best to just reference | 4577 | not intended to be user-configurable. It is best to just reference |
4110 | the variable to see which machine features are being backfilled for | 4578 | the variable to see which machine features are being backfilled for |
4111 | all machine configurations. See the "`Feature | 4579 | all machine configurations. See the "`Feature |
4112 | Backfilling <#ref-features-backfill>`__" section for more | 4580 | Backfilling <#ref-features-backfill>`__" section for more |
4113 | information. | 4581 | information. |
4114 | 4582 | ||
4115 | MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED | 4583 | MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED |
4116 | Features from ``MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL`` that should not be | 4584 | Features from ``MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL`` that should not be |
4117 | backfilled (i.e. added to ``MACHINE_FEATURES``) during the build. See | 4585 | backfilled (i.e. added to ``MACHINE_FEATURES``) during the build. See |
4118 | the "`Feature Backfilling <#ref-features-backfill>`__" section for | 4586 | the "`Feature Backfilling <#ref-features-backfill>`__" section for |
4119 | more information. | 4587 | more information. |
4120 | 4588 | ||
4121 | MACHINEOVERRIDES | 4589 | MACHINEOVERRIDES |
4122 | A colon-separated list of overrides that apply to the current | 4590 | A colon-separated list of overrides that apply to the current |
4123 | machine. By default, this list includes the value of | 4591 | machine. By default, this list includes the value of |
4124 | :term:`MACHINE`. | 4592 | :term:`MACHINE`. |
4125 | 4593 | ||
4126 | You can extend ``MACHINEOVERRIDES`` to add extra overrides that | 4594 | You can extend ``MACHINEOVERRIDES`` to add extra overrides that |
4127 | should apply to a machine. For example, all machines emulated in QEMU | 4595 | should apply to a machine. For example, all machines emulated in QEMU |
4128 | (e.g. ``qemuarm``, ``qemux86``, and so forth) include a file named | 4596 | (e.g. ``qemuarm``, ``qemux86``, and so forth) include a file named |
4129 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/qemu.inc`` that prepends the following | 4597 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/qemu.inc`` that prepends the following |
4130 | override to ``MACHINEOVERRIDES``: MACHINEOVERRIDES =. "qemuall:" This | 4598 | override to ``MACHINEOVERRIDES``: |
4599 | :: | ||
4600 | |||
4601 | MACHINEOVERRIDES =. "qemuall:" | ||
4602 | |||
4603 | This | ||
4131 | override allows variables to be overriden for all machines emulated | 4604 | override allows variables to be overriden for all machines emulated |
4132 | in QEMU, like in the following example from the ``connman-conf`` | 4605 | in QEMU, like in the following example from the ``connman-conf`` |
4133 | recipe: SRC_URI_append_qemuall = "file://wired.config \\ | 4606 | recipe: |
4134 | file://wired-setup \\ " The underlying mechanism behind | 4607 | :: |
4608 | |||
4609 | SRC_URI_append_qemuall = "file://wired.config \ | ||
4610 | file://wired-setup \ | ||
4611 | " | ||
4612 | |||
4613 | The underlying mechanism behind | ||
4135 | ``MACHINEOVERRIDES`` is simply that it is included in the default | 4614 | ``MACHINEOVERRIDES`` is simply that it is included in the default |
4136 | value of :term:`OVERRIDES`. | 4615 | value of :term:`OVERRIDES`. |
4137 | 4616 | ||
4138 | MAINTAINER | 4617 | MAINTAINER |
4139 | The email address of the distribution maintainer. | 4618 | The email address of the distribution maintainer. |
4140 | 4619 | ||
4141 | MIRRORS | 4620 | MIRRORS |
4142 | Specifies additional paths from which the OpenEmbedded build system | 4621 | Specifies additional paths from which the OpenEmbedded build system |
4143 | gets source code. When the build system searches for source code, it | 4622 | gets source code. When the build system searches for source code, it |
@@ -4145,20 +4624,20 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4145 | build system tries locations defined by | 4624 | build system tries locations defined by |
4146 | :term:`PREMIRRORS`, the upstream source, and then | 4625 | :term:`PREMIRRORS`, the upstream source, and then |
4147 | locations specified by ``MIRRORS`` in that order. | 4626 | locations specified by ``MIRRORS`` in that order. |
4148 | 4627 | ||
4149 | Assuming your distribution (:term:`DISTRO`) is "poky", | 4628 | Assuming your distribution (:term:`DISTRO`) is "poky", |
4150 | the default value for ``MIRRORS`` is defined in the | 4629 | the default value for ``MIRRORS`` is defined in the |
4151 | ``conf/distro/poky.conf`` file in the ``meta-poky`` Git repository. | 4630 | ``conf/distro/poky.conf`` file in the ``meta-poky`` Git repository. |
4152 | 4631 | ||
4153 | MLPREFIX | 4632 | MLPREFIX |
4154 | Specifies a prefix has been added to :term:`PN` to create a | 4633 | Specifies a prefix has been added to :term:`PN` to create a |
4155 | special version of a recipe or package (i.e. a Multilib version). The | 4634 | special version of a recipe or package (i.e. a Multilib version). The |
4156 | variable is used in places where the prefix needs to be added to or | 4635 | variable is used in places where the prefix needs to be added to or |
4157 | removed from a the name (e.g. the :term:`BPN` variable). | 4636 | removed from a the name (e.g. the :term:`BPN` variable). |
4158 | ``MLPREFIX`` gets set when a prefix has been added to ``PN``. | 4637 | ``MLPREFIX`` gets set when a prefix has been added to ``PN``. |
4159 | 4638 | ||
4160 | .. note:: | 4639 | .. note:: |
4161 | 4640 | ||
4162 | The "ML" in | 4641 | The "ML" in |
4163 | MLPREFIX | 4642 | MLPREFIX |
4164 | stands for "MultiLib". This representation is historical and comes | 4643 | stands for "MultiLib". This representation is historical and comes |
@@ -4169,7 +4648,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4169 | was turned into a prefix, it made sense to set | 4648 | was turned into a prefix, it made sense to set |
4170 | MLPREFIX | 4649 | MLPREFIX |
4171 | for it as well. | 4650 | for it as well. |
4172 | 4651 | ||
4173 | To help understand when ``MLPREFIX`` might be needed, consider when | 4652 | To help understand when ``MLPREFIX`` might be needed, consider when |
4174 | :term:`BBCLASSEXTEND` is used to provide a | 4653 | :term:`BBCLASSEXTEND` is used to provide a |
4175 | ``nativesdk`` version of a recipe in addition to the target version. | 4654 | ``nativesdk`` version of a recipe in addition to the target version. |
@@ -4177,25 +4656,37 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4177 | recipes by using :term:`DEPENDS`, then a dependency on | 4656 | recipes by using :term:`DEPENDS`, then a dependency on |
4178 | "foo" will automatically get rewritten to a dependency on | 4657 | "foo" will automatically get rewritten to a dependency on |
4179 | "nativesdk-foo". However, dependencies like the following will not | 4658 | "nativesdk-foo". However, dependencies like the following will not |
4180 | get rewritten automatically: do_foo[depends] += "recipe:do_foo" If | 4659 | get rewritten automatically: |
4181 | you want such a dependency to also get transformed, you can do the | 4660 | :: |
4182 | following: do_foo[depends] += "${MLPREFIX}recipe:do_foo" | 4661 | |
4183 | 4662 | do_foo[depends] += "recipe:do_foo" | |
4663 | |||
4664 | If you want such a dependency to also get transformed, you can do the | ||
4665 | following: | ||
4666 | :: | ||
4667 | |||
4668 | do_foo[depends] += "${MLPREFIX}recipe:do_foo" | ||
4669 | |||
4184 | module_autoload | 4670 | module_autoload |
4185 | This variable has been replaced by the ``KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD`` | 4671 | This variable has been replaced by the ``KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD`` |
4186 | variable. You should replace all occurrences of ``module_autoload`` | 4672 | variable. You should replace all occurrences of ``module_autoload`` |
4187 | with additions to ``KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD``, for example: | 4673 | with additions to ``KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD``, for example: |
4188 | module_autoload_rfcomm = "rfcomm" | 4674 | :: |
4189 | 4675 | ||
4190 | should now be replaced with: KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD += "rfcomm" See | 4676 | module_autoload_rfcomm = "rfcomm" |
4191 | the :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` | 4677 | |
4192 | variable for more information. | 4678 | should now be replaced with: |
4193 | 4679 | :: | |
4680 | |||
4681 | KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD += "rfcomm" | ||
4682 | |||
4683 | See the :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` variable for more information. | ||
4684 | |||
4194 | module_conf | 4685 | module_conf |
4195 | Specifies ```modprobe.d`http://linux.die.net/man/5/modprobe.d | 4686 | Specifies `modprobe.d <http://linux.die.net/man/5/modprobe.d>`_ |
4196 | syntax lines for inclusion in the ``/etc/modprobe.d/modname.conf`` | 4687 | syntax lines for inclusion in the ``/etc/modprobe.d/modname.conf`` |
4197 | file. | 4688 | file. |
4198 | 4689 | ||
4199 | You can use this variable anywhere that it can be recognized by the | 4690 | You can use this variable anywhere that it can be recognized by the |
4200 | kernel recipe or out-of-tree kernel module recipe (e.g. a machine | 4691 | kernel recipe or out-of-tree kernel module recipe (e.g. a machine |
4201 | configuration file, a distribution configuration file, an append file | 4692 | configuration file, a distribution configuration file, an append file |
@@ -4203,64 +4694,80 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4203 | must also be sure to list the module name in the | 4694 | must also be sure to list the module name in the |
4204 | :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` | 4695 | :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` |
4205 | variable. | 4696 | variable. |
4206 | 4697 | ||
4207 | Here is the general syntax: module_conf_module_name = | 4698 | Here is the general syntax: |
4208 | "modprobe.d-syntax" You must use the kernel module name override. | 4699 | :: |
4209 | 4700 | ||
4701 | module_conf_module_name = "modprobe.d-syntax" | ||
4702 | |||
4703 | You must use the kernel module name override. | ||
4704 | |||
4210 | Run ``man modprobe.d`` in the shell to find out more information on | 4705 | Run ``man modprobe.d`` in the shell to find out more information on |
4211 | the exact syntax you want to provide with ``module_conf``. | 4706 | the exact syntax you want to provide with ``module_conf``. |
4212 | 4707 | ||
4213 | Including ``module_conf`` causes the OpenEmbedded build system to | 4708 | Including ``module_conf`` causes the OpenEmbedded build system to |
4214 | populate the ``/etc/modprobe.d/modname.conf`` file with | 4709 | populate the ``/etc/modprobe.d/modname.conf`` file with |
4215 | ``modprobe.d`` syntax lines. Here is an example that adds the options | 4710 | ``modprobe.d`` syntax lines. Here is an example that adds the options |
4216 | ``arg1`` and ``arg2`` to a module named ``mymodule``: | 4711 | ``arg1`` and ``arg2`` to a module named ``mymodule``: |
4217 | module_conf_mymodule = "options mymodule arg1=val1 arg2=val2" | 4712 | :: |
4218 | 4713 | ||
4714 | module_conf_mymodule = "options mymodule arg1=val1 arg2=val2" | ||
4715 | |||
4219 | For information on how to specify kernel modules to auto-load on | 4716 | For information on how to specify kernel modules to auto-load on |
4220 | boot, see the | 4717 | boot, see the :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` variable. |
4221 | :term:`KERNEL_MODULE_AUTOLOAD` | 4718 | |
4222 | variable. | ||
4223 | |||
4224 | MODULE_TARBALL_DEPLOY | 4719 | MODULE_TARBALL_DEPLOY |
4225 | Controls creation of the ``modules-*.tgz`` file. Set this variable to | 4720 | Controls creation of the ``modules-*.tgz`` file. Set this variable to |
4226 | "0" to disable creation of this file, which contains all of the | 4721 | "0" to disable creation of this file, which contains all of the |
4227 | kernel modules resulting from a kernel build. | 4722 | kernel modules resulting from a kernel build. |
4228 | 4723 | ||
4229 | MODULE_TARBALL_LINK_NAME | 4724 | MODULE_TARBALL_LINK_NAME |
4230 | The link name of the kernel module tarball. This variable is set in | 4725 | The link name of the kernel module tarball. This variable is set in |
4231 | the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows: | 4726 | the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows: |
4232 | MODULE_TARBALL_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" The value | 4727 | :: |
4728 | |||
4729 | MODULE_TARBALL_LINK_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME}" | ||
4730 | |||
4731 | The value | ||
4233 | of the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the | 4732 | of the ``KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME`` variable, which is set in the |
4234 | same file, has the following value: KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= | 4733 | same file, has the following value: |
4235 | "${MACHINE}" | 4734 | :: |
4236 | 4735 | ||
4237 | See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional | 4736 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_LINK_NAME ?= "${MACHINE}" |
4238 | information. | 4737 | |
4239 | 4738 | See the :term:`MACHINE` variable for additional information. | |
4739 | |||
4240 | MODULE_TARBALL_NAME | 4740 | MODULE_TARBALL_NAME |
4241 | The base name of the kernel module tarball. This variable is set in | 4741 | The base name of the kernel module tarball. This variable is set in |
4242 | the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows: | 4742 | the ``meta/classes/kernel-artifact-names.bbclass`` file as follows: |
4243 | MODULE_TARBALL_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" The value of the | 4743 | :: |
4244 | :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` variable, | 4744 | |
4745 | MODULE_TARBALL_NAME ?= "${KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME}" | ||
4746 | |||
4747 | The value of the :term:`KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME` variable, | ||
4245 | which is set in the same file, has the following value: | 4748 | which is set in the same file, has the following value: |
4246 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= | 4749 | :: |
4247 | "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" | 4750 | |
4248 | 4751 | KERNEL_ARTIFACT_NAME ?= "${PKGE}-${PKGV}-${PKGR}-${MACHINE}${IMAGE_VERSION_SUFFIX}" | |
4752 | |||
4249 | MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS | 4753 | MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS |
4250 | Uniquely identifies the type of the target system for which packages | 4754 | Uniquely identifies the type of the target system for which packages |
4251 | are being built. This variable allows output for different types of | 4755 | are being built. This variable allows output for different types of |
4252 | target systems to be put into different subdirectories of the same | 4756 | target systems to be put into different subdirectories of the same |
4253 | output directory. | 4757 | output directory. |
4254 | 4758 | ||
4255 | The default value of this variable is: | 4759 | The default value of this variable is: |
4256 | ${PACKAGE_ARCH}${TARGET_VENDOR}-${TARGET_OS} Some classes (e.g. | 4760 | :: |
4761 | |||
4762 | ${PACKAGE_ARCH}${TARGET_VENDOR}-${TARGET_OS} | ||
4763 | |||
4764 | Some classes (e.g. | ||
4257 | :ref:`cross-canadian <ref-classes-cross-canadian>`) modify the | 4765 | :ref:`cross-canadian <ref-classes-cross-canadian>`) modify the |
4258 | ``MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS`` value. | 4766 | ``MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS`` value. |
4259 | 4767 | ||
4260 | See the :term:`STAMP` variable for an example. See the | 4768 | See the :term:`STAMP` variable for an example. See the |
4261 | :term:`STAGING_DIR_TARGET` variable for | 4769 | :term:`STAGING_DIR_TARGET` variable for more information. |
4262 | more information. | 4770 | |
4263 | |||
4264 | NATIVELSBSTRING | 4771 | NATIVELSBSTRING |
4265 | A string identifying the host distribution. Strings consist of the | 4772 | A string identifying the host distribution. Strings consist of the |
4266 | host distributor ID followed by the release, as reported by the | 4773 | host distributor ID followed by the release, as reported by the |
@@ -4268,17 +4775,17 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4268 | example, when running a build on Ubuntu 12.10, the value is | 4775 | example, when running a build on Ubuntu 12.10, the value is |
4269 | "Ubuntu-12.10". If this information is unable to be determined, the | 4776 | "Ubuntu-12.10". If this information is unable to be determined, the |
4270 | value resolves to "Unknown". | 4777 | value resolves to "Unknown". |
4271 | 4778 | ||
4272 | This variable is used by default to isolate native shared state | 4779 | This variable is used by default to isolate native shared state |
4273 | packages for different distributions (e.g. to avoid problems with | 4780 | packages for different distributions (e.g. to avoid problems with |
4274 | ``glibc`` version incompatibilities). Additionally, the variable is | 4781 | ``glibc`` version incompatibilities). Additionally, the variable is |
4275 | checked against | 4782 | checked against |
4276 | :term:`SANITY_TESTED_DISTROS` if that | 4783 | :term:`SANITY_TESTED_DISTROS` if that |
4277 | variable is set. | 4784 | variable is set. |
4278 | 4785 | ||
4279 | NM | 4786 | NM |
4280 | The minimal command and arguments to run ``nm``. | 4787 | The minimal command and arguments to run ``nm``. |
4281 | 4788 | ||
4282 | NO_GENERIC_LICENSE | 4789 | NO_GENERIC_LICENSE |
4283 | Avoids QA errors when you use a non-common, non-CLOSED license in a | 4790 | Avoids QA errors when you use a non-common, non-CLOSED license in a |
4284 | recipe. Packages exist, such as the linux-firmware package, with many | 4791 | recipe. Packages exist, such as the linux-firmware package, with many |
@@ -4287,60 +4794,71 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4287 | which are only applicable to a specific package. | 4794 | which are only applicable to a specific package. |
4288 | ``NO_GENERIC_LICENSE`` is used to allow copying a license that does | 4795 | ``NO_GENERIC_LICENSE`` is used to allow copying a license that does |
4289 | not exist in common licenses. | 4796 | not exist in common licenses. |
4290 | 4797 | ||
4291 | The following example shows how to add ``NO_GENERIC_LICENSE`` to a | 4798 | The following example shows how to add ``NO_GENERIC_LICENSE`` to a |
4292 | recipe: NO_GENERIC_LICENSE[license_name] = | 4799 | recipe: |
4293 | "license_file_in_fetched_source" The following is an example that | 4800 | :: |
4801 | |||
4802 | NO_GENERIC_LICENSE[license_name] = "license_file_in_fetched_source" | ||
4803 | |||
4804 | The following is an example that | ||
4294 | uses the ``LICENSE.Abilis.txt`` file as the license from the fetched | 4805 | uses the ``LICENSE.Abilis.txt`` file as the license from the fetched |
4295 | source: NO_GENERIC_LICENSE[Firmware-Abilis] = "LICENSE.Abilis.txt" | 4806 | source: |
4296 | 4807 | :: | |
4808 | |||
4809 | NO_GENERIC_LICENSE[Firmware-Abilis] = "LICENSE.Abilis.txt" | ||
4810 | |||
4297 | NO_RECOMMENDATIONS | 4811 | NO_RECOMMENDATIONS |
4298 | Prevents installation of all "recommended-only" packages. | 4812 | Prevents installation of all "recommended-only" packages. |
4299 | Recommended-only packages are packages installed only through the | 4813 | Recommended-only packages are packages installed only through the |
4300 | :term:`RRECOMMENDS` variable). Setting the | 4814 | :term:`RRECOMMENDS` variable). Setting the |
4301 | ``NO_RECOMMENDATIONS`` variable to "1" turns this feature on: | 4815 | ``NO_RECOMMENDATIONS`` variable to "1" turns this feature on: :: |
4302 | NO_RECOMMENDATIONS = "1" | 4816 | |
4303 | 4817 | NO_RECOMMENDATIONS = "1" | |
4818 | |||
4304 | You can set this variable globally in your ``local.conf`` file or you | 4819 | You can set this variable globally in your ``local.conf`` file or you |
4305 | can attach it to a specific image recipe by using the recipe name | 4820 | can attach it to a specific image recipe by using the recipe name |
4306 | override: NO_RECOMMENDATIONS_pn-target_image = "1" | 4821 | override: :: |
4307 | 4822 | ||
4823 | NO_RECOMMENDATIONS_pn-target_image = "1" | ||
4824 | |||
4308 | It is important to realize that if you choose to not install packages | 4825 | It is important to realize that if you choose to not install packages |
4309 | using this variable and some other packages are dependent on them | 4826 | using this variable and some other packages are dependent on them |
4310 | (i.e. listed in a recipe's :term:`RDEPENDS` | 4827 | (i.e. listed in a recipe's :term:`RDEPENDS` |
4311 | variable), the OpenEmbedded build system ignores your request and | 4828 | variable), the OpenEmbedded build system ignores your request and |
4312 | will install the packages to avoid dependency errors. | 4829 | will install the packages to avoid dependency errors. |
4313 | 4830 | ||
4314 | .. note:: | 4831 | .. note:: |
4315 | 4832 | ||
4316 | Some recommended packages might be required for certain system | 4833 | Some recommended packages might be required for certain system |
4317 | functionality, such as kernel modules. It is up to you to add | 4834 | functionality, such as kernel modules. It is up to you to add |
4318 | packages with the | 4835 | packages with the IMAGE_INSTALL variable. |
4319 | IMAGE_INSTALL | 4836 | |
4320 | variable. | ||
4321 | |||
4322 | Support for this variable exists only when using the IPK and RPM | 4837 | Support for this variable exists only when using the IPK and RPM |
4323 | packaging backend. Support does not exist for DEB. | 4838 | packaging backend. Support does not exist for DEB. |
4324 | 4839 | ||
4325 | See the :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS` and | 4840 | See the :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS` and |
4326 | the :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE` variables for | 4841 | the :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE` variables for |
4327 | related information. | 4842 | related information. |
4328 | 4843 | ||
4329 | NOAUTOPACKAGEDEBUG | 4844 | NOAUTOPACKAGEDEBUG |
4330 | Disables auto package from splitting ``.debug`` files. If a recipe | 4845 | Disables auto package from splitting ``.debug`` files. If a recipe |
4331 | requires ``FILES_${PN}-dbg`` to be set manually, the | 4846 | requires ``FILES_${PN}-dbg`` to be set manually, the |
4332 | ``NOAUTOPACKAGEDEBUG`` can be defined allowing you to define the | 4847 | ``NOAUTOPACKAGEDEBUG`` can be defined allowing you to define the |
4333 | content of the debug package. For example: NOAUTOPACKAGEDEBUG = "1" | 4848 | content of the debug package. For example: |
4334 | FILES_${PN}-dev = "${includedir}/${QT_DIR_NAME}/Qt/*" FILES_${PN}-dbg | 4849 | :: |
4335 | = "/usr/src/debug/" FILES_${QT_BASE_NAME}-demos-doc = | 4850 | |
4336 | "${docdir}/${QT_DIR_NAME}/qch/qt.qch" | 4851 | NOAUTOPACKAGEDEBUG = "1" |
4337 | 4852 | FILES_${PN}-dev = "${includedir}/${QT_DIR_NAME}/Qt/*" | |
4853 | FILES_${PN}-dbg = "/usr/src/debug/" | ||
4854 | FILES_${QT_BASE_NAME}-demos-doc = "${docdir}/${QT_DIR_NAME}/qch/qt.qch" | ||
4855 | |||
4338 | OBJCOPY | 4856 | OBJCOPY |
4339 | The minimal command and arguments to run ``objcopy``. | 4857 | The minimal command and arguments to run ``objcopy``. |
4340 | 4858 | ||
4341 | OBJDUMP | 4859 | OBJDUMP |
4342 | The minimal command and arguments to run ``objdump``. | 4860 | The minimal command and arguments to run ``objdump``. |
4343 | 4861 | ||
4344 | OE_BINCONFIG_EXTRA_MANGLE | 4862 | OE_BINCONFIG_EXTRA_MANGLE |
4345 | When inheriting the :ref:`binconfig <ref-classes-binconfig>` class, | 4863 | When inheriting the :ref:`binconfig <ref-classes-binconfig>` class, |
4346 | this variable specifies additional arguments passed to the "sed" | 4864 | this variable specifies additional arguments passed to the "sed" |
@@ -4349,60 +4867,66 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4349 | results in all paths in these scripts being changed to point into the | 4867 | results in all paths in these scripts being changed to point into the |
4350 | ``sysroots/`` directory so that all builds that use the script will | 4868 | ``sysroots/`` directory so that all builds that use the script will |
4351 | use the correct directories for the cross compiling layout. | 4869 | use the correct directories for the cross compiling layout. |
4352 | 4870 | ||
4353 | See the ``meta/classes/binconfig.bbclass`` in the | 4871 | See the ``meta/classes/binconfig.bbclass`` in the |
4354 | :term:`Source Directory` for details on how this class | 4872 | :term:`Source Directory` for details on how this class |
4355 | applies these additional sed command arguments. For general | 4873 | applies these additional sed command arguments. For general |
4356 | information on the ``binconfig`` class, see the | 4874 | information on the ``binconfig`` class, see the |
4357 | ":ref:`binconfig.bbclass <ref-classes-binconfig>`" section. | 4875 | ":ref:`binconfig.bbclass <ref-classes-binconfig>`" section. |
4358 | 4876 | ||
4359 | OE_IMPORTS | 4877 | OE_IMPORTS |
4360 | An internal variable used to tell the OpenEmbedded build system what | 4878 | An internal variable used to tell the OpenEmbedded build system what |
4361 | Python modules to import for every Python function run by the system. | 4879 | Python modules to import for every Python function run by the system. |
4362 | 4880 | ||
4363 | .. note:: | 4881 | .. note:: |
4364 | 4882 | ||
4365 | Do not set this variable. It is for internal use only. | 4883 | Do not set this variable. It is for internal use only. |
4366 | 4884 | ||
4367 | OE_INIT_ENV_SCRIPT | 4885 | OE_INIT_ENV_SCRIPT |
4368 | The name of the build environment setup script for the purposes of | 4886 | The name of the build environment setup script for the purposes of |
4369 | setting up the environment within the extensible SDK. The default | 4887 | setting up the environment within the extensible SDK. The default |
4370 | value is "oe-init-build-env". | 4888 | value is "oe-init-build-env". |
4371 | 4889 | ||
4372 | If you use a custom script to set up your build environment, set the | 4890 | If you use a custom script to set up your build environment, set the |
4373 | ``OE_INIT_ENV_SCRIPT`` variable to its name. | 4891 | ``OE_INIT_ENV_SCRIPT`` variable to its name. |
4374 | 4892 | ||
4375 | OE_TERMINAL | 4893 | OE_TERMINAL |
4376 | Controls how the OpenEmbedded build system spawns interactive | 4894 | Controls how the OpenEmbedded build system spawns interactive |
4377 | terminals on the host development system (e.g. using the BitBake | 4895 | terminals on the host development system (e.g. using the BitBake |
4378 | command with the ``-c devshell`` command-line option). For more | 4896 | command with the ``-c devshell`` command-line option). For more |
4379 | information, see the "`Using a Development | 4897 | information, see the ":ref:`platdev-appdev-devshell`" section in |
4380 | Shell <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#platdev-appdev-devshell>`__" section in | ||
4381 | the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 4898 | the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
4382 | 4899 | ||
4383 | You can use the following values for the ``OE_TERMINAL`` variable: | 4900 | You can use the following values for the ``OE_TERMINAL`` variable: |
4384 | auto gnome xfce rxvt screen konsole none | 4901 | |
4385 | 4902 | - auto | |
4903 | - gnome | ||
4904 | - xfce | ||
4905 | - rxvt | ||
4906 | - screen | ||
4907 | - konsole | ||
4908 | - none | ||
4909 | |||
4386 | OEROOT | 4910 | OEROOT |
4387 | The directory from which the top-level build environment setup script | 4911 | The directory from which the top-level build environment setup script |
4388 | is sourced. The Yocto Project provides a top-level build environment | 4912 | is sourced. The Yocto Project provides a top-level build environment |
4389 | setup script: ````` <#structure-core-script>`__. When you run this | 4913 | setup script: ````` <#structure-core-script>`__. When you run this |
4390 | script, the ``OEROOT`` variable resolves to the directory that | 4914 | script, the ``OEROOT`` variable resolves to the directory that |
4391 | contains the script. | 4915 | contains the script. |
4392 | 4916 | ||
4393 | For additional information on how this variable is used, see the | 4917 | For additional information on how this variable is used, see the |
4394 | initialization script. | 4918 | initialization script. |
4395 | 4919 | ||
4396 | OLDEST_KERNEL | 4920 | OLDEST_KERNEL |
4397 | Declares the oldest version of the Linux kernel that the produced | 4921 | Declares the oldest version of the Linux kernel that the produced |
4398 | binaries must support. This variable is passed into the build of the | 4922 | binaries must support. This variable is passed into the build of the |
4399 | Embedded GNU C Library (``glibc``). | 4923 | Embedded GNU C Library (``glibc``). |
4400 | 4924 | ||
4401 | The default for this variable comes from the | 4925 | The default for this variable comes from the |
4402 | ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file. You can override this | 4926 | ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file. You can override this |
4403 | default by setting the variable in a custom distribution | 4927 | default by setting the variable in a custom distribution |
4404 | configuration file. | 4928 | configuration file. |
4405 | 4929 | ||
4406 | OVERRIDES | 4930 | OVERRIDES |
4407 | A colon-separated list of overrides that currently apply. Overrides | 4931 | A colon-separated list of overrides that currently apply. Overrides |
4408 | are a BitBake mechanism that allows variables to be selectively | 4932 | are a BitBake mechanism that allows variables to be selectively |
@@ -4410,26 +4934,33 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4410 | ``OVERRIDES`` represents the "state" during building, which includes | 4934 | ``OVERRIDES`` represents the "state" during building, which includes |
4411 | the current recipe being built, the machine for which it is being | 4935 | the current recipe being built, the machine for which it is being |
4412 | built, and so forth. | 4936 | built, and so forth. |
4413 | 4937 | ||
4414 | As an example, if the string "an-override" appears as an element in | 4938 | As an example, if the string "an-override" appears as an element in |
4415 | the colon-separated list in ``OVERRIDES``, then the following | 4939 | the colon-separated list in ``OVERRIDES``, then the following |
4416 | assignment will override ``FOO`` with the value "overridden" at the | 4940 | assignment will override ``FOO`` with the value "overridden" at the |
4417 | end of parsing: FOO_an-override = "overridden" See the | 4941 | end of parsing: |
4942 | :: | ||
4943 | |||
4944 | FOO_an-override = "overridden" | ||
4945 | |||
4946 | See the | ||
4418 | ":ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:conditional syntax (overrides)`" | 4947 | ":ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:conditional syntax (overrides)`" |
4419 | section in the BitBake User Manual for more information on the | 4948 | section in the BitBake User Manual for more information on the |
4420 | overrides mechanism. | 4949 | overrides mechanism. |
4421 | 4950 | ||
4422 | The default value of ``OVERRIDES`` includes the values of the | 4951 | The default value of ``OVERRIDES`` includes the values of the |
4423 | :term:`CLASSOVERRIDE`, | 4952 | :term:`CLASSOVERRIDE`, |
4424 | :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES`, and | 4953 | :term:`MACHINEOVERRIDES`, and |
4425 | :term:`DISTROOVERRIDES` variables. Another | 4954 | :term:`DISTROOVERRIDES` variables. Another |
4426 | important override included by default is ``pn-${PN}``. This override | 4955 | important override included by default is ``pn-${PN}``. This override |
4427 | allows variables to be set for a single recipe within configuration | 4956 | allows variables to be set for a single recipe within configuration |
4428 | (``.conf``) files. Here is an example: FOO_pn-myrecipe = | 4957 | (``.conf``) files. Here is an example: |
4429 | "myrecipe-specific value" | 4958 | :: |
4430 | 4959 | ||
4960 | FOO_pn-myrecipe = "myrecipe-specific value" | ||
4961 | |||
4431 | .. note:: | 4962 | .. note:: |
4432 | 4963 | ||
4433 | An easy way to see what overrides apply is to search for | 4964 | An easy way to see what overrides apply is to search for |
4434 | OVERRIDES | 4965 | OVERRIDES |
4435 | in the output of the | 4966 | in the output of the |
@@ -4438,128 +4969,134 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4438 | Viewing Variable Values | 4969 | Viewing Variable Values |
4439 | " section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more | 4970 | " section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more |
4440 | information. | 4971 | information. |
4441 | 4972 | ||
4442 | P | 4973 | P |
4443 | The recipe name and version. ``P`` is comprised of the following: | 4974 | The recipe name and version. ``P`` is comprised of the following: |
4444 | ${PN}-${PV} | 4975 | :: |
4445 | 4976 | ||
4977 | ${PN}-${PV} | ||
4978 | |||
4446 | PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA | 4979 | PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA |
4447 | This variable defines additional metdata to add to packages. | 4980 | This variable defines additional metdata to add to packages. |
4448 | 4981 | ||
4449 | You may find you need to inject additional metadata into packages. | 4982 | You may find you need to inject additional metadata into packages. |
4450 | This variable allows you to do that by setting the injected data as | 4983 | This variable allows you to do that by setting the injected data as |
4451 | the value. Multiple fields can be added by splitting the content with | 4984 | the value. Multiple fields can be added by splitting the content with |
4452 | the literal separator "\n". | 4985 | the literal separator "\n". |
4453 | 4986 | ||
4454 | The suffixes '_IPK', '_DEB', or '_RPM' can be applied to the variable | 4987 | The suffixes '_IPK', '_DEB', or '_RPM' can be applied to the variable |
4455 | to do package type specific settings. It can also be made package | 4988 | to do package type specific settings. It can also be made package |
4456 | specific by using the package name as a suffix. | 4989 | specific by using the package name as a suffix. |
4457 | 4990 | ||
4458 | You can find out more about applying this variable in the "`Adding | 4991 | You can find out more about applying this variable in the |
4459 | custom metadata to | 4992 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:adding custom metadata to packages`" |
4460 | packages <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#adding-custom-metadata-to-packages>`__" | ||
4461 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 4993 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
4462 | 4994 | ||
4463 | PACKAGE_ARCH | 4995 | PACKAGE_ARCH |
4464 | The architecture of the resulting package or packages. | 4996 | The architecture of the resulting package or packages. |
4465 | 4997 | ||
4466 | By default, the value of this variable is set to | 4998 | By default, the value of this variable is set to |
4467 | :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH` when building for the | 4999 | :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH` when building for the |
4468 | target, :term:`BUILD_ARCH` when building for the | 5000 | target, :term:`BUILD_ARCH` when building for the |
4469 | build host, and "${SDK_ARCH}-${SDKPKGSUFFIX}" when building for the | 5001 | build host, and "${SDK_ARCH}-${SDKPKGSUFFIX}" when building for the |
4470 | SDK. | 5002 | SDK. |
4471 | 5003 | ||
4472 | .. note:: | 5004 | .. note:: |
4473 | 5005 | ||
4474 | See | 5006 | See |
4475 | SDK_ARCH | 5007 | SDK_ARCH |
4476 | for more information. | 5008 | for more information. |
4477 | 5009 | ||
4478 | However, if your recipe's output packages are built specific to the | 5010 | However, if your recipe's output packages are built specific to the |
4479 | target machine rather than generally for the architecture of the | 5011 | target machine rather than generally for the architecture of the |
4480 | machine, you should set ``PACKAGE_ARCH`` to the value of | 5012 | machine, you should set ``PACKAGE_ARCH`` to the value of |
4481 | :term:`MACHINE_ARCH` in the recipe as follows: | 5013 | :term:`MACHINE_ARCH` in the recipe as follows: |
4482 | PACKAGE_ARCH = "${MACHINE_ARCH}" | 5014 | :: |
4483 | 5015 | ||
5016 | PACKAGE_ARCH = "${MACHINE_ARCH}" | ||
5017 | |||
4484 | PACKAGE_ARCHS | 5018 | PACKAGE_ARCHS |
4485 | Specifies a list of architectures compatible with the target machine. | 5019 | Specifies a list of architectures compatible with the target machine. |
4486 | This variable is set automatically and should not normally be | 5020 | This variable is set automatically and should not normally be |
4487 | hand-edited. Entries are separated using spaces and listed in order | 5021 | hand-edited. Entries are separated using spaces and listed in order |
4488 | of priority. The default value for ``PACKAGE_ARCHS`` is "all any | 5022 | of priority. The default value for ``PACKAGE_ARCHS`` is "all any |
4489 | noarch ${PACKAGE_EXTRA_ARCHS} ${MACHINE_ARCH}". | 5023 | noarch ${PACKAGE_EXTRA_ARCHS} ${MACHINE_ARCH}". |
4490 | 5024 | ||
4491 | PACKAGE_BEFORE_PN | 5025 | PACKAGE_BEFORE_PN |
4492 | Enables easily adding packages to ``PACKAGES`` before ``${PN}`` so | 5026 | Enables easily adding packages to ``PACKAGES`` before ``${PN}`` so |
4493 | that those added packages can pick up files that would normally be | 5027 | that those added packages can pick up files that would normally be |
4494 | included in the default package. | 5028 | included in the default package. |
4495 | 5029 | ||
4496 | PACKAGE_CLASSES | 5030 | PACKAGE_CLASSES |
4497 | This variable, which is set in the ``local.conf`` configuration file | 5031 | This variable, which is set in the ``local.conf`` configuration file |
4498 | found in the ``conf`` folder of the | 5032 | found in the ``conf`` folder of the |
4499 | :term:`Build Directory`, specifies the package manager the | 5033 | :term:`Build Directory`, specifies the package manager the |
4500 | OpenEmbedded build system uses when packaging data. | 5034 | OpenEmbedded build system uses when packaging data. |
4501 | 5035 | ||
4502 | You can provide one or more of the following arguments for the | 5036 | You can provide one or more of the following arguments for the |
4503 | variable: PACKAGE_CLASSES ?= "package_rpm package_deb package_ipk | 5037 | variable: PACKAGE_CLASSES ?= "package_rpm package_deb package_ipk |
4504 | package_tar" | 5038 | package_tar" |
4505 | 5039 | ||
4506 | .. note:: | 5040 | .. note:: |
4507 | 5041 | ||
4508 | While it is a legal option, the | 5042 | While it is a legal option, the |
4509 | package_tar | 5043 | package_tar |
4510 | class has limited functionality due to no support for package | 5044 | class has limited functionality due to no support for package |
4511 | dependencies by that backend. Therefore, it is recommended that | 5045 | dependencies by that backend. Therefore, it is recommended that |
4512 | you do not use it. | 5046 | you do not use it. |
4513 | 5047 | ||
4514 | The build system uses only the first argument in the list as the | 5048 | The build system uses only the first argument in the list as the |
4515 | package manager when creating your image or SDK. However, packages | 5049 | package manager when creating your image or SDK. However, packages |
4516 | will be created using any additional packaging classes you specify. | 5050 | will be created using any additional packaging classes you specify. |
4517 | For example, if you use the following in your ``local.conf`` file: | 5051 | For example, if you use the following in your ``local.conf`` file: |
4518 | PACKAGE_CLASSES ?= "package_ipk" The OpenEmbedded build system uses | 5052 | :: |
5053 | |||
5054 | PACKAGE_CLASSES ?= "package_ipk" | ||
5055 | |||
5056 | The OpenEmbedded build system uses | ||
4519 | the IPK package manager to create your image or SDK. | 5057 | the IPK package manager to create your image or SDK. |
4520 | 5058 | ||
4521 | For information on packaging and build performance effects as a | 5059 | For information on packaging and build performance effects as a |
4522 | result of the package manager in use, see the | 5060 | result of the package manager in use, see the |
4523 | ":ref:`package.bbclass <ref-classes-package>`" section. | 5061 | ":ref:`package.bbclass <ref-classes-package>`" section. |
4524 | 5062 | ||
4525 | PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT_STYLE | 5063 | PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT_STYLE |
4526 | Determines how to split up the binary and debug information when | 5064 | Determines how to split up the binary and debug information when |
4527 | creating ``*-dbg`` packages to be used with the GNU Project Debugger | 5065 | creating ``*-dbg`` packages to be used with the GNU Project Debugger |
4528 | (GDB). | 5066 | (GDB). |
4529 | 5067 | ||
4530 | With the ``PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT_STYLE`` variable, you can control | 5068 | With the ``PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT_STYLE`` variable, you can control |
4531 | where debug information, which can include or exclude source files, | 5069 | where debug information, which can include or exclude source files, |
4532 | is stored: | 5070 | is stored: |
4533 | 5071 | ||
4534 | - ".debug": Debug symbol files are placed next to the binary in a | 5072 | - ".debug": Debug symbol files are placed next to the binary in a |
4535 | ``.debug`` directory on the target. For example, if a binary is | 5073 | ``.debug`` directory on the target. For example, if a binary is |
4536 | installed into ``/bin``, the corresponding debug symbol files are | 5074 | installed into ``/bin``, the corresponding debug symbol files are |
4537 | installed in ``/bin/.debug``. Source files are placed in | 5075 | installed in ``/bin/.debug``. Source files are placed in |
4538 | ``/usr/src/debug``. | 5076 | ``/usr/src/debug``. |
4539 | 5077 | ||
4540 | - "debug-file-directory": Debug symbol files are placed under | 5078 | - "debug-file-directory": Debug symbol files are placed under |
4541 | ``/usr/lib/debug`` on the target, and separated by the path from | 5079 | ``/usr/lib/debug`` on the target, and separated by the path from |
4542 | where the binary is installed. For example, if a binary is | 5080 | where the binary is installed. For example, if a binary is |
4543 | installed in ``/bin``, the corresponding debug symbols are | 5081 | installed in ``/bin``, the corresponding debug symbols are |
4544 | installed in ``/usr/lib/debug/bin``. Source files are placed in | 5082 | installed in ``/usr/lib/debug/bin``. Source files are placed in |
4545 | ``/usr/src/debug``. | 5083 | ``/usr/src/debug``. |
4546 | 5084 | ||
4547 | - "debug-without-src": The same behavior as ".debug" previously | 5085 | - "debug-without-src": The same behavior as ".debug" previously |
4548 | described with the exception that no source files are installed. | 5086 | described with the exception that no source files are installed. |
4549 | 5087 | ||
4550 | - "debug-with-srcpkg": The same behavior as ".debug" previously | 5088 | - "debug-with-srcpkg": The same behavior as ".debug" previously |
4551 | described with the exception that all source files are placed in a | 5089 | described with the exception that all source files are placed in a |
4552 | separate ``*-src`` pkg. This is the default behavior. | 5090 | separate ``*-src`` pkg. This is the default behavior. |
4553 | 5091 | ||
4554 | You can find out more about debugging using GDB by reading the | 5092 | You can find out more about debugging using GDB by reading the |
4555 | "`Debugging With the GNU Project Debugger (GDB) | 5093 | ":ref:`platdev-gdb-remotedebug`" section |
4556 | Remotely <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#platdev-gdb-remotedebug>`__" section | ||
4557 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 5094 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
4558 | 5095 | ||
4559 | PACKAGE_EXCLUDE_COMPLEMENTARY | 5096 | PACKAGE_EXCLUDE_COMPLEMENTARY |
4560 | Prevents specific packages from being installed when you are | 5097 | Prevents specific packages from being installed when you are |
4561 | installing complementary packages. | 5098 | installing complementary packages. |
4562 | 5099 | ||
4563 | You might find that you want to prevent installing certain packages | 5100 | You might find that you want to prevent installing certain packages |
4564 | when you are installing complementary packages. For example, if you | 5101 | when you are installing complementary packages. For example, if you |
4565 | are using :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` to install | 5102 | are using :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` to install |
@@ -4567,16 +5104,21 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4567 | particular multilib. If you find yourself in this situation, you can | 5104 | particular multilib. If you find yourself in this situation, you can |
4568 | use the ``PACKAGE_EXCLUDE_COMPLEMENTARY`` variable to specify regular | 5105 | use the ``PACKAGE_EXCLUDE_COMPLEMENTARY`` variable to specify regular |
4569 | expressions to match the packages you want to exclude. | 5106 | expressions to match the packages you want to exclude. |
4570 | 5107 | ||
4571 | PACKAGE_EXCLUDE | 5108 | PACKAGE_EXCLUDE |
4572 | Lists packages that should not be installed into an image. For | 5109 | Lists packages that should not be installed into an image. For |
4573 | example: PACKAGE_EXCLUDE = "package_name package_name package_name | 5110 | example: |
4574 | ..." | 5111 | :: |
4575 | 5112 | ||
5113 | PACKAGE_EXCLUDE = "package_name package_name package_name ..." | ||
5114 | |||
4576 | You can set this variable globally in your ``local.conf`` file or you | 5115 | You can set this variable globally in your ``local.conf`` file or you |
4577 | can attach it to a specific image recipe by using the recipe name | 5116 | can attach it to a specific image recipe by using the recipe name |
4578 | override: PACKAGE_EXCLUDE_pn-target_image = "package_name" | 5117 | override: |
4579 | 5118 | :: | |
5119 | |||
5120 | PACKAGE_EXCLUDE_pn-target_image = "package_name" | ||
5121 | |||
4580 | If you choose to not install a package using this variable and some | 5122 | If you choose to not install a package using this variable and some |
4581 | other package is dependent on it (i.e. listed in a recipe's | 5123 | other package is dependent on it (i.e. listed in a recipe's |
4582 | :term:`RDEPENDS` variable), the OpenEmbedded build | 5124 | :term:`RDEPENDS` variable), the OpenEmbedded build |
@@ -4584,19 +5126,19 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4584 | halts the process with a fatal error, you can use the variable with | 5126 | halts the process with a fatal error, you can use the variable with |
4585 | an iterative development process to remove specific components from a | 5127 | an iterative development process to remove specific components from a |
4586 | system. | 5128 | system. |
4587 | 5129 | ||
4588 | Support for this variable exists only when using the IPK and RPM | 5130 | Support for this variable exists only when using the IPK and RPM |
4589 | packaging backend. Support does not exist for DEB. | 5131 | packaging backend. Support does not exist for DEB. |
4590 | 5132 | ||
4591 | See the :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS` and the | 5133 | See the :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS` and the |
4592 | :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS` variables for | 5134 | :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS` variables for |
4593 | related information. | 5135 | related information. |
4594 | 5136 | ||
4595 | PACKAGE_EXTRA_ARCHS | 5137 | PACKAGE_EXTRA_ARCHS |
4596 | Specifies the list of architectures compatible with the device CPU. | 5138 | Specifies the list of architectures compatible with the device CPU. |
4597 | This variable is useful when you build for several different devices | 5139 | This variable is useful when you build for several different devices |
4598 | that use miscellaneous processors such as XScale and ARM926-EJS. | 5140 | that use miscellaneous processors such as XScale and ARM926-EJS. |
4599 | 5141 | ||
4600 | PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS | 5142 | PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS |
4601 | Optionally specifies the package architectures used as part of the | 5143 | Optionally specifies the package architectures used as part of the |
4602 | package feed URIs during the build. When used, the | 5144 | package feed URIs during the build. When used, the |
@@ -4605,9 +5147,9 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4605 | :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS` and | 5147 | :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS` and |
4606 | :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS` | 5148 | :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS` |
4607 | variables. | 5149 | variables. |
4608 | 5150 | ||
4609 | .. note:: | 5151 | .. note:: |
4610 | 5152 | ||
4611 | You can use the | 5153 | You can use the |
4612 | PACKAGE_FEEDS_ARCHS | 5154 | PACKAGE_FEEDS_ARCHS |
4613 | variable to whitelist specific package architectures. If you do | 5155 | variable to whitelist specific package architectures. If you do |
@@ -4615,73 +5157,91 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4615 | case, you can omit this variable. Omitting the variable results in | 5157 | case, you can omit this variable. Omitting the variable results in |
4616 | all available architectures for the current machine being included | 5158 | all available architectures for the current machine being included |
4617 | into remote package feeds. | 5159 | into remote package feeds. |
4618 | 5160 | ||
4619 | Consider the following example where the ``PACKAGE_FEED_URIS``, | 5161 | Consider the following example where the ``PACKAGE_FEED_URIS``, |
4620 | ``PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS``, and ``PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`` variables are | 5162 | ``PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS``, and ``PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`` variables are |
4621 | defined in your ``local.conf`` file: PACKAGE_FEED_URIS = | 5163 | defined in your ``local.conf`` file: |
4622 | "https://example.com/packagerepos/release \\ | 5164 | :: |
4623 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates" PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS = | 5165 | |
4624 | "rpm rpm-dev" PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS = "all core2-64" Given these | 5166 | PACKAGE_FEED_URIS = "https://example.com/packagerepos/release \ |
4625 | settings, the resulting package feeds are as follows: | 5167 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates" |
4626 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/all | 5168 | PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS = "rpm rpm-dev" |
4627 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/core2-64 | 5169 | PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS = "all core2-64" |
4628 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/all | 5170 | |
4629 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/core2-64 | 5171 | Given these settings, the resulting package feeds are as follows: |
4630 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/all | 5172 | :: |
4631 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/core2-64 | 5173 | |
4632 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/all | 5174 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/all |
4633 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/core2-64 | 5175 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/core2-64 |
4634 | 5176 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/all | |
5177 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/core2-64 | ||
5178 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/all | ||
5179 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/core2-64 | ||
5180 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/all | ||
5181 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/core2-64 | ||
5182 | |||
4635 | PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS | 5183 | PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS |
4636 | Specifies the base path used when constructing package feed URIs. The | 5184 | Specifies the base path used when constructing package feed URIs. The |
4637 | ``PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`` variable makes up the middle portion of a | 5185 | ``PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`` variable makes up the middle portion of a |
4638 | package feed URI used by the OpenEmbedded build system. The base path | 5186 | package feed URI used by the OpenEmbedded build system. The base path |
4639 | lies between the :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS` | 5187 | lies between the :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS` |
4640 | and :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` variables. | 5188 | and :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` variables. |
4641 | 5189 | ||
4642 | Consider the following example where the ``PACKAGE_FEED_URIS``, | 5190 | Consider the following example where the ``PACKAGE_FEED_URIS``, |
4643 | ``PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS``, and ``PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`` variables are | 5191 | ``PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS``, and ``PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`` variables are |
4644 | defined in your ``local.conf`` file: PACKAGE_FEED_URIS = | 5192 | defined in your ``local.conf`` file: |
4645 | "https://example.com/packagerepos/release \\ | 5193 | :: |
4646 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates" PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS = | 5194 | |
4647 | "rpm rpm-dev" PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS = "all core2-64" Given these | 5195 | PACKAGE_FEED_URIS = "https://example.com/packagerepos/release \ |
4648 | settings, the resulting package feeds are as follows: | 5196 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates" |
4649 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/all | 5197 | PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS = "rpm rpm-dev" |
4650 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/core2-64 | 5198 | PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS = "all core2-64" |
4651 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/all | 5199 | |
4652 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/core2-64 | 5200 | Given these settings, the resulting package feeds are as follows: |
4653 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/all | 5201 | :: |
4654 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/core2-64 | 5202 | |
4655 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/all | 5203 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/all |
4656 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/core2-64 | 5204 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/core2-64 |
4657 | 5205 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/all | |
5206 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/core2-64 | ||
5207 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/all | ||
5208 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/core2-64 | ||
5209 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/all | ||
5210 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/core2-64 | ||
5211 | |||
4658 | PACKAGE_FEED_URIS | 5212 | PACKAGE_FEED_URIS |
4659 | Specifies the front portion of the package feed URI used by the | 5213 | Specifies the front portion of the package feed URI used by the |
4660 | OpenEmbedded build system. Each final package feed URI is comprised | 5214 | OpenEmbedded build system. Each final package feed URI is comprised |
4661 | of ``PACKAGE_FEED_URIS``, | 5215 | of ``PACKAGE_FEED_URIS``, |
4662 | :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`, and | 5216 | :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`, and |
4663 | :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` variables. | 5217 | :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS` variables. |
4664 | 5218 | ||
4665 | Consider the following example where the ``PACKAGE_FEED_URIS``, | 5219 | Consider the following example where the ``PACKAGE_FEED_URIS``, |
4666 | ``PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS``, and ``PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`` variables are | 5220 | ``PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS``, and ``PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`` variables are |
4667 | defined in your ``local.conf`` file: PACKAGE_FEED_URIS = | 5221 | defined in your ``local.conf`` file: |
4668 | "https://example.com/packagerepos/release \\ | 5222 | :: |
4669 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates" PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS = | 5223 | |
4670 | "rpm rpm-dev" PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS = "all core2-64" Given these | 5224 | PACKAGE_FEED_URIS = "https://example.com/packagerepos/release \ |
4671 | settings, the resulting package feeds are as follows: | 5225 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates" |
4672 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/all | 5226 | PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS = "rpm rpm-dev" |
4673 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/core2-64 | 5227 | PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS = "all core2-64" |
4674 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/all | 5228 | |
4675 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/core2-64 | 5229 | Given these settings, the resulting package feeds are as follows: |
4676 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/all | 5230 | :: |
4677 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/core2-64 | 5231 | |
4678 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/all | 5232 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/all |
4679 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/core2-64 | 5233 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm/core2-64 |
4680 | 5234 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/all | |
5235 | https://example.com/packagerepos/release/rpm-dev/core2-64 | ||
5236 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/all | ||
5237 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm/core2-64 | ||
5238 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/all | ||
5239 | https://example.com/packagerepos/updates/rpm-dev/core2-64 | ||
5240 | |||
4681 | PACKAGE_INSTALL | 5241 | PACKAGE_INSTALL |
4682 | The final list of packages passed to the package manager for | 5242 | The final list of packages passed to the package manager for |
4683 | installation into the image. | 5243 | installation into the image. |
4684 | 5244 | ||
4685 | Because the package manager controls actual installation of all | 5245 | Because the package manager controls actual installation of all |
4686 | packages, the list of packages passed using ``PACKAGE_INSTALL`` is | 5246 | packages, the list of packages passed using ``PACKAGE_INSTALL`` is |
4687 | not the final list of packages that are actually installed. This | 5247 | not the final list of packages that are actually installed. This |
@@ -4693,21 +5253,20 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4693 | ```core-image-minimal-initramfs`` <#images-core-image-minimal-initramfs>`__ | 5253 | ```core-image-minimal-initramfs`` <#images-core-image-minimal-initramfs>`__ |
4694 | image. When working with an initial RAM filesystem (initramfs) image, | 5254 | image. When working with an initial RAM filesystem (initramfs) image, |
4695 | use the ``PACKAGE_INSTALL`` variable. For information on creating an | 5255 | use the ``PACKAGE_INSTALL`` variable. For information on creating an |
4696 | initramfs, see the "`Building an Initial RAM Filesystem (initramfs) | 5256 | initramfs, see the ":ref:`building-an-initramfs-image`" section |
4697 | Image <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#building-an-initramfs-image>`__" section | ||
4698 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 5257 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
4699 | 5258 | ||
4700 | PACKAGE_INSTALL_ATTEMPTONLY | 5259 | PACKAGE_INSTALL_ATTEMPTONLY |
4701 | Specifies a list of packages the OpenEmbedded build system attempts | 5260 | Specifies a list of packages the OpenEmbedded build system attempts |
4702 | to install when creating an image. If a listed package fails to | 5261 | to install when creating an image. If a listed package fails to |
4703 | install, the build system does not generate an error. This variable | 5262 | install, the build system does not generate an error. This variable |
4704 | is generally not user-defined. | 5263 | is generally not user-defined. |
4705 | 5264 | ||
4706 | PACKAGE_PREPROCESS_FUNCS | 5265 | PACKAGE_PREPROCESS_FUNCS |
4707 | Specifies a list of functions run to pre-process the | 5266 | Specifies a list of functions run to pre-process the |
4708 | :term:`PKGD` directory prior to splitting the files out | 5267 | :term:`PKGD` directory prior to splitting the files out |
4709 | to individual packages. | 5268 | to individual packages. |
4710 | 5269 | ||
4711 | PACKAGE_WRITE_DEPS | 5270 | PACKAGE_WRITE_DEPS |
4712 | Specifies a list of dependencies for post-installation and | 5271 | Specifies a list of dependencies for post-installation and |
4713 | pre-installation scripts on native/cross tools. If your | 5272 | pre-installation scripts on native/cross tools. If your |
@@ -4715,93 +5274,114 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4715 | creation time rather than on the target but depends on a native tool | 5274 | creation time rather than on the target but depends on a native tool |
4716 | in order to execute, you need to list the tools in | 5275 | in order to execute, you need to list the tools in |
4717 | ``PACKAGE_WRITE_DEPS``. | 5276 | ``PACKAGE_WRITE_DEPS``. |
4718 | 5277 | ||
4719 | For information on running post-installation scripts, see the | 5278 | For information on running post-installation scripts, see the |
4720 | "`Post-Installation | 5279 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:post-installation scripts`" |
4721 | Scripts <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#new-recipe-post-installation-scripts>`__" | ||
4722 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 5280 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
4723 | 5281 | ||
4724 | PACKAGECONFIG | 5282 | PACKAGECONFIG |
4725 | This variable provides a means of enabling or disabling features of a | 5283 | This variable provides a means of enabling or disabling features of a |
4726 | recipe on a per-recipe basis. ``PACKAGECONFIG`` blocks are defined in | 5284 | recipe on a per-recipe basis. ``PACKAGECONFIG`` blocks are defined in |
4727 | recipes when you specify features and then arguments that define | 5285 | recipes when you specify features and then arguments that define |
4728 | feature behaviors. Here is the basic block structure (broken over | 5286 | feature behaviors. Here is the basic block structure (broken over |
4729 | multiple lines for readability): PACKAGECONFIG ??= "f1 f2 f3 ..." | 5287 | multiple lines for readability): |
4730 | PACKAGECONFIG[f1] = "\\ --with-f1, \\ --without-f1, \\ | 5288 | :: |
4731 | build-deps-for-f1, \\ runtime-deps-for-f1, \\ | 5289 | |
4732 | runtime-recommends-for-f1, \\ packageconfig-conflicts-for-f1 \\ " | 5290 | PACKAGECONFIG ??= "f1 f2 f3 ..." |
4733 | PACKAGECONFIG[f2] = "\\ ... and so on and so on ... | 5291 | PACKAGECONFIG[f1] = "\ |
4734 | 5292 | --with-f1, \ | |
5293 | --without-f1, \ | ||
5294 | build-deps-for-f1, \ | ||
5295 | runtime-deps-for-f1, \ | ||
5296 | runtime-recommends-for-f1, \ | ||
5297 | packageconfig-conflicts-for-f1" | ||
5298 | PACKAGECONFIG[f2] = "\ | ||
5299 | ... and so on and so on ... | ||
5300 | |||
4735 | The ``PACKAGECONFIG`` variable itself specifies a space-separated | 5301 | The ``PACKAGECONFIG`` variable itself specifies a space-separated |
4736 | list of the features to enable. Following the features, you can | 5302 | list of the features to enable. Following the features, you can |
4737 | determine the behavior of each feature by providing up to six | 5303 | determine the behavior of each feature by providing up to six |
4738 | order-dependent arguments, which are separated by commas. You can | 5304 | order-dependent arguments, which are separated by commas. You can |
4739 | omit any argument you like but must retain the separating commas. The | 5305 | omit any argument you like but must retain the separating commas. The |
4740 | order is important and specifies the following: | 5306 | order is important and specifies the following: |
4741 | 5307 | ||
4742 | 1. Extra arguments that should be added to the configure script | 5308 | 1. Extra arguments that should be added to the configure script |
4743 | argument list (:term:`EXTRA_OECONF` or | 5309 | argument list (:term:`EXTRA_OECONF` or |
4744 | :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`) if | 5310 | :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`) if |
4745 | the feature is enabled. | 5311 | the feature is enabled. |
4746 | 5312 | ||
4747 | 2. Extra arguments that should be added to ``EXTRA_OECONF`` or | 5313 | 2. Extra arguments that should be added to ``EXTRA_OECONF`` or |
4748 | ``PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`` if the feature is disabled. | 5314 | ``PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`` if the feature is disabled. |
4749 | 5315 | ||
4750 | 3. Additional build dependencies (:term:`DEPENDS`) | 5316 | 3. Additional build dependencies (:term:`DEPENDS`) |
4751 | that should be added if the feature is enabled. | 5317 | that should be added if the feature is enabled. |
4752 | 5318 | ||
4753 | 4. Additional runtime dependencies (:term:`RDEPENDS`) | 5319 | 4. Additional runtime dependencies (:term:`RDEPENDS`) |
4754 | that should be added if the feature is enabled. | 5320 | that should be added if the feature is enabled. |
4755 | 5321 | ||
4756 | 5. Additional runtime recommendations | 5322 | 5. Additional runtime recommendations |
4757 | (:term:`RRECOMMENDS`) that should be added if | 5323 | (:term:`RRECOMMENDS`) that should be added if |
4758 | the feature is enabled. | 5324 | the feature is enabled. |
4759 | 5325 | ||
4760 | 6. Any conflicting (that is, mutually exclusive) ``PACKAGECONFIG`` | 5326 | 6. Any conflicting (that is, mutually exclusive) ``PACKAGECONFIG`` |
4761 | settings for this feature. | 5327 | settings for this feature. |
4762 | 5328 | ||
4763 | Consider the following ``PACKAGECONFIG`` block taken from the | 5329 | Consider the following ``PACKAGECONFIG`` block taken from the |
4764 | ``librsvg`` recipe. In this example the feature is ``gtk``, which has | 5330 | ``librsvg`` recipe. In this example the feature is ``gtk``, which has |
4765 | three arguments that determine the feature's behavior. | 5331 | three arguments that determine the feature's behavior. |
4766 | PACKAGECONFIG[gtk] = "--with-gtk3,--without-gtk3,gtk+3" The | 5332 | :: |
5333 | |||
5334 | PACKAGECONFIG[gtk] = "--with-gtk3,--without-gtk3,gtk+3" | ||
5335 | |||
5336 | The | ||
4767 | ``--with-gtk3`` and ``gtk+3`` arguments apply only if the feature is | 5337 | ``--with-gtk3`` and ``gtk+3`` arguments apply only if the feature is |
4768 | enabled. In this case, ``--with-gtk3`` is added to the configure | 5338 | enabled. In this case, ``--with-gtk3`` is added to the configure |
4769 | script argument list and ``gtk+3`` is added to ``DEPENDS``. On the | 5339 | script argument list and ``gtk+3`` is added to ``DEPENDS``. On the |
4770 | other hand, if the feature is disabled say through a ``.bbappend`` | 5340 | other hand, if the feature is disabled say through a ``.bbappend`` |
4771 | file in another layer, then the second argument ``--without-gtk3`` is | 5341 | file in another layer, then the second argument ``--without-gtk3`` is |
4772 | added to the configure script instead. | 5342 | added to the configure script instead. |
4773 | 5343 | ||
4774 | The basic ``PACKAGECONFIG`` structure previously described holds true | 5344 | The basic ``PACKAGECONFIG`` structure previously described holds true |
4775 | regardless of whether you are creating a block or changing a block. | 5345 | regardless of whether you are creating a block or changing a block. |
4776 | When creating a block, use the structure inside your recipe. | 5346 | When creating a block, use the structure inside your recipe. |
4777 | 5347 | ||
4778 | If you want to change an existing ``PACKAGECONFIG`` block, you can do | 5348 | If you want to change an existing ``PACKAGECONFIG`` block, you can do |
4779 | so one of two ways: | 5349 | so one of two ways: |
4780 | 5350 | ||
4781 | - *Append file:* Create an append file named | 5351 | - *Append file:* Create an append file named |
4782 | recipename\ ``.bbappend`` in your layer and override the value of | 5352 | recipename\ ``.bbappend`` in your layer and override the value of |
4783 | ``PACKAGECONFIG``. You can either completely override the | 5353 | ``PACKAGECONFIG``. You can either completely override the |
4784 | variable: PACKAGECONFIG = "f4 f5" Or, you can just append the | 5354 | variable: |
4785 | variable: PACKAGECONFIG_append = " f4" | 5355 | :: |
4786 | 5356 | ||
5357 | PACKAGECONFIG = "f4 f5" | ||
5358 | |||
5359 | Or, you can just append the variable: | ||
5360 | :: | ||
5361 | |||
5362 | PACKAGECONFIG_append = " f4" | ||
5363 | |||
4787 | - *Configuration file:* This method is identical to changing the | 5364 | - *Configuration file:* This method is identical to changing the |
4788 | block through an append file except you edit your ``local.conf`` | 5365 | block through an append file except you edit your ``local.conf`` |
4789 | or ``mydistro.conf`` file. As with append files previously | 5366 | or ``mydistro.conf`` file. As with append files previously |
4790 | described, you can either completely override the variable: | 5367 | described, you can either completely override the variable: |
4791 | PACKAGECONFIG_pn-recipename = "f4 f5" Or, you can just amend the | 5368 | PACKAGECONFIG_pn-recipename = "f4 f5" Or, you can just amend the |
4792 | variable: PACKAGECONFIG_append_pn-recipename = " f4" | 5369 | variable: |
4793 | 5370 | :: | |
5371 | |||
5372 | PACKAGECONFIG_append_pn-recipename = " f4" | ||
5373 | |||
4794 | PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS | 5374 | PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS |
4795 | A space-separated list of configuration options generated from the | 5375 | A space-separated list of configuration options generated from the |
4796 | :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` setting. | 5376 | :term:`PACKAGECONFIG` setting. |
4797 | 5377 | ||
4798 | Classes such as :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` and | 5378 | Classes such as :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` and |
4799 | :ref:`cmake <ref-classes-cmake>` use ``PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`` to | 5379 | :ref:`cmake <ref-classes-cmake>` use ``PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`` to |
4800 | pass ``PACKAGECONFIG`` options to ``configure`` and ``cmake``, | 5380 | pass ``PACKAGECONFIG`` options to ``configure`` and ``cmake``, |
4801 | respectively. If you are using ``PACKAGECONFIG`` but not a class that | 5381 | respectively. If you are using ``PACKAGECONFIG`` but not a class that |
4802 | handles the ``do_configure`` task, then you need to use | 5382 | handles the ``do_configure`` task, then you need to use |
4803 | ``PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`` appropriately. | 5383 | ``PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`` appropriately. |
4804 | 5384 | ||
4805 | PACKAGEGROUP_DISABLE_COMPLEMENTARY | 5385 | PACKAGEGROUP_DISABLE_COMPLEMENTARY |
4806 | For recipes inheriting the | 5386 | For recipes inheriting the |
4807 | :ref:`packagegroup <ref-classes-packagegroup>` class, setting | 5387 | :ref:`packagegroup <ref-classes-packagegroup>` class, setting |
@@ -4809,25 +5389,27 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4809 | normal complementary packages (i.e. ``-dev``, ``-dbg``, and so forth) | 5389 | normal complementary packages (i.e. ``-dev``, ``-dbg``, and so forth) |
4810 | should not be automatically created by the ``packagegroup`` recipe, | 5390 | should not be automatically created by the ``packagegroup`` recipe, |
4811 | which is the default behavior. | 5391 | which is the default behavior. |
4812 | 5392 | ||
4813 | PACKAGES | 5393 | PACKAGES |
4814 | The list of packages the recipe creates. The default value is the | 5394 | The list of packages the recipe creates. The default value is the |
4815 | following: ${PN}-dbg ${PN}-staticdev ${PN}-dev ${PN}-doc ${PN}-locale | 5395 | following: |
4816 | ${PACKAGE_BEFORE_PN} ${PN} | 5396 | :: |
4817 | 5397 | ||
5398 | ${PN}-dbg ${PN}-staticdev ${PN}-dev ${PN}-doc ${PN}-locale ${PACKAGE_BEFORE_PN} ${PN} | ||
5399 | |||
4818 | During packaging, the :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task | 5400 | During packaging, the :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task |
4819 | goes through ``PACKAGES`` and uses the :term:`FILES` | 5401 | goes through ``PACKAGES`` and uses the :term:`FILES` |
4820 | variable corresponding to each package to assign files to the | 5402 | variable corresponding to each package to assign files to the |
4821 | package. If a file matches the ``FILES`` variable for more than one | 5403 | package. If a file matches the ``FILES`` variable for more than one |
4822 | package in ``PACKAGES``, it will be assigned to the earliest | 5404 | package in ``PACKAGES``, it will be assigned to the earliest |
4823 | (leftmost) package. | 5405 | (leftmost) package. |
4824 | 5406 | ||
4825 | Packages in the variable's list that are empty (i.e. where none of | 5407 | Packages in the variable's list that are empty (i.e. where none of |
4826 | the patterns in ``FILES_``\ pkg match any files installed by the | 5408 | the patterns in ``FILES_``\ pkg match any files installed by the |
4827 | :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task) are not generated, | 5409 | :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task) are not generated, |
4828 | unless generation is forced through the | 5410 | unless generation is forced through the |
4829 | :term:`ALLOW_EMPTY` variable. | 5411 | :term:`ALLOW_EMPTY` variable. |
4830 | 5412 | ||
4831 | PACKAGES_DYNAMIC | 5413 | PACKAGES_DYNAMIC |
4832 | A promise that your recipe satisfies runtime dependencies for | 5414 | A promise that your recipe satisfies runtime dependencies for |
4833 | optional modules that are found in other recipes. | 5415 | optional modules that are found in other recipes. |
@@ -4840,17 +5422,17 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4840 | to include that package in an image, you will get a dependency | 5422 | to include that package in an image, you will get a dependency |
4841 | failure from the packaging system during the | 5423 | failure from the packaging system during the |
4842 | :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task. | 5424 | :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task. |
4843 | 5425 | ||
4844 | Typically, if there is a chance that such a situation can occur and | 5426 | Typically, if there is a chance that such a situation can occur and |
4845 | the package that is not created is valid without the dependency being | 5427 | the package that is not created is valid without the dependency being |
4846 | satisfied, then you should use :term:`RRECOMMENDS` | 5428 | satisfied, then you should use :term:`RRECOMMENDS` |
4847 | (a soft runtime dependency) instead of ``RDEPENDS``. | 5429 | (a soft runtime dependency) instead of ``RDEPENDS``. |
4848 | 5430 | ||
4849 | For an example of how to use the ``PACKAGES_DYNAMIC`` variable when | 5431 | For an example of how to use the ``PACKAGES_DYNAMIC`` variable when |
4850 | you are splitting packages, see the "`Handling Optional Module | 5432 | you are splitting packages, see the |
4851 | Packaging <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#handling-optional-module-packaging>`__" | 5433 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:handling optional module packaging`" |
4852 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 5434 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
4853 | 5435 | ||
4854 | PACKAGESPLITFUNCS | 5436 | PACKAGESPLITFUNCS |
4855 | Specifies a list of functions run to perform additional splitting of | 5437 | Specifies a list of functions run to perform additional splitting of |
4856 | files into individual packages. Recipes can either prepend to this | 5438 | files into individual packages. Recipes can either prepend to this |
@@ -4860,16 +5442,16 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4860 | :term:`FILES`, :term:`RDEPENDS` and | 5442 | :term:`FILES`, :term:`RDEPENDS` and |
4861 | other packaging variables appropriately in order to perform the | 5443 | other packaging variables appropriately in order to perform the |
4862 | desired splitting. | 5444 | desired splitting. |
4863 | 5445 | ||
4864 | PARALLEL_MAKE | 5446 | PARALLEL_MAKE |
4865 | Extra options passed to the ``make`` command during the | 5447 | Extra options passed to the ``make`` command during the |
4866 | :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task in order to specify | 5448 | :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task in order to specify |
4867 | parallel compilation on the local build host. This variable is | 5449 | parallel compilation on the local build host. This variable is |
4868 | usually in the form "-j x", where x represents the maximum number of | 5450 | usually in the form "-j x", where x represents the maximum number of |
4869 | parallel threads ``make`` can run. | 5451 | parallel threads ``make`` can run. |
4870 | 5452 | ||
4871 | .. note:: | 5453 | .. note:: |
4872 | 5454 | ||
4873 | In order for | 5455 | In order for |
4874 | PARALLEL_MAKE | 5456 | PARALLEL_MAKE |
4875 | to be effective, | 5457 | to be effective, |
@@ -4881,12 +5463,12 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4881 | . An easy way to ensure this is to use the | 5463 | . An easy way to ensure this is to use the |
4882 | oe_runmake | 5464 | oe_runmake |
4883 | function. | 5465 | function. |
4884 | 5466 | ||
4885 | By default, the OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this | 5467 | By default, the OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this |
4886 | variable to be equal to the number of cores the build system uses. | 5468 | variable to be equal to the number of cores the build system uses. |
4887 | 5469 | ||
4888 | .. note:: | 5470 | .. note:: |
4889 | 5471 | ||
4890 | If the software being built experiences dependency issues during | 5472 | If the software being built experiences dependency issues during |
4891 | the | 5473 | the |
4892 | do_compile | 5474 | do_compile |
@@ -4896,50 +5478,49 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4896 | addressing race conditions, see the " | 5478 | addressing race conditions, see the " |
4897 | Debugging Parallel Make Races | 5479 | Debugging Parallel Make Races |
4898 | " section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 5480 | " section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
4899 | 5481 | ||
4900 | For single socket systems (i.e. one CPU), you should not have to | 5482 | For single socket systems (i.e. one CPU), you should not have to |
4901 | override this variable to gain optimal parallelism during builds. | 5483 | override this variable to gain optimal parallelism during builds. |
4902 | However, if you have very large systems that employ multiple physical | 5484 | However, if you have very large systems that employ multiple physical |
4903 | CPUs, you might want to make sure the ``PARALLEL_MAKE`` variable is | 5485 | CPUs, you might want to make sure the ``PARALLEL_MAKE`` variable is |
4904 | not set higher than "-j 20". | 5486 | not set higher than "-j 20". |
4905 | 5487 | ||
4906 | For more information on speeding up builds, see the "`Speeding Up a | 5488 | For more information on speeding up builds, see the |
4907 | Build <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#speeding-up-a-build>`__" section in the | 5489 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:speeding up a build`" |
4908 | Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 5490 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
4909 | 5491 | ||
4910 | PARALLEL_MAKEINST | 5492 | PARALLEL_MAKEINST |
4911 | Extra options passed to the ``make install`` command during the | 5493 | Extra options passed to the ``make install`` command during the |
4912 | :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task in order to specify | 5494 | :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task in order to specify |
4913 | parallel installation. This variable defaults to the value of | 5495 | parallel installation. This variable defaults to the value of |
4914 | :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE`. | 5496 | :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE`. |
4915 | 5497 | ||
4916 | .. note:: | 5498 | .. note:: |
4917 | 5499 | ||
4918 | In order for ``PARALLEL_MAKEINST`` to be effective, ``make`` must | 5500 | In order for ``PARALLEL_MAKEINST`` to be effective, ``make`` must |
4919 | be called with | 5501 | be called with |
4920 | ``${``\ :term:`EXTRA_OEMAKE`\ ``}``. An easy | 5502 | ``${``\ :term:`EXTRA_OEMAKE`\ ``}``. An easy |
4921 | way to ensure this is to use the ``oe_runmake`` function. | 5503 | way to ensure this is to use the ``oe_runmake`` function. |
4922 | 5504 | ||
4923 | If the software being built experiences dependency issues during | 5505 | If the software being built experiences dependency issues during |
4924 | the ``do_install`` task that result in race conditions, you can | 5506 | the ``do_install`` task that result in race conditions, you can |
4925 | clear the ``PARALLEL_MAKEINST`` variable within the recipe as a | 5507 | clear the ``PARALLEL_MAKEINST`` variable within the recipe as a |
4926 | workaround. For information on addressing race conditions, see the | 5508 | workaround. For information on addressing race conditions, see the |
4927 | "`Debugging Parallel Make | 5509 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:debugging parallel make races`" |
4928 | Races <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#debugging-parallel-make-races>`__" | ||
4929 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 5510 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
4930 | 5511 | ||
4931 | PATCHRESOLVE | 5512 | PATCHRESOLVE |
4932 | Determines the action to take when a patch fails. You can set this | 5513 | Determines the action to take when a patch fails. You can set this |
4933 | variable to one of two values: "noop" and "user". | 5514 | variable to one of two values: "noop" and "user". |
4934 | 5515 | ||
4935 | The default value of "noop" causes the build to simply fail when the | 5516 | The default value of "noop" causes the build to simply fail when the |
4936 | OpenEmbedded build system cannot successfully apply a patch. Setting | 5517 | OpenEmbedded build system cannot successfully apply a patch. Setting |
4937 | the value to "user" causes the build system to launch a shell and | 5518 | the value to "user" causes the build system to launch a shell and |
4938 | places you in the right location so that you can manually resolve the | 5519 | places you in the right location so that you can manually resolve the |
4939 | conflicts. | 5520 | conflicts. |
4940 | 5521 | ||
4941 | Set this variable in your ``local.conf`` file. | 5522 | Set this variable in your ``local.conf`` file. |
4942 | 5523 | ||
4943 | PATCHTOOL | 5524 | PATCHTOOL |
4944 | Specifies the utility used to apply patches for a recipe during the | 5525 | Specifies the utility used to apply patches for a recipe during the |
4945 | :ref:`ref-tasks-patch` task. You can specify one of | 5526 | :ref:`ref-tasks-patch` task. You can specify one of |
@@ -4947,24 +5528,28 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4947 | is "quilt" except for the quilt-native recipe itself. Because the | 5528 | is "quilt" except for the quilt-native recipe itself. Because the |
4948 | quilt tool is not available at the time quilt-native is being | 5529 | quilt tool is not available at the time quilt-native is being |
4949 | patched, it uses "patch". | 5530 | patched, it uses "patch". |
4950 | 5531 | ||
4951 | If you wish to use an alternative patching tool, set the variable in | 5532 | If you wish to use an alternative patching tool, set the variable in |
4952 | the recipe using one of the following: PATCHTOOL = "patch" PATCHTOOL | 5533 | the recipe using one of the following: |
4953 | = "quilt" PATCHTOOL = "git" | 5534 | :: |
4954 | 5535 | ||
5536 | PATCHTOOL = "patch" | ||
5537 | PATCHTOOL = "quilt" | ||
5538 | PATCHTOOL = "git" | ||
5539 | |||
4955 | PE | 5540 | PE |
4956 | The epoch of the recipe. By default, this variable is unset. The | 5541 | The epoch of the recipe. By default, this variable is unset. The |
4957 | variable is used to make upgrades possible when the versioning scheme | 5542 | variable is used to make upgrades possible when the versioning scheme |
4958 | changes in some backwards incompatible way. | 5543 | changes in some backwards incompatible way. |
4959 | 5544 | ||
4960 | ``PE`` is the default value of the :term:`PKGE` variable. | 5545 | ``PE`` is the default value of the :term:`PKGE` variable. |
4961 | 5546 | ||
4962 | PF | 5547 | PF |
4963 | Specifies the recipe or package name and includes all version and | 5548 | Specifies the recipe or package name and includes all version and |
4964 | revision numbers (i.e. ``glibc-2.13-r20+svnr15508/`` and | 5549 | revision numbers (i.e. ``glibc-2.13-r20+svnr15508/`` and |
4965 | ``bash-4.2-r1/``). This variable is comprised of the following: | 5550 | ``bash-4.2-r1/``). This variable is comprised of the following: |
4966 | ${:term:`PN`}-${:term:`EXTENDPE`}${:term:`PV`}-${:term:`PR`} | 5551 | ${:term:`PN`}-${:term:`EXTENDPE`}${:term:`PV`}-${:term:`PR`} |
4967 | 5552 | ||
4968 | PIXBUF_PACKAGES | 5553 | PIXBUF_PACKAGES |
4969 | When inheriting the :ref:`pixbufcache <ref-classes-pixbufcache>` | 5554 | When inheriting the :ref:`pixbufcache <ref-classes-pixbufcache>` |
4970 | class, this variable identifies packages that contain the pixbuf | 5555 | class, this variable identifies packages that contain the pixbuf |
@@ -4972,139 +5557,158 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
4972 | class assumes that the loaders are in the recipe's main package (i.e. | 5557 | class assumes that the loaders are in the recipe's main package (i.e. |
4973 | ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``). Use this variable if the | 5558 | ``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``). Use this variable if the |
4974 | loaders you need are in a package other than that main package. | 5559 | loaders you need are in a package other than that main package. |
4975 | 5560 | ||
4976 | PKG | 5561 | PKG |
4977 | The name of the resulting package created by the OpenEmbedded build | 5562 | The name of the resulting package created by the OpenEmbedded build |
4978 | system. | 5563 | system. |
4979 | 5564 | ||
4980 | .. note:: | 5565 | .. note:: |
4981 | 5566 | ||
4982 | When using the | 5567 | When using the |
4983 | PKG | 5568 | PKG |
4984 | variable, you must use a package name override. | 5569 | variable, you must use a package name override. |
4985 | 5570 | ||
4986 | For example, when the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class | 5571 | For example, when the :ref:`debian <ref-classes-debian>` class |
4987 | renames the output package, it does so by setting | 5572 | renames the output package, it does so by setting |
4988 | ``PKG_packagename``. | 5573 | ``PKG_packagename``. |
4989 | 5574 | ||
4990 | PKG_CONFIG_PATH | 5575 | PKG_CONFIG_PATH |
4991 | The path to ``pkg-config`` files for the current build context. | 5576 | The path to ``pkg-config`` files for the current build context. |
4992 | ``pkg-config`` reads this variable from the environment. | 5577 | ``pkg-config`` reads this variable from the environment. |
4993 | 5578 | ||
4994 | PKGD | 5579 | PKGD |
4995 | Points to the destination directory for files to be packaged before | 5580 | Points to the destination directory for files to be packaged before |
4996 | they are split into individual packages. This directory defaults to | 5581 | they are split into individual packages. This directory defaults to |
4997 | the following: ${WORKDIR}/package | 5582 | the following: |
4998 | 5583 | :: | |
5584 | |||
5585 | ${WORKDIR}/package | ||
5586 | |||
4999 | Do not change this default. | 5587 | Do not change this default. |
5000 | 5588 | ||
5001 | PKGDATA_DIR | 5589 | PKGDATA_DIR |
5002 | Points to a shared, global-state directory that holds data generated | 5590 | Points to a shared, global-state directory that holds data generated |
5003 | during the packaging process. During the packaging process, the | 5591 | during the packaging process. During the packaging process, the |
5004 | :ref:`ref-tasks-packagedata` task packages data | 5592 | :ref:`ref-tasks-packagedata` task packages data |
5005 | for each recipe and installs it into this temporary, shared area. | 5593 | for each recipe and installs it into this temporary, shared area. |
5006 | This directory defaults to the following, which you should not | 5594 | This directory defaults to the following, which you should not |
5007 | change: ${STAGING_DIR_HOST}/pkgdata For examples of how this data is | 5595 | change: |
5008 | used, see the "`Automatically Added Runtime | 5596 | :: |
5009 | Dependencies <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#automatically-added-runtime-dependencies>`__" | 5597 | |
5598 | ${STAGING_DIR_HOST}/pkgdata | ||
5599 | |||
5600 | For examples of how this data is used, see the | ||
5601 | ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`" | ||
5010 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual and the | 5602 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual and the |
5011 | "`Viewing Package Information with | 5603 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:viewing package information with \`\`oe-pkgdata-util\`\``" |
5012 | ``oe-pkgdata-util`` <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#viewing-package-information-with-oe-pkgdata-util>`__" | ||
5013 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. For more | 5604 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. For more |
5014 | information on the shared, global-state directory, see | 5605 | information on the shared, global-state directory, see |
5015 | :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`. | 5606 | :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`. |
5016 | 5607 | ||
5017 | PKGDEST | 5608 | PKGDEST |
5018 | Points to the parent directory for files to be packaged after they | 5609 | Points to the parent directory for files to be packaged after they |
5019 | have been split into individual packages. This directory defaults to | 5610 | have been split into individual packages. This directory defaults to |
5020 | the following: ${WORKDIR}/packages-split | 5611 | the following: |
5021 | 5612 | :: | |
5613 | |||
5614 | ${WORKDIR}/packages-split | ||
5615 | |||
5022 | Under this directory, the build system creates directories for each | 5616 | Under this directory, the build system creates directories for each |
5023 | package specified in :term:`PACKAGES`. Do not change | 5617 | package specified in :term:`PACKAGES`. Do not change |
5024 | this default. | 5618 | this default. |
5025 | 5619 | ||
5026 | PKGDESTWORK | 5620 | PKGDESTWORK |
5027 | Points to a temporary work area where the | 5621 | Points to a temporary work area where the |
5028 | :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task saves package metadata. | 5622 | :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task saves package metadata. |
5029 | The ``PKGDESTWORK`` location defaults to the following: | 5623 | The ``PKGDESTWORK`` location defaults to the following: |
5030 | ${WORKDIR}/pkgdata Do not change this default. | 5624 | :: |
5031 | 5625 | ||
5626 | ${WORKDIR}/pkgdata | ||
5627 | |||
5628 | Do not change this default. | ||
5629 | |||
5032 | The :ref:`ref-tasks-packagedata` task copies the | 5630 | The :ref:`ref-tasks-packagedata` task copies the |
5033 | package metadata from ``PKGDESTWORK`` to | 5631 | package metadata from ``PKGDESTWORK`` to |
5034 | :term:`PKGDATA_DIR` to make it available globally. | 5632 | :term:`PKGDATA_DIR` to make it available globally. |
5035 | 5633 | ||
5036 | PKGE | 5634 | PKGE |
5037 | The epoch of the package(s) built by the recipe. By default, ``PKGE`` | 5635 | The epoch of the package(s) built by the recipe. By default, ``PKGE`` |
5038 | is set to :term:`PE`. | 5636 | is set to :term:`PE`. |
5039 | 5637 | ||
5040 | PKGR | 5638 | PKGR |
5041 | The revision of the package(s) built by the recipe. By default, | 5639 | The revision of the package(s) built by the recipe. By default, |
5042 | ``PKGR`` is set to :term:`PR`. | 5640 | ``PKGR`` is set to :term:`PR`. |
5043 | 5641 | ||
5044 | PKGV | 5642 | PKGV |
5045 | The version of the package(s) built by the recipe. By default, | 5643 | The version of the package(s) built by the recipe. By default, |
5046 | ``PKGV`` is set to :term:`PV`. | 5644 | ``PKGV`` is set to :term:`PV`. |
5047 | 5645 | ||
5048 | PN | 5646 | PN |
5049 | This variable can have two separate functions depending on the | 5647 | This variable can have two separate functions depending on the |
5050 | context: a recipe name or a resulting package name. | 5648 | context: a recipe name or a resulting package name. |
5051 | 5649 | ||
5052 | ``PN`` refers to a recipe name in the context of a file used by the | 5650 | ``PN`` refers to a recipe name in the context of a file used by the |
5053 | OpenEmbedded build system as input to create a package. The name is | 5651 | OpenEmbedded build system as input to create a package. The name is |
5054 | normally extracted from the recipe file name. For example, if the | 5652 | normally extracted from the recipe file name. For example, if the |
5055 | recipe is named ``expat_2.0.1.bb``, then the default value of ``PN`` | 5653 | recipe is named ``expat_2.0.1.bb``, then the default value of ``PN`` |
5056 | will be "expat". | 5654 | will be "expat". |
5057 | 5655 | ||
5058 | The variable refers to a package name in the context of a file | 5656 | The variable refers to a package name in the context of a file |
5059 | created or produced by the OpenEmbedded build system. | 5657 | created or produced by the OpenEmbedded build system. |
5060 | 5658 | ||
5061 | If applicable, the ``PN`` variable also contains any special suffix | 5659 | If applicable, the ``PN`` variable also contains any special suffix |
5062 | or prefix. For example, using ``bash`` to build packages for the | 5660 | or prefix. For example, using ``bash`` to build packages for the |
5063 | native machine, ``PN`` is ``bash-native``. Using ``bash`` to build | 5661 | native machine, ``PN`` is ``bash-native``. Using ``bash`` to build |
5064 | packages for the target and for Multilib, ``PN`` would be ``bash`` | 5662 | packages for the target and for Multilib, ``PN`` would be ``bash`` |
5065 | and ``lib64-bash``, respectively. | 5663 | and ``lib64-bash``, respectively. |
5066 | 5664 | ||
5067 | PNBLACKLIST | 5665 | PNBLACKLIST |
5068 | Lists recipes you do not want the OpenEmbedded build system to build. | 5666 | Lists recipes you do not want the OpenEmbedded build system to build. |
5069 | This variable works in conjunction with the | 5667 | This variable works in conjunction with the |
5070 | :ref:`blacklist <ref-classes-blacklist>` class, which is inherited | 5668 | :ref:`blacklist <ref-classes-blacklist>` class, which is inherited |
5071 | globally. | 5669 | globally. |
5072 | 5670 | ||
5073 | To prevent a recipe from being built, use the ``PNBLACKLIST`` | 5671 | To prevent a recipe from being built, use the ``PNBLACKLIST`` |
5074 | variable in your ``local.conf`` file. Here is an example that | 5672 | variable in your ``local.conf`` file. Here is an example that |
5075 | prevents ``myrecipe`` from being built: PNBLACKLIST[myrecipe] = "Not | 5673 | prevents ``myrecipe`` from being built: |
5076 | supported by our organization." | 5674 | :: |
5077 | 5675 | ||
5676 | PNBLACKLIST[myrecipe] = "Not supported by our organization." | ||
5677 | |||
5078 | POPULATE_SDK_POST_HOST_COMMAND | 5678 | POPULATE_SDK_POST_HOST_COMMAND |
5079 | Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build | 5679 | Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build |
5080 | system has created the host part of the SDK. You can specify | 5680 | system has created the host part of the SDK. You can specify |
5081 | functions separated by semicolons: POPULATE_SDK_POST_HOST_COMMAND += | 5681 | functions separated by semicolons: |
5082 | "function; ... " | 5682 | :: |
5083 | 5683 | ||
5684 | POPULATE_SDK_POST_HOST_COMMAND += "function; ... " | ||
5685 | |||
5084 | If you need to pass the SDK path to a command within a function, you | 5686 | If you need to pass the SDK path to a command within a function, you |
5085 | can use ``${SDK_DIR}``, which points to the parent directory used by | 5687 | can use ``${SDK_DIR}``, which points to the parent directory used by |
5086 | the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK output. See the | 5688 | the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK output. See the |
5087 | :term:`SDK_DIR` variable for more information. | 5689 | :term:`SDK_DIR` variable for more information. |
5088 | 5690 | ||
5089 | POPULATE_SDK_POST_TARGET_COMMAND | 5691 | POPULATE_SDK_POST_TARGET_COMMAND |
5090 | Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build | 5692 | Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build |
5091 | system has created the target part of the SDK. You can specify | 5693 | system has created the target part of the SDK. You can specify |
5092 | functions separated by semicolons: POPULATE_SDK_POST_TARGET_COMMAND | 5694 | functions separated by semicolons: |
5093 | += "function; ... " | 5695 | :: |
5094 | 5696 | ||
5697 | POPULATE_SDK_POST_TARGET_COMMAND += "function; ... " | ||
5698 | |||
5095 | If you need to pass the SDK path to a command within a function, you | 5699 | If you need to pass the SDK path to a command within a function, you |
5096 | can use ``${SDK_DIR}``, which points to the parent directory used by | 5700 | can use ``${SDK_DIR}``, which points to the parent directory used by |
5097 | the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK output. See the | 5701 | the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK output. See the |
5098 | :term:`SDK_DIR` variable for more information. | 5702 | :term:`SDK_DIR` variable for more information. |
5099 | 5703 | ||
5100 | PR | 5704 | PR |
5101 | The revision of the recipe. The default value for this variable is | 5705 | The revision of the recipe. The default value for this variable is |
5102 | "r0". Subsequent revisions of the recipe conventionally have the | 5706 | "r0". Subsequent revisions of the recipe conventionally have the |
5103 | values "r1", "r2", and so forth. When :term:`PV` increases, | 5707 | values "r1", "r2", and so forth. When :term:`PV` increases, |
5104 | ``PR`` is conventionally reset to "r0". | 5708 | ``PR`` is conventionally reset to "r0". |
5105 | 5709 | ||
5106 | .. note:: | 5710 | .. note:: |
5107 | 5711 | ||
5108 | The OpenEmbedded build system does not need the aid of | 5712 | The OpenEmbedded build system does not need the aid of |
5109 | PR | 5713 | PR |
5110 | to know when to rebuild a recipe. The build system uses the task | 5714 | to know when to rebuild a recipe. The build system uses the task |
@@ -5114,7 +5718,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5114 | and | 5718 | and |
5115 | shared state cache | 5719 | shared state cache |
5116 | mechanisms. | 5720 | mechanisms. |
5117 | 5721 | ||
5118 | The ``PR`` variable primarily becomes significant when a package | 5722 | The ``PR`` variable primarily becomes significant when a package |
5119 | manager dynamically installs packages on an already built image. In | 5723 | manager dynamically installs packages on an already built image. In |
5120 | this case, ``PR``, which is the default value of | 5724 | this case, ``PR``, which is the default value of |
@@ -5124,37 +5728,45 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5124 | the same ``PV`` usually means that the packages all install the same | 5728 | the same ``PV`` usually means that the packages all install the same |
5125 | upstream version, but with later (``PR``) version packages including | 5729 | upstream version, but with later (``PR``) version packages including |
5126 | packaging fixes. | 5730 | packaging fixes. |
5127 | 5731 | ||
5128 | .. note:: | 5732 | .. note:: |
5129 | 5733 | ||
5130 | PR | 5734 | PR |
5131 | does not need to be increased for changes that do not change the | 5735 | does not need to be increased for changes that do not change the |
5132 | package contents or metadata. | 5736 | package contents or metadata. |
5133 | 5737 | ||
5134 | Because manually managing ``PR`` can be cumbersome and error-prone, | 5738 | Because manually managing ``PR`` can be cumbersome and error-prone, |
5135 | an automated solution exists. See the "`Working With a PR | 5739 | an automated solution exists. See the |
5136 | Service <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#working-with-a-pr-service>`__" section | 5740 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:working with a pr service`" section |
5137 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more information. | 5741 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more information. |
5138 | 5742 | ||
5139 | PREFERRED_PROVIDER | 5743 | PREFERRED_PROVIDER |
5140 | If multiple recipes provide the same item, this variable determines | 5744 | If multiple recipes provide the same item, this variable determines |
5141 | which recipe is preferred and thus provides the item (i.e. the | 5745 | which recipe is preferred and thus provides the item (i.e. the |
5142 | preferred provider). You should always suffix this variable with the | 5746 | preferred provider). You should always suffix this variable with the |
5143 | name of the provided item. And, you should define the variable using | 5747 | name of the provided item. And, you should define the variable using |
5144 | the preferred recipe's name (:term:`PN`). Here is a common | 5748 | the preferred recipe's name (:term:`PN`). Here is a common |
5145 | example: PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/kernel ?= "linux-yocto" In the | 5749 | example: |
5146 | previous example, multiple recipes are providing "virtual/kernel". | 5750 | :: |
5751 | |||
5752 | PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/kernel ?= "linux-yocto" | ||
5753 | |||
5754 | In the previous example, multiple recipes are providing "virtual/kernel". | ||
5147 | The ``PREFERRED_PROVIDER`` variable is set with the name (``PN``) of | 5755 | The ``PREFERRED_PROVIDER`` variable is set with the name (``PN``) of |
5148 | the recipe you prefer to provide "virtual/kernel". | 5756 | the recipe you prefer to provide "virtual/kernel". |
5149 | 5757 | ||
5150 | Following are more examples: PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/xserver = | 5758 | Following are more examples: |
5151 | "xserver-xf86" PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/libgl ?= "mesa" For more | 5759 | :: |
5152 | information, see the "`Using Virtual | 5760 | |
5153 | Providers <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#metadata-virtual-providers>`__" | 5761 | PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/xserver = "xserver-xf86" |
5762 | PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/libgl ?= "mesa" | ||
5763 | |||
5764 | For more | ||
5765 | information, see the ":ref:`metadata-virtual-providers`" | ||
5154 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 5766 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
5155 | 5767 | ||
5156 | .. note:: | 5768 | .. note:: |
5157 | 5769 | ||
5158 | If you use a | 5770 | If you use a |
5159 | virtual/\* | 5771 | virtual/\* |
5160 | item with | 5772 | item with |
@@ -5166,56 +5778,69 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5166 | is prevented from building, which is usually desirable since this | 5778 | is prevented from building, which is usually desirable since this |
5167 | mechanism is designed to select between mutually exclusive | 5779 | mechanism is designed to select between mutually exclusive |
5168 | alternative providers. | 5780 | alternative providers. |
5169 | 5781 | ||
5170 | PREFERRED_VERSION | 5782 | PREFERRED_VERSION |
5171 | If multiple versions of recipes exist, this variable determines which | 5783 | If multiple versions of recipes exist, this variable determines which |
5172 | version is given preference. You must always suffix the variable with | 5784 | version is given preference. You must always suffix the variable with |
5173 | the :term:`PN` you want to select, and you should set the | 5785 | the :term:`PN` you want to select, and you should set the |
5174 | :term:`PV` accordingly for precedence. | 5786 | :term:`PV` accordingly for precedence. |
5175 | 5787 | ||
5176 | The ``PREFERRED_VERSION`` variable supports limited wildcard use | 5788 | The ``PREFERRED_VERSION`` variable supports limited wildcard use |
5177 | through the "``%``" character. You can use the character to match any | 5789 | through the "``%``" character. You can use the character to match any |
5178 | number of characters, which can be useful when specifying versions | 5790 | number of characters, which can be useful when specifying versions |
5179 | that contain long revision numbers that potentially change. Here are | 5791 | that contain long revision numbers that potentially change. Here are |
5180 | two examples: PREFERRED_VERSION_python = "3.4.0" | 5792 | two examples: |
5181 | PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto = "5.0%" | 5793 | :: |
5182 | 5794 | ||
5795 | PREFERRED_VERSION_python = "3.4.0" | ||
5796 | PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto = "5.0%" | ||
5797 | |||
5183 | .. note:: | 5798 | .. note:: |
5184 | 5799 | ||
5185 | The use of the " | 5800 | The use of the "%" character is limited in that it only works at the end of the |
5186 | % | ||
5187 | " character is limited in that it only works at the end of the | ||
5188 | string. You cannot use the wildcard character in any other | 5801 | string. You cannot use the wildcard character in any other |
5189 | location of the string. | 5802 | location of the string. |
5190 | 5803 | ||
5191 | The specified version is matched against :term:`PV`, which | 5804 | The specified version is matched against :term:`PV`, which |
5192 | does not necessarily match the version part of the recipe's filename. | 5805 | does not necessarily match the version part of the recipe's filename. |
5193 | For example, consider two recipes ``foo_1.2.bb`` and ``foo_git.bb`` | 5806 | For example, consider two recipes ``foo_1.2.bb`` and ``foo_git.bb`` |
5194 | where ``foo_git.bb`` contains the following assignment: PV = | 5807 | where ``foo_git.bb`` contains the following assignment: |
5195 | "1.1+git${SRCPV}" In this case, the correct way to select | 5808 | :: |
5809 | |||
5810 | PV = "1.1+git${SRCPV}" | ||
5811 | |||
5812 | In this case, the correct way to select | ||
5196 | ``foo_git.bb`` is by using an assignment such as the following: | 5813 | ``foo_git.bb`` is by using an assignment such as the following: |
5197 | PREFERRED_VERSION_foo = "1.1+git%" Compare that previous example | 5814 | :: |
5815 | |||
5816 | PREFERRED_VERSION_foo = "1.1+git%" | ||
5817 | |||
5818 | Compare that previous example | ||
5198 | against the following incorrect example, which does not work: | 5819 | against the following incorrect example, which does not work: |
5199 | PREFERRED_VERSION_foo = "git" | 5820 | :: |
5200 | 5821 | ||
5822 | PREFERRED_VERSION_foo = "git" | ||
5823 | |||
5201 | Sometimes the ``PREFERRED_VERSION`` variable can be set by | 5824 | Sometimes the ``PREFERRED_VERSION`` variable can be set by |
5202 | configuration files in a way that is hard to change. You can use | 5825 | configuration files in a way that is hard to change. You can use |
5203 | :term:`OVERRIDES` to set a machine-specific | 5826 | :term:`OVERRIDES` to set a machine-specific |
5204 | override. Here is an example: PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto_qemux86 = | 5827 | override. Here is an example: |
5205 | "5.0%" Although not recommended, worst case, you can also use the | 5828 | :: |
5829 | |||
5830 | PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto_qemux86 = "5.0%" | ||
5831 | |||
5832 | Although not recommended, worst case, you can also use the | ||
5206 | "forcevariable" override, which is the strongest override possible. | 5833 | "forcevariable" override, which is the strongest override possible. |
5207 | Here is an example: PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto_forcevariable = | 5834 | Here is an example: |
5208 | "5.0%" | 5835 | :: |
5209 | 5836 | ||
5837 | PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto_forcevariable = "5.0%" | ||
5838 | |||
5210 | .. note:: | 5839 | .. note:: |
5211 | 5840 | ||
5212 | The | 5841 | The \_forcevariable override is not handled specially. This override |
5213 | \_forcevariable | 5842 | only works because the default value of OVERRIDES includes "forcevariable". |
5214 | override is not handled specially. This override only works | 5843 | |
5215 | because the default value of | ||
5216 | OVERRIDES | ||
5217 | includes "forcevariable". | ||
5218 | |||
5219 | PREMIRRORS | 5844 | PREMIRRORS |
5220 | Specifies additional paths from which the OpenEmbedded build system | 5845 | Specifies additional paths from which the OpenEmbedded build system |
5221 | gets source code. When the build system searches for source code, it | 5846 | gets source code. When the build system searches for source code, it |
@@ -5223,35 +5848,40 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5223 | build system tries locations defined by ``PREMIRRORS``, the upstream | 5848 | build system tries locations defined by ``PREMIRRORS``, the upstream |
5224 | source, and then locations specified by | 5849 | source, and then locations specified by |
5225 | :term:`MIRRORS` in that order. | 5850 | :term:`MIRRORS` in that order. |
5226 | 5851 | ||
5227 | Assuming your distribution (:term:`DISTRO`) is "poky", | 5852 | Assuming your distribution (:term:`DISTRO`) is "poky", |
5228 | the default value for ``PREMIRRORS`` is defined in the | 5853 | the default value for ``PREMIRRORS`` is defined in the |
5229 | ``conf/distro/poky.conf`` file in the ``meta-poky`` Git repository. | 5854 | ``conf/distro/poky.conf`` file in the ``meta-poky`` Git repository. |
5230 | 5855 | ||
5231 | Typically, you could add a specific server for the build system to | 5856 | Typically, you could add a specific server for the build system to |
5232 | attempt before any others by adding something like the following to | 5857 | attempt before any others by adding something like the following to |
5233 | the ``local.conf`` configuration file in the | 5858 | the ``local.conf`` configuration file in the |
5234 | :term:`Build Directory`: PREMIRRORS_prepend = "\\ | 5859 | :term:`Build Directory`: |
5235 | git://.*/.\* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \\n \\ ftp://.*/.\* | 5860 | :: |
5236 | http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \\n \\ http://.*/.\* | 5861 | |
5237 | http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \\n \\ https://.*/.\* | 5862 | PREMIRRORS_prepend = "\ |
5238 | http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \\n" These changes cause the | 5863 | git://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n \ |
5864 | ftp://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n \ | ||
5865 | http://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n \ | ||
5866 | https://.*/.* http://www.yoctoproject.org/sources/ \n" | ||
5867 | |||
5868 | These changes cause the | ||
5239 | build system to intercept Git, FTP, HTTP, and HTTPS requests and | 5869 | build system to intercept Git, FTP, HTTP, and HTTPS requests and |
5240 | direct them to the ``http://`` sources mirror. You can use | 5870 | direct them to the ``http://`` sources mirror. You can use |
5241 | ``file://`` URLs to point to local directories or network shares as | 5871 | ``file://`` URLs to point to local directories or network shares as |
5242 | well. | 5872 | well. |
5243 | 5873 | ||
5244 | PRIORITY | 5874 | PRIORITY |
5245 | Indicates the importance of a package. | 5875 | Indicates the importance of a package. |
5246 | 5876 | ||
5247 | ``PRIORITY`` is considered to be part of the distribution policy | 5877 | ``PRIORITY`` is considered to be part of the distribution policy |
5248 | because the importance of any given recipe depends on the purpose for | 5878 | because the importance of any given recipe depends on the purpose for |
5249 | which the distribution is being produced. Thus, ``PRIORITY`` is not | 5879 | which the distribution is being produced. Thus, ``PRIORITY`` is not |
5250 | normally set within recipes. | 5880 | normally set within recipes. |
5251 | 5881 | ||
5252 | You can set ``PRIORITY`` to "required", "standard", "extra", and | 5882 | You can set ``PRIORITY`` to "required", "standard", "extra", and |
5253 | "optional", which is the default. | 5883 | "optional", which is the default. |
5254 | 5884 | ||
5255 | PRIVATE_LIBS | 5885 | PRIVATE_LIBS |
5256 | Specifies libraries installed within a recipe that should be ignored | 5886 | Specifies libraries installed within a recipe that should be ignored |
5257 | by the OpenEmbedded build system's shared library resolver. This | 5887 | by the OpenEmbedded build system's shared library resolver. This |
@@ -5261,16 +5891,23 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5261 | private libraries to be set as a dependency on other unrelated | 5891 | private libraries to be set as a dependency on other unrelated |
5262 | packages that should instead depend on the package providing the | 5892 | packages that should instead depend on the package providing the |
5263 | standard version of the library. | 5893 | standard version of the library. |
5264 | 5894 | ||
5265 | Libraries specified in this variable should be specified by their | 5895 | Libraries specified in this variable should be specified by their |
5266 | file name. For example, from the Firefox recipe in meta-browser: | 5896 | file name. For example, from the Firefox recipe in meta-browser: |
5267 | PRIVATE_LIBS = "libmozjs.so \\ libxpcom.so \\ libnspr4.so \\ | 5897 | :: |
5268 | libxul.so \\ libmozalloc.so \\ libplc4.so \\ libplds4.so" | 5898 | |
5269 | 5899 | PRIVATE_LIBS = "libmozjs.so \ | |
5270 | For more information, see the "`Automatically Added Runtime | 5900 | libxpcom.so \ |
5271 | Dependencies <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#automatically-added-runtime-dependencies>`__" | 5901 | libnspr4.so \ |
5902 | libxul.so \ | ||
5903 | libmozalloc.so \ | ||
5904 | libplc4.so \ | ||
5905 | libplds4.so" | ||
5906 | |||
5907 | For more information, see the | ||
5908 | ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`" | ||
5272 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. | 5909 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. |
5273 | 5910 | ||
5274 | PROVIDES | 5911 | PROVIDES |
5275 | A list of aliases by which a particular recipe can be known. By | 5912 | A list of aliases by which a particular recipe can be known. By |
5276 | default, a recipe's own ``PN`` is implicitly already in its | 5913 | default, a recipe's own ``PN`` is implicitly already in its |
@@ -5279,13 +5916,18 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5279 | aliases are synonyms for the recipe and can be useful for satisfying | 5916 | aliases are synonyms for the recipe and can be useful for satisfying |
5280 | dependencies of other recipes during the build as specified by | 5917 | dependencies of other recipes during the build as specified by |
5281 | ``DEPENDS``. | 5918 | ``DEPENDS``. |
5282 | 5919 | ||
5283 | Consider the following example ``PROVIDES`` statement from the recipe | 5920 | Consider the following example ``PROVIDES`` statement from the recipe |
5284 | file ``eudev_3.2.9.bb``: PROVIDES = "udev" The ``PROVIDES`` statement | 5921 | file ``eudev_3.2.9.bb``: |
5922 | :: | ||
5923 | |||
5924 | PROVIDES = "udev" | ||
5925 | |||
5926 | The ``PROVIDES`` statement | ||
5285 | results in the "eudev" recipe also being available as simply "udev". | 5927 | results in the "eudev" recipe also being available as simply "udev". |
5286 | 5928 | ||
5287 | .. note:: | 5929 | .. note:: |
5288 | 5930 | ||
5289 | Given that a recipe's own recipe name is already implicitly in its | 5931 | Given that a recipe's own recipe name is already implicitly in its |
5290 | own | 5932 | own |
5291 | PROVIDES | 5933 | PROVIDES |
@@ -5293,12 +5935,12 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5293 | using a simple assignment will be sufficient. In other words, | 5935 | using a simple assignment will be sufficient. In other words, |
5294 | while you could write: | 5936 | while you could write: |
5295 | :: | 5937 | :: |
5296 | 5938 | ||
5297 | PROVIDES += "udev" | 5939 | PROVIDES += "udev" |
5298 | 5940 | ||
5299 | 5941 | ||
5300 | in the above, the "+=" is overkill and unnecessary. | 5942 | in the above, the "+=" is overkill and unnecessary. |
5301 | 5943 | ||
5302 | In addition to providing recipes under alternate names, the | 5944 | In addition to providing recipes under alternate names, the |
5303 | ``PROVIDES`` mechanism is also used to implement virtual targets. A | 5945 | ``PROVIDES`` mechanism is also used to implement virtual targets. A |
5304 | virtual target is a name that corresponds to some particular | 5946 | virtual target is a name that corresponds to some particular |
@@ -5306,48 +5948,52 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5306 | functionality in question list the virtual target in ``PROVIDES``. | 5948 | functionality in question list the virtual target in ``PROVIDES``. |
5307 | Recipes that depend on the functionality in question can include the | 5949 | Recipes that depend on the functionality in question can include the |
5308 | virtual target in ``DEPENDS`` to leave the choice of provider open. | 5950 | virtual target in ``DEPENDS`` to leave the choice of provider open. |
5309 | 5951 | ||
5310 | Conventionally, virtual targets have names on the form | 5952 | Conventionally, virtual targets have names on the form |
5311 | "virtual/function" (e.g. "virtual/kernel"). The slash is simply part | 5953 | "virtual/function" (e.g. "virtual/kernel"). The slash is simply part |
5312 | of the name and has no syntactical significance. | 5954 | of the name and has no syntactical significance. |
5313 | 5955 | ||
5314 | The :term:`PREFERRED_PROVIDER` variable is | 5956 | The :term:`PREFERRED_PROVIDER` variable is |
5315 | used to select which particular recipe provides a virtual target. | 5957 | used to select which particular recipe provides a virtual target. |
5316 | 5958 | ||
5317 | .. note:: | 5959 | .. note:: |
5318 | 5960 | ||
5319 | A corresponding mechanism for virtual runtime dependencies | 5961 | A corresponding mechanism for virtual runtime dependencies |
5320 | (packages) exists. However, the mechanism does not depend on any | 5962 | (packages) exists. However, the mechanism does not depend on any |
5321 | special functionality beyond ordinary variable assignments. For | 5963 | special functionality beyond ordinary variable assignments. For |
5322 | example, ``VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager`` refers to the package of | 5964 | example, ``VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager`` refers to the package of |
5323 | the component that manages the ``/dev`` directory. | 5965 | the component that manages the ``/dev`` directory. |
5324 | 5966 | ||
5325 | Setting the "preferred provider" for runtime dependencies is as | 5967 | Setting the "preferred provider" for runtime dependencies is as |
5326 | simple as using the following assignment in a configuration file: | 5968 | simple as using the following assignment in a configuration file: |
5327 | |||
5328 | :: | 5969 | :: |
5329 | 5970 | ||
5330 | VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager = "udev" | 5971 | VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager = "udev" |
5331 | 5972 | ||
5332 | 5973 | ||
5333 | PRSERV_HOST | 5974 | PRSERV_HOST |
5334 | The network based :term:`PR` service host and port. | 5975 | The network based :term:`PR` service host and port. |
5335 | 5976 | ||
5336 | The ``conf/local.conf.sample.extended`` configuration file in the | 5977 | The ``conf/local.conf.sample.extended`` configuration file in the |
5337 | :term:`Source Directory` shows how the | 5978 | :term:`Source Directory` shows how the |
5338 | ``PRSERV_HOST`` variable is set: PRSERV_HOST = "localhost:0" You must | 5979 | ``PRSERV_HOST`` variable is set: |
5339 | set the variable if you want to automatically start a local `PR | 5980 | :: |
5340 | service <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#working-with-a-pr-service>`__. You can | 5981 | |
5982 | PRSERV_HOST = "localhost:0" | ||
5983 | |||
5984 | You must | ||
5985 | set the variable if you want to automatically start a local :ref:`PR | ||
5986 | service <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:working with a pr service>`. You can | ||
5341 | set ``PRSERV_HOST`` to other values to use a remote PR service. | 5987 | set ``PRSERV_HOST`` to other values to use a remote PR service. |
5342 | 5988 | ||
5343 | PTEST_ENABLED | 5989 | PTEST_ENABLED |
5344 | Specifies whether or not `Package | 5990 | Specifies whether or not :ref:`Package |
5345 | Test <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#testing-packages-with-ptest>`__ (ptest) | 5991 | Test <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:testing packages with ptest>` (ptest) |
5346 | functionality is enabled when building a recipe. You should not set | 5992 | functionality is enabled when building a recipe. You should not set |
5347 | this variable directly. Enabling and disabling building Package Tests | 5993 | this variable directly. Enabling and disabling building Package Tests |
5348 | at build time should be done by adding "ptest" to (or removing it | 5994 | at build time should be done by adding "ptest" to (or removing it |
5349 | from) :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`. | 5995 | from) :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`. |
5350 | 5996 | ||
5351 | PV | 5997 | PV |
5352 | The version of the recipe. The version is normally extracted from the | 5998 | The version of the recipe. The version is normally extracted from the |
5353 | recipe filename. For example, if the recipe is named | 5999 | recipe filename. For example, if the recipe is named |
@@ -5355,9 +6001,9 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5355 | ``PV`` is generally not overridden within a recipe unless it is | 6001 | ``PV`` is generally not overridden within a recipe unless it is |
5356 | building an unstable (i.e. development) version from a source code | 6002 | building an unstable (i.e. development) version from a source code |
5357 | repository (e.g. Git or Subversion). | 6003 | repository (e.g. Git or Subversion). |
5358 | 6004 | ||
5359 | ``PV`` is the default value of the :term:`PKGV` variable. | 6005 | ``PV`` is the default value of the :term:`PKGV` variable. |
5360 | 6006 | ||
5361 | PYTHON_ABI | 6007 | PYTHON_ABI |
5362 | When used by recipes that inherit the | 6008 | When used by recipes that inherit the |
5363 | :ref:`distutils3 <ref-classes-distutils3>`, | 6009 | :ref:`distutils3 <ref-classes-distutils3>`, |
@@ -5367,15 +6013,15 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5367 | Application Binary Interface (ABI) currently in use for Python. By | 6013 | Application Binary Interface (ABI) currently in use for Python. By |
5368 | default, the ABI is "m". You do not have to set this variable as the | 6014 | default, the ABI is "m". You do not have to set this variable as the |
5369 | OpenEmbedded build system sets it for you. | 6015 | OpenEmbedded build system sets it for you. |
5370 | 6016 | ||
5371 | The OpenEmbedded build system uses the ABI to construct directory | 6017 | The OpenEmbedded build system uses the ABI to construct directory |
5372 | names used when installing the Python headers and libraries in | 6018 | names used when installing the Python headers and libraries in |
5373 | sysroot (e.g. ``.../python3.3m/...``). | 6019 | sysroot (e.g. ``.../python3.3m/...``). |
5374 | 6020 | ||
5375 | Recipes that inherit the ``distutils`` class during cross-builds also | 6021 | Recipes that inherit the ``distutils`` class during cross-builds also |
5376 | use this variable to locate the headers and libraries of the | 6022 | use this variable to locate the headers and libraries of the |
5377 | appropriate Python that the extension is targeting. | 6023 | appropriate Python that the extension is targeting. |
5378 | 6024 | ||
5379 | PYTHON_PN | 6025 | PYTHON_PN |
5380 | When used by recipes that inherit the | 6026 | When used by recipes that inherit the |
5381 | `distutils3 <ref-classes-distutils3>`, | 6027 | `distutils3 <ref-classes-distutils3>`, |
@@ -5385,43 +6031,62 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5385 | major Python version being built. For Python 3.x, ``PYTHON_PN`` would | 6031 | major Python version being built. For Python 3.x, ``PYTHON_PN`` would |
5386 | be "python3". You do not have to set this variable as the | 6032 | be "python3". You do not have to set this variable as the |
5387 | OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets it for you. | 6033 | OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets it for you. |
5388 | 6034 | ||
5389 | The variable allows recipes to use common infrastructure such as the | 6035 | The variable allows recipes to use common infrastructure such as the |
5390 | following: DEPENDS += "${PYTHON_PN}-native" In the previous example, | 6036 | following: |
6037 | :: | ||
6038 | |||
6039 | DEPENDS += "${PYTHON_PN}-native" | ||
6040 | |||
6041 | In the previous example, | ||
5391 | the version of the dependency is ``PYTHON_PN``. | 6042 | the version of the dependency is ``PYTHON_PN``. |
5392 | 6043 | ||
5393 | RANLIB | 6044 | RANLIB |
5394 | The minimal command and arguments to run ``ranlib``. | 6045 | The minimal command and arguments to run ``ranlib``. |
5395 | 6046 | ||
5396 | RCONFLICTS | 6047 | RCONFLICTS |
5397 | The list of packages that conflict with packages. Note that packages | 6048 | The list of packages that conflict with packages. Note that packages |
5398 | will not be installed if conflicting packages are not first removed. | 6049 | will not be installed if conflicting packages are not first removed. |
5399 | 6050 | ||
5400 | Like all package-controlling variables, you must always use them in | 6051 | Like all package-controlling variables, you must always use them in |
5401 | conjunction with a package name override. Here is an example: | 6052 | conjunction with a package name override. Here is an example: |
5402 | RCONFLICTS_${PN} = "another_conflicting_package_name" | 6053 | :: |
5403 | 6054 | ||
6055 | RCONFLICTS_${PN} = "another_conflicting_package_name" | ||
6056 | |||
5404 | BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports | 6057 | BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports |
5405 | specifying versioned dependencies. Although the syntax varies | 6058 | specifying versioned dependencies. Although the syntax varies |
5406 | depending on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences | 6059 | depending on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences |
5407 | from you. Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the | 6060 | from you. Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the |
5408 | ``RCONFLICTS`` variable: RCONFLICTS_${PN} = "package (operator | 6061 | ``RCONFLICTS`` variable: |
5409 | version)" For ``operator``, you can specify the following: = < > <= | 6062 | :: |
6063 | |||
6064 | RCONFLICTS_${PN} = "package (operator version)" | ||
6065 | |||
6066 | For ``operator``, you can specify the following: = < > <= | ||
5410 | >= For example, the following sets up a dependency on version 1.2 or | 6067 | >= For example, the following sets up a dependency on version 1.2 or |
5411 | greater of the package ``foo``: RCONFLICTS_${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)" | 6068 | greater of the package ``foo``: |
5412 | 6069 | :: | |
6070 | |||
6071 | RCONFLICTS_${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)" | ||
6072 | |||
5413 | RDEPENDS | 6073 | RDEPENDS |
5414 | Lists runtime dependencies of a package. These dependencies are other | 6074 | Lists runtime dependencies of a package. These dependencies are other |
5415 | packages that must be installed in order for the package to function | 6075 | packages that must be installed in order for the package to function |
5416 | correctly. As an example, the following assignment declares that the | 6076 | correctly. As an example, the following assignment declares that the |
5417 | package ``foo`` needs the packages ``bar`` and ``baz`` to be | 6077 | package ``foo`` needs the packages ``bar`` and ``baz`` to be |
5418 | installed: RDEPENDS_foo = "bar baz" The most common types of package | 6078 | installed: |
6079 | :: | ||
6080 | |||
6081 | RDEPENDS_foo = "bar baz" | ||
6082 | |||
6083 | The most common types of package | ||
5419 | runtime dependencies are automatically detected and added. Therefore, | 6084 | runtime dependencies are automatically detected and added. Therefore, |
5420 | most recipes do not need to set ``RDEPENDS``. For more information, | 6085 | most recipes do not need to set ``RDEPENDS``. For more information, |
5421 | see the "`Automatically Added Runtime | 6086 | see the |
5422 | Dependencies <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#automatically-added-runtime-dependencies>`__" | 6087 | ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`" |
5423 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. | 6088 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. |
5424 | 6089 | ||
5425 | The practical effect of the above ``RDEPENDS`` assignment is that | 6090 | The practical effect of the above ``RDEPENDS`` assignment is that |
5426 | ``bar`` and ``baz`` will be declared as dependencies inside the | 6091 | ``bar`` and ``baz`` will be declared as dependencies inside the |
5427 | package ``foo`` when it is written out by one of the | 6092 | package ``foo`` when it is written out by one of the |
@@ -5431,7 +6096,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5431 | :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`. When the | 6096 | :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`. When the |
5432 | corresponding package manager installs the package, it will know to | 6097 | corresponding package manager installs the package, it will know to |
5433 | also install the packages on which it depends. | 6098 | also install the packages on which it depends. |
5434 | 6099 | ||
5435 | To ensure that the packages ``bar`` and ``baz`` get built, the | 6100 | To ensure that the packages ``bar`` and ``baz`` get built, the |
5436 | previous ``RDEPENDS`` assignment also causes a task dependency to be | 6101 | previous ``RDEPENDS`` assignment also causes a task dependency to be |
5437 | added. This dependency is from the recipe's | 6102 | added. This dependency is from the recipe's |
@@ -5439,26 +6104,31 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5439 | :ref:`ref-tasks-compile`) task to the | 6104 | :ref:`ref-tasks-compile`) task to the |
5440 | ``do_package_write_*`` task of the recipes that build ``bar`` and | 6105 | ``do_package_write_*`` task of the recipes that build ``bar`` and |
5441 | ``baz``. | 6106 | ``baz``. |
5442 | 6107 | ||
5443 | The names of the packages you list within ``RDEPENDS`` must be the | 6108 | The names of the packages you list within ``RDEPENDS`` must be the |
5444 | names of other packages - they cannot be recipe names. Although | 6109 | names of other packages - they cannot be recipe names. Although |
5445 | package names and recipe names usually match, the important point | 6110 | package names and recipe names usually match, the important point |
5446 | here is that you are providing package names within the ``RDEPENDS`` | 6111 | here is that you are providing package names within the ``RDEPENDS`` |
5447 | variable. For an example of the default list of packages created from | 6112 | variable. For an example of the default list of packages created from |
5448 | a recipe, see the :term:`PACKAGES` variable. | 6113 | a recipe, see the :term:`PACKAGES` variable. |
5449 | 6114 | ||
5450 | Because the ``RDEPENDS`` variable applies to packages being built, | 6115 | Because the ``RDEPENDS`` variable applies to packages being built, |
5451 | you should always use the variable in a form with an attached package | 6116 | you should always use the variable in a form with an attached package |
5452 | name (remember that a single recipe can build multiple packages). For | 6117 | name (remember that a single recipe can build multiple packages). For |
5453 | example, suppose you are building a development package that depends | 6118 | example, suppose you are building a development package that depends |
5454 | on the ``perl`` package. In this case, you would use the following | 6119 | on the ``perl`` package. In this case, you would use the following |
5455 | ``RDEPENDS`` statement: RDEPENDS_${PN}-dev += "perl" In the example, | 6120 | ``RDEPENDS`` statement: |
6121 | :: | ||
6122 | |||
6123 | RDEPENDS_${PN}-dev += "perl" | ||
6124 | |||
6125 | In the example, | ||
5456 | the development package depends on the ``perl`` package. Thus, the | 6126 | the development package depends on the ``perl`` package. Thus, the |
5457 | ``RDEPENDS`` variable has the ``${PN}-dev`` package name as part of | 6127 | ``RDEPENDS`` variable has the ``${PN}-dev`` package name as part of |
5458 | the variable. | 6128 | the variable. |
5459 | 6129 | ||
5460 | .. note:: | 6130 | .. note:: |
5461 | 6131 | ||
5462 | RDEPENDS_${PN}-dev | 6132 | RDEPENDS_${PN}-dev |
5463 | includes | 6133 | includes |
5464 | ${ | 6134 | ${ |
@@ -5472,7 +6142,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5472 | when modifying | 6142 | when modifying |
5473 | RDEPENDS_${PN}-dev | 6143 | RDEPENDS_${PN}-dev |
5474 | . Use the "+=" operator rather than the "=" operator. | 6144 | . Use the "+=" operator rather than the "=" operator. |
5475 | 6145 | ||
5476 | The package names you use with ``RDEPENDS`` must appear as they would | 6146 | The package names you use with ``RDEPENDS`` must appear as they would |
5477 | in the ``PACKAGES`` variable. The :term:`PKG` variable | 6147 | in the ``PACKAGES`` variable. The :term:`PKG` variable |
5478 | allows a different name to be used for the final package (e.g. the | 6148 | allows a different name to be used for the final package (e.g. the |
@@ -5480,31 +6150,38 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5480 | packages), but this final package name cannot be used with | 6150 | packages), but this final package name cannot be used with |
5481 | ``RDEPENDS``, which makes sense as ``RDEPENDS`` is meant to be | 6151 | ``RDEPENDS``, which makes sense as ``RDEPENDS`` is meant to be |
5482 | independent of the package format used. | 6152 | independent of the package format used. |
5483 | 6153 | ||
5484 | BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports | 6154 | BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports |
5485 | specifying versioned dependencies. Although the syntax varies | 6155 | specifying versioned dependencies. Although the syntax varies |
5486 | depending on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences | 6156 | depending on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences |
5487 | from you. Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the | 6157 | from you. Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the |
5488 | ``RDEPENDS`` variable: RDEPENDS_${PN} = "package (operator version)" | 6158 | ``RDEPENDS`` variable: |
6159 | :: | ||
6160 | |||
6161 | RDEPENDS_${PN} = "package (operator version)" | ||
6162 | |||
5489 | For operator, you can specify the following: = < > <= >= For version, | 6163 | For operator, you can specify the following: = < > <= >= For version, |
5490 | provide the version number. | 6164 | provide the version number. |
5491 | 6165 | ||
5492 | .. note:: | 6166 | .. note:: |
5493 | 6167 | ||
5494 | You can use | 6168 | You can use |
5495 | EXTENDPKGV | 6169 | EXTENDPKGV |
5496 | to provide a full package version specification. | 6170 | to provide a full package version specification. |
5497 | 6171 | ||
5498 | For example, the following sets up a dependency on version 1.2 or | 6172 | For example, the following sets up a dependency on version 1.2 or |
5499 | greater of the package ``foo``: RDEPENDS_${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)" | 6173 | greater of the package ``foo``: |
5500 | 6174 | :: | |
6175 | |||
6176 | RDEPENDS_${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)" | ||
6177 | |||
5501 | For information on build-time dependencies, see the | 6178 | For information on build-time dependencies, see the |
5502 | :term:`DEPENDS` variable. You can also see the | 6179 | :term:`DEPENDS` variable. You can also see the |
5503 | ":ref:`Tasks <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:tasks>`" and | 6180 | ":ref:`Tasks <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:tasks>`" and |
5504 | ":ref:`Dependencies <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-execution:dependencies>`" sections in the | 6181 | ":ref:`Dependencies <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-execution:dependencies>`" sections in the |
5505 | BitBake User Manual for additional information on tasks and | 6182 | BitBake User Manual for additional information on tasks and |
5506 | dependencies. | 6183 | dependencies. |
5507 | 6184 | ||
5508 | REQUIRED_DISTRO_FEATURES | 6185 | REQUIRED_DISTRO_FEATURES |
5509 | When inheriting the | 6186 | When inheriting the |
5510 | :ref:`distro_features_check <ref-classes-distro_features_check>` | 6187 | :ref:`distro_features_check <ref-classes-distro_features_check>` |
@@ -5514,115 +6191,136 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5514 | ``REQUIRED_DISTRO_FEATURES`` variable lists a feature that does not | 6191 | ``REQUIRED_DISTRO_FEATURES`` variable lists a feature that does not |
5515 | appear in ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` within the current configuration, an | 6192 | appear in ``DISTRO_FEATURES`` within the current configuration, an |
5516 | error occurs and the build stops. | 6193 | error occurs and the build stops. |
5517 | 6194 | ||
5518 | RM_WORK_EXCLUDE | 6195 | RM_WORK_EXCLUDE |
5519 | With ``rm_work`` enabled, this variable specifies a list of recipes | 6196 | With ``rm_work`` enabled, this variable specifies a list of recipes |
5520 | whose work directories should not be removed. See the | 6197 | whose work directories should not be removed. See the |
5521 | ":ref:`rm_work.bbclass <ref-classes-rm-work>`" section for more | 6198 | ":ref:`rm_work.bbclass <ref-classes-rm-work>`" section for more |
5522 | details. | 6199 | details. |
5523 | 6200 | ||
5524 | ROOT_HOME | 6201 | ROOT_HOME |
5525 | Defines the root home directory. By default, this directory is set as | 6202 | Defines the root home directory. By default, this directory is set as |
5526 | follows in the BitBake configuration file: ROOT_HOME ??= "/home/root" | 6203 | follows in the BitBake configuration file: |
5527 | 6204 | :: | |
6205 | |||
6206 | ROOT_HOME ??= "/home/root" | ||
6207 | |||
5528 | .. note:: | 6208 | .. note:: |
5529 | 6209 | ||
5530 | This default value is likely used because some embedded solutions | 6210 | This default value is likely used because some embedded solutions |
5531 | prefer to have a read-only root filesystem and prefer to keep | 6211 | prefer to have a read-only root filesystem and prefer to keep |
5532 | writeable data in one place. | 6212 | writeable data in one place. |
5533 | 6213 | ||
5534 | You can override the default by setting the variable in any layer or | 6214 | You can override the default by setting the variable in any layer or |
5535 | in the ``local.conf`` file. Because the default is set using a "weak" | 6215 | in the ``local.conf`` file. Because the default is set using a "weak" |
5536 | assignment (i.e. "??="), you can use either of the following forms to | 6216 | assignment (i.e. "??="), you can use either of the following forms to |
5537 | define your override: ROOT_HOME = "/root" ROOT_HOME ?= "/root" These | 6217 | define your override: |
6218 | :: | ||
6219 | |||
6220 | ROOT_HOME = "/root" | ||
6221 | ROOT_HOME ?= "/root" | ||
6222 | |||
6223 | These | ||
5538 | override examples use ``/root``, which is probably the most commonly | 6224 | override examples use ``/root``, which is probably the most commonly |
5539 | used override. | 6225 | used override. |
5540 | 6226 | ||
5541 | ROOTFS | 6227 | ROOTFS |
5542 | Indicates a filesystem image to include as the root filesystem. | 6228 | Indicates a filesystem image to include as the root filesystem. |
5543 | 6229 | ||
5544 | The ``ROOTFS`` variable is an optional variable used with the | 6230 | The ``ROOTFS`` variable is an optional variable used with the |
5545 | :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` class. | 6231 | :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>` class. |
5546 | 6232 | ||
5547 | ROOTFS_POSTINSTALL_COMMAND | 6233 | ROOTFS_POSTINSTALL_COMMAND |
5548 | Specifies a list of functions to call after the OpenEmbedded build | 6234 | Specifies a list of functions to call after the OpenEmbedded build |
5549 | system has installed packages. You can specify functions separated by | 6235 | system has installed packages. You can specify functions separated by |
5550 | semicolons: ROOTFS_POSTINSTALL_COMMAND += "function; ... " | 6236 | semicolons: |
5551 | 6237 | :: | |
6238 | |||
6239 | ROOTFS_POSTINSTALL_COMMAND += "function; ... " | ||
6240 | |||
5552 | If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a | 6241 | If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a |
5553 | function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the | 6242 | function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the |
5554 | directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the | 6243 | directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the |
5555 | :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more | 6244 | :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more |
5556 | information. | 6245 | information. |
5557 | 6246 | ||
5558 | ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND | 6247 | ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND |
5559 | Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build | 6248 | Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build |
5560 | system has created the root filesystem. You can specify functions | 6249 | system has created the root filesystem. You can specify functions |
5561 | separated by semicolons: ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND += "function; ... | 6250 | separated by semicolons: |
5562 | " | 6251 | :: |
5563 | 6252 | ||
6253 | ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND += "function; ... " | ||
6254 | |||
5564 | If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a | 6255 | If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a |
5565 | function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the | 6256 | function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the |
5566 | directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the | 6257 | directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the |
5567 | :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more | 6258 | :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more |
5568 | information. | 6259 | information. |
5569 | 6260 | ||
5570 | ROOTFS_POSTUNINSTALL_COMMAND | 6261 | ROOTFS_POSTUNINSTALL_COMMAND |
5571 | Specifies a list of functions to call after the OpenEmbedded build | 6262 | Specifies a list of functions to call after the OpenEmbedded build |
5572 | system has removed unnecessary packages. When runtime package | 6263 | system has removed unnecessary packages. When runtime package |
5573 | management is disabled in the image, several packages are removed | 6264 | management is disabled in the image, several packages are removed |
5574 | including ``base-passwd``, ``shadow``, and ``update-alternatives``. | 6265 | including ``base-passwd``, ``shadow``, and ``update-alternatives``. |
5575 | You can specify functions separated by semicolons: | 6266 | You can specify functions separated by semicolons: |
5576 | ROOTFS_POSTUNINSTALL_COMMAND += "function; ... " | 6267 | :: |
5577 | 6268 | ||
6269 | ROOTFS_POSTUNINSTALL_COMMAND += "function; ... " | ||
6270 | |||
5578 | If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a | 6271 | If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a |
5579 | function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the | 6272 | function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the |
5580 | directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the | 6273 | directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the |
5581 | :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more | 6274 | :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more |
5582 | information. | 6275 | information. |
5583 | 6276 | ||
5584 | ROOTFS_PREPROCESS_COMMAND | 6277 | ROOTFS_PREPROCESS_COMMAND |
5585 | Specifies a list of functions to call before the OpenEmbedded build | 6278 | Specifies a list of functions to call before the OpenEmbedded build |
5586 | system has created the root filesystem. You can specify functions | 6279 | system has created the root filesystem. You can specify functions |
5587 | separated by semicolons: ROOTFS_PREPROCESS_COMMAND += "function; ... | 6280 | separated by semicolons: |
5588 | " | 6281 | :: |
5589 | 6282 | ||
6283 | ROOTFS_PREPROCESS_COMMAND += "function; ... " | ||
6284 | |||
5590 | If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a | 6285 | If you need to pass the root filesystem path to a command within a |
5591 | function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the | 6286 | function, you can use ``${IMAGE_ROOTFS}``, which points to the |
5592 | directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the | 6287 | directory that becomes the root filesystem image. See the |
5593 | :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more | 6288 | :term:`IMAGE_ROOTFS` variable for more |
5594 | information. | 6289 | information. |
5595 | 6290 | ||
5596 | RPROVIDES | 6291 | RPROVIDES |
5597 | A list of package name aliases that a package also provides. These | 6292 | A list of package name aliases that a package also provides. These |
5598 | aliases are useful for satisfying runtime dependencies of other | 6293 | aliases are useful for satisfying runtime dependencies of other |
5599 | packages both during the build and on the target (as specified by | 6294 | packages both during the build and on the target (as specified by |
5600 | ``RDEPENDS``). | 6295 | ``RDEPENDS``). |
5601 | 6296 | ||
5602 | .. note:: | 6297 | .. note:: |
5603 | 6298 | ||
5604 | A package's own name is implicitly already in its | 6299 | A package's own name is implicitly already in its |
5605 | RPROVIDES | 6300 | RPROVIDES |
5606 | list. | 6301 | list. |
5607 | 6302 | ||
5608 | As with all package-controlling variables, you must always use the | 6303 | As with all package-controlling variables, you must always use the |
5609 | variable in conjunction with a package name override. Here is an | 6304 | variable in conjunction with a package name override. Here is an |
5610 | example: RPROVIDES_${PN} = "widget-abi-2" | 6305 | example: |
5611 | 6306 | :: | |
6307 | |||
6308 | RPROVIDES_${PN} = "widget-abi-2" | ||
6309 | |||
5612 | RRECOMMENDS | 6310 | RRECOMMENDS |
5613 | A list of packages that extends the usability of a package being | 6311 | A list of packages that extends the usability of a package being |
5614 | built. The package being built does not depend on this list of | 6312 | built. The package being built does not depend on this list of |
5615 | packages in order to successfully build, but rather uses them for | 6313 | packages in order to successfully build, but rather uses them for |
5616 | extended usability. To specify runtime dependencies for packages, see | 6314 | extended usability. To specify runtime dependencies for packages, see |
5617 | the ``RDEPENDS`` variable. | 6315 | the ``RDEPENDS`` variable. |
5618 | 6316 | ||
5619 | The package manager will automatically install the ``RRECOMMENDS`` | 6317 | The package manager will automatically install the ``RRECOMMENDS`` |
5620 | list of packages when installing the built package. However, you can | 6318 | list of packages when installing the built package. However, you can |
5621 | prevent listed packages from being installed by using the | 6319 | prevent listed packages from being installed by using the |
5622 | :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS`, | 6320 | :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS`, |
5623 | :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS`, and | 6321 | :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS`, and |
5624 | :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE` variables. | 6322 | :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE` variables. |
5625 | 6323 | ||
5626 | Packages specified in ``RRECOMMENDS`` need not actually be produced. | 6324 | Packages specified in ``RRECOMMENDS`` need not actually be produced. |
5627 | However, a recipe must exist that provides each package, either | 6325 | However, a recipe must exist that provides each package, either |
5628 | through the :term:`PACKAGES` or | 6326 | through the :term:`PACKAGES` or |
@@ -5630,55 +6328,93 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5630 | :term:`RPROVIDES` variable, or an error will occur | 6328 | :term:`RPROVIDES` variable, or an error will occur |
5631 | during the build. If such a recipe does exist and the package is not | 6329 | during the build. If such a recipe does exist and the package is not |
5632 | produced, the build continues without error. | 6330 | produced, the build continues without error. |
5633 | 6331 | ||
5634 | Because the ``RRECOMMENDS`` variable applies to packages being built, | 6332 | Because the ``RRECOMMENDS`` variable applies to packages being built, |
5635 | you should always attach an override to the variable to specify the | 6333 | you should always attach an override to the variable to specify the |
5636 | particular package whose usability is being extended. For example, | 6334 | particular package whose usability is being extended. For example, |
5637 | suppose you are building a development package that is extended to | 6335 | suppose you are building a development package that is extended to |
5638 | support wireless functionality. In this case, you would use the | 6336 | support wireless functionality. In this case, you would use the |
5639 | following: RRECOMMENDS_${PN}-dev += "wireless_package_name" In the | 6337 | following: |
6338 | :: | ||
6339 | |||
6340 | RRECOMMENDS_${PN}-dev += "wireless_package_name" | ||
6341 | |||
6342 | In the | ||
5640 | example, the package name (``${PN}-dev``) must appear as it would in | 6343 | example, the package name (``${PN}-dev``) must appear as it would in |
5641 | the ``PACKAGES`` namespace before any renaming of the output package | 6344 | the ``PACKAGES`` namespace before any renaming of the output package |
5642 | by classes such as ``debian.bbclass``. | 6345 | by classes such as ``debian.bbclass``. |
5643 | 6346 | ||
5644 | BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports | 6347 | BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports |
5645 | specifying versioned recommends. Although the syntax varies depending | 6348 | specifying versioned recommends. Although the syntax varies depending |
5646 | on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences from you. | 6349 | on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences from you. |
5647 | Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the | 6350 | Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the |
5648 | ``RRECOMMENDS`` variable: RRECOMMENDS_${PN} = "package (operator | 6351 | ``RRECOMMENDS`` variable: |
5649 | version)" For ``operator``, you can specify the following: = < > <= | 6352 | :: |
5650 | >= For example, the following sets up a recommend on version 1.2 or | 6353 | |
5651 | greater of the package ``foo``: RRECOMMENDS_${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)" | 6354 | RRECOMMENDS_${PN} = "package (operator version)" |
5652 | 6355 | ||
6356 | For ``operator``, you can specify the following: | ||
6357 | |||
6358 | - = | ||
6359 | - < | ||
6360 | - > | ||
6361 | - <= | ||
6362 | - >= | ||
6363 | |||
6364 | For example, the following sets up a recommend on version 1.2 or | ||
6365 | greater of the package ``foo``: | ||
6366 | :: | ||
6367 | |||
6368 | RRECOMMENDS_${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)" | ||
6369 | |||
5653 | RREPLACES | 6370 | RREPLACES |
5654 | A list of packages replaced by a package. The package manager uses | 6371 | A list of packages replaced by a package. The package manager uses |
5655 | this variable to determine which package should be installed to | 6372 | this variable to determine which package should be installed to |
5656 | replace other package(s) during an upgrade. In order to also have the | 6373 | replace other package(s) during an upgrade. In order to also have the |
5657 | other package(s) removed at the same time, you must add the name of | 6374 | other package(s) removed at the same time, you must add the name of |
5658 | the other package to the ``RCONFLICTS`` variable. | 6375 | the other package to the ``RCONFLICTS`` variable. |
5659 | 6376 | ||
5660 | As with all package-controlling variables, you must use this variable | 6377 | As with all package-controlling variables, you must use this variable |
5661 | in conjunction with a package name override. Here is an example: | 6378 | in conjunction with a package name override. Here is an example: |
5662 | RREPLACES_${PN} = "other_package_being_replaced" | 6379 | :: |
5663 | 6380 | ||
6381 | RREPLACES_${PN} = "other_package_being_replaced" | ||
6382 | |||
5664 | BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports | 6383 | BitBake, which the OpenEmbedded build system uses, supports |
5665 | specifying versioned replacements. Although the syntax varies | 6384 | specifying versioned replacements. Although the syntax varies |
5666 | depending on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences | 6385 | depending on the packaging format, BitBake hides these differences |
5667 | from you. Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the | 6386 | from you. Here is the general syntax to specify versions with the |
5668 | ``RREPLACES`` variable: RREPLACES_${PN} = "package (operator | 6387 | ``RREPLACES`` variable: |
5669 | version)" For ``operator``, you can specify the following: = < > <= | 6388 | :: |
5670 | >= For example, the following sets up a replacement using version 1.2 | 6389 | |
5671 | or greater of the package ``foo``: RREPLACES_${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)" | 6390 | RREPLACES_${PN} = "package (operator version)" |
5672 | 6391 | ||
6392 | For ``operator``, you can specify the following: | ||
6393 | |||
6394 | - = | ||
6395 | - < | ||
6396 | - > | ||
6397 | - <= | ||
6398 | - >= | ||
6399 | |||
6400 | For example, the following sets up a replacement using version 1.2 | ||
6401 | or greater of the package ``foo``: | ||
6402 | :: | ||
6403 | |||
6404 | RREPLACES_${PN} = "foo (>= 1.2)" | ||
6405 | |||
5673 | RSUGGESTS | 6406 | RSUGGESTS |
5674 | A list of additional packages that you can suggest for installation | 6407 | A list of additional packages that you can suggest for installation |
5675 | by the package manager at the time a package is installed. Not all | 6408 | by the package manager at the time a package is installed. Not all |
5676 | package managers support this functionality. | 6409 | package managers support this functionality. |
5677 | 6410 | ||
5678 | As with all package-controlling variables, you must always use this | 6411 | As with all package-controlling variables, you must always use this |
5679 | variable in conjunction with a package name override. Here is an | 6412 | variable in conjunction with a package name override. Here is an |
5680 | example: RSUGGESTS_${PN} = "useful_package another_package" | 6413 | example: |
5681 | 6414 | :: | |
6415 | |||
6416 | RSUGGESTS_${PN} = "useful_package another_package" | ||
6417 | |||
5682 | S | 6418 | S |
5683 | The location in the :term:`Build Directory` where | 6419 | The location in the :term:`Build Directory` where |
5684 | unpacked recipe source code resides. By default, this directory is | 6420 | unpacked recipe source code resides. By default, this directory is |
@@ -5689,27 +6425,33 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5689 | fetched from an SCM such as Git or Subversion, then you must set | 6425 | fetched from an SCM such as Git or Subversion, then you must set |
5690 | ``S`` in the recipe so that the OpenEmbedded build system knows where | 6426 | ``S`` in the recipe so that the OpenEmbedded build system knows where |
5691 | to find the unpacked source. | 6427 | to find the unpacked source. |
5692 | 6428 | ||
5693 | As an example, assume a :term:`Source Directory` | 6429 | As an example, assume a :term:`Source Directory` |
5694 | top-level folder named ``poky`` and a default Build Directory at | 6430 | top-level folder named ``poky`` and a default Build Directory at |
5695 | ``poky/build``. In this case, the work directory the build system | 6431 | ``poky/build``. In this case, the work directory the build system |
5696 | uses to keep the unpacked recipe for ``db`` is the following: | 6432 | uses to keep the unpacked recipe for ``db`` is the following: |
5697 | poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/db/5.1.19-r3/db-5.1.19 The | 6433 | :: |
5698 | unpacked source code resides in the ``db-5.1.19`` folder. | 6434 | |
5699 | 6435 | poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/db/5.1.19-r3/db-5.1.19 | |
6436 | |||
6437 | The unpacked source code resides in the ``db-5.1.19`` folder. | ||
6438 | |||
5700 | This next example assumes a Git repository. By default, Git | 6439 | This next example assumes a Git repository. By default, Git |
5701 | repositories are cloned to ``${WORKDIR}/git`` during | 6440 | repositories are cloned to ``${WORKDIR}/git`` during |
5702 | :ref:`ref-tasks-fetch`. Since this path is different | 6441 | :ref:`ref-tasks-fetch`. Since this path is different |
5703 | from the default value of ``S``, you must set it specifically so the | 6442 | from the default value of ``S``, you must set it specifically so the |
5704 | source can be located: SRC_URI = "git://path/to/repo.git" S = | 6443 | source can be located: |
5705 | "${WORKDIR}/git" | 6444 | :: |
5706 | 6445 | ||
6446 | SRC_URI = "git://path/to/repo.git" | ||
6447 | S = "${WORKDIR}/git" | ||
6448 | |||
5707 | SANITY_REQUIRED_UTILITIES | 6449 | SANITY_REQUIRED_UTILITIES |
5708 | Specifies a list of command-line utilities that should be checked for | 6450 | Specifies a list of command-line utilities that should be checked for |
5709 | during the initial sanity checking process when running BitBake. If | 6451 | during the initial sanity checking process when running BitBake. If |
5710 | any of the utilities are not installed on the build host, then | 6452 | any of the utilities are not installed on the build host, then |
5711 | BitBake immediately exits with an error. | 6453 | BitBake immediately exits with an error. |
5712 | 6454 | ||
5713 | SANITY_TESTED_DISTROS | 6455 | SANITY_TESTED_DISTROS |
5714 | A list of the host distribution identifiers that the build system has | 6456 | A list of the host distribution identifiers that the build system has |
5715 | been tested against. Identifiers consist of the host distributor ID | 6457 | been tested against. Identifiers consist of the host distributor ID |
@@ -5720,25 +6462,31 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5720 | :term:`NATIVELSBSTRING` does not appear in the | 6462 | :term:`NATIVELSBSTRING` does not appear in the |
5721 | list, then the build system reports a warning that indicates the | 6463 | list, then the build system reports a warning that indicates the |
5722 | current host distribution has not been tested as a build host. | 6464 | current host distribution has not been tested as a build host. |
5723 | 6465 | ||
5724 | SDK_ARCH | 6466 | SDK_ARCH |
5725 | The target architecture for the SDK. Typically, you do not directly | 6467 | The target architecture for the SDK. Typically, you do not directly |
5726 | set this variable. Instead, use :term:`SDKMACHINE`. | 6468 | set this variable. Instead, use :term:`SDKMACHINE`. |
5727 | 6469 | ||
5728 | SDK_DEPLOY | 6470 | SDK_DEPLOY |
5729 | The directory set up and used by the | 6471 | The directory set up and used by the |
5730 | :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk>` class to which | 6472 | :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk>` class to which |
5731 | the SDK is deployed. The ``populate_sdk_base`` class defines | 6473 | the SDK is deployed. The ``populate_sdk_base`` class defines |
5732 | ``SDK_DEPLOY`` as follows: SDK_DEPLOY = "${TMPDIR}/deploy/sdk" | 6474 | ``SDK_DEPLOY`` as follows: |
5733 | 6475 | :: | |
6476 | |||
6477 | SDK_DEPLOY = "${TMPDIR}/deploy/sdk" | ||
6478 | |||
5734 | SDK_DIR | 6479 | SDK_DIR |
5735 | The parent directory used by the OpenEmbedded build system when | 6480 | The parent directory used by the OpenEmbedded build system when |
5736 | creating SDK output. The | 6481 | creating SDK output. The |
5737 | :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class defines | 6482 | :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class defines |
5738 | the variable as follows: SDK_DIR = "${WORKDIR}/sdk" | 6483 | the variable as follows: |
5739 | 6484 | :: | |
6485 | |||
6486 | SDK_DIR = "${WORKDIR}/sdk" | ||
6487 | |||
5740 | .. note:: | 6488 | .. note:: |
5741 | 6489 | ||
5742 | The | 6490 | The |
5743 | SDK_DIR | 6491 | SDK_DIR |
5744 | directory is a temporary directory as it is part of | 6492 | directory is a temporary directory as it is part of |
@@ -5746,47 +6494,53 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5746 | . The final output directory is | 6494 | . The final output directory is |
5747 | SDK_DEPLOY | 6495 | SDK_DEPLOY |
5748 | . | 6496 | . |
5749 | 6497 | ||
5750 | SDK_EXT_TYPE | 6498 | SDK_EXT_TYPE |
5751 | Controls whether or not shared state artifacts are copied into the | 6499 | Controls whether or not shared state artifacts are copied into the |
5752 | extensible SDK. The default value of "full" copies all of the | 6500 | extensible SDK. The default value of "full" copies all of the |
5753 | required shared state artifacts into the extensible SDK. The value | 6501 | required shared state artifacts into the extensible SDK. The value |
5754 | "minimal" leaves these artifacts out of the SDK. | 6502 | "minimal" leaves these artifacts out of the SDK. |
5755 | 6503 | ||
5756 | .. note:: | 6504 | .. note:: |
5757 | 6505 | ||
5758 | If you set the variable to "minimal", you need to ensure | 6506 | If you set the variable to "minimal", you need to ensure |
5759 | SSTATE_MIRRORS | 6507 | SSTATE_MIRRORS |
5760 | is set in the SDK's configuration to enable the artifacts to be | 6508 | is set in the SDK's configuration to enable the artifacts to be |
5761 | fetched as needed. | 6509 | fetched as needed. |
5762 | 6510 | ||
5763 | SDK_HOST_MANIFEST | 6511 | SDK_HOST_MANIFEST |
5764 | The manifest file for the host part of the SDK. This file lists all | 6512 | The manifest file for the host part of the SDK. This file lists all |
5765 | the installed packages that make up the host part of the SDK. The | 6513 | the installed packages that make up the host part of the SDK. The |
5766 | file contains package information on a line-per-package basis as | 6514 | file contains package information on a line-per-package basis as |
5767 | follows: packagename packagearch version | 6515 | follows: |
5768 | 6516 | :: | |
6517 | |||
6518 | packagename packagearch version | ||
6519 | |||
5769 | The :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class | 6520 | The :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class |
5770 | defines the manifest file as follows: SDK_HOST_MANIFEST = | 6521 | defines the manifest file as follows: |
5771 | "${SDK_DEPLOY}/${TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME}.host.manifest" The location is | 6522 | :: |
5772 | derived using the :term:`SDK_DEPLOY` and | 6523 | |
6524 | SDK_HOST_MANIFEST = "${SDK_DEPLOY}/${TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME}.host.manifest" | ||
6525 | |||
6526 | The location is derived using the :term:`SDK_DEPLOY` and | ||
5773 | :term:`TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME` variables. | 6527 | :term:`TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME` variables. |
5774 | 6528 | ||
5775 | SDK_INCLUDE_PKGDATA | 6529 | SDK_INCLUDE_PKGDATA |
5776 | When set to "1", specifies to include the packagedata for all recipes | 6530 | When set to "1", specifies to include the packagedata for all recipes |
5777 | in the "world" target in the extensible SDK. Including this data | 6531 | in the "world" target in the extensible SDK. Including this data |
5778 | allows the ``devtool search`` command to find these recipes in search | 6532 | allows the ``devtool search`` command to find these recipes in search |
5779 | results, as well as allows the ``devtool add`` command to map | 6533 | results, as well as allows the ``devtool add`` command to map |
5780 | dependencies more effectively. | 6534 | dependencies more effectively. |
5781 | 6535 | ||
5782 | .. note:: | 6536 | .. note:: |
5783 | 6537 | ||
5784 | Enabling the | 6538 | Enabling the |
5785 | SDK_INCLUDE_PKGDATA | 6539 | SDK_INCLUDE_PKGDATA |
5786 | variable significantly increases build time because all of world | 6540 | variable significantly increases build time because all of world |
5787 | needs to be built. Enabling the variable also slightly increases | 6541 | needs to be built. Enabling the variable also slightly increases |
5788 | the size of the extensible SDK. | 6542 | the size of the extensible SDK. |
5789 | 6543 | ||
5790 | SDK_INCLUDE_TOOLCHAIN | 6544 | SDK_INCLUDE_TOOLCHAIN |
5791 | When set to "1", specifies to include the toolchain in the extensible | 6545 | When set to "1", specifies to include the toolchain in the extensible |
5792 | SDK. Including the toolchain is useful particularly when | 6546 | SDK. Including the toolchain is useful particularly when |
@@ -5795,375 +6549,417 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
5795 | toolchain. For example, suppose you want to use the toolchain from an | 6549 | toolchain. For example, suppose you want to use the toolchain from an |
5796 | IDE or from other tools and you do not want to perform additional | 6550 | IDE or from other tools and you do not want to perform additional |
5797 | steps to install the toolchain. | 6551 | steps to install the toolchain. |
5798 | 6552 | ||
5799 | The ``SDK_INCLUDE_TOOLCHAIN`` variable defaults to "0" if | 6553 | The ``SDK_INCLUDE_TOOLCHAIN`` variable defaults to "0" if |
5800 | ``SDK_EXT_TYPE`` is set to "minimal", and defaults to "1" if | 6554 | ``SDK_EXT_TYPE`` is set to "minimal", and defaults to "1" if |
5801 | ``SDK_EXT_TYPE`` is set to "full". | 6555 | ``SDK_EXT_TYPE`` is set to "full". |
5802 | 6556 | ||
5803 | SDK_INHERIT_BLACKLIST | 6557 | SDK_INHERIT_BLACKLIST |
5804 | A list of classes to remove from the :term:`INHERIT` | 6558 | A list of classes to remove from the :term:`INHERIT` |
5805 | value globally within the extensible SDK configuration. The | 6559 | value globally within the extensible SDK configuration. The |
5806 | :ref:`populate-sdk-ext <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class sets the | 6560 | :ref:`populate-sdk-ext <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class sets the |
5807 | default value: SDK_INHERIT_BLACKLIST ?= "buildhistory icecc" | 6561 | default value: |
5808 | 6562 | :: | |
6563 | |||
6564 | SDK_INHERIT_BLACKLIST ?= "buildhistory icecc" | ||
6565 | |||
5809 | Some classes are not generally applicable within the extensible SDK | 6566 | Some classes are not generally applicable within the extensible SDK |
5810 | context. You can use this variable to disable those classes. | 6567 | context. You can use this variable to disable those classes. |
5811 | 6568 | ||
5812 | For additional information on how to customize the extensible SDK's | 6569 | For additional information on how to customize the extensible SDK's |
5813 | configuration, see the "`Configuring the Extensible | 6570 | configuration, see the |
5814 | SDK <&YOCTO_DOCS_SDK_URL;#sdk-configuring-the-extensible-sdk>`__" | 6571 | ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing:configuring the extensible sdk`" |
5815 | section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the | 6572 | section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the |
5816 | Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. | 6573 | Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. |
5817 | 6574 | ||
5818 | SDK_LOCAL_CONF_BLACKLIST | 6575 | SDK_LOCAL_CONF_BLACKLIST |
5819 | A list of variables not allowed through from the OpenEmbedded build | 6576 | A list of variables not allowed through from the OpenEmbedded build |
5820 | system configuration into the extensible SDK configuration. Usually, | 6577 | system configuration into the extensible SDK configuration. Usually, |
5821 | these are variables that are specific to the machine on which the | 6578 | these are variables that are specific to the machine on which the |
5822 | build system is running and thus would be potentially problematic | 6579 | build system is running and thus would be potentially problematic |
5823 | within the extensible SDK. | 6580 | within the extensible SDK. |
5824 | 6581 | ||
5825 | By default, ``SDK_LOCAL_CONF_BLACKLIST`` is set in the | 6582 | By default, ``SDK_LOCAL_CONF_BLACKLIST`` is set in the |
5826 | :ref:`populate-sdk-ext <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class and | 6583 | :ref:`populate-sdk-ext <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class and |
5827 | excludes the following variables: | 6584 | excludes the following variables: |
5828 | :term:`CONF_VERSION` | 6585 | |
5829 | :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS` | 6586 | - :term:`CONF_VERSION` |
5830 | :term:`bitbake:BB_NUMBER_PARSE_THREADS` | 6587 | - :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS` |
5831 | :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` | 6588 | - :term:`bitbake:BB_NUMBER_PARSE_THREADS` |
5832 | :term:`PRSERV_HOST` | 6589 | - :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` |
5833 | :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` :term:`DL_DIR` | 6590 | - :term:`PRSERV_HOST` |
5834 | :term:`SSTATE_DIR` :term:`TMPDIR` | 6591 | - :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` :term:`DL_DIR` |
5835 | :term:`BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT` | 6592 | - :term:`SSTATE_DIR` :term:`TMPDIR` |
5836 | 6593 | - :term:`BB_SERVER_TIMEOUT` | |
6594 | |||
5837 | For additional information on how to customize the extensible SDK's | 6595 | For additional information on how to customize the extensible SDK's |
5838 | configuration, see the "`Configuring the Extensible | 6596 | configuration, see the |
5839 | SDK <&YOCTO_DOCS_SDK_URL;#sdk-configuring-the-extensible-sdk>`__" | 6597 | ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing:configuring the extensible sdk`" |
5840 | section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the | 6598 | section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the |
5841 | Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. | 6599 | Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. |
5842 | 6600 | ||
5843 | SDK_LOCAL_CONF_WHITELIST | 6601 | SDK_LOCAL_CONF_WHITELIST |
5844 | A list of variables allowed through from the OpenEmbedded build | 6602 | A list of variables allowed through from the OpenEmbedded build |
5845 | system configuration into the extensible SDK configuration. By | 6603 | system configuration into the extensible SDK configuration. By |
5846 | default, the list of variables is empty and is set in the | 6604 | default, the list of variables is empty and is set in the |
5847 | :ref:`populate-sdk-ext <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class. | 6605 | :ref:`populate-sdk-ext <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class. |
5848 | 6606 | ||
5849 | This list overrides the variables specified using the | 6607 | This list overrides the variables specified using the |
5850 | :term:`SDK_LOCAL_CONF_BLACKLIST` | 6608 | :term:`SDK_LOCAL_CONF_BLACKLIST` |
5851 | variable as well as any variables identified by automatic | 6609 | variable as well as any variables identified by automatic |
5852 | blacklisting due to the "/" character being found at the start of the | 6610 | blacklisting due to the "/" character being found at the start of the |
5853 | value, which is usually indicative of being a path and thus might not | 6611 | value, which is usually indicative of being a path and thus might not |
5854 | be valid on the system where the SDK is installed. | 6612 | be valid on the system where the SDK is installed. |
5855 | 6613 | ||
5856 | For additional information on how to customize the extensible SDK's | 6614 | For additional information on how to customize the extensible SDK's |
5857 | configuration, see the "`Configuring the Extensible | 6615 | configuration, see the |
5858 | SDK <&YOCTO_DOCS_SDK_URL;#sdk-configuring-the-extensible-sdk>`__" | 6616 | ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing:configuring the extensible sdk`" |
5859 | section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the | 6617 | section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the |
5860 | Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. | 6618 | Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. |
5861 | 6619 | ||
5862 | SDK_NAME | 6620 | SDK_NAME |
5863 | The base name for SDK output files. The name is derived from the | 6621 | The base name for SDK output files. The name is derived from the |
5864 | :term:`DISTRO`, :term:`TCLIBC`, | 6622 | :term:`DISTRO`, :term:`TCLIBC`, |
5865 | :term:`SDK_ARCH`, | 6623 | :term:`SDK_ARCH`, |
5866 | :term:`IMAGE_BASENAME`, and | 6624 | :term:`IMAGE_BASENAME`, and |
5867 | :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH` variables: SDK_NAME = | 6625 | :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH` variables: |
5868 | "${DISTRO}-${TCLIBC}-${SDK_ARCH}-${IMAGE_BASENAME}-${TUNE_PKGARCH}" | 6626 | :: |
5869 | 6627 | ||
6628 | SDK_NAME = "${DISTRO}-${TCLIBC}-${SDK_ARCH}-${IMAGE_BASENAME}-${TUNE_PKGARCH}" | ||
6629 | |||
5870 | SDK_OS | 6630 | SDK_OS |
5871 | Specifies the operating system for which the SDK will be built. The | 6631 | Specifies the operating system for which the SDK will be built. The |
5872 | default value is the value of :term:`BUILD_OS`. | 6632 | default value is the value of :term:`BUILD_OS`. |
5873 | 6633 | ||
5874 | SDK_OUTPUT | 6634 | SDK_OUTPUT |
5875 | The location used by the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK | 6635 | The location used by the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK |
5876 | output. The :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` | 6636 | output. The :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` |
5877 | class defines the variable as follows: SDK_DIR = "${WORKDIR}/sdk" | 6637 | class defines the variable as follows: |
5878 | SDK_OUTPUT = "${SDK_DIR}/image" SDK_DEPLOY = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/sdk" | 6638 | :: |
5879 | 6639 | ||
6640 | SDK_DIR = "${WORKDIR}/sdk" | ||
6641 | SDK_OUTPUT = "${SDK_DIR}/image" | ||
6642 | SDK_DEPLOY = "${DEPLOY_DIR}/sdk" | ||
6643 | |||
5880 | .. note:: | 6644 | .. note:: |
5881 | 6645 | ||
5882 | The | 6646 | The SDK_OUTPUT directory is a temporary directory as it is part of |
5883 | SDK_OUTPUT | 6647 | WORKDIR by way of SDK_DIR. The final output directory is |
5884 | directory is a temporary directory as it is part of | 6648 | SDK_DEPLOY. |
5885 | WORKDIR | 6649 | |
5886 | by way of | ||
5887 | SDK_DIR | ||
5888 | . The final output directory is | ||
5889 | SDK_DEPLOY | ||
5890 | . | ||
5891 | |||
5892 | SDK_PACKAGE_ARCHS | 6650 | SDK_PACKAGE_ARCHS |
5893 | Specifies a list of architectures compatible with the SDK machine. | 6651 | Specifies a list of architectures compatible with the SDK machine. |
5894 | This variable is set automatically and should not normally be | 6652 | This variable is set automatically and should not normally be |
5895 | hand-edited. Entries are separated using spaces and listed in order | 6653 | hand-edited. Entries are separated using spaces and listed in order |
5896 | of priority. The default value for ``SDK_PACKAGE_ARCHS`` is "all any | 6654 | of priority. The default value for ``SDK_PACKAGE_ARCHS`` is "all any |
5897 | noarch ${SDK_ARCH}-${SDKPKGSUFFIX}". | 6655 | noarch ${SDK_ARCH}-${SDKPKGSUFFIX}". |
5898 | 6656 | ||
5899 | SDK_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND | 6657 | SDK_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND |
5900 | Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build | 6658 | Specifies a list of functions to call once the OpenEmbedded build |
5901 | system creates the SDK. You can specify functions separated by | 6659 | system creates the SDK. You can specify functions separated by |
5902 | semicolons: SDK_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND += "function; ... " | 6660 | semicolons: SDK_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND += "function; ... " |
5903 | 6661 | ||
5904 | If you need to pass an SDK path to a command within a function, you | 6662 | If you need to pass an SDK path to a command within a function, you |
5905 | can use ``${SDK_DIR}``, which points to the parent directory used by | 6663 | can use ``${SDK_DIR}``, which points to the parent directory used by |
5906 | the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK output. See the | 6664 | the OpenEmbedded build system when creating SDK output. See the |
5907 | :term:`SDK_DIR` variable for more information. | 6665 | :term:`SDK_DIR` variable for more information. |
5908 | 6666 | ||
5909 | SDK_PREFIX | 6667 | SDK_PREFIX |
5910 | The toolchain binary prefix used for ``nativesdk`` recipes. The | 6668 | The toolchain binary prefix used for ``nativesdk`` recipes. The |
5911 | OpenEmbedded build system uses the ``SDK_PREFIX`` value to set the | 6669 | OpenEmbedded build system uses the ``SDK_PREFIX`` value to set the |
5912 | :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` when building | 6670 | :term:`TARGET_PREFIX` when building |
5913 | ``nativesdk`` recipes. The default value is "${SDK_SYS}-". | 6671 | ``nativesdk`` recipes. The default value is "${SDK_SYS}-". |
5914 | 6672 | ||
5915 | SDK_RECRDEP_TASKS | 6673 | SDK_RECRDEP_TASKS |
5916 | A list of shared state tasks added to the extensible SDK. By default, | 6674 | A list of shared state tasks added to the extensible SDK. By default, |
5917 | the following tasks are added: do_populate_lic do_package_qa | 6675 | the following tasks are added: |
5918 | do_populate_sysroot do_deploy Despite the default value of "" for the | 6676 | |
6677 | - do_populate_lic | ||
6678 | - do_package_qa | ||
6679 | - do_populate_sysroot | ||
6680 | - do_deploy | ||
6681 | |||
6682 | Despite the default value of "" for the | ||
5919 | ``SDK_RECRDEP_TASKS`` variable, the above four tasks are always added | 6683 | ``SDK_RECRDEP_TASKS`` variable, the above four tasks are always added |
5920 | to the SDK. To specify tasks beyond these four, you need to use the | 6684 | to the SDK. To specify tasks beyond these four, you need to use the |
5921 | ``SDK_RECRDEP_TASKS`` variable (e.g. you are defining additional | 6685 | ``SDK_RECRDEP_TASKS`` variable (e.g. you are defining additional |
5922 | tasks that are needed in order to build | 6686 | tasks that are needed in order to build |
5923 | :term:`SDK_TARGETS`). | 6687 | :term:`SDK_TARGETS`). |
5924 | 6688 | ||
5925 | SDK_SYS | 6689 | SDK_SYS |
5926 | Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating | 6690 | Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating |
5927 | system, for which the SDK will be built. | 6691 | system, for which the SDK will be built. |
5928 | 6692 | ||
5929 | The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based | 6693 | The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based |
5930 | on :term:`SDK_ARCH`, | 6694 | on :term:`SDK_ARCH`, |
5931 | :term:`SDK_VENDOR`, and | 6695 | :term:`SDK_VENDOR`, and |
5932 | :term:`SDK_OS`. You do not need to set the ``SDK_SYS`` | 6696 | :term:`SDK_OS`. You do not need to set the ``SDK_SYS`` |
5933 | variable yourself. | 6697 | variable yourself. |
5934 | 6698 | ||
5935 | SDK_TARGET_MANIFEST | 6699 | SDK_TARGET_MANIFEST |
5936 | The manifest file for the target part of the SDK. This file lists all | 6700 | The manifest file for the target part of the SDK. This file lists all |
5937 | the installed packages that make up the target part of the SDK. The | 6701 | the installed packages that make up the target part of the SDK. The |
5938 | file contains package information on a line-per-package basis as | 6702 | file contains package information on a line-per-package basis as |
5939 | follows: packagename packagearch version | 6703 | follows: |
5940 | 6704 | :: | |
6705 | |||
6706 | packagename packagearch version | ||
6707 | |||
5941 | The :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class | 6708 | The :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class |
5942 | defines the manifest file as follows: SDK_TARGET_MANIFEST = | 6709 | defines the manifest file as follows: |
5943 | "${SDK_DEPLOY}/${TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME}.target.manifest" The location | 6710 | :: |
5944 | is derived using the :term:`SDK_DEPLOY` and | 6711 | |
6712 | SDK_TARGET_MANIFEST = "${SDK_DEPLOY}/${TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME}.target.manifest" | ||
6713 | |||
6714 | The location is derived using the :term:`SDK_DEPLOY` and | ||
5945 | :term:`TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME` variables. | 6715 | :term:`TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME` variables. |
5946 | 6716 | ||
5947 | SDK_TARGETS | 6717 | SDK_TARGETS |
5948 | A list of targets to install from shared state as part of the | 6718 | A list of targets to install from shared state as part of the |
5949 | standard or extensible SDK installation. The default value is "${PN}" | 6719 | standard or extensible SDK installation. The default value is "${PN}" |
5950 | (i.e. the image from which the SDK is built). | 6720 | (i.e. the image from which the SDK is built). |
5951 | 6721 | ||
5952 | The ``SDK_TARGETS`` variable is an internal variable and typically | 6722 | The ``SDK_TARGETS`` variable is an internal variable and typically |
5953 | would not be changed. | 6723 | would not be changed. |
5954 | 6724 | ||
5955 | SDK_TITLE | 6725 | SDK_TITLE |
5956 | The title to be printed when running the SDK installer. By default, | 6726 | The title to be printed when running the SDK installer. By default, |
5957 | this title is based on the :term:`DISTRO_NAME` or | 6727 | this title is based on the :term:`DISTRO_NAME` or |
5958 | :term:`DISTRO` variable and is set in the | 6728 | :term:`DISTRO` variable and is set in the |
5959 | :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class as | 6729 | :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class as |
5960 | follows: SDK_TITLE ??= "${@d.getVar('DISTRO_NAME') or | 6730 | follows: |
5961 | d.getVar('DISTRO')} SDK" For the default distribution "poky", | 6731 | :: |
6732 | |||
6733 | SDK_TITLE ??= "${@d.getVar('DISTRO_NAME') or d.getVar('DISTRO')} SDK" | ||
6734 | |||
6735 | For the default distribution "poky", | ||
5962 | ``SDK_TITLE`` is set to "Poky (Yocto Project Reference Distro)". | 6736 | ``SDK_TITLE`` is set to "Poky (Yocto Project Reference Distro)". |
5963 | 6737 | ||
5964 | For information on how to change this default title, see the | 6738 | For information on how to change this default title, see the |
5965 | "`Changing the Extensible SDK Installer | 6739 | ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing:changing the extensible sdk installer title`" |
5966 | Title <&YOCTO_DOCS_SDK_URL;#sdk-changing-the-sdk-installer-title>`__" | ||
5967 | section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the | 6740 | section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the |
5968 | Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. | 6741 | Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. |
5969 | 6742 | ||
5970 | SDK_UPDATE_URL | 6743 | SDK_UPDATE_URL |
5971 | An optional URL for an update server for the extensible SDK. If set, | 6744 | An optional URL for an update server for the extensible SDK. If set, |
5972 | the value is used as the default update server when running | 6745 | the value is used as the default update server when running |
5973 | ``devtool sdk-update`` within the extensible SDK. | 6746 | ``devtool sdk-update`` within the extensible SDK. |
5974 | 6747 | ||
5975 | SDK_VENDOR | 6748 | SDK_VENDOR |
5976 | Specifies the name of the SDK vendor. | 6749 | Specifies the name of the SDK vendor. |
5977 | 6750 | ||
5978 | SDK_VERSION | 6751 | SDK_VERSION |
5979 | Specifies the version of the SDK. The distribution configuration file | 6752 | Specifies the version of the SDK. The distribution configuration file |
5980 | (e.g. ``/meta-poky/conf/distro/poky.conf``) defines the | 6753 | (e.g. ``/meta-poky/conf/distro/poky.conf``) defines the |
5981 | ``SDK_VERSION`` as follows: SDK_VERSION = | 6754 | ``SDK_VERSION`` as follows: |
5982 | "${@d.getVar('DISTRO_VERSION').replace('snapshot-${DATE}','snapshot')}" | 6755 | :: |
5983 | 6756 | ||
6757 | SDK_VERSION = "${@d.getVar('DISTRO_VERSION').replace('snapshot-${DATE}','snapshot')}" | ||
6758 | |||
5984 | For additional information, see the | 6759 | For additional information, see the |
5985 | :term:`DISTRO_VERSION` and | 6760 | :term:`DISTRO_VERSION` and |
5986 | :term:`DATE` variables. | 6761 | :term:`DATE` variables. |
5987 | 6762 | ||
5988 | SDKEXTPATH | 6763 | SDKEXTPATH |
5989 | The default installation directory for the Extensible SDK. By | 6764 | The default installation directory for the Extensible SDK. By |
5990 | default, this directory is based on the :term:`DISTRO` | 6765 | default, this directory is based on the :term:`DISTRO` |
5991 | variable and is set in the | 6766 | variable and is set in the |
5992 | :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class as | 6767 | :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class as |
5993 | follows: SDKEXTPATH ??= "~/${@d.getVar('DISTRO')}_sdk" For the | 6768 | follows: |
6769 | :: | ||
6770 | |||
6771 | SDKEXTPATH ??= "~/${@d.getVar('DISTRO')}_sdk" | ||
6772 | |||
6773 | For the | ||
5994 | default distribution "poky", the ``SDKEXTPATH`` is set to "poky_sdk". | 6774 | default distribution "poky", the ``SDKEXTPATH`` is set to "poky_sdk". |
5995 | 6775 | ||
5996 | For information on how to change this default directory, see the | 6776 | For information on how to change this default directory, see the |
5997 | "`Changing the Default SDK Installation | 6777 | ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing:changing the default sdk installation directory`" |
5998 | Directory <&YOCTO_DOCS_SDK_URL;#sdk-changing-the-default-sdk-installation-directory>`__" | ||
5999 | section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the | 6778 | section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the |
6000 | Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. | 6779 | Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual. |
6001 | 6780 | ||
6002 | SDKIMAGE_FEATURES | 6781 | SDKIMAGE_FEATURES |
6003 | Equivalent to ``IMAGE_FEATURES``. However, this variable applies to | 6782 | Equivalent to ``IMAGE_FEATURES``. However, this variable applies to |
6004 | the SDK generated from an image using the following command: $ | 6783 | the SDK generated from an image using the following command: |
6005 | bitbake -c populate_sdk imagename | 6784 | :: |
6006 | 6785 | ||
6786 | $ bitbake -c populate_sdk imagename | ||
6787 | |||
6007 | SDKMACHINE | 6788 | SDKMACHINE |
6008 | The machine for which the SDK is built. In other words, the SDK is | 6789 | The machine for which the SDK is built. In other words, the SDK is |
6009 | built such that it runs on the target you specify with the | 6790 | built such that it runs on the target you specify with the |
6010 | ``SDKMACHINE`` value. The value points to a corresponding ``.conf`` | 6791 | ``SDKMACHINE`` value. The value points to a corresponding ``.conf`` |
6011 | file under ``conf/machine-sdk/``. | 6792 | file under ``conf/machine-sdk/``. |
6012 | 6793 | ||
6013 | You can use "i686" and "x86_64" as possible values for this variable. | 6794 | You can use "i686" and "x86_64" as possible values for this variable. |
6014 | The variable defaults to "i686" and is set in the local.conf file in | 6795 | The variable defaults to "i686" and is set in the local.conf file in |
6015 | the Build Directory. SDKMACHINE ?= "i686" | 6796 | the Build Directory. |
6016 | 6797 | :: | |
6798 | |||
6799 | SDKMACHINE ?= "i686" | ||
6800 | |||
6017 | .. note:: | 6801 | .. note:: |
6018 | 6802 | ||
6019 | You cannot set the | 6803 | You cannot set the |
6020 | SDKMACHINE | 6804 | SDKMACHINE |
6021 | variable in your distribution configuration file. If you do, the | 6805 | variable in your distribution configuration file. If you do, the |
6022 | configuration will not take affect. | 6806 | configuration will not take affect. |
6023 | 6807 | ||
6024 | SDKPATH | 6808 | SDKPATH |
6025 | Defines the path offered to the user for installation of the SDK that | 6809 | Defines the path offered to the user for installation of the SDK that |
6026 | is generated by the OpenEmbedded build system. The path appears as | 6810 | is generated by the OpenEmbedded build system. The path appears as |
6027 | the default location for installing the SDK when you run the SDK's | 6811 | the default location for installing the SDK when you run the SDK's |
6028 | installation script. You can override the offered path when you run | 6812 | installation script. You can override the offered path when you run |
6029 | the script. | 6813 | the script. |
6030 | 6814 | ||
6031 | SDKTARGETSYSROOT | 6815 | SDKTARGETSYSROOT |
6032 | The full path to the sysroot used for cross-compilation within an SDK | 6816 | The full path to the sysroot used for cross-compilation within an SDK |
6033 | as it will be when installed into the default | 6817 | as it will be when installed into the default |
6034 | :term:`SDKPATH`. | 6818 | :term:`SDKPATH`. |
6035 | 6819 | ||
6036 | SECTION | 6820 | SECTION |
6037 | The section in which packages should be categorized. Package | 6821 | The section in which packages should be categorized. Package |
6038 | management utilities can make use of this variable. | 6822 | management utilities can make use of this variable. |
6039 | 6823 | ||
6040 | SELECTED_OPTIMIZATION | 6824 | SELECTED_OPTIMIZATION |
6041 | Specifies the optimization flags passed to the C compiler when | 6825 | Specifies the optimization flags passed to the C compiler when |
6042 | building for the target. The flags are passed through the default | 6826 | building for the target. The flags are passed through the default |
6043 | value of the :term:`TARGET_CFLAGS` variable. | 6827 | value of the :term:`TARGET_CFLAGS` variable. |
6044 | 6828 | ||
6045 | The ``SELECTED_OPTIMIZATION`` variable takes the value of | 6829 | The ``SELECTED_OPTIMIZATION`` variable takes the value of |
6046 | ``FULL_OPTIMIZATION`` unless ``DEBUG_BUILD`` = "1". If that is the | 6830 | ``FULL_OPTIMIZATION`` unless ``DEBUG_BUILD`` = "1". If that is the |
6047 | case, the value of ``DEBUG_OPTIMIZATION`` is used. | 6831 | case, the value of ``DEBUG_OPTIMIZATION`` is used. |
6048 | 6832 | ||
6049 | SERIAL_CONSOLE | 6833 | SERIAL_CONSOLE |
6050 | Defines a serial console (TTY) to enable using | 6834 | Defines a serial console (TTY) to enable using |
6051 | `getty <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Getty_(Unix)>`__. Provide a | 6835 | `getty <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Getty_(Unix)>`__. Provide a |
6052 | value that specifies the baud rate followed by the TTY device name | 6836 | value that specifies the baud rate followed by the TTY device name |
6053 | separated by a space. You cannot specify more than one TTY device: | 6837 | separated by a space. You cannot specify more than one TTY device: |
6054 | SERIAL_CONSOLE = "115200 ttyS0" | 6838 | :: |
6055 | 6839 | ||
6840 | SERIAL_CONSOLE = "115200 ttyS0" | ||
6841 | |||
6056 | .. note:: | 6842 | .. note:: |
6057 | 6843 | ||
6058 | The | 6844 | The |
6059 | SERIAL_CONSOLE | 6845 | SERIAL_CONSOLE |
6060 | variable is deprecated. Please use the | 6846 | variable is deprecated. Please use the |
6061 | SERIAL_CONSOLES | 6847 | SERIAL_CONSOLES |
6062 | variable. | 6848 | variable. |
6063 | 6849 | ||
6064 | SERIAL_CONSOLES | 6850 | SERIAL_CONSOLES |
6065 | Defines a serial console (TTY) to enable using | 6851 | Defines a serial console (TTY) to enable using |
6066 | `getty <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Getty_(Unix)>`__. Provide a | 6852 | `getty <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Getty_(Unix)>`__. Provide a |
6067 | value that specifies the baud rate followed by the TTY device name | 6853 | value that specifies the baud rate followed by the TTY device name |
6068 | separated by a semicolon. Use spaces to separate multiple devices: | 6854 | separated by a semicolon. Use spaces to separate multiple devices: |
6069 | SERIAL_CONSOLES = "115200;ttyS0 115200;ttyS1" | 6855 | :: |
6070 | 6856 | ||
6857 | SERIAL_CONSOLES = "115200;ttyS0 115200;ttyS1" | ||
6858 | |||
6071 | SERIAL_CONSOLES_CHECK | 6859 | SERIAL_CONSOLES_CHECK |
6072 | Specifies serial consoles, which must be listed in | 6860 | Specifies serial consoles, which must be listed in |
6073 | :term:`SERIAL_CONSOLES`, to check against | 6861 | :term:`SERIAL_CONSOLES`, to check against |
6074 | ``/proc/console`` before enabling them using getty. This variable | 6862 | ``/proc/console`` before enabling them using getty. This variable |
6075 | allows aliasing in the format: <device>:<alias>. If a device was | 6863 | allows aliasing in the format: <device>:<alias>. If a device was |
6076 | listed as "sclp_line0" in ``/dev/`` and "ttyS0" was listed in | 6864 | listed as "sclp_line0" in ``/dev/`` and "ttyS0" was listed in |
6077 | ``/proc/console``, you would do the following: SERIAL_CONSOLES_CHECK | 6865 | ``/proc/console``, you would do the following: :: |
6078 | = "slcp_line0:ttyS0" This variable is currently only supported with | 6866 | |
6079 | SysVinit (i.e. not with systemd). | 6867 | SERIAL_CONSOLES_CHECK = "slcp_line0:ttyS0" |
6080 | 6868 | ||
6869 | This variable is currently only supported with SysVinit (i.e. not | ||
6870 | with systemd). | ||
6871 | |||
6081 | SIGGEN_EXCLUDE_SAFE_RECIPE_DEPS | 6872 | SIGGEN_EXCLUDE_SAFE_RECIPE_DEPS |
6082 | A list of recipe dependencies that should not be used to determine | 6873 | A list of recipe dependencies that should not be used to determine |
6083 | signatures of tasks from one recipe when they depend on tasks from | 6874 | signatures of tasks from one recipe when they depend on tasks from |
6084 | another recipe. For example: SIGGEN_EXCLUDE_SAFE_RECIPE_DEPS += | 6875 | another recipe. For example: :: |
6085 | "intone->mplayer2" | 6876 | |
6086 | 6877 | SIGGEN_EXCLUDE_SAFE_RECIPE_DEPS += "intone->mplayer2" | |
6878 | |||
6087 | In the previous example, ``intone`` depends on ``mplayer2``. | 6879 | In the previous example, ``intone`` depends on ``mplayer2``. |
6088 | 6880 | ||
6089 | You can use the special token ``"*"`` on the left-hand side of the | 6881 | You can use the special token ``"*"`` on the left-hand side of the |
6090 | dependency to match all recipes except the one on the right-hand | 6882 | dependency to match all recipes except the one on the right-hand |
6091 | side. Here is an example: SIGGEN_EXCLUDE_SAFE_RECIPE_DEPS += | 6883 | side. Here is an example: :: |
6092 | "*->quilt-native" | 6884 | |
6093 | 6885 | SIGGEN_EXCLUDE_SAFE_RECIPE_DEPS += "*->quilt-native" | |
6886 | |||
6094 | In the previous example, all recipes except ``quilt-native`` ignore | 6887 | In the previous example, all recipes except ``quilt-native`` ignore |
6095 | task signatures from the ``quilt-native`` recipe when determining | 6888 | task signatures from the ``quilt-native`` recipe when determining |
6096 | their task signatures. | 6889 | their task signatures. |
6097 | 6890 | ||
6098 | Use of this variable is one mechanism to remove dependencies that | 6891 | Use of this variable is one mechanism to remove dependencies that |
6099 | affect task signatures and thus force rebuilds when a recipe changes. | 6892 | affect task signatures and thus force rebuilds when a recipe changes. |
6100 | 6893 | ||
6101 | .. note:: | 6894 | .. note:: |
6102 | 6895 | ||
6103 | If you add an inappropriate dependency for a recipe relationship, | 6896 | If you add an inappropriate dependency for a recipe relationship, |
6104 | the software might break during runtime if the interface of the | 6897 | the software might break during runtime if the interface of the |
6105 | second recipe was changed after the first recipe had been built. | 6898 | second recipe was changed after the first recipe had been built. |
6106 | 6899 | ||
6107 | SIGGEN_EXCLUDERECIPES_ABISAFE | 6900 | SIGGEN_EXCLUDERECIPES_ABISAFE |
6108 | A list of recipes that are completely stable and will never change. | 6901 | A list of recipes that are completely stable and will never change. |
6109 | The ABI for the recipes in the list are presented by output from the | 6902 | The ABI for the recipes in the list are presented by output from the |
6110 | tasks run to build the recipe. Use of this variable is one way to | 6903 | tasks run to build the recipe. Use of this variable is one way to |
6111 | remove dependencies from one recipe on another that affect task | 6904 | remove dependencies from one recipe on another that affect task |
6112 | signatures and thus force rebuilds when the recipe changes. | 6905 | signatures and thus force rebuilds when the recipe changes. |
6113 | 6906 | ||
6114 | .. note:: | 6907 | .. note:: |
6115 | 6908 | ||
6116 | If you add an inappropriate variable to this list, the software | 6909 | If you add an inappropriate variable to this list, the software |
6117 | might break at runtime if the interface of the recipe was changed | 6910 | might break at runtime if the interface of the recipe was changed |
6118 | after the other had been built. | 6911 | after the other had been built. |
6119 | 6912 | ||
6120 | SITEINFO_BITS | 6913 | SITEINFO_BITS |
6121 | Specifies the number of bits for the target system CPU. The value | 6914 | Specifies the number of bits for the target system CPU. The value |
6122 | should be either "32" or "64". | 6915 | should be either "32" or "64". |
6123 | 6916 | ||
6124 | SITEINFO_ENDIANNESS | 6917 | SITEINFO_ENDIANNESS |
6125 | Specifies the endian byte order of the target system. The value | 6918 | Specifies the endian byte order of the target system. The value |
6126 | should be either "le" for little-endian or "be" for big-endian. | 6919 | should be either "le" for little-endian or "be" for big-endian. |
6127 | 6920 | ||
6128 | SKIP_FILEDEPS | 6921 | SKIP_FILEDEPS |
6129 | Enables removal of all files from the "Provides" section of an RPM | 6922 | Enables removal of all files from the "Provides" section of an RPM |
6130 | package. Removal of these files is required for packages containing | 6923 | package. Removal of these files is required for packages containing |
6131 | prebuilt binaries and libraries such as ``libstdc++`` and ``glibc``. | 6924 | prebuilt binaries and libraries such as ``libstdc++`` and ``glibc``. |
6132 | 6925 | ||
6133 | To enable file removal, set the variable to "1" in your | 6926 | To enable file removal, set the variable to "1" in your |
6134 | ``conf/local.conf`` configuration file in your: | 6927 | ``conf/local.conf`` configuration file in your: |
6135 | :term:`Build Directory`. SKIP_FILEDEPS = "1" | 6928 | :term:`Build Directory`. |
6136 | 6929 | :: | |
6930 | |||
6931 | SKIP_FILEDEPS = "1" | ||
6932 | |||
6137 | SOC_FAMILY | 6933 | SOC_FAMILY |
6138 | Groups together machines based upon the same family of SOC (System On | 6934 | Groups together machines based upon the same family of SOC (System On |
6139 | Chip). You typically set this variable in a common ``.inc`` file that | 6935 | Chip). You typically set this variable in a common ``.inc`` file that |
6140 | you include in the configuration files of all the machines. | 6936 | you include in the configuration files of all the machines. |
6141 | 6937 | ||
6142 | .. note:: | 6938 | .. note:: |
6143 | 6939 | ||
6144 | You must include | 6940 | You must include |
6145 | conf/machine/include/soc-family.inc | 6941 | conf/machine/include/soc-family.inc |
6146 | for this variable to appear in | 6942 | for this variable to appear in |
6147 | MACHINEOVERRIDES | 6943 | MACHINEOVERRIDES |
6148 | . | 6944 | . |
6149 | 6945 | ||
6150 | SOLIBS | 6946 | SOLIBS |
6151 | Defines the suffix for shared libraries used on the target platform. | 6947 | Defines the suffix for shared libraries used on the target platform. |
6152 | By default, this suffix is ".so.*" for all Linux-based systems and is | 6948 | By default, this suffix is ".so.*" for all Linux-based systems and is |
6153 | defined in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file. | 6949 | defined in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file. |
6154 | 6950 | ||
6155 | You will see this variable referenced in the default values of | 6951 | You will see this variable referenced in the default values of |
6156 | ``FILES_${PN}``. | 6952 | ``FILES_${PN}``. |
6157 | 6953 | ||
6158 | SOLIBSDEV | 6954 | SOLIBSDEV |
6159 | Defines the suffix for the development symbolic link (symlink) for | 6955 | Defines the suffix for the development symbolic link (symlink) for |
6160 | shared libraries on the target platform. By default, this suffix is | 6956 | shared libraries on the target platform. By default, this suffix is |
6161 | ".so" for Linux-based systems and is defined in the | 6957 | ".so" for Linux-based systems and is defined in the |
6162 | ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file. | 6958 | ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file. |
6163 | 6959 | ||
6164 | You will see this variable referenced in the default values of | 6960 | You will see this variable referenced in the default values of |
6165 | ``FILES_${PN}-dev``. | 6961 | ``FILES_${PN}-dev``. |
6166 | 6962 | ||
6167 | SOURCE_MIRROR_FETCH | 6963 | SOURCE_MIRROR_FETCH |
6168 | When you are fetching files to create a mirror of sources (i.e. | 6964 | When you are fetching files to create a mirror of sources (i.e. |
6169 | creating a source mirror), setting ``SOURCE_MIRROR_FETCH`` to "1" in | 6965 | creating a source mirror), setting ``SOURCE_MIRROR_FETCH`` to "1" in |
@@ -6175,69 +6971,75 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6175 | variable and :term:`COMPATIBLE_HOST` variables | 6971 | variable and :term:`COMPATIBLE_HOST` variables |
6176 | specify compatibility with a machine other than that of the current | 6972 | specify compatibility with a machine other than that of the current |
6177 | machine or host. | 6973 | machine or host. |
6178 | 6974 | ||
6179 | .. note:: | 6975 | .. note:: |
6180 | 6976 | ||
6181 | Do not set the | 6977 | Do not set the |
6182 | SOURCE_MIRROR_FETCH | 6978 | SOURCE_MIRROR_FETCH |
6183 | variable unless you are creating a source mirror. In other words, | 6979 | variable unless you are creating a source mirror. In other words, |
6184 | do not set the variable during a normal build. | 6980 | do not set the variable during a normal build. |
6185 | 6981 | ||
6186 | SOURCE_MIRROR_URL | 6982 | SOURCE_MIRROR_URL |
6187 | Defines your own :term:`PREMIRRORS` from which to | 6983 | Defines your own :term:`PREMIRRORS` from which to |
6188 | first fetch source before attempting to fetch from the upstream | 6984 | first fetch source before attempting to fetch from the upstream |
6189 | specified in :term:`SRC_URI`. | 6985 | specified in :term:`SRC_URI`. |
6190 | 6986 | ||
6191 | To use this variable, you must globally inherit the | 6987 | To use this variable, you must globally inherit the |
6192 | :ref:`own-mirrors <ref-classes-own-mirrors>` class and then provide | 6988 | :ref:`own-mirrors <ref-classes-own-mirrors>` class and then provide |
6193 | the URL to your mirrors. Here is the general syntax: INHERIT += | 6989 | the URL to your mirrors. Here is the general syntax: |
6194 | "own-mirrors" SOURCE_MIRROR_URL = | 6990 | :: |
6195 | "http://example.com/my_source_mirror" | 6991 | |
6196 | 6992 | INHERIT += "own-mirrors" | |
6993 | SOURCE_MIRROR_URL = "http://example.com/my_source_mirror" | ||
6994 | |||
6197 | .. note:: | 6995 | .. note:: |
6198 | 6996 | ||
6199 | You can specify only a single URL in | 6997 | You can specify only a single URL in |
6200 | SOURCE_MIRROR_URL | 6998 | SOURCE_MIRROR_URL |
6201 | . | 6999 | . |
6202 | 7000 | ||
6203 | SPDXLICENSEMAP | 7001 | SPDXLICENSEMAP |
6204 | Maps commonly used license names to their SPDX counterparts found in | 7002 | Maps commonly used license names to their SPDX counterparts found in |
6205 | ``meta/files/common-licenses/``. For the default ``SPDXLICENSEMAP`` | 7003 | ``meta/files/common-licenses/``. For the default ``SPDXLICENSEMAP`` |
6206 | mappings, see the ``meta/conf/licenses.conf`` file. | 7004 | mappings, see the ``meta/conf/licenses.conf`` file. |
6207 | 7005 | ||
6208 | For additional information, see the :term:`LICENSE` | 7006 | For additional information, see the :term:`LICENSE` |
6209 | variable. | 7007 | variable. |
6210 | 7008 | ||
6211 | SPECIAL_PKGSUFFIX | 7009 | SPECIAL_PKGSUFFIX |
6212 | A list of prefixes for :term:`PN` used by the OpenEmbedded | 7010 | A list of prefixes for :term:`PN` used by the OpenEmbedded |
6213 | build system to create variants of recipes or packages. The list | 7011 | build system to create variants of recipes or packages. The list |
6214 | specifies the prefixes to strip off during certain circumstances such | 7012 | specifies the prefixes to strip off during certain circumstances such |
6215 | as the generation of the :term:`BPN` variable. | 7013 | as the generation of the :term:`BPN` variable. |
6216 | 7014 | ||
6217 | SPL_BINARY | 7015 | SPL_BINARY |
6218 | The file type for the Secondary Program Loader (SPL). Some devices | 7016 | The file type for the Secondary Program Loader (SPL). Some devices |
6219 | use an SPL from which to boot (e.g. the BeagleBone development | 7017 | use an SPL from which to boot (e.g. the BeagleBone development |
6220 | board). For such cases, you can declare the file type of the SPL | 7018 | board). For such cases, you can declare the file type of the SPL |
6221 | binary in the ``u-boot.inc`` include file, which is used in the | 7019 | binary in the ``u-boot.inc`` include file, which is used in the |
6222 | U-Boot recipe. | 7020 | U-Boot recipe. |
6223 | 7021 | ||
6224 | The SPL file type is set to "null" by default in the ``u-boot.inc`` | 7022 | The SPL file type is set to "null" by default in the ``u-boot.inc`` |
6225 | file as follows: # Some versions of u-boot build an SPL (Second | 7023 | file as follows: |
6226 | Program Loader) image that # should be packaged along with the u-boot | 7024 | :: |
6227 | binary as well as placed in the # deploy directory. For those | 7025 | |
6228 | versions they can set the following variables # to allow packaging | 7026 | # Some versions of u-boot build an SPL (Second Program Loader) image that |
6229 | the SPL. SPL_BINARY ?= "" SPL_BINARYNAME ?= | 7027 | # should be packaged along with the u-boot binary as well as placed in the |
6230 | "${@os.path.basename(d.getVar("SPL_BINARY"))}" SPL_IMAGE ?= | 7028 | # deploy directory. For those versions they can set the following variables |
6231 | "${SPL_BINARYNAME}-${MACHINE}-${PV}-${PR}" SPL_SYMLINK ?= | 7029 | # to allow packaging the SPL. |
6232 | "${SPL_BINARYNAME}-${MACHINE}" The ``SPL_BINARY`` variable helps form | 7030 | SPL_BINARY ?= "" |
7031 | SPL_BINARYNAME ?= "${@os.path.basename(d.getVar("SPL_BINARY"))}" | ||
7032 | SPL_IMAGE ?= "${SPL_BINARYNAME}-${MACHINE}-${PV}-${PR}" | ||
7033 | SPL_SYMLINK ?= "${SPL_BINARYNAME}-${MACHINE}" | ||
7034 | |||
7035 | The ``SPL_BINARY`` variable helps form | ||
6233 | various ``SPL_*`` variables used by the OpenEmbedded build system. | 7036 | various ``SPL_*`` variables used by the OpenEmbedded build system. |
6234 | 7037 | ||
6235 | See the BeagleBone machine configuration example in the "`Creating a | 7038 | See the BeagleBone machine configuration example in the |
6236 | new BSP Layer Using the ``bitbake-layers`` | 7039 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:adding a layer using the \`\`bitbake-layers\`\` script`" |
6237 | Script <&YOCTO_DOCS_BSP_URL;#creating-a-new-bsp-layer-using-the-bitbake-layers-script>`__" | ||
6238 | section in the Yocto Project Board Support Package Developer's Guide | 7040 | section in the Yocto Project Board Support Package Developer's Guide |
6239 | for additional information. | 7041 | for additional information. |
6240 | 7042 | ||
6241 | SRC_URI | 7043 | SRC_URI |
6242 | The list of source files - local or remote. This variable tells the | 7044 | The list of source files - local or remote. This variable tells the |
6243 | OpenEmbedded build system which bits to pull in for the build and how | 7045 | OpenEmbedded build system which bits to pull in for the build and how |
@@ -6247,34 +7049,34 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6247 | append file needs to fetch a tarball, apply two patches, and include | 7049 | append file needs to fetch a tarball, apply two patches, and include |
6248 | a custom file, the recipe or append file would include four instances | 7050 | a custom file, the recipe or append file would include four instances |
6249 | of the variable. | 7051 | of the variable. |
6250 | 7052 | ||
6251 | The following list explains the available URI protocols. URI | 7053 | The following list explains the available URI protocols. URI |
6252 | protocols are highly dependent on particular BitBake Fetcher | 7054 | protocols are highly dependent on particular BitBake Fetcher |
6253 | submodules. Depending on the fetcher BitBake uses, various URL | 7055 | submodules. Depending on the fetcher BitBake uses, various URL |
6254 | parameters are employed. For specifics on the supported Fetchers, see | 7056 | parameters are employed. For specifics on the supported Fetchers, see |
6255 | the ":ref:`Fetchers <bitbake:bb-fetchers>`" section in the | 7057 | the ":ref:`Fetchers <bitbake:bb-fetchers>`" section in the |
6256 | BitBake User Manual. | 7058 | BitBake User Manual. |
6257 | 7059 | ||
6258 | - *``file://`` -* Fetches files, which are usually files shipped | 7060 | - ``file://`` - Fetches files, which are usually files shipped |
6259 | with the :term:`Metadata`, from the local machine (e.g. | 7061 | with the :term:`Metadata`, from the local machine (e.g. |
6260 | `patch <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#patching-dev-environment>`__ files). | 7062 | :ref:`patch <patching-dev-environment>` files). |
6261 | The path is relative to the :term:`FILESPATH` | 7063 | The path is relative to the :term:`FILESPATH` |
6262 | variable. Thus, the build system searches, in order, from the | 7064 | variable. Thus, the build system searches, in order, from the |
6263 | following directories, which are assumed to be a subdirectories of | 7065 | following directories, which are assumed to be a subdirectories of |
6264 | the directory in which the recipe file (``.bb``) or append file | 7066 | the directory in which the recipe file (``.bb``) or append file |
6265 | (``.bbappend``) resides: | 7067 | (``.bbappend``) resides: |
6266 | 7068 | ||
6267 | - *``${BPN}`` -* The base recipe name without any special suffix | 7069 | - ``${BPN}`` - The base recipe name without any special suffix |
6268 | or version numbers. | 7070 | or version numbers. |
6269 | 7071 | ||
6270 | - *``${BP}`` -* ``${BPN}-${PV}``. The base recipe name and | 7072 | - ``${BP}`` - ``${BPN}-${PV}``. The base recipe name and |
6271 | version but without any special package name suffix. | 7073 | version but without any special package name suffix. |
6272 | 7074 | ||
6273 | - *files -* Files within a directory, which is named ``files`` | 7075 | - *files -* Files within a directory, which is named ``files`` |
6274 | and is also alongside the recipe or append file. | 7076 | and is also alongside the recipe or append file. |
6275 | 7077 | ||
6276 | .. note:: | 7078 | .. note:: |
6277 | 7079 | ||
6278 | If you want the build system to pick up files specified through | 7080 | If you want the build system to pick up files specified through |
6279 | a | 7081 | a |
6280 | SRC_URI | 7082 | SRC_URI |
@@ -6284,127 +7086,133 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6284 | variable by also using the | 7086 | variable by also using the |
6285 | FILESEXTRAPATHS | 7087 | FILESEXTRAPATHS |
6286 | variable from within your append file. | 7088 | variable from within your append file. |
6287 | 7089 | ||
6288 | - *``bzr://`` -* Fetches files from a Bazaar revision control | 7090 | - ``bzr://`` - Fetches files from a Bazaar revision control |
6289 | repository. | 7091 | repository. |
6290 | 7092 | ||
6291 | - *``git://`` -* Fetches files from a Git revision control | 7093 | - ``git://`` - Fetches files from a Git revision control |
6292 | repository. | 7094 | repository. |
6293 | 7095 | ||
6294 | - *``osc://`` -* Fetches files from an OSC (OpenSUSE Build service) | 7096 | - ``osc://`` - Fetches files from an OSC (OpenSUSE Build service) |
6295 | revision control repository. | 7097 | revision control repository. |
6296 | 7098 | ||
6297 | - *``repo://`` -* Fetches files from a repo (Git) repository. | 7099 | - ``repo://`` - Fetches files from a repo (Git) repository. |
6298 | 7100 | ||
6299 | - *``ccrc://`` -* Fetches files from a ClearCase repository. | 7101 | - ``ccrc://`` - Fetches files from a ClearCase repository. |
6300 | 7102 | ||
6301 | - *``http://`` -* Fetches files from the Internet using ``http``. | 7103 | - ``http://`` - Fetches files from the Internet using ``http``. |
6302 | 7104 | ||
6303 | - *``https://`` -* Fetches files from the Internet using ``https``. | 7105 | - ``https://`` - Fetches files from the Internet using ``https``. |
6304 | 7106 | ||
6305 | - *``ftp://`` -* Fetches files from the Internet using ``ftp``. | 7107 | - ``ftp://`` - Fetches files from the Internet using ``ftp``. |
6306 | 7108 | ||
6307 | - *``cvs://`` -* Fetches files from a CVS revision control | 7109 | - ``cvs://`` - Fetches files from a CVS revision control |
6308 | repository. | 7110 | repository. |
6309 | 7111 | ||
6310 | - *``hg://`` -* Fetches files from a Mercurial (``hg``) revision | 7112 | - ``hg://`` - Fetches files from a Mercurial (``hg``) revision |
6311 | control repository. | 7113 | control repository. |
6312 | 7114 | ||
6313 | - *``p4://`` -* Fetches files from a Perforce (``p4``) revision | 7115 | - ``p4://`` - Fetches files from a Perforce (``p4``) revision |
6314 | control repository. | 7116 | control repository. |
6315 | 7117 | ||
6316 | - *``ssh://`` -* Fetches files from a secure shell. | 7118 | - ``ssh://`` - Fetches files from a secure shell. |
6317 | 7119 | ||
6318 | - *``svn://`` -* Fetches files from a Subversion (``svn``) revision | 7120 | - ``svn://`` - Fetches files from a Subversion (``svn``) revision |
6319 | control repository. | 7121 | control repository. |
6320 | 7122 | ||
6321 | - *``npm://`` -* Fetches JavaScript modules from a registry. | 7123 | - ``npm://`` - Fetches JavaScript modules from a registry. |
6322 | 7124 | ||
6323 | Standard and recipe-specific options for ``SRC_URI`` exist. Here are | 7125 | Standard and recipe-specific options for ``SRC_URI`` exist. Here are |
6324 | standard options: | 7126 | standard options: |
6325 | 7127 | ||
6326 | - *``apply`` -* Whether to apply the patch or not. The default | 7128 | - ``apply`` - Whether to apply the patch or not. The default |
6327 | action is to apply the patch. | 7129 | action is to apply the patch. |
6328 | 7130 | ||
6329 | - *``striplevel`` -* Which striplevel to use when applying the | 7131 | - ``striplevel`` - Which striplevel to use when applying the |
6330 | patch. The default level is 1. | 7132 | patch. The default level is 1. |
6331 | 7133 | ||
6332 | - *``patchdir`` -* Specifies the directory in which the patch should | 7134 | - ``patchdir`` - Specifies the directory in which the patch should |
6333 | be applied. The default is ``${``\ :term:`S`\ ``}``. | 7135 | be applied. The default is ``${``\ :term:`S`\ ``}``. |
6334 | 7136 | ||
6335 | Here are options specific to recipes building code from a revision | 7137 | Here are options specific to recipes building code from a revision |
6336 | control system: | 7138 | control system: |
6337 | 7139 | ||
6338 | - *``mindate`` -* Apply the patch only if | 7140 | - ``mindate`` - Apply the patch only if |
6339 | :term:`SRCDATE` is equal to or greater than | 7141 | :term:`SRCDATE` is equal to or greater than |
6340 | ``mindate``. | 7142 | ``mindate``. |
6341 | 7143 | ||
6342 | - *``maxdate`` -* Apply the patch only if ``SRCDATE`` is not later | 7144 | - ``maxdate`` - Apply the patch only if ``SRCDATE`` is not later |
6343 | than ``maxdate``. | 7145 | than ``maxdate``. |
6344 | 7146 | ||
6345 | - *``minrev`` -* Apply the patch only if ``SRCREV`` is equal to or | 7147 | - ``minrev`` - Apply the patch only if ``SRCREV`` is equal to or |
6346 | greater than ``minrev``. | 7148 | greater than ``minrev``. |
6347 | 7149 | ||
6348 | - *``maxrev`` -* Apply the patch only if ``SRCREV`` is not later | 7150 | - ``maxrev`` - Apply the patch only if ``SRCREV`` is not later |
6349 | than ``maxrev``. | 7151 | than ``maxrev``. |
6350 | 7152 | ||
6351 | - *``rev`` -* Apply the patch only if ``SRCREV`` is equal to | 7153 | - ``rev`` - Apply the patch only if ``SRCREV`` is equal to |
6352 | ``rev``. | 7154 | ``rev``. |
6353 | 7155 | ||
6354 | - *``notrev`` -* Apply the patch only if ``SRCREV`` is not equal to | 7156 | - ``notrev`` - Apply the patch only if ``SRCREV`` is not equal to |
6355 | ``rev``. | 7157 | ``rev``. |
6356 | 7158 | ||
6357 | Here are some additional options worth mentioning: | 7159 | Here are some additional options worth mentioning: |
6358 | 7160 | ||
6359 | - *``unpack`` -* Controls whether or not to unpack the file if it is | 7161 | - ``unpack`` - Controls whether or not to unpack the file if it is |
6360 | an archive. The default action is to unpack the file. | 7162 | an archive. The default action is to unpack the file. |
6361 | 7163 | ||
6362 | - *``destsuffix`` -* Places the file (or extracts its contents) into | 7164 | - ``destsuffix`` - Places the file (or extracts its contents) into |
6363 | the specified subdirectory of :term:`WORKDIR` when | 7165 | the specified subdirectory of :term:`WORKDIR` when |
6364 | the Git fetcher is used. | 7166 | the Git fetcher is used. |
6365 | 7167 | ||
6366 | - *``subdir`` -* Places the file (or extracts its contents) into the | 7168 | - ``subdir`` - Places the file (or extracts its contents) into the |
6367 | specified subdirectory of ``WORKDIR`` when the local (``file://``) | 7169 | specified subdirectory of ``WORKDIR`` when the local (``file://``) |
6368 | fetcher is used. | 7170 | fetcher is used. |
6369 | 7171 | ||
6370 | - *``localdir`` -* Places the file (or extracts its contents) into | 7172 | - ``localdir`` - Places the file (or extracts its contents) into |
6371 | the specified subdirectory of ``WORKDIR`` when the CVS fetcher is | 7173 | the specified subdirectory of ``WORKDIR`` when the CVS fetcher is |
6372 | used. | 7174 | used. |
6373 | 7175 | ||
6374 | - *``subpath`` -* Limits the checkout to a specific subpath of the | 7176 | - ``subpath`` - Limits the checkout to a specific subpath of the |
6375 | tree when using the Git fetcher is used. | 7177 | tree when using the Git fetcher is used. |
6376 | 7178 | ||
6377 | - *``name`` -* Specifies a name to be used for association with | 7179 | - ``name`` - Specifies a name to be used for association with |
6378 | ``SRC_URI`` checksums when you have more than one file specified | 7180 | ``SRC_URI`` checksums when you have more than one file specified |
6379 | in ``SRC_URI``. | 7181 | in ``SRC_URI``. |
6380 | 7182 | ||
6381 | - *``downloadfilename`` -* Specifies the filename used when storing | 7183 | - ``downloadfilename`` - Specifies the filename used when storing |
6382 | the downloaded file. | 7184 | the downloaded file. |
6383 | 7185 | ||
6384 | SRC_URI_OVERRIDES_PACKAGE_ARCH | 7186 | SRC_URI_OVERRIDES_PACKAGE_ARCH |
6385 | By default, the OpenEmbedded build system automatically detects | 7187 | By default, the OpenEmbedded build system automatically detects |
6386 | whether ``SRC_URI`` contains files that are machine-specific. If so, | 7188 | whether ``SRC_URI`` contains files that are machine-specific. If so, |
6387 | the build system automatically changes ``PACKAGE_ARCH``. Setting this | 7189 | the build system automatically changes ``PACKAGE_ARCH``. Setting this |
6388 | variable to "0" disables this behavior. | 7190 | variable to "0" disables this behavior. |
6389 | 7191 | ||
6390 | SRCDATE | 7192 | SRCDATE |
6391 | The date of the source code used to build the package. This variable | 7193 | The date of the source code used to build the package. This variable |
6392 | applies only if the source was fetched from a Source Code Manager | 7194 | applies only if the source was fetched from a Source Code Manager |
6393 | (SCM). | 7195 | (SCM). |
6394 | 7196 | ||
6395 | SRCPV | 7197 | SRCPV |
6396 | Returns the version string of the current package. This string is | 7198 | Returns the version string of the current package. This string is |
6397 | used to help define the value of :term:`PV`. | 7199 | used to help define the value of :term:`PV`. |
6398 | 7200 | ||
6399 | The ``SRCPV`` variable is defined in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` | 7201 | The ``SRCPV`` variable is defined in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` |
6400 | configuration file in the :term:`Source Directory` as | 7202 | configuration file in the :term:`Source Directory` as |
6401 | follows: SRCPV = "${@bb.fetch2.get_srcrev(d)}" | 7203 | follows: |
6402 | 7204 | :: | |
7205 | |||
7206 | SRCPV = "${@bb.fetch2.get_srcrev(d)}" | ||
7207 | |||
6403 | Recipes that need to define ``PV`` do so with the help of the | 7208 | Recipes that need to define ``PV`` do so with the help of the |
6404 | ``SRCPV``. For example, the ``ofono`` recipe (``ofono_git.bb``) | 7209 | ``SRCPV``. For example, the ``ofono`` recipe (``ofono_git.bb``) |
6405 | located in ``meta/recipes-connectivity`` in the Source Directory | 7210 | located in ``meta/recipes-connectivity`` in the Source Directory |
6406 | defines ``PV`` as follows: PV = "0.12-git${SRCPV}" | 7211 | defines ``PV`` as follows: |
6407 | 7212 | :: | |
7213 | |||
7214 | PV = "0.12-git${SRCPV}" | ||
7215 | |||
6408 | SRCREV | 7216 | SRCREV |
6409 | The revision of the source code used to build the package. This | 7217 | The revision of the source code used to build the package. This |
6410 | variable applies to Subversion, Git, Mercurial, and Bazaar only. Note | 7218 | variable applies to Subversion, Git, Mercurial, and Bazaar only. Note |
@@ -6412,9 +7220,9 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6412 | performing a query on the remote repository every time BitBake parses | 7220 | performing a query on the remote repository every time BitBake parses |
6413 | your recipe, you should specify a ``SRCREV`` that is a full revision | 7221 | your recipe, you should specify a ``SRCREV`` that is a full revision |
6414 | identifier and not just a tag. | 7222 | identifier and not just a tag. |
6415 | 7223 | ||
6416 | .. note:: | 7224 | .. note:: |
6417 | 7225 | ||
6418 | For information on limitations when inheriting the latest revision | 7226 | For information on limitations when inheriting the latest revision |
6419 | of software using | 7227 | of software using |
6420 | SRCREV | 7228 | SRCREV |
@@ -6423,10 +7231,10 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6423 | variable description and the " | 7231 | variable description and the " |
6424 | Automatically Incrementing a Binary Package Revision Number | 7232 | Automatically Incrementing a Binary Package Revision Number |
6425 | " section, which is in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 7233 | " section, which is in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
6426 | 7234 | ||
6427 | SSTATE_DIR | 7235 | SSTATE_DIR |
6428 | The directory for the shared state cache. | 7236 | The directory for the shared state cache. |
6429 | 7237 | ||
6430 | SSTATE_MIRROR_ALLOW_NETWORK | 7238 | SSTATE_MIRROR_ALLOW_NETWORK |
6431 | If set to "1", allows fetches from mirrors that are specified in | 7239 | If set to "1", allows fetches from mirrors that are specified in |
6432 | :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` to work even when | 7240 | :term:`SSTATE_MIRRORS` to work even when |
@@ -6435,19 +7243,19 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6435 | you have set ``SSTATE_MIRRORS`` to point to an internal server for | 7243 | you have set ``SSTATE_MIRRORS`` to point to an internal server for |
6436 | your shared state cache, but you want to disable any other fetching | 7244 | your shared state cache, but you want to disable any other fetching |
6437 | from the network. | 7245 | from the network. |
6438 | 7246 | ||
6439 | SSTATE_MIRRORS | 7247 | SSTATE_MIRRORS |
6440 | Configures the OpenEmbedded build system to search other mirror | 7248 | Configures the OpenEmbedded build system to search other mirror |
6441 | locations for prebuilt cache data objects before building out the | 7249 | locations for prebuilt cache data objects before building out the |
6442 | data. This variable works like fetcher :term:`MIRRORS` | 7250 | data. This variable works like fetcher :term:`MIRRORS` |
6443 | and :term:`PREMIRRORS` and points to the cache | 7251 | and :term:`PREMIRRORS` and points to the cache |
6444 | locations to check for the shared state (sstate) objects. | 7252 | locations to check for the shared state (sstate) objects. |
6445 | 7253 | ||
6446 | You can specify a filesystem directory or a remote URL such as HTTP | 7254 | You can specify a filesystem directory or a remote URL such as HTTP |
6447 | or FTP. The locations you specify need to contain the shared state | 7255 | or FTP. The locations you specify need to contain the shared state |
6448 | cache (sstate-cache) results from previous builds. The sstate-cache | 7256 | cache (sstate-cache) results from previous builds. The sstate-cache |
6449 | you point to can also be from builds on other machines. | 7257 | you point to can also be from builds on other machines. |
6450 | 7258 | ||
6451 | When pointing to sstate build artifacts on another machine that uses | 7259 | When pointing to sstate build artifacts on another machine that uses |
6452 | a different GCC version for native builds, you must configure | 7260 | a different GCC version for native builds, you must configure |
6453 | ``SSTATE_MIRRORS`` with a regular expression that maps local search | 7261 | ``SSTATE_MIRRORS`` with a regular expression that maps local search |
@@ -6455,24 +7263,27 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6455 | :term:`NATIVELSBSTRING` set by the | 7263 | :term:`NATIVELSBSTRING` set by the |
6456 | :ref:`uninative <ref-classes-uninative>` class. For example, the | 7264 | :ref:`uninative <ref-classes-uninative>` class. For example, the |
6457 | following maps the local search path ``universal-4.9`` to the | 7265 | following maps the local search path ``universal-4.9`` to the |
6458 | server-provided path server_url_sstate_path: SSTATE_MIRRORS ?= | 7266 | server-provided path server_url_sstate_path: |
6459 | file://universal-4.9/(.*) | 7267 | :: |
6460 | http://server_url_sstate_path/universal-4.8/\1 \\n | 7268 | |
6461 | 7269 | SSTATE_MIRRORS ?= "file://universal-4.9/(.*) http://server_url_sstate_path/universal-4.8/\1 \n" | |
7270 | |||
6462 | If a mirror uses the same structure as | 7271 | If a mirror uses the same structure as |
6463 | :term:`SSTATE_DIR`, you need to add "PATH" at the | 7272 | :term:`SSTATE_DIR`, you need to add "PATH" at the |
6464 | end as shown in the examples below. The build system substitutes the | 7273 | end as shown in the examples below. The build system substitutes the |
6465 | correct path within the directory structure. SSTATE_MIRRORS ?= "\\ | 7274 | correct path within the directory structure. |
6466 | file://.\* | 7275 | :: |
6467 | http://someserver.tld/share/sstate/PATH;downloadfilename=PATH \\n \\ | 7276 | |
6468 | file://.\* file:///some-local-dir/sstate/PATH" | 7277 | SSTATE_MIRRORS ?= "\ |
6469 | 7278 | file://.* http://someserver.tld/share/sstate/PATH;downloadfilename=PATH \n \ | |
7279 | file://.* file:///some-local-dir/sstate/PATH" | ||
7280 | |||
6470 | SSTATE_SCAN_FILES | 7281 | SSTATE_SCAN_FILES |
6471 | Controls the list of files the OpenEmbedded build system scans for | 7282 | Controls the list of files the OpenEmbedded build system scans for |
6472 | hardcoded installation paths. The variable uses a space-separated | 7283 | hardcoded installation paths. The variable uses a space-separated |
6473 | list of filenames (not paths) with standard wildcard characters | 7284 | list of filenames (not paths) with standard wildcard characters |
6474 | allowed. | 7285 | allowed. |
6475 | 7286 | ||
6476 | During a build, the OpenEmbedded build system creates a shared state | 7287 | During a build, the OpenEmbedded build system creates a shared state |
6477 | (sstate) object during the first stage of preparing the sysroots. | 7288 | (sstate) object during the first stage of preparing the sysroots. |
6478 | That object is scanned for hardcoded paths for original installation | 7289 | That object is scanned for hardcoded paths for original installation |
@@ -6482,32 +7293,32 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6482 | than the variable being comprehensively set. The | 7293 | than the variable being comprehensively set. The |
6483 | :ref:`sstate <ref-classes-sstate>` class specifies the default list | 7294 | :ref:`sstate <ref-classes-sstate>` class specifies the default list |
6484 | of files. | 7295 | of files. |
6485 | 7296 | ||
6486 | For details on the process, see the | 7297 | For details on the process, see the |
6487 | :ref:`staging <ref-classes-staging>` class. | 7298 | :ref:`staging <ref-classes-staging>` class. |
6488 | 7299 | ||
6489 | STAGING_BASE_LIBDIR_NATIVE | 7300 | STAGING_BASE_LIBDIR_NATIVE |
6490 | Specifies the path to the ``/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot | 7301 | Specifies the path to the ``/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot |
6491 | directory for the build host. | 7302 | directory for the build host. |
6492 | 7303 | ||
6493 | STAGING_BASELIBDIR | 7304 | STAGING_BASELIBDIR |
6494 | Specifies the path to the ``/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot | 7305 | Specifies the path to the ``/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot |
6495 | directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built | 7306 | directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built |
6496 | (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). | 7307 | (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). |
6497 | 7308 | ||
6498 | STAGING_BINDIR | 7309 | STAGING_BINDIR |
6499 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/bin`` subdirectory of the sysroot | 7310 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/bin`` subdirectory of the sysroot |
6500 | directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built | 7311 | directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built |
6501 | (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). | 7312 | (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). |
6502 | 7313 | ||
6503 | STAGING_BINDIR_CROSS | 7314 | STAGING_BINDIR_CROSS |
6504 | Specifies the path to the directory containing binary configuration | 7315 | Specifies the path to the directory containing binary configuration |
6505 | scripts. These scripts provide configuration information for other | 7316 | scripts. These scripts provide configuration information for other |
6506 | software that wants to make use of libraries or include files | 7317 | software that wants to make use of libraries or include files |
6507 | provided by the software associated with the script. | 7318 | provided by the software associated with the script. |
6508 | 7319 | ||
6509 | .. note:: | 7320 | .. note:: |
6510 | 7321 | ||
6511 | This style of build configuration has been largely replaced by | 7322 | This style of build configuration has been largely replaced by |
6512 | pkg-config | 7323 | pkg-config |
6513 | . Consequently, if | 7324 | . Consequently, if |
@@ -6516,36 +7327,34 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6516 | recommended you use | 7327 | recommended you use |
6517 | pkg-config | 7328 | pkg-config |
6518 | instead of a provided configuration script. | 7329 | instead of a provided configuration script. |
6519 | 7330 | ||
6520 | STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE | 7331 | STAGING_BINDIR_NATIVE |
6521 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/bin`` subdirectory of the sysroot | 7332 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/bin`` subdirectory of the sysroot |
6522 | directory for the build host. | 7333 | directory for the build host. |
6523 | 7334 | ||
6524 | STAGING_DATADIR | 7335 | STAGING_DATADIR |
6525 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/share`` subdirectory of the sysroot | 7336 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/share`` subdirectory of the sysroot |
6526 | directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built | 7337 | directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built |
6527 | (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). | 7338 | (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). |
6528 | 7339 | ||
6529 | STAGING_DATADIR_NATIVE | 7340 | STAGING_DATADIR_NATIVE |
6530 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/share`` subdirectory of the sysroot | 7341 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/share`` subdirectory of the sysroot |
6531 | directory for the build host. | 7342 | directory for the build host. |
6532 | 7343 | ||
6533 | STAGING_DIR | 7344 | STAGING_DIR |
6534 | Helps construct the ``recipe-sysroots`` directory, which is used | 7345 | Helps construct the ``recipe-sysroots`` directory, which is used |
6535 | during packaging. | 7346 | during packaging. |
6536 | 7347 | ||
6537 | For information on how staging for recipe-specific sysroots occurs, | 7348 | For information on how staging for recipe-specific sysroots occurs, |
6538 | see the :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` | 7349 | see the :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` |
6539 | task, the "`Sharing Files Between | 7350 | task, the ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-extensible:sharing files between recipes`" |
6540 | Recipes <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#new-sharing-files-between-recipes>`__" | ||
6541 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual, the | 7351 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual, the |
6542 | "`Configuration, Compilation, and | 7352 | ":ref:`configuration-compilation-and-staging-dev-environment`" |
6543 | Staging <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#configuration-compilation-and-staging-dev-environment>`__" | ||
6544 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual, and the | 7353 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual, and the |
6545 | :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS` variable. | 7354 | :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS` variable. |
6546 | 7355 | ||
6547 | .. note:: | 7356 | .. note:: |
6548 | 7357 | ||
6549 | Recipes should never write files directly under the | 7358 | Recipes should never write files directly under the |
6550 | STAGING_DIR | 7359 | STAGING_DIR |
6551 | directory because the OpenEmbedded build system manages the | 7360 | directory because the OpenEmbedded build system manages the |
@@ -6557,7 +7366,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6557 | do_install | 7366 | do_install |
6558 | task and then the OpenEmbedded build system will stage a subset of | 7367 | task and then the OpenEmbedded build system will stage a subset of |
6559 | those files into the sysroot. | 7368 | those files into the sysroot. |
6560 | 7369 | ||
6561 | STAGING_DIR_HOST | 7370 | STAGING_DIR_HOST |
6562 | Specifies the path to the sysroot directory for the system on which | 7371 | Specifies the path to the sysroot directory for the system on which |
6563 | the component is built to run (the system that hosts the component). | 7372 | the component is built to run (the system that hosts the component). |
@@ -6568,16 +7377,16 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6568 | :term:`STAGING_DIR_NATIVE`. Depending on | 7377 | :term:`STAGING_DIR_NATIVE`. Depending on |
6569 | the type of recipe and the build target, ``STAGING_DIR_HOST`` can | 7378 | the type of recipe and the build target, ``STAGING_DIR_HOST`` can |
6570 | have the following values: | 7379 | have the following values: |
6571 | 7380 | ||
6572 | - For recipes building for the target machine, the value is | 7381 | - For recipes building for the target machine, the value is |
6573 | "${:term:`STAGING_DIR`}/${:term:`MACHINE`}". | 7382 | "${:term:`STAGING_DIR`}/${:term:`MACHINE`}". |
6574 | 7383 | ||
6575 | - For native recipes building for the build host, the value is empty | 7384 | - For native recipes building for the build host, the value is empty |
6576 | given the assumption that when building for the build host, the | 7385 | given the assumption that when building for the build host, the |
6577 | build host's own directories should be used. | 7386 | build host's own directories should be used. |
6578 | 7387 | ||
6579 | .. note:: | 7388 | .. note:: |
6580 | 7389 | ||
6581 | ``-native`` recipes are not installed into host paths like such | 7390 | ``-native`` recipes are not installed into host paths like such |
6582 | as ``/usr``. Rather, these recipes are installed into | 7391 | as ``/usr``. Rather, these recipes are installed into |
6583 | ``STAGING_DIR_NATIVE``. When compiling ``-native`` recipes, | 7392 | ``STAGING_DIR_NATIVE``. When compiling ``-native`` recipes, |
@@ -6586,7 +7395,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6586 | :term:`CFLAGS` are set up so that both host paths | 7395 | :term:`CFLAGS` are set up so that both host paths |
6587 | and ``STAGING_DIR_NATIVE`` are searched for libraries and | 7396 | and ``STAGING_DIR_NATIVE`` are searched for libraries and |
6588 | headers using, for example, GCC's ``-isystem`` option. | 7397 | headers using, for example, GCC's ``-isystem`` option. |
6589 | 7398 | ||
6590 | Thus, the emphasis is that the ``STAGING_DIR*`` variables | 7399 | Thus, the emphasis is that the ``STAGING_DIR*`` variables |
6591 | should be viewed as input variables by tasks such as | 7400 | should be viewed as input variables by tasks such as |
6592 | :ref:`ref-tasks-configure`, | 7401 | :ref:`ref-tasks-configure`, |
@@ -6595,17 +7404,17 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6595 | root correspond to ``STAGING_DIR_HOST`` makes conceptual sense | 7404 | root correspond to ``STAGING_DIR_HOST`` makes conceptual sense |
6596 | for ``-native`` recipes, as they make use of host headers and | 7405 | for ``-native`` recipes, as they make use of host headers and |
6597 | libraries. | 7406 | libraries. |
6598 | 7407 | ||
6599 | STAGING_DIR_NATIVE | 7408 | STAGING_DIR_NATIVE |
6600 | Specifies the path to the sysroot directory used when building | 7409 | Specifies the path to the sysroot directory used when building |
6601 | components that run on the build host itself. | 7410 | components that run on the build host itself. |
6602 | 7411 | ||
6603 | STAGING_DIR_TARGET | 7412 | STAGING_DIR_TARGET |
6604 | Specifies the path to the sysroot used for the system for which the | 7413 | Specifies the path to the sysroot used for the system for which the |
6605 | component generates code. For components that do not generate code, | 7414 | component generates code. For components that do not generate code, |
6606 | which is the majority, ``STAGING_DIR_TARGET`` is set to match | 7415 | which is the majority, ``STAGING_DIR_TARGET`` is set to match |
6607 | :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`. | 7416 | :term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`. |
6608 | 7417 | ||
6609 | Some recipes build binaries that can run on the target system but | 7418 | Some recipes build binaries that can run on the target system but |
6610 | those binaries in turn generate code for another different system | 7419 | those binaries in turn generate code for another different system |
6611 | (e.g. cross-canadian recipes). Using terminology from GNU, the | 7420 | (e.g. cross-canadian recipes). Using terminology from GNU, the |
@@ -6615,171 +7424,203 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6615 | system. The ``STAGING_DIR_HOST`` variable points to the sysroot used | 7424 | system. The ``STAGING_DIR_HOST`` variable points to the sysroot used |
6616 | for the "HOST" system, while ``STAGING_DIR_TARGET`` points to the | 7425 | for the "HOST" system, while ``STAGING_DIR_TARGET`` points to the |
6617 | sysroot used for the "TARGET" system. | 7426 | sysroot used for the "TARGET" system. |
6618 | 7427 | ||
6619 | STAGING_ETCDIR_NATIVE | 7428 | STAGING_ETCDIR_NATIVE |
6620 | Specifies the path to the ``/etc`` subdirectory of the sysroot | 7429 | Specifies the path to the ``/etc`` subdirectory of the sysroot |
6621 | directory for the build host. | 7430 | directory for the build host. |
6622 | 7431 | ||
6623 | STAGING_EXECPREFIXDIR | 7432 | STAGING_EXECPREFIXDIR |
6624 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr`` subdirectory of the sysroot | 7433 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr`` subdirectory of the sysroot |
6625 | directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built | 7434 | directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built |
6626 | (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). | 7435 | (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). |
6627 | 7436 | ||
6628 | STAGING_INCDIR | 7437 | STAGING_INCDIR |
6629 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/include`` subdirectory of the | 7438 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/include`` subdirectory of the |
6630 | sysroot directory for the target for which the current recipe being | 7439 | sysroot directory for the target for which the current recipe being |
6631 | built (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). | 7440 | built (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). |
6632 | 7441 | ||
6633 | STAGING_INCDIR_NATIVE | 7442 | STAGING_INCDIR_NATIVE |
6634 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/include`` subdirectory of the | 7443 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/include`` subdirectory of the |
6635 | sysroot directory for the build host. | 7444 | sysroot directory for the build host. |
6636 | 7445 | ||
6637 | STAGING_KERNEL_BUILDDIR | 7446 | STAGING_KERNEL_BUILDDIR |
6638 | Points to the directory containing the kernel build artifacts. | 7447 | Points to the directory containing the kernel build artifacts. |
6639 | Recipes building software that needs to access kernel build artifacts | 7448 | Recipes building software that needs to access kernel build artifacts |
6640 | (e.g. ``systemtap-uprobes``) can look in the directory specified with | 7449 | (e.g. ``systemtap-uprobes``) can look in the directory specified with |
6641 | the ``STAGING_KERNEL_BUILDDIR`` variable to find these artifacts | 7450 | the ``STAGING_KERNEL_BUILDDIR`` variable to find these artifacts |
6642 | after the kernel has been built. | 7451 | after the kernel has been built. |
6643 | 7452 | ||
6644 | STAGING_KERNEL_DIR | 7453 | STAGING_KERNEL_DIR |
6645 | The directory with kernel headers that are required to build | 7454 | The directory with kernel headers that are required to build |
6646 | out-of-tree modules. | 7455 | out-of-tree modules. |
6647 | 7456 | ||
6648 | STAGING_LIBDIR | 7457 | STAGING_LIBDIR |
6649 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot | 7458 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot |
6650 | directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built | 7459 | directory for the target for which the current recipe is being built |
6651 | (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). | 7460 | (:term:`STAGING_DIR_HOST`). |
6652 | 7461 | ||
6653 | STAGING_LIBDIR_NATIVE | 7462 | STAGING_LIBDIR_NATIVE |
6654 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot | 7463 | Specifies the path to the ``/usr/lib`` subdirectory of the sysroot |
6655 | directory for the build host. | 7464 | directory for the build host. |
6656 | 7465 | ||
6657 | STAMP | 7466 | STAMP |
6658 | Specifies the base path used to create recipe stamp files. The path | 7467 | Specifies the base path used to create recipe stamp files. The path |
6659 | to an actual stamp file is constructed by evaluating this string and | 7468 | to an actual stamp file is constructed by evaluating this string and |
6660 | then appending additional information. Currently, the default | 7469 | then appending additional information. Currently, the default |
6661 | assignment for ``STAMP`` as set in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` | 7470 | assignment for ``STAMP`` as set in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` |
6662 | file is: STAMP = | 7471 | file is: |
6663 | "${STAMPS_DIR}/${MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS}/${PN}/${EXTENDPE}${PV}-${PR}" | 7472 | :: |
6664 | 7473 | ||
7474 | STAMP = "${STAMPS_DIR}/${MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS}/${PN}/${EXTENDPE}${PV}-${PR}" | ||
7475 | |||
6665 | For information on how BitBake uses stamp files to determine if a | 7476 | For information on how BitBake uses stamp files to determine if a |
6666 | task should be rerun, see the "`Stamp Files and the Rerunning of | 7477 | task should be rerun, see the |
6667 | Tasks <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#stamp-files-and-the-rerunning-of-tasks>`__" | 7478 | ":ref:`overview-manual/overview-manual-concepts:stamp files and the rerunning of tasks`" |
6668 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. | 7479 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. |
6669 | 7480 | ||
6670 | See :term:`STAMPS_DIR`, | 7481 | See :term:`STAMPS_DIR`, |
6671 | :term:`MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS`, | 7482 | :term:`MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS`, |
6672 | :term:`PN`, :term:`EXTENDPE`, | 7483 | :term:`PN`, :term:`EXTENDPE`, |
6673 | :term:`PV`, and :term:`PR` for related variable | 7484 | :term:`PV`, and :term:`PR` for related variable |
6674 | information. | 7485 | information. |
6675 | 7486 | ||
6676 | STAMPS_DIR | 7487 | STAMPS_DIR |
6677 | Specifies the base directory in which the OpenEmbedded build system | 7488 | Specifies the base directory in which the OpenEmbedded build system |
6678 | places stamps. The default directory is ``${TMPDIR}/stamps``. | 7489 | places stamps. The default directory is ``${TMPDIR}/stamps``. |
6679 | 7490 | ||
6680 | STRIP | 7491 | STRIP |
6681 | The minimal command and arguments to run ``strip``, which is used to | 7492 | The minimal command and arguments to run ``strip``, which is used to |
6682 | strip symbols. | 7493 | strip symbols. |
6683 | 7494 | ||
6684 | SUMMARY | 7495 | SUMMARY |
6685 | The short (72 characters or less) summary of the binary package for | 7496 | The short (72 characters or less) summary of the binary package for |
6686 | packaging systems such as ``opkg``, ``rpm``, or ``dpkg``. By default, | 7497 | packaging systems such as ``opkg``, ``rpm``, or ``dpkg``. By default, |
6687 | ``SUMMARY`` is used to define the | 7498 | ``SUMMARY`` is used to define the |
6688 | :term:`DESCRIPTION` variable if ``DESCRIPTION`` is | 7499 | :term:`DESCRIPTION` variable if ``DESCRIPTION`` is |
6689 | not set in the recipe. | 7500 | not set in the recipe. |
6690 | 7501 | ||
6691 | SVNDIR | 7502 | SVNDIR |
6692 | The directory in which files checked out of a Subversion system are | 7503 | The directory in which files checked out of a Subversion system are |
6693 | stored. | 7504 | stored. |
6694 | 7505 | ||
6695 | SYSLINUX_DEFAULT_CONSOLE | 7506 | SYSLINUX_DEFAULT_CONSOLE |
6696 | Specifies the kernel boot default console. If you want to use a | 7507 | Specifies the kernel boot default console. If you want to use a |
6697 | console other than the default, set this variable in your recipe as | 7508 | console other than the default, set this variable in your recipe as |
6698 | follows where "X" is the console number you want to use: | 7509 | follows where "X" is the console number you want to use: |
6699 | SYSLINUX_DEFAULT_CONSOLE = "console=ttyX" | 7510 | :: |
6700 | 7511 | ||
7512 | SYSLINUX_DEFAULT_CONSOLE = "console=ttyX" | ||
7513 | |||
6701 | The :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class initially sets | 7514 | The :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class initially sets |
6702 | this variable to null but then checks for a value later. | 7515 | this variable to null but then checks for a value later. |
6703 | 7516 | ||
6704 | SYSLINUX_OPTS | 7517 | SYSLINUX_OPTS |
6705 | Lists additional options to add to the syslinux file. You need to set | 7518 | Lists additional options to add to the syslinux file. You need to set |
6706 | this variable in your recipe. If you want to list multiple options, | 7519 | this variable in your recipe. If you want to list multiple options, |
6707 | separate the options with a semicolon character (``;``). | 7520 | separate the options with a semicolon character (``;``). |
6708 | 7521 | ||
6709 | The :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class uses this variable | 7522 | The :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class uses this variable |
6710 | to create a set of options. | 7523 | to create a set of options. |
6711 | 7524 | ||
6712 | SYSLINUX_SERIAL | 7525 | SYSLINUX_SERIAL |
6713 | Specifies the alternate serial port or turns it off. To turn off | 7526 | Specifies the alternate serial port or turns it off. To turn off |
6714 | serial, set this variable to an empty string in your recipe. The | 7527 | serial, set this variable to an empty string in your recipe. The |
6715 | variable's default value is set in the | 7528 | variable's default value is set in the |
6716 | :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class as follows: | 7529 | :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class as follows: |
6717 | SYSLINUX_SERIAL ?= "0 115200" | 7530 | :: |
6718 | 7531 | ||
7532 | SYSLINUX_SERIAL ?= "0 115200" | ||
7533 | |||
6719 | The class checks for and uses the variable as needed. | 7534 | The class checks for and uses the variable as needed. |
6720 | 7535 | ||
6721 | SYSLINUX_SPLASH | 7536 | SYSLINUX_SPLASH |
6722 | An ``.LSS`` file used as the background for the VGA boot menu when | 7537 | An ``.LSS`` file used as the background for the VGA boot menu when |
6723 | you use the boot menu. You need to set this variable in your recipe. | 7538 | you use the boot menu. You need to set this variable in your recipe. |
6724 | 7539 | ||
6725 | The :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class checks for this | 7540 | The :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class checks for this |
6726 | variable and if found, the OpenEmbedded build system installs the | 7541 | variable and if found, the OpenEmbedded build system installs the |
6727 | splash screen. | 7542 | splash screen. |
6728 | 7543 | ||
6729 | SYSLINUX_SERIAL_TTY | 7544 | SYSLINUX_SERIAL_TTY |
6730 | Specifies the alternate console=tty... kernel boot argument. The | 7545 | Specifies the alternate console=tty... kernel boot argument. The |
6731 | variable's default value is set in the | 7546 | variable's default value is set in the |
6732 | :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class as follows: | 7547 | :ref:`syslinux <ref-classes-syslinux>` class as follows: |
6733 | SYSLINUX_SERIAL_TTY ?= "console=ttyS0,115200" | 7548 | :: |
6734 | 7549 | ||
7550 | SYSLINUX_SERIAL_TTY ?= "console=ttyS0,115200" | ||
7551 | |||
6735 | The class checks for and uses the variable as needed. | 7552 | The class checks for and uses the variable as needed. |
6736 | 7553 | ||
6737 | SYSROOT_DESTDIR | 7554 | SYSROOT_DESTDIR |
6738 | Points to the temporary directory under the work directory (default | 7555 | Points to the temporary directory under the work directory (default |
6739 | "``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/sysroot-destdir``") | 7556 | "``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/sysroot-destdir``") |
6740 | where the files populated into the sysroot are assembled during the | 7557 | where the files populated into the sysroot are assembled during the |
6741 | :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task. | 7558 | :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task. |
6742 | 7559 | ||
6743 | SYSROOT_DIRS | 7560 | SYSROOT_DIRS |
6744 | Directories that are staged into the sysroot by the | 7561 | Directories that are staged into the sysroot by the |
6745 | :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task. By | 7562 | :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task. By |
6746 | default, the following directories are staged: SYSROOT_DIRS = " \\ | 7563 | default, the following directories are staged: |
6747 | ${includedir} \\ ${libdir} \\ ${base_libdir} \\ | 7564 | :: |
6748 | ${nonarch_base_libdir} \\ ${datadir} \\ " | 7565 | |
6749 | 7566 | SYSROOT_DIRS = " \ | |
7567 | ${includedir} \ | ||
7568 | ${libdir} \ | ||
7569 | ${base_libdir} \ | ||
7570 | ${nonarch_base_libdir} \ | ||
7571 | ${datadir} \ | ||
7572 | " | ||
7573 | |||
6750 | SYSROOT_DIRS_BLACKLIST | 7574 | SYSROOT_DIRS_BLACKLIST |
6751 | Directories that are not staged into the sysroot by the | 7575 | Directories that are not staged into the sysroot by the |
6752 | :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task. You | 7576 | :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task. You |
6753 | can use this variable to exclude certain subdirectories of | 7577 | can use this variable to exclude certain subdirectories of |
6754 | directories listed in :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS` from | 7578 | directories listed in :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS` from |
6755 | staging. By default, the following directories are not staged: | 7579 | staging. By default, the following directories are not staged: |
6756 | SYSROOT_DIRS_BLACKLIST = " \\ ${mandir} \\ ${docdir} \\ ${infodir} \\ | 7580 | :: |
6757 | ${datadir}/locale \\ ${datadir}/applications \\ ${datadir}/fonts \\ | 7581 | |
6758 | ${datadir}/pixmaps \\ " | 7582 | SYSROOT_DIRS_BLACKLIST = " \ |
6759 | 7583 | ${mandir} \ | |
7584 | ${docdir} \ | ||
7585 | ${infodir} \ | ||
7586 | ${datadir}/locale \ | ||
7587 | ${datadir}/applications \ | ||
7588 | ${datadir}/fonts \ | ||
7589 | ${datadir}/pixmaps \ | ||
7590 | " | ||
7591 | |||
6760 | SYSROOT_DIRS_NATIVE | 7592 | SYSROOT_DIRS_NATIVE |
6761 | Extra directories staged into the sysroot by the | 7593 | Extra directories staged into the sysroot by the |
6762 | :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task for | 7594 | :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task for |
6763 | ``-native`` recipes, in addition to those specified in | 7595 | ``-native`` recipes, in addition to those specified in |
6764 | :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS`. By default, the following | 7596 | :term:`SYSROOT_DIRS`. By default, the following |
6765 | extra directories are staged: SYSROOT_DIRS_NATIVE = " \\ ${bindir} \\ | 7597 | extra directories are staged: |
6766 | ${sbindir} \\ ${base_bindir} \\ ${base_sbindir} \\ ${libexecdir} \\ | 7598 | :: |
6767 | ${sysconfdir} \\ ${localstatedir} \\ " | 7599 | |
6768 | 7600 | SYSROOT_DIRS_NATIVE = " \ | |
7601 | ${bindir} \ | ||
7602 | ${sbindir} \ | ||
7603 | ${base_bindir} \ | ||
7604 | ${base_sbindir} \ | ||
7605 | ${libexecdir} \ | ||
7606 | ${sysconfdir} \ | ||
7607 | ${localstatedir} \ | ||
7608 | " | ||
7609 | |||
6769 | .. note:: | 7610 | .. note:: |
6770 | 7611 | ||
6771 | Programs built by | 7612 | Programs built by |
6772 | -native | 7613 | -native |
6773 | recipes run directly from the sysroot ( | 7614 | recipes run directly from the sysroot ( |
6774 | STAGING_DIR_NATIVE | 7615 | STAGING_DIR_NATIVE |
6775 | ), which is why additional directories containing program | 7616 | ), which is why additional directories containing program |
6776 | executables and supporting files need to be staged. | 7617 | executables and supporting files need to be staged. |
6777 | 7618 | ||
6778 | SYSROOT_PREPROCESS_FUNCS | 7619 | SYSROOT_PREPROCESS_FUNCS |
6779 | A list of functions to execute after files are staged into the | 7620 | A list of functions to execute after files are staged into the |
6780 | sysroot. These functions are usually used to apply additional | 7621 | sysroot. These functions are usually used to apply additional |
6781 | processing on the staged files, or to stage additional files. | 7622 | processing on the staged files, or to stage additional files. |
6782 | 7623 | ||
6783 | SYSTEMD_AUTO_ENABLE | 7624 | SYSTEMD_AUTO_ENABLE |
6784 | When inheriting the :ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class, | 7625 | When inheriting the :ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class, |
6785 | this variable specifies whether the specified service in | 7626 | this variable specifies whether the specified service in |
@@ -6787,111 +7628,138 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6787 | automatically or not. By default, the service is enabled to | 7628 | automatically or not. By default, the service is enabled to |
6788 | automatically start at boot time. The default setting is in the | 7629 | automatically start at boot time. The default setting is in the |
6789 | :ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class as follows: | 7630 | :ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class as follows: |
6790 | SYSTEMD_AUTO_ENABLE ??= "enable" | 7631 | :: |
6791 | 7632 | ||
7633 | SYSTEMD_AUTO_ENABLE ??= "enable" | ||
7634 | |||
6792 | You can disable the service by setting the variable to "disable". | 7635 | You can disable the service by setting the variable to "disable". |
6793 | 7636 | ||
6794 | SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG | 7637 | SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG |
6795 | When :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` is set to | 7638 | When :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` is set to |
6796 | "systemd-boot", the ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG`` variable specifies the | 7639 | "systemd-boot", the ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG`` variable specifies the |
6797 | configuration file that should be used. By default, the | 7640 | configuration file that should be used. By default, the |
6798 | :ref:`systemd-boot <ref-classes-systemd-boot>` class sets the | 7641 | :ref:`systemd-boot <ref-classes-systemd-boot>` class sets the |
6799 | ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG`` as follows: SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG ?= | 7642 | ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG`` as follows: |
6800 | "${:term:`S`}/loader.conf" | 7643 | :: |
6801 | 7644 | ||
7645 | SYSTEMD_BOOT_CFG ?= "${:term:`S`}/loader.conf" | ||
7646 | |||
6802 | For information on Systemd-boot, see the `Systemd-boot | 7647 | For information on Systemd-boot, see the `Systemd-boot |
6803 | documentation <http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/systemd-boot/>`__. | 7648 | documentation <http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/systemd-boot/>`__. |
6804 | 7649 | ||
6805 | SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES | 7650 | SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES |
6806 | When :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` is set to | 7651 | When :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` is set to |
6807 | "systemd-boot", the ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES`` variable specifies a | 7652 | "systemd-boot", the ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES`` variable specifies a |
6808 | list of entry files (``*.conf``) to install that contain one boot | 7653 | list of entry files (``*.conf``) to install that contain one boot |
6809 | entry per file. By default, the | 7654 | entry per file. By default, the |
6810 | :ref:`systemd-boot <ref-classes-systemd-boot>` class sets the | 7655 | :ref:`systemd-boot <ref-classes-systemd-boot>` class sets the |
6811 | ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES`` as follows: SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES ?= "" | 7656 | ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES`` as follows: |
6812 | 7657 | :: | |
7658 | |||
7659 | SYSTEMD_BOOT_ENTRIES ?= "" | ||
7660 | |||
6813 | For information on Systemd-boot, see the `Systemd-boot | 7661 | For information on Systemd-boot, see the `Systemd-boot |
6814 | documentation <http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/systemd-boot/>`__. | 7662 | documentation <http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/systemd-boot/>`__. |
6815 | 7663 | ||
6816 | SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT | 7664 | SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT |
6817 | When :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` is set to | 7665 | When :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` is set to |
6818 | "systemd-boot", the ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT`` variable specifies the | 7666 | "systemd-boot", the ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT`` variable specifies the |
6819 | boot menu timeout in seconds. By default, the | 7667 | boot menu timeout in seconds. By default, the |
6820 | :ref:`systemd-boot <ref-classes-systemd-boot>` class sets the | 7668 | :ref:`systemd-boot <ref-classes-systemd-boot>` class sets the |
6821 | ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT`` as follows: SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT ?= "10" | 7669 | ``SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT`` as follows: |
6822 | 7670 | :: | |
7671 | |||
7672 | SYSTEMD_BOOT_TIMEOUT ?= "10" | ||
7673 | |||
6823 | For information on Systemd-boot, see the `Systemd-boot | 7674 | For information on Systemd-boot, see the `Systemd-boot |
6824 | documentation <http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/systemd-boot/>`__. | 7675 | documentation <http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/systemd-boot/>`__. |
6825 | 7676 | ||
6826 | SYSTEMD_PACKAGES | 7677 | SYSTEMD_PACKAGES |
6827 | When inheriting the :ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class, | 7678 | When inheriting the :ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class, |
6828 | this variable locates the systemd unit files when they are not found | 7679 | this variable locates the systemd unit files when they are not found |
6829 | in the main recipe's package. By default, the ``SYSTEMD_PACKAGES`` | 7680 | in the main recipe's package. By default, the ``SYSTEMD_PACKAGES`` |
6830 | variable is set such that the systemd unit files are assumed to | 7681 | variable is set such that the systemd unit files are assumed to |
6831 | reside in the recipes main package: SYSTEMD_PACKAGES ?= "${PN}" | 7682 | reside in the recipes main package: |
6832 | 7683 | :: | |
7684 | |||
7685 | SYSTEMD_PACKAGES ?= "${PN}" | ||
7686 | |||
6833 | If these unit files are not in this recipe's main package, you need | 7687 | If these unit files are not in this recipe's main package, you need |
6834 | to use ``SYSTEMD_PACKAGES`` to list the package or packages in which | 7688 | to use ``SYSTEMD_PACKAGES`` to list the package or packages in which |
6835 | the build system can find the systemd unit files. | 7689 | the build system can find the systemd unit files. |
6836 | 7690 | ||
6837 | SYSTEMD_SERVICE | 7691 | SYSTEMD_SERVICE |
6838 | When inheriting the :ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class, | 7692 | When inheriting the :ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class, |
6839 | this variable specifies the systemd service name for a package. | 7693 | this variable specifies the systemd service name for a package. |
6840 | 7694 | ||
6841 | When you specify this file in your recipe, use a package name | 7695 | When you specify this file in your recipe, use a package name |
6842 | override to indicate the package to which the value applies. Here is | 7696 | override to indicate the package to which the value applies. Here is |
6843 | an example from the connman recipe: SYSTEMD_SERVICE_${PN} = | 7697 | an example from the connman recipe: |
6844 | "connman.service" | 7698 | :: |
6845 | 7699 | ||
7700 | SYSTEMD_SERVICE_${PN} = "connman.service" | ||
7701 | |||
6846 | SYSVINIT_ENABLED_GETTYS | 7702 | SYSVINIT_ENABLED_GETTYS |
6847 | When using | 7703 | When using |
6848 | `SysVinit <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#new-recipe-enabling-system-services>`__, | 7704 | :ref:`SysVinit <dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:enabling system services>`, |
6849 | specifies a space-separated list of the virtual terminals that should | 7705 | specifies a space-separated list of the virtual terminals that should |
6850 | run a `getty <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Getty_%28Unix%29>`__ | 7706 | run a `getty <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Getty_%28Unix%29>`__ |
6851 | (allowing login), assuming :term:`USE_VT` is not set to | 7707 | (allowing login), assuming :term:`USE_VT` is not set to |
6852 | "0". | 7708 | "0". |
6853 | 7709 | ||
6854 | The default value for ``SYSVINIT_ENABLED_GETTYS`` is "1" (i.e. only | 7710 | The default value for ``SYSVINIT_ENABLED_GETTYS`` is "1" (i.e. only |
6855 | run a getty on the first virtual terminal). | 7711 | run a getty on the first virtual terminal). |
6856 | 7712 | ||
6857 | T | 7713 | T |
6858 | This variable points to a directory were BitBake places temporary | 7714 | This variable points to a directory were BitBake places temporary |
6859 | files, which consist mostly of task logs and scripts, when building a | 7715 | files, which consist mostly of task logs and scripts, when building a |
6860 | particular recipe. The variable is typically set as follows: T = | 7716 | particular recipe. The variable is typically set as follows: |
6861 | "${WORKDIR}/temp" | 7717 | :: |
6862 | 7718 | ||
7719 | T = "${WORKDIR}/temp" | ||
7720 | |||
6863 | The :term:`WORKDIR` is the directory into which | 7721 | The :term:`WORKDIR` is the directory into which |
6864 | BitBake unpacks and builds the recipe. The default ``bitbake.conf`` | 7722 | BitBake unpacks and builds the recipe. The default ``bitbake.conf`` |
6865 | file sets this variable. | 7723 | file sets this variable. |
6866 | 7724 | ||
6867 | The ``T`` variable is not to be confused with the | 7725 | The ``T`` variable is not to be confused with the |
6868 | :term:`TMPDIR` variable, which points to the root of | 7726 | :term:`TMPDIR` variable, which points to the root of |
6869 | the directory tree where BitBake places the output of an entire | 7727 | the directory tree where BitBake places the output of an entire |
6870 | build. | 7728 | build. |
6871 | 7729 | ||
6872 | TARGET_ARCH | 7730 | TARGET_ARCH |
6873 | The target machine's architecture. The OpenEmbedded build system | 7731 | The target machine's architecture. The OpenEmbedded build system |
6874 | supports many architectures. Here is an example list of architectures | 7732 | supports many architectures. Here is an example list of architectures |
6875 | supported. This list is by no means complete as the architecture is | 7733 | supported. This list is by no means complete as the architecture is |
6876 | configurable: arm i586 x86_64 powerpc powerpc64 mips mipsel | 7734 | configurable: |
6877 | 7735 | ||
7736 | - arm | ||
7737 | - i586 | ||
7738 | - x86_64 | ||
7739 | - powerpc | ||
7740 | - powerpc64 | ||
7741 | - mips | ||
7742 | - mipsel | ||
7743 | |||
6878 | For additional information on machine architectures, see the | 7744 | For additional information on machine architectures, see the |
6879 | :term:`TUNE_ARCH` variable. | 7745 | :term:`TUNE_ARCH` variable. |
6880 | 7746 | ||
6881 | TARGET_AS_ARCH | 7747 | TARGET_AS_ARCH |
6882 | Specifies architecture-specific assembler flags for the target | 7748 | Specifies architecture-specific assembler flags for the target |
6883 | system. ``TARGET_AS_ARCH`` is initialized from | 7749 | system. ``TARGET_AS_ARCH`` is initialized from |
6884 | :term:`TUNE_ASARGS` by default in the BitBake | 7750 | :term:`TUNE_ASARGS` by default in the BitBake |
6885 | configuration file (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``): TARGET_AS_ARCH = | 7751 | configuration file (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``): |
6886 | "${TUNE_ASARGS}" | 7752 | :: |
6887 | 7753 | ||
7754 | TARGET_AS_ARCH = "${TUNE_ASARGS}" | ||
7755 | |||
6888 | TARGET_CC_ARCH | 7756 | TARGET_CC_ARCH |
6889 | Specifies architecture-specific C compiler flags for the target | 7757 | Specifies architecture-specific C compiler flags for the target |
6890 | system. ``TARGET_CC_ARCH`` is initialized from | 7758 | system. ``TARGET_CC_ARCH`` is initialized from |
6891 | :term:`TUNE_CCARGS` by default. | 7759 | :term:`TUNE_CCARGS` by default. |
6892 | 7760 | ||
6893 | .. note:: | 7761 | .. note:: |
6894 | 7762 | ||
6895 | It is a common workaround to append | 7763 | It is a common workaround to append |
6896 | LDFLAGS | 7764 | LDFLAGS |
6897 | to | 7765 | to |
@@ -6900,7 +7768,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6900 | otherwise respect the exported | 7768 | otherwise respect the exported |
6901 | LDFLAGS | 7769 | LDFLAGS |
6902 | variable. | 7770 | variable. |
6903 | 7771 | ||
6904 | TARGET_CC_KERNEL_ARCH | 7772 | TARGET_CC_KERNEL_ARCH |
6905 | This is a specific kernel compiler flag for a CPU or Application | 7773 | This is a specific kernel compiler flag for a CPU or Application |
6906 | Binary Interface (ABI) tune. The flag is used rarely and only for | 7774 | Binary Interface (ABI) tune. The flag is used rarely and only for |
@@ -6910,118 +7778,118 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
6910 | different configuration. See the | 7778 | different configuration. See the |
6911 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/arm/feature-arm-thumb.inc`` file in the | 7779 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/arm/feature-arm-thumb.inc`` file in the |
6912 | :term:`Source Directory` for an example. | 7780 | :term:`Source Directory` for an example. |
6913 | 7781 | ||
6914 | TARGET_CFLAGS | 7782 | TARGET_CFLAGS |
6915 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler when building for the | 7783 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C compiler when building for the |
6916 | target. When building in the target context, | 7784 | target. When building in the target context, |
6917 | :term:`CFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable by | 7785 | :term:`CFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable by |
6918 | default. | 7786 | default. |
6919 | 7787 | ||
6920 | Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the ``CFLAGS`` | 7788 | Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the ``CFLAGS`` |
6921 | variable in the environment to the ``TARGET_CFLAGS`` value so that | 7789 | variable in the environment to the ``TARGET_CFLAGS`` value so that |
6922 | executables built using the SDK also have the flags applied. | 7790 | executables built using the SDK also have the flags applied. |
6923 | 7791 | ||
6924 | TARGET_CPPFLAGS | 7792 | TARGET_CPPFLAGS |
6925 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C pre-processor (i.e. to both the | 7793 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C pre-processor (i.e. to both the |
6926 | C and the C++ compilers) when building for the target. When building | 7794 | C and the C++ compilers) when building for the target. When building |
6927 | in the target context, :term:`CPPFLAGS` is set to the | 7795 | in the target context, :term:`CPPFLAGS` is set to the |
6928 | value of this variable by default. | 7796 | value of this variable by default. |
6929 | 7797 | ||
6930 | Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the | 7798 | Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the |
6931 | ``CPPFLAGS`` variable in the environment to the ``TARGET_CPPFLAGS`` | 7799 | ``CPPFLAGS`` variable in the environment to the ``TARGET_CPPFLAGS`` |
6932 | value so that executables built using the SDK also have the flags | 7800 | value so that executables built using the SDK also have the flags |
6933 | applied. | 7801 | applied. |
6934 | 7802 | ||
6935 | TARGET_CXXFLAGS | 7803 | TARGET_CXXFLAGS |
6936 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler when building for the | 7804 | Specifies the flags to pass to the C++ compiler when building for the |
6937 | target. When building in the target context, | 7805 | target. When building in the target context, |
6938 | :term:`CXXFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable | 7806 | :term:`CXXFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable |
6939 | by default. | 7807 | by default. |
6940 | 7808 | ||
6941 | Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the | 7809 | Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the |
6942 | ``CXXFLAGS`` variable in the environment to the ``TARGET_CXXFLAGS`` | 7810 | ``CXXFLAGS`` variable in the environment to the ``TARGET_CXXFLAGS`` |
6943 | value so that executables built using the SDK also have the flags | 7811 | value so that executables built using the SDK also have the flags |
6944 | applied. | 7812 | applied. |
6945 | 7813 | ||
6946 | TARGET_FPU | 7814 | TARGET_FPU |
6947 | Specifies the method for handling FPU code. For FPU-less targets, | 7815 | Specifies the method for handling FPU code. For FPU-less targets, |
6948 | which include most ARM CPUs, the variable must be set to "soft". If | 7816 | which include most ARM CPUs, the variable must be set to "soft". If |
6949 | not, the kernel emulation gets used, which results in a performance | 7817 | not, the kernel emulation gets used, which results in a performance |
6950 | penalty. | 7818 | penalty. |
6951 | 7819 | ||
6952 | TARGET_LD_ARCH | 7820 | TARGET_LD_ARCH |
6953 | Specifies architecture-specific linker flags for the target system. | 7821 | Specifies architecture-specific linker flags for the target system. |
6954 | ``TARGET_LD_ARCH`` is initialized from | 7822 | ``TARGET_LD_ARCH`` is initialized from |
6955 | :term:`TUNE_LDARGS` by default in the BitBake | 7823 | :term:`TUNE_LDARGS` by default in the BitBake |
6956 | configuration file (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``): TARGET_LD_ARCH = | 7824 | configuration file (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``): |
6957 | "${TUNE_LDARGS}" | 7825 | :: |
6958 | 7826 | ||
7827 | TARGET_LD_ARCH = "${TUNE_LDARGS}" | ||
7828 | |||
6959 | TARGET_LDFLAGS | 7829 | TARGET_LDFLAGS |
6960 | Specifies the flags to pass to the linker when building for the | 7830 | Specifies the flags to pass to the linker when building for the |
6961 | target. When building in the target context, | 7831 | target. When building in the target context, |
6962 | :term:`LDFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable | 7832 | :term:`LDFLAGS` is set to the value of this variable |
6963 | by default. | 7833 | by default. |
6964 | 7834 | ||
6965 | Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the | 7835 | Additionally, the SDK's environment setup script sets the |
6966 | :term:`LDFLAGS` variable in the environment to the | 7836 | :term:`LDFLAGS` variable in the environment to the |
6967 | ``TARGET_LDFLAGS`` value so that executables built using the SDK also | 7837 | ``TARGET_LDFLAGS`` value so that executables built using the SDK also |
6968 | have the flags applied. | 7838 | have the flags applied. |
6969 | 7839 | ||
6970 | TARGET_OS | 7840 | TARGET_OS |
6971 | Specifies the target's operating system. The variable can be set to | 7841 | Specifies the target's operating system. The variable can be set to |
6972 | "linux" for glibc-based systems (GNU C Library) and to "linux-musl" | 7842 | "linux" for glibc-based systems (GNU C Library) and to "linux-musl" |
6973 | for musl libc. For ARM/EABI targets, "linux-gnueabi" and | 7843 | for musl libc. For ARM/EABI targets, "linux-gnueabi" and |
6974 | "linux-musleabi" possible values exist. | 7844 | "linux-musleabi" possible values exist. |
6975 | 7845 | ||
6976 | TARGET_PREFIX | 7846 | TARGET_PREFIX |
6977 | Specifies the prefix used for the toolchain binary target tools. | 7847 | Specifies the prefix used for the toolchain binary target tools. |
6978 | 7848 | ||
6979 | Depending on the type of recipe and the build target, | 7849 | Depending on the type of recipe and the build target, |
6980 | ``TARGET_PREFIX`` is set as follows: | 7850 | ``TARGET_PREFIX`` is set as follows: |
6981 | 7851 | ||
6982 | - For recipes building for the target machine, the value is | 7852 | - For recipes building for the target machine, the value is |
6983 | "${:term:`TARGET_SYS`}-". | 7853 | "${:term:`TARGET_SYS`}-". |
6984 | 7854 | ||
6985 | - For native recipes, the build system sets the variable to the | 7855 | - For native recipes, the build system sets the variable to the |
6986 | value of ``BUILD_PREFIX``. | 7856 | value of ``BUILD_PREFIX``. |
6987 | 7857 | ||
6988 | - For native SDK recipes (``nativesdk``), the build system sets the | 7858 | - For native SDK recipes (``nativesdk``), the build system sets the |
6989 | variable to the value of ``SDK_PREFIX``. | 7859 | variable to the value of ``SDK_PREFIX``. |
6990 | 7860 | ||
6991 | TARGET_SYS | 7861 | TARGET_SYS |
6992 | Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating | 7862 | Specifies the system, including the architecture and the operating |
6993 | system, for which the build is occurring in the context of the | 7863 | system, for which the build is occurring in the context of the |
6994 | current recipe. | 7864 | current recipe. |
6995 | 7865 | ||
6996 | The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based | 7866 | The OpenEmbedded build system automatically sets this variable based |
6997 | on :term:`TARGET_ARCH`, | 7867 | on :term:`TARGET_ARCH`, |
6998 | :term:`TARGET_VENDOR`, and | 7868 | :term:`TARGET_VENDOR`, and |
6999 | :term:`TARGET_OS` variables. | 7869 | :term:`TARGET_OS` variables. |
7000 | 7870 | ||
7001 | .. note:: | 7871 | .. note:: |
7002 | 7872 | ||
7003 | You do not need to set the | 7873 | You do not need to set the TARGET_SYS variable yourself. |
7004 | TARGET_SYS | 7874 | |
7005 | variable yourself. | ||
7006 | |||
7007 | Consider these two examples: | 7875 | Consider these two examples: |
7008 | 7876 | ||
7009 | - Given a native recipe on a 32-bit, x86 machine running Linux, the | 7877 | - Given a native recipe on a 32-bit, x86 machine running Linux, the |
7010 | value is "i686-linux". | 7878 | value is "i686-linux". |
7011 | 7879 | ||
7012 | - Given a recipe being built for a little-endian, MIPS target | 7880 | - Given a recipe being built for a little-endian, MIPS target |
7013 | running Linux, the value might be "mipsel-linux". | 7881 | running Linux, the value might be "mipsel-linux". |
7014 | 7882 | ||
7015 | TARGET_VENDOR | 7883 | TARGET_VENDOR |
7016 | Specifies the name of the target vendor. | 7884 | Specifies the name of the target vendor. |
7017 | 7885 | ||
7018 | TCLIBC | 7886 | TCLIBC |
7019 | Specifies the GNU standard C library (``libc``) variant to use during | 7887 | Specifies the GNU standard C library (``libc``) variant to use during |
7020 | the build process. This variable replaces ``POKYLIBC``, which is no | 7888 | the build process. This variable replaces ``POKYLIBC``, which is no |
7021 | longer supported. | 7889 | longer supported. |
7022 | 7890 | ||
7023 | You can select "glibc", "musl", "newlib", or "baremetal" | 7891 | You can select "glibc", "musl", "newlib", or "baremetal" |
7024 | 7892 | ||
7025 | TCLIBCAPPEND | 7893 | TCLIBCAPPEND |
7026 | Specifies a suffix to be appended onto the | 7894 | Specifies a suffix to be appended onto the |
7027 | :term:`TMPDIR` value. The suffix identifies the | 7895 | :term:`TMPDIR` value. The suffix identifies the |
@@ -7029,13 +7897,13 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7029 | variants with the same :term:`Build Directory`, this | 7897 | variants with the same :term:`Build Directory`, this |
7030 | mechanism ensures that output for different ``libc`` variants is kept | 7898 | mechanism ensures that output for different ``libc`` variants is kept |
7031 | separate to avoid potential conflicts. | 7899 | separate to avoid potential conflicts. |
7032 | 7900 | ||
7033 | In the ``defaultsetup.conf`` file, the default value of | 7901 | In the ``defaultsetup.conf`` file, the default value of |
7034 | ``TCLIBCAPPEND`` is "-${TCLIBC}". However, distros such as poky, | 7902 | ``TCLIBCAPPEND`` is "-${TCLIBC}". However, distros such as poky, |
7035 | which normally only support one ``libc`` variant, set | 7903 | which normally only support one ``libc`` variant, set |
7036 | ``TCLIBCAPPEND`` to "" in their distro configuration file resulting | 7904 | ``TCLIBCAPPEND`` to "" in their distro configuration file resulting |
7037 | in no suffix being applied. | 7905 | in no suffix being applied. |
7038 | 7906 | ||
7039 | TCMODE | 7907 | TCMODE |
7040 | Specifies the toolchain selector. ``TCMODE`` controls the | 7908 | Specifies the toolchain selector. ``TCMODE`` controls the |
7041 | characteristics of the generated packages and images by telling the | 7909 | characteristics of the generated packages and images by telling the |
@@ -7043,9 +7911,9 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7043 | the OpenEmbedded build system builds its own internal toolchain. The | 7911 | the OpenEmbedded build system builds its own internal toolchain. The |
7044 | variable's default value is "default", which uses that internal | 7912 | variable's default value is "default", which uses that internal |
7045 | toolchain. | 7913 | toolchain. |
7046 | 7914 | ||
7047 | .. note:: | 7915 | .. note:: |
7048 | 7916 | ||
7049 | If | 7917 | If |
7050 | TCMODE | 7918 | TCMODE |
7051 | is set to a value other than "default", then it is your | 7919 | is set to a value other than "default", then it is your |
@@ -7058,53 +7926,53 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7058 | Downloads | 7926 | Downloads |
7059 | page on the Yocto Project website and click on the "RELEASE | 7927 | page on the Yocto Project website and click on the "RELEASE |
7060 | INFORMATION" link for the appropriate release. | 7928 | INFORMATION" link for the appropriate release. |
7061 | 7929 | ||
7062 | The ``TCMODE`` variable is similar to :term:`TCLIBC`, | 7930 | The ``TCMODE`` variable is similar to :term:`TCLIBC`, |
7063 | which controls the variant of the GNU standard C library (``libc``) | 7931 | which controls the variant of the GNU standard C library (``libc``) |
7064 | used during the build process: ``glibc`` or ``musl``. | 7932 | used during the build process: ``glibc`` or ``musl``. |
7065 | 7933 | ||
7066 | With additional layers, it is possible to use a pre-compiled external | 7934 | With additional layers, it is possible to use a pre-compiled external |
7067 | toolchain. One example is the Sourcery G++ Toolchain. The support for | 7935 | toolchain. One example is the Sourcery G++ Toolchain. The support for |
7068 | this toolchain resides in the separate Mentor Graphics | 7936 | this toolchain resides in the separate Mentor Graphics |
7069 | ``meta-sourcery`` layer at | 7937 | ``meta-sourcery`` layer at |
7070 | http://github.com/MentorEmbedded/meta-sourcery/. | 7938 | http://github.com/MentorEmbedded/meta-sourcery/. |
7071 | 7939 | ||
7072 | The layer's ``README`` file contains information on how to use the | 7940 | The layer's ``README`` file contains information on how to use the |
7073 | Sourcery G++ Toolchain as an external toolchain. In summary, you must | 7941 | Sourcery G++ Toolchain as an external toolchain. In summary, you must |
7074 | be sure to add the layer to your ``bblayers.conf`` file in front of | 7942 | be sure to add the layer to your ``bblayers.conf`` file in front of |
7075 | the ``meta`` layer and then set the ``EXTERNAL_TOOLCHAIN`` variable | 7943 | the ``meta`` layer and then set the ``EXTERNAL_TOOLCHAIN`` variable |
7076 | in your ``local.conf`` file to the location in which you installed | 7944 | in your ``local.conf`` file to the location in which you installed |
7077 | the toolchain. | 7945 | the toolchain. |
7078 | 7946 | ||
7079 | The fundamentals used for this example apply to any external | 7947 | The fundamentals used for this example apply to any external |
7080 | toolchain. You can use ``meta-sourcery`` as a template for adding | 7948 | toolchain. You can use ``meta-sourcery`` as a template for adding |
7081 | support for other external toolchains. | 7949 | support for other external toolchains. |
7082 | 7950 | ||
7083 | TEST_EXPORT_DIR | 7951 | TEST_EXPORT_DIR |
7084 | The location the OpenEmbedded build system uses to export tests when | 7952 | The location the OpenEmbedded build system uses to export tests when |
7085 | the :term:`TEST_EXPORT_ONLY` variable is set | 7953 | the :term:`TEST_EXPORT_ONLY` variable is set |
7086 | to "1". | 7954 | to "1". |
7087 | 7955 | ||
7088 | The ``TEST_EXPORT_DIR`` variable defaults to | 7956 | The ``TEST_EXPORT_DIR`` variable defaults to |
7089 | ``"${TMPDIR}/testimage/${PN}"``. | 7957 | ``"${TMPDIR}/testimage/${PN}"``. |
7090 | 7958 | ||
7091 | TEST_EXPORT_ONLY | 7959 | TEST_EXPORT_ONLY |
7092 | Specifies to export the tests only. Set this variable to "1" if you | 7960 | Specifies to export the tests only. Set this variable to "1" if you |
7093 | do not want to run the tests but you want them to be exported in a | 7961 | do not want to run the tests but you want them to be exported in a |
7094 | manner that you to run them outside of the build system. | 7962 | manner that you to run them outside of the build system. |
7095 | 7963 | ||
7096 | TEST_LOG_DIR | 7964 | TEST_LOG_DIR |
7097 | Holds the SSH log and the boot log for QEMU machines. The | 7965 | Holds the SSH log and the boot log for QEMU machines. The |
7098 | ``TEST_LOG_DIR`` variable defaults to ``"${WORKDIR}/testimage"``. | 7966 | ``TEST_LOG_DIR`` variable defaults to ``"${WORKDIR}/testimage"``. |
7099 | 7967 | ||
7100 | .. note:: | 7968 | .. note:: |
7101 | 7969 | ||
7102 | Actual test results reside in the task log ( | 7970 | Actual test results reside in the task log ( |
7103 | log.do_testimage | 7971 | log.do_testimage |
7104 | ), which is in the | 7972 | ), which is in the |
7105 | ${WORKDIR}/temp/ | 7973 | ${WORKDIR}/temp/ |
7106 | directory. | 7974 | directory. |
7107 | 7975 | ||
7108 | TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD | 7976 | TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD |
7109 | For automated hardware testing, specifies the command to use to | 7977 | For automated hardware testing, specifies the command to use to |
7110 | control the power of the target machine under test. Typically, this | 7978 | control the power of the target machine under test. Typically, this |
@@ -7113,7 +7981,7 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7113 | command should expect to receive as the last argument "off", "on" or | 7981 | command should expect to receive as the last argument "off", "on" or |
7114 | "cycle" specifying to power off, on, or cycle (power off and then | 7982 | "cycle" specifying to power off, on, or cycle (power off and then |
7115 | power on) the device, respectively. | 7983 | power on) the device, respectively. |
7116 | 7984 | ||
7117 | TEST_POWERCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS | 7985 | TEST_POWERCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS |
7118 | For automated hardware testing, specifies additional arguments to | 7986 | For automated hardware testing, specifies additional arguments to |
7119 | pass through to the command specified in | 7987 | pass through to the command specified in |
@@ -7121,30 +7989,31 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7121 | ``TEST_POWERCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS`` is optional. You can use it if you | 7989 | ``TEST_POWERCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS`` is optional. You can use it if you |
7122 | wish, for example, to separate the machine-specific and | 7990 | wish, for example, to separate the machine-specific and |
7123 | non-machine-specific parts of the arguments. | 7991 | non-machine-specific parts of the arguments. |
7124 | 7992 | ||
7125 | TEST_QEMUBOOT_TIMEOUT | 7993 | TEST_QEMUBOOT_TIMEOUT |
7126 | The time in seconds allowed for an image to boot before automated | 7994 | The time in seconds allowed for an image to boot before automated |
7127 | runtime tests begin to run against an image. The default timeout | 7995 | runtime tests begin to run against an image. The default timeout |
7128 | period to allow the boot process to reach the login prompt is 500 | 7996 | period to allow the boot process to reach the login prompt is 500 |
7129 | seconds. You can specify a different value in the ``local.conf`` | 7997 | seconds. You can specify a different value in the ``local.conf`` |
7130 | file. | 7998 | file. |
7131 | 7999 | ||
7132 | For more information on testing images, see the "`Performing | 8000 | For more information on testing images, see the |
7133 | Automated Runtime | 8001 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:performing automated runtime testing`" |
7134 | Testing <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#performing-automated-runtime-testing>`__" | ||
7135 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 8002 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
7136 | 8003 | ||
7137 | TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD | 8004 | TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD |
7138 | For automated hardware testing, specifies the command to use to | 8005 | For automated hardware testing, specifies the command to use to |
7139 | connect to the serial console of the target machine under test. This | 8006 | connect to the serial console of the target machine under test. This |
7140 | command simply needs to connect to the serial console and forward | 8007 | command simply needs to connect to the serial console and forward |
7141 | that connection to standard input and output as any normal terminal | 8008 | that connection to standard input and output as any normal terminal |
7142 | program does. | 8009 | program does. |
7143 | 8010 | ||
7144 | For example, to use the Picocom terminal program on serial device | 8011 | For example, to use the Picocom terminal program on serial device |
7145 | ``/dev/ttyUSB0`` at 115200bps, you would set the variable as follows: | 8012 | ``/dev/ttyUSB0`` at 115200bps, you would set the variable as follows: |
7146 | TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD = "picocom /dev/ttyUSB0 -b 115200" | 8013 | :: |
7147 | 8014 | ||
8015 | TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD = "picocom /dev/ttyUSB0 -b 115200" | ||
8016 | |||
7148 | TEST_SERIALCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS | 8017 | TEST_SERIALCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS |
7149 | For automated hardware testing, specifies additional arguments to | 8018 | For automated hardware testing, specifies additional arguments to |
7150 | pass through to the command specified in | 8019 | pass through to the command specified in |
@@ -7152,238 +8021,273 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7152 | ``TEST_SERIALCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS`` is optional. You can use it if you | 8021 | ``TEST_SERIALCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS`` is optional. You can use it if you |
7153 | wish, for example, to separate the machine-specific and | 8022 | wish, for example, to separate the machine-specific and |
7154 | non-machine-specific parts of the command. | 8023 | non-machine-specific parts of the command. |
7155 | 8024 | ||
7156 | TEST_SERVER_IP | 8025 | TEST_SERVER_IP |
7157 | The IP address of the build machine (host machine). This IP address | 8026 | The IP address of the build machine (host machine). This IP address |
7158 | is usually automatically detected. However, if detection fails, this | 8027 | is usually automatically detected. However, if detection fails, this |
7159 | variable needs to be set to the IP address of the build machine (i.e. | 8028 | variable needs to be set to the IP address of the build machine (i.e. |
7160 | where the build is taking place). | 8029 | where the build is taking place). |
7161 | 8030 | ||
7162 | .. note:: | 8031 | .. note:: |
7163 | 8032 | ||
7164 | The | 8033 | The |
7165 | TEST_SERVER_IP | 8034 | TEST_SERVER_IP |
7166 | variable is only used for a small number of tests such as the | 8035 | variable is only used for a small number of tests such as the |
7167 | "dnf" test suite, which needs to download packages from | 8036 | "dnf" test suite, which needs to download packages from |
7168 | WORKDIR/oe-rootfs-repo | 8037 | WORKDIR/oe-rootfs-repo |
7169 | . | 8038 | . |
7170 | 8039 | ||
7171 | TEST_TARGET | 8040 | TEST_TARGET |
7172 | Specifies the target controller to use when running tests against a | 8041 | Specifies the target controller to use when running tests against a |
7173 | test image. The default controller to use is "qemu": TEST_TARGET = | 8042 | test image. The default controller to use is "qemu": |
7174 | "qemu" | 8043 | :: |
7175 | 8044 | ||
8045 | TEST_TARGET = "qemu" | ||
8046 | |||
7176 | A target controller is a class that defines how an image gets | 8047 | A target controller is a class that defines how an image gets |
7177 | deployed on a target and how a target is started. A layer can extend | 8048 | deployed on a target and how a target is started. A layer can extend |
7178 | the controllers by adding a module in the layer's | 8049 | the controllers by adding a module in the layer's |
7179 | ``/lib/oeqa/controllers`` directory and by inheriting the | 8050 | ``/lib/oeqa/controllers`` directory and by inheriting the |
7180 | ``BaseTarget`` class, which is an abstract class that cannot be used | 8051 | ``BaseTarget`` class, which is an abstract class that cannot be used |
7181 | as a value of ``TEST_TARGET``. | 8052 | as a value of ``TEST_TARGET``. |
7182 | 8053 | ||
7183 | You can provide the following arguments with ``TEST_TARGET``: | 8054 | You can provide the following arguments with ``TEST_TARGET``: |
7184 | 8055 | ||
7185 | - *"qemu":* Boots a QEMU image and runs the tests. See the | 8056 | - *"qemu":* Boots a QEMU image and runs the tests. See the |
7186 | "`Enabling Runtime Tests on | 8057 | ":ref:`qemu-image-enabling-tests`" section |
7187 | QEMU <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#qemu-image-enabling-tests>`__" section | ||
7188 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more | 8058 | in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for more |
7189 | information. | 8059 | information. |
7190 | 8060 | ||
7191 | - *"simpleremote":* Runs the tests on target hardware that is | 8061 | - *"simpleremote":* Runs the tests on target hardware that is |
7192 | already up and running. The hardware can be on the network or it | 8062 | already up and running. The hardware can be on the network or it |
7193 | can be a device running an image on QEMU. You must also set | 8063 | can be a device running an image on QEMU. You must also set |
7194 | :term:`TEST_TARGET_IP` when you use | 8064 | :term:`TEST_TARGET_IP` when you use |
7195 | "simpleremote". | 8065 | "simpleremote". |
7196 | 8066 | ||
7197 | .. note:: | 8067 | .. note:: |
7198 | 8068 | ||
7199 | This argument is defined in | 8069 | This argument is defined in |
7200 | meta/lib/oeqa/controllers/simpleremote.py | 8070 | meta/lib/oeqa/controllers/simpleremote.py |
7201 | . | 8071 | . |
7202 | 8072 | ||
7203 | For information on running tests on hardware, see the "`Enabling | 8073 | For information on running tests on hardware, see the |
7204 | Runtime Tests on | 8074 | ":ref:`hardware-image-enabling-tests`" |
7205 | Hardware <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#hardware-image-enabling-tests>`__" | ||
7206 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 8075 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
7207 | 8076 | ||
7208 | TEST_TARGET_IP | 8077 | TEST_TARGET_IP |
7209 | The IP address of your hardware under test. The ``TEST_TARGET_IP`` | 8078 | The IP address of your hardware under test. The ``TEST_TARGET_IP`` |
7210 | variable has no effect when :term:`TEST_TARGET` is | 8079 | variable has no effect when :term:`TEST_TARGET` is |
7211 | set to "qemu". | 8080 | set to "qemu". |
7212 | 8081 | ||
7213 | When you specify the IP address, you can also include a port. Here is | 8082 | When you specify the IP address, you can also include a port. Here is |
7214 | an example: TEST_TARGET_IP = "192.168.1.4:2201" Specifying a port is | 8083 | an example: |
8084 | :: | ||
8085 | |||
8086 | TEST_TARGET_IP = "192.168.1.4:2201" | ||
8087 | |||
8088 | Specifying a port is | ||
7215 | useful when SSH is started on a non-standard port or in cases when | 8089 | useful when SSH is started on a non-standard port or in cases when |
7216 | your hardware under test is behind a firewall or network that is not | 8090 | your hardware under test is behind a firewall or network that is not |
7217 | directly accessible from your host and you need to do port address | 8091 | directly accessible from your host and you need to do port address |
7218 | translation. | 8092 | translation. |
7219 | 8093 | ||
7220 | TEST_SUITES | 8094 | TEST_SUITES |
7221 | An ordered list of tests (modules) to run against an image when | 8095 | An ordered list of tests (modules) to run against an image when |
7222 | performing automated runtime testing. | 8096 | performing automated runtime testing. |
7223 | 8097 | ||
7224 | The OpenEmbedded build system provides a core set of tests that can | 8098 | The OpenEmbedded build system provides a core set of tests that can |
7225 | be used against images. | 8099 | be used against images. |
7226 | 8100 | ||
7227 | .. note:: | 8101 | .. note:: |
7228 | 8102 | ||
7229 | Currently, there is only support for running these tests under | 8103 | Currently, there is only support for running these tests under |
7230 | QEMU. | 8104 | QEMU. |
7231 | 8105 | ||
7232 | Tests include ``ping``, ``ssh``, ``df`` among others. You can add | 8106 | Tests include ``ping``, ``ssh``, ``df`` among others. You can add |
7233 | your own tests to the list of tests by appending ``TEST_SUITES`` as | 8107 | your own tests to the list of tests by appending ``TEST_SUITES`` as |
7234 | follows: TEST_SUITES_append = " mytest" Alternatively, you can | 8108 | follows: |
8109 | :: | ||
8110 | |||
8111 | TEST_SUITES_append = " mytest" | ||
8112 | |||
8113 | Alternatively, you can | ||
7235 | provide the "auto" option to have all applicable tests run against | 8114 | provide the "auto" option to have all applicable tests run against |
7236 | the image. TEST_SUITES_append = " auto" Using this option causes the | 8115 | the image. |
8116 | :: | ||
8117 | |||
8118 | TEST_SUITES_append = " auto" | ||
8119 | |||
8120 | Using this option causes the | ||
7237 | build system to automatically run tests that are applicable to the | 8121 | build system to automatically run tests that are applicable to the |
7238 | image. Tests that are not applicable are skipped. | 8122 | image. Tests that are not applicable are skipped. |
7239 | 8123 | ||
7240 | The order in which tests are run is important. Tests that depend on | 8124 | The order in which tests are run is important. Tests that depend on |
7241 | another test must appear later in the list than the test on which | 8125 | another test must appear later in the list than the test on which |
7242 | they depend. For example, if you append the list of tests with two | 8126 | they depend. For example, if you append the list of tests with two |
7243 | tests (``test_A`` and ``test_B``) where ``test_B`` is dependent on | 8127 | tests (``test_A`` and ``test_B``) where ``test_B`` is dependent on |
7244 | ``test_A``, then you must order the tests as follows: TEST_SUITES = " | 8128 | ``test_A``, then you must order the tests as follows: |
7245 | test_A test_B" | 8129 | :: |
7246 | 8130 | ||
7247 | For more information on testing images, see the "`Performing | 8131 | TEST_SUITES = "test_A test_B" |
7248 | Automated Runtime | 8132 | |
7249 | Testing <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#performing-automated-runtime-testing>`__" | 8133 | For more information on testing images, see the |
8134 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:performing automated runtime testing`" | ||
7250 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. | 8135 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. |
7251 | 8136 | ||
7252 | TESTIMAGE_AUTO | 8137 | TESTIMAGE_AUTO |
7253 | Automatically runs the series of automated tests for images when an | 8138 | Automatically runs the series of automated tests for images when an |
7254 | image is successfully built. Setting ``TESTIMAGE_AUTO`` to "1" causes | 8139 | image is successfully built. Setting ``TESTIMAGE_AUTO`` to "1" causes |
7255 | any image that successfully builds to automatically boot under QEMU. | 8140 | any image that successfully builds to automatically boot under QEMU. |
7256 | Using the variable also adds in dependencies so that any SDK for | 8141 | Using the variable also adds in dependencies so that any SDK for |
7257 | which testing is requested is automatically built first. | 8142 | which testing is requested is automatically built first. |
7258 | 8143 | ||
7259 | These tests are written in Python making use of the ``unittest`` | 8144 | These tests are written in Python making use of the ``unittest`` |
7260 | module, and the majority of them run commands on the target system | 8145 | module, and the majority of them run commands on the target system |
7261 | over ``ssh``. You can set this variable to "1" in your ``local.conf`` | 8146 | over ``ssh``. You can set this variable to "1" in your ``local.conf`` |
7262 | file in the :term:`Build Directory` to have the | 8147 | file in the :term:`Build Directory` to have the |
7263 | OpenEmbedded build system automatically run these tests after an | 8148 | OpenEmbedded build system automatically run these tests after an |
7264 | image successfully builds: TESTIMAGE_AUTO = "1" For more information | 8149 | image successfully builds: |
7265 | on enabling, running, and writing these tests, see the "`Performing | 8150 | |
7266 | Automated Runtime | 8151 | TESTIMAGE_AUTO = "1" |
7267 | Testing <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#performing-automated-runtime-testing>`__" | 8152 | |
8153 | For more information | ||
8154 | on enabling, running, and writing these tests, see the | ||
8155 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:performing automated runtime testing`" | ||
7268 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual and the | 8156 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual and the |
7269 | ":ref:`testimage*.bbclass <ref-classes-testimage*>`" section. | 8157 | ":ref:`testimage*.bbclass <ref-classes-testimage*>`" section. |
7270 | 8158 | ||
7271 | THISDIR | 8159 | THISDIR |
7272 | The directory in which the file BitBake is currently parsing is | 8160 | The directory in which the file BitBake is currently parsing is |
7273 | located. Do not manually set this variable. | 8161 | located. Do not manually set this variable. |
7274 | 8162 | ||
7275 | TIME | 8163 | TIME |
7276 | The time the build was started. Times appear using the hour, minute, | 8164 | The time the build was started. Times appear using the hour, minute, |
7277 | and second (HMS) format (e.g. "140159" for one minute and fifty-nine | 8165 | and second (HMS) format (e.g. "140159" for one minute and fifty-nine |
7278 | seconds past 1400 hours). | 8166 | seconds past 1400 hours). |
7279 | 8167 | ||
7280 | TMPDIR | 8168 | TMPDIR |
7281 | This variable is the base directory the OpenEmbedded build system | 8169 | This variable is the base directory the OpenEmbedded build system |
7282 | uses for all build output and intermediate files (other than the | 8170 | uses for all build output and intermediate files (other than the |
7283 | shared state cache). By default, the ``TMPDIR`` variable points to | 8171 | shared state cache). By default, the ``TMPDIR`` variable points to |
7284 | ``tmp`` within the :term:`Build Directory`. | 8172 | ``tmp`` within the :term:`Build Directory`. |
7285 | 8173 | ||
7286 | If you want to establish this directory in a location other than the | 8174 | If you want to establish this directory in a location other than the |
7287 | default, you can uncomment and edit the following statement in the | 8175 | default, you can uncomment and edit the following statement in the |
7288 | ``conf/local.conf`` file in the :term:`Source Directory`: | 8176 | ``conf/local.conf`` file in the :term:`Source Directory`: |
7289 | #TMPDIR = "${TOPDIR}/tmp" An | 8177 | :: |
7290 | example use for this scenario is to set ``TMPDIR`` to a local disk, | 8178 | |
8179 | #TMPDIR = "${TOPDIR}/tmp" | ||
8180 | |||
8181 | An example use for this scenario is to set ``TMPDIR`` to a local disk, | ||
7291 | which does not use NFS, while having the Build Directory use NFS. | 8182 | which does not use NFS, while having the Build Directory use NFS. |
7292 | 8183 | ||
7293 | The filesystem used by ``TMPDIR`` must have standard filesystem | 8184 | The filesystem used by ``TMPDIR`` must have standard filesystem |
7294 | semantics (i.e. mixed-case files are unique, POSIX file locking, and | 8185 | semantics (i.e. mixed-case files are unique, POSIX file locking, and |
7295 | persistent inodes). Due to various issues with NFS and bugs in some | 8186 | persistent inodes). Due to various issues with NFS and bugs in some |
7296 | implementations, NFS does not meet this minimum requirement. | 8187 | implementations, NFS does not meet this minimum requirement. |
7297 | Consequently, ``TMPDIR`` cannot be on NFS. | 8188 | Consequently, ``TMPDIR`` cannot be on NFS. |
7298 | 8189 | ||
7299 | TOOLCHAIN_HOST_TASK | 8190 | TOOLCHAIN_HOST_TASK |
7300 | This variable lists packages the OpenEmbedded build system uses when | 8191 | This variable lists packages the OpenEmbedded build system uses when |
7301 | building an SDK, which contains a cross-development environment. The | 8192 | building an SDK, which contains a cross-development environment. The |
7302 | packages specified by this variable are part of the toolchain set | 8193 | packages specified by this variable are part of the toolchain set |
7303 | that runs on the :term:`SDKMACHINE`, and each | 8194 | that runs on the :term:`SDKMACHINE`, and each |
7304 | package should usually have the prefix ``nativesdk-``. For example, | 8195 | package should usually have the prefix ``nativesdk-``. For example, |
7305 | consider the following command when building an SDK: $ bitbake -c | 8196 | consider the following command when building an SDK: |
7306 | populate_sdk imagename In this case, a default list of packages is | 8197 | :: |
8198 | |||
8199 | $ bitbake -c populate_sdk imagename | ||
8200 | |||
8201 | In this case, a default list of packages is | ||
7307 | set in this variable, but you can add additional packages to the | 8202 | set in this variable, but you can add additional packages to the |
7308 | list. See the "`Adding Individual Packages to the Standard | 8203 | list. See the |
7309 | SDK <&YOCTO_DOCS_SDK_URL;#sdk-adding-individual-packages>`__" section | 8204 | ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing-standard:adding individual packages to the standard sdk`" section |
7310 | in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible | 8205 | in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible |
7311 | Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual for more information. | 8206 | Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual for more information. |
7312 | 8207 | ||
7313 | For background information on cross-development toolchains in the | 8208 | For background information on cross-development toolchains in the |
7314 | Yocto Project development environment, see the "`Cross-Development | 8209 | Yocto Project development environment, see the |
7315 | Toolchain | 8210 | ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-intro:the cross-development toolchain`" |
7316 | Generation <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#cross-development-toolchain-generation>`__" | ||
7317 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. For | 8211 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. For |
7318 | information on setting up a cross-development environment, see the | 8212 | information on setting up a cross-development environment, see the |
7319 | `Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible Software | 8213 | :doc:`../sdk-manual/sdk-manual` manual. |
7320 | Development Kit (eSDK) <&YOCTO_DOCS_SDK_URL;>`__ manual. | 8214 | |
7321 | |||
7322 | TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME | 8215 | TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME |
7323 | This variable defines the name used for the toolchain output. The | 8216 | This variable defines the name used for the toolchain output. The |
7324 | :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class sets | 8217 | :ref:`populate_sdk_base <ref-classes-populate-sdk-*>` class sets |
7325 | the ``TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME`` variable as follows: | 8218 | the ``TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME`` variable as follows: |
7326 | TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME ?= "${SDK_NAME}-toolchain-${SDK_VERSION}" See | 8219 | :: |
8220 | |||
8221 | TOOLCHAIN_OUTPUTNAME ?= "${SDK_NAME}-toolchain-${SDK_VERSION}" | ||
8222 | |||
8223 | See | ||
7327 | the :term:`SDK_NAME` and | 8224 | the :term:`SDK_NAME` and |
7328 | :term:`SDK_VERSION` variables for additional | 8225 | :term:`SDK_VERSION` variables for additional |
7329 | information. | 8226 | information. |
7330 | 8227 | ||
7331 | TOOLCHAIN_TARGET_TASK | 8228 | TOOLCHAIN_TARGET_TASK |
7332 | This variable lists packages the OpenEmbedded build system uses when | 8229 | This variable lists packages the OpenEmbedded build system uses when |
7333 | it creates the target part of an SDK (i.e. the part built for the | 8230 | it creates the target part of an SDK (i.e. the part built for the |
7334 | target hardware), which includes libraries and headers. Use this | 8231 | target hardware), which includes libraries and headers. Use this |
7335 | variable to add individual packages to the part of the SDK that runs | 8232 | variable to add individual packages to the part of the SDK that runs |
7336 | on the target. See the "`Adding Individual Packages to the Standard | 8233 | on the target. See the |
7337 | SDK <&YOCTO_DOCS_SDK_URL;#sdk-adding-individual-packages>`__" section | 8234 | ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-appendix-customizing-standard:adding individual packages to the standard sdk`" section |
7338 | in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible | 8235 | in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible |
7339 | Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual for more information. | 8236 | Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual for more information. |
7340 | 8237 | ||
7341 | For background information on cross-development toolchains in the | 8238 | For background information on cross-development toolchains in the |
7342 | Yocto Project development environment, see the "`Cross-Development | 8239 | Yocto Project development environment, see the |
7343 | Toolchain | 8240 | ":ref:`sdk-manual/sdk-intro:the cross-development toolchain`" |
7344 | Generation <&YOCTO_DOCS_OM_URL;#cross-development-toolchain-generation>`__" | ||
7345 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. For | 8241 | section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. For |
7346 | information on setting up a cross-development environment, see the | 8242 | information on setting up a cross-development environment, see the |
7347 | `Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible Software | 8243 | :doc:`../sdk-manual/sdk-manual` manual. |
7348 | Development Kit (eSDK) <&YOCTO_DOCS_SDK_URL;>`__ manual. | 8244 | |
7349 | |||
7350 | TOPDIR | 8245 | TOPDIR |
7351 | The top-level :term:`Build Directory`. BitBake | 8246 | The top-level :term:`Build Directory`. BitBake |
7352 | automatically sets this variable when you initialize your build | 8247 | automatically sets this variable when you initialize your build |
7353 | environment using ````` <#structure-core-script>`__. | 8248 | environment using ````` <#structure-core-script>`__. |
7354 | 8249 | ||
7355 | TRANSLATED_TARGET_ARCH | 8250 | TRANSLATED_TARGET_ARCH |
7356 | A sanitized version of :term:`TARGET_ARCH`. This | 8251 | A sanitized version of :term:`TARGET_ARCH`. This |
7357 | variable is used where the architecture is needed in a value where | 8252 | variable is used where the architecture is needed in a value where |
7358 | underscores are not allowed, for example within package filenames. In | 8253 | underscores are not allowed, for example within package filenames. In |
7359 | this case, dash characters replace any underscore characters used in | 8254 | this case, dash characters replace any underscore characters used in |
7360 | ``TARGET_ARCH``. | 8255 | ``TARGET_ARCH``. |
7361 | 8256 | ||
7362 | Do not edit this variable. | 8257 | Do not edit this variable. |
7363 | 8258 | ||
7364 | TUNE_ARCH | 8259 | TUNE_ARCH |
7365 | The GNU canonical architecture for a specific architecture (i.e. | 8260 | The GNU canonical architecture for a specific architecture (i.e. |
7366 | ``arm``, ``armeb``, ``mips``, ``mips64``, and so forth). BitBake uses | 8261 | ``arm``, ``armeb``, ``mips``, ``mips64``, and so forth). BitBake uses |
7367 | this value to setup configuration. | 8262 | this value to setup configuration. |
7368 | 8263 | ||
7369 | ``TUNE_ARCH`` definitions are specific to a given architecture. The | 8264 | ``TUNE_ARCH`` definitions are specific to a given architecture. The |
7370 | definitions can be a single static definition, or can be dynamically | 8265 | definitions can be a single static definition, or can be dynamically |
7371 | adjusted. You can see details for a given CPU family by looking at | 8266 | adjusted. You can see details for a given CPU family by looking at |
7372 | the architecture's ``README`` file. For example, the | 8267 | the architecture's ``README`` file. For example, the |
7373 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/mips/README`` file in the | 8268 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/mips/README`` file in the |
7374 | :term:`Source Directory` provides information for | 8269 | :term:`Source Directory` provides information for |
7375 | ``TUNE_ARCH`` specific to the ``mips`` architecture. | 8270 | ``TUNE_ARCH`` specific to the ``mips`` architecture. |
7376 | 8271 | ||
7377 | ``TUNE_ARCH`` is tied closely to | 8272 | ``TUNE_ARCH`` is tied closely to |
7378 | :term:`TARGET_ARCH`, which defines the target | 8273 | :term:`TARGET_ARCH`, which defines the target |
7379 | machine's architecture. The BitBake configuration file | 8274 | machine's architecture. The BitBake configuration file |
7380 | (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``) sets ``TARGET_ARCH`` as follows: | 8275 | (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``) sets ``TARGET_ARCH`` as follows: |
7381 | TARGET_ARCH = "${TUNE_ARCH}" | 8276 | :: |
7382 | 8277 | ||
8278 | TARGET_ARCH = "${TUNE_ARCH}" | ||
8279 | |||
7383 | The following list, which is by no means complete since architectures | 8280 | The following list, which is by no means complete since architectures |
7384 | are configurable, shows supported machine architectures: arm i586 | 8281 | are configurable, shows supported machine architectures: |
7385 | x86_64 powerpc powerpc64 mips mipsel | 8282 | |
7386 | 8283 | - arm | |
8284 | - i586 | ||
8285 | - x86_64 | ||
8286 | - powerpc | ||
8287 | - powerpc64 | ||
8288 | - mips | ||
8289 | - mipsel | ||
8290 | |||
7387 | TUNE_ASARGS | 8291 | TUNE_ASARGS |
7388 | Specifies architecture-specific assembler flags for the target | 8292 | Specifies architecture-specific assembler flags for the target |
7389 | system. The set of flags is based on the selected tune features. | 8293 | system. The set of flags is based on the selected tune features. |
@@ -7391,28 +8295,30 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7391 | typically under ``meta/conf/machine/include/`` and are influenced | 8295 | typically under ``meta/conf/machine/include/`` and are influenced |
7392 | through :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. For example, the | 8296 | through :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. For example, the |
7393 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/x86/arch-x86.inc`` file defines the flags | 8297 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/x86/arch-x86.inc`` file defines the flags |
7394 | for the x86 architecture as follows: TUNE_ASARGS += | 8298 | for the x86 architecture as follows: |
7395 | "${@bb.utils.contains("TUNE_FEATURES", "mx32", "-x32", "", d)}" | 8299 | :: |
7396 | 8300 | ||
8301 | TUNE_ASARGS += "${@bb.utils.contains("TUNE_FEATURES", "mx32", "-x32", "", d)}" | ||
8302 | |||
7397 | .. note:: | 8303 | .. note:: |
7398 | 8304 | ||
7399 | Board Support Packages (BSPs) select the tune. The selected tune, | 8305 | Board Support Packages (BSPs) select the tune. The selected tune, |
7400 | in turn, affects the tune variables themselves (i.e. the tune can | 8306 | in turn, affects the tune variables themselves (i.e. the tune can |
7401 | supply its own set of flags). | 8307 | supply its own set of flags). |
7402 | 8308 | ||
7403 | TUNE_CCARGS | 8309 | TUNE_CCARGS |
7404 | Specifies architecture-specific C compiler flags for the target | 8310 | Specifies architecture-specific C compiler flags for the target |
7405 | system. The set of flags is based on the selected tune features. | 8311 | system. The set of flags is based on the selected tune features. |
7406 | ``TUNE_CCARGS`` is set using the tune include files, which are | 8312 | ``TUNE_CCARGS`` is set using the tune include files, which are |
7407 | typically under ``meta/conf/machine/include/`` and are influenced | 8313 | typically under ``meta/conf/machine/include/`` and are influenced |
7408 | through :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. | 8314 | through :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. |
7409 | 8315 | ||
7410 | .. note:: | 8316 | .. note:: |
7411 | 8317 | ||
7412 | Board Support Packages (BSPs) select the tune. The selected tune, | 8318 | Board Support Packages (BSPs) select the tune. The selected tune, |
7413 | in turn, affects the tune variables themselves (i.e. the tune can | 8319 | in turn, affects the tune variables themselves (i.e. the tune can |
7414 | supply its own set of flags). | 8320 | supply its own set of flags). |
7415 | 8321 | ||
7416 | TUNE_LDARGS | 8322 | TUNE_LDARGS |
7417 | Specifies architecture-specific linker flags for the target system. | 8323 | Specifies architecture-specific linker flags for the target system. |
7418 | The set of flags is based on the selected tune features. | 8324 | The set of flags is based on the selected tune features. |
@@ -7420,41 +8326,49 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7420 | typically under ``meta/conf/machine/include/`` and are influenced | 8326 | typically under ``meta/conf/machine/include/`` and are influenced |
7421 | through :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. For example, the | 8327 | through :term:`TUNE_FEATURES`. For example, the |
7422 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/x86/arch-x86.inc`` file defines the flags | 8328 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/x86/arch-x86.inc`` file defines the flags |
7423 | for the x86 architecture as follows: TUNE_LDARGS += | 8329 | for the x86 architecture as follows: |
7424 | "${@bb.utils.contains("TUNE_FEATURES", "mx32", "-m elf32_x86_64", "", | 8330 | :: |
7425 | d)}" | 8331 | |
7426 | 8332 | TUNE_LDARGS += "${@bb.utils.contains("TUNE_FEATURES", "mx32", "-m elf32_x86_64", "", d)}" | |
8333 | |||
7427 | .. note:: | 8334 | .. note:: |
7428 | 8335 | ||
7429 | Board Support Packages (BSPs) select the tune. The selected tune, | 8336 | Board Support Packages (BSPs) select the tune. The selected tune, |
7430 | in turn, affects the tune variables themselves (i.e. the tune can | 8337 | in turn, affects the tune variables themselves (i.e. the tune can |
7431 | supply its own set of flags). | 8338 | supply its own set of flags). |
7432 | 8339 | ||
7433 | TUNE_FEATURES | 8340 | TUNE_FEATURES |
7434 | Features used to "tune" a compiler for optimal use given a specific | 8341 | Features used to "tune" a compiler for optimal use given a specific |
7435 | processor. The features are defined within the tune files and allow | 8342 | processor. The features are defined within the tune files and allow |
7436 | arguments (i.e. ``TUNE_*ARGS``) to be dynamically generated based on | 8343 | arguments (i.e. ``TUNE_*ARGS``) to be dynamically generated based on |
7437 | the features. | 8344 | the features. |
7438 | 8345 | ||
7439 | The OpenEmbedded build system verifies the features to be sure they | 8346 | The OpenEmbedded build system verifies the features to be sure they |
7440 | are not conflicting and that they are supported. | 8347 | are not conflicting and that they are supported. |
7441 | 8348 | ||
7442 | The BitBake configuration file (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``) defines | 8349 | The BitBake configuration file (``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``) defines |
7443 | ``TUNE_FEATURES`` as follows: TUNE_FEATURES ??= | 8350 | ``TUNE_FEATURES`` as follows: |
7444 | "${TUNE_FEATURES_tune-${DEFAULTTUNE}}" See the | 8351 | :: |
7445 | :term:`DEFAULTTUNE` variable for more information. | 8352 | |
7446 | 8353 | TUNE_FEATURES ??= "${TUNE_FEATURES_tune-${DEFAULTTUNE}}" | |
8354 | |||
8355 | See the :term:`DEFAULTTUNE` variable for more information. | ||
8356 | |||
7447 | TUNE_PKGARCH | 8357 | TUNE_PKGARCH |
7448 | The package architecture understood by the packaging system to define | 8358 | The package architecture understood by the packaging system to define |
7449 | the architecture, ABI, and tuning of output packages. The specific | 8359 | the architecture, ABI, and tuning of output packages. The specific |
7450 | tune is defined using the "_tune" override as follows: | 8360 | tune is defined using the "_tune" override as follows: |
7451 | TUNE_PKGARCH_tune-tune = "tune" | 8361 | :: |
7452 | 8362 | ||
8363 | TUNE_PKGARCH_tune-tune = "tune" | ||
8364 | |||
7453 | These tune-specific package architectures are defined in the machine | 8365 | These tune-specific package architectures are defined in the machine |
7454 | include files. Here is an example of the "core2-32" tuning as used in | 8366 | include files. Here is an example of the "core2-32" tuning as used in |
7455 | the ``meta/conf/machine/include/tune-core2.inc`` file: | 8367 | the ``meta/conf/machine/include/tune-core2.inc`` file: |
7456 | TUNE_PKGARCH_tune-core2-32 = "core2-32" | 8368 | :: |
7457 | 8369 | ||
8370 | TUNE_PKGARCH_tune-core2-32 = "core2-32" | ||
8371 | |||
7458 | TUNEABI | 8372 | TUNEABI |
7459 | An underlying Application Binary Interface (ABI) used by a particular | 8373 | An underlying Application Binary Interface (ABI) used by a particular |
7460 | tuning in a given toolchain layer. Providers that use prebuilt | 8374 | tuning in a given toolchain layer. Providers that use prebuilt |
@@ -7462,11 +8376,11 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7462 | :term:`TUNEABI_OVERRIDE`, and | 8376 | :term:`TUNEABI_OVERRIDE`, and |
7463 | :term:`TUNEABI_WHITELIST` variables to check | 8377 | :term:`TUNEABI_WHITELIST` variables to check |
7464 | compatibility of tunings against their selection of libraries. | 8378 | compatibility of tunings against their selection of libraries. |
7465 | 8379 | ||
7466 | If ``TUNEABI`` is undefined, then every tuning is allowed. See the | 8380 | If ``TUNEABI`` is undefined, then every tuning is allowed. See the |
7467 | :ref:`sanity <ref-classes-sanity>` class to see how the variable is | 8381 | :ref:`sanity <ref-classes-sanity>` class to see how the variable is |
7468 | used. | 8382 | used. |
7469 | 8383 | ||
7470 | TUNEABI_OVERRIDE | 8384 | TUNEABI_OVERRIDE |
7471 | If set, the OpenEmbedded system ignores the | 8385 | If set, the OpenEmbedded system ignores the |
7472 | :term:`TUNEABI_WHITELIST` variable. | 8386 | :term:`TUNEABI_WHITELIST` variable. |
@@ -7474,10 +8388,10 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7474 | ``TUNEABI_OVERRIDE``, ``TUNEABI_WHITELIST``, and | 8388 | ``TUNEABI_OVERRIDE``, ``TUNEABI_WHITELIST``, and |
7475 | :term:`TUNEABI` variables to check compatibility of a | 8389 | :term:`TUNEABI` variables to check compatibility of a |
7476 | tuning against their selection of libraries. | 8390 | tuning against their selection of libraries. |
7477 | 8391 | ||
7478 | See the :ref:`sanity <ref-classes-sanity>` class to see how the | 8392 | See the :ref:`sanity <ref-classes-sanity>` class to see how the |
7479 | variable is used. | 8393 | variable is used. |
7480 | 8394 | ||
7481 | TUNEABI_WHITELIST | 8395 | TUNEABI_WHITELIST |
7482 | A whitelist of permissible :term:`TUNEABI` values. If | 8396 | A whitelist of permissible :term:`TUNEABI` values. If |
7483 | ``TUNEABI_WHITELIST`` is not set, all tunes are allowed. Providers | 8397 | ``TUNEABI_WHITELIST`` is not set, all tunes are allowed. Providers |
@@ -7485,100 +8399,112 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7485 | :term:`TUNEABI_OVERRIDE`, and ``TUNEABI`` | 8399 | :term:`TUNEABI_OVERRIDE`, and ``TUNEABI`` |
7486 | variables to check compatibility of a tuning against their selection | 8400 | variables to check compatibility of a tuning against their selection |
7487 | of libraries. | 8401 | of libraries. |
7488 | 8402 | ||
7489 | See the :ref:`sanity <ref-classes-sanity>` class to see how the | 8403 | See the :ref:`sanity <ref-classes-sanity>` class to see how the |
7490 | variable is used. | 8404 | variable is used. |
7491 | 8405 | ||
7492 | TUNECONFLICTS[feature] | 8406 | TUNECONFLICTS[feature] |
7493 | Specifies CPU or Application Binary Interface (ABI) tuning features | 8407 | Specifies CPU or Application Binary Interface (ABI) tuning features |
7494 | that conflict with feature. | 8408 | that conflict with feature. |
7495 | 8409 | ||
7496 | Known tuning conflicts are specified in the machine include files in | 8410 | Known tuning conflicts are specified in the machine include files in |
7497 | the :term:`Source Directory`. Here is an example from | 8411 | the :term:`Source Directory`. Here is an example from |
7498 | the ``meta/conf/machine/include/mips/arch-mips.inc`` include file | 8412 | the ``meta/conf/machine/include/mips/arch-mips.inc`` include file |
7499 | that lists the "o32" and "n64" features as conflicting with the "n32" | 8413 | that lists the "o32" and "n64" features as conflicting with the "n32" |
7500 | feature: TUNECONFLICTS[n32] = "o32 n64" | 8414 | feature: |
7501 | 8415 | :: | |
8416 | |||
8417 | TUNECONFLICTS[n32] = "o32 n64" | ||
8418 | |||
7502 | TUNEVALID[feature] | 8419 | TUNEVALID[feature] |
7503 | Specifies a valid CPU or Application Binary Interface (ABI) tuning | 8420 | Specifies a valid CPU or Application Binary Interface (ABI) tuning |
7504 | feature. The specified feature is stored as a flag. Valid features | 8421 | feature. The specified feature is stored as a flag. Valid features |
7505 | are specified in the machine include files (e.g. | 8422 | are specified in the machine include files (e.g. |
7506 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/arm/arch-arm.inc``). Here is an example | 8423 | ``meta/conf/machine/include/arm/arch-arm.inc``). Here is an example |
7507 | from that file: TUNEVALID[bigendian] = "Enable big-endian mode." | 8424 | from that file: |
7508 | 8425 | :: | |
8426 | |||
8427 | TUNEVALID[bigendian] = "Enable big-endian mode." | ||
8428 | |||
7509 | See the machine include files in the :term:`Source Directory` | 8429 | See the machine include files in the :term:`Source Directory` |
7510 | for these features. | 8430 | for these features. |
7511 | 8431 | ||
7512 | UBOOT_CONFIG | 8432 | UBOOT_CONFIG |
7513 | Configures the :term:`UBOOT_MACHINE` and can | 8433 | Configures the :term:`UBOOT_MACHINE` and can |
7514 | also define :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` for individual | 8434 | also define :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` for individual |
7515 | cases. | 8435 | cases. |
7516 | 8436 | ||
7517 | Following is an example from the ``meta-fsl-arm`` layer. UBOOT_CONFIG | 8437 | Following is an example from the ``meta-fsl-arm`` layer. :: |
7518 | ??= "sd" UBOOT_CONFIG[sd] = "mx6qsabreauto_config,sdcard" | 8438 | |
7519 | UBOOT_CONFIG[eimnor] = "mx6qsabreauto_eimnor_config" | 8439 | UBOOT_CONFIG ??= "sd" |
7520 | UBOOT_CONFIG[nand] = "mx6qsabreauto_nand_config,ubifs" | 8440 | UBOOT_CONFIG[sd] = "mx6qsabreauto_config,sdcard" |
7521 | UBOOT_CONFIG[spinor] = "mx6qsabreauto_spinor_config" In this example, | 8441 | UBOOT_CONFIG[eimnor] = "mx6qsabreauto_eimnor_config" |
7522 | "sd" is selected as the configuration of the possible four for the | 8442 | UBOOT_CONFIG[nand] = "mx6qsabreauto_nand_config,ubifs" |
8443 | UBOOT_CONFIG[spinor] = "mx6qsabreauto_spinor_config" | ||
8444 | |||
8445 | In this example, "sd" is selected as the configuration of the possible four for the | ||
7523 | ``UBOOT_MACHINE``. The "sd" configuration defines | 8446 | ``UBOOT_MACHINE``. The "sd" configuration defines |
7524 | "mx6qsabreauto_config" as the value for ``UBOOT_MACHINE``, while the | 8447 | "mx6qsabreauto_config" as the value for ``UBOOT_MACHINE``, while the |
7525 | "sdcard" specifies the ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` to use for the U-boot image. | 8448 | "sdcard" specifies the ``IMAGE_FSTYPES`` to use for the U-boot image. |
7526 | 8449 | ||
7527 | For more information on how the ``UBOOT_CONFIG`` is handled, see the | 8450 | For more information on how the ``UBOOT_CONFIG`` is handled, see the |
7528 | ```uboot-config`http://git.yoctoproject.org/cgit/cgit.cgi/poky/tree/meta/classes/uboot-config.bbclass | 8451 | :ref:`uboot-config <ref-classes-uboot-config>` |
7529 | class. | 8452 | class. |
7530 | 8453 | ||
7531 | UBOOT_DTB_LOADADDRESS | 8454 | UBOOT_DTB_LOADADDRESS |
7532 | Specifies the load address for the dtb image used by U-boot. During FIT | 8455 | Specifies the load address for the dtb image used by U-boot. During FIT |
7533 | image creation, the ``UBOOT_DTB_LOADADDRESS`` variable is used in | 8456 | image creation, the ``UBOOT_DTB_LOADADDRESS`` variable is used in |
7534 | ``kernel-fitimage`` class to specify the load address to be used in | 8457 | :ref:`kernel-fitimage <ref-classes-kernel-fitimage>` class to specify |
8458 | the load address to be used in | ||
7535 | creating the dtb sections of Image Tree Source for the FIT image. | 8459 | creating the dtb sections of Image Tree Source for the FIT image. |
7536 | 8460 | ||
7537 | UBOOT_DTBO_LOADADDRESS | 8461 | UBOOT_DTBO_LOADADDRESS |
7538 | Specifies the load address for the dtbo image used by U-boot. During FIT | 8462 | Specifies the load address for the dtbo image used by U-boot. During FIT |
7539 | image creation, the ``UBOOT_DTBO_LOADADDRESS`` variable is used in | 8463 | image creation, the ``UBOOT_DTBO_LOADADDRESS`` variable is used in |
7540 | ``kernel-fitimage`` class to specify the load address to be used in | 8464 | :ref:`kernel-fitimage <ref-classes-kernel-fitimage>` class to specify the load address to be used in |
7541 | creating the dtbo sections of Image Tree Source for the FIT image. | 8465 | creating the dtbo sections of Image Tree Source for the FIT image. |
7542 | 8466 | ||
7543 | UBOOT_ENTRYPOINT | 8467 | UBOOT_ENTRYPOINT |
7544 | Specifies the entry point for the U-Boot image. During U-Boot image | 8468 | Specifies the entry point for the U-Boot image. During U-Boot image |
7545 | creation, the ``UBOOT_ENTRYPOINT`` variable is passed as a | 8469 | creation, the ``UBOOT_ENTRYPOINT`` variable is passed as a |
7546 | command-line parameter to the ``uboot-mkimage`` utility. | 8470 | command-line parameter to the ``uboot-mkimage`` utility. |
7547 | 8471 | ||
7548 | UBOOT_LOADADDRESS | 8472 | UBOOT_LOADADDRESS |
7549 | Specifies the load address for the U-Boot image. During U-Boot image | 8473 | Specifies the load address for the U-Boot image. During U-Boot image |
7550 | creation, the ``UBOOT_LOADADDRESS`` variable is passed as a | 8474 | creation, the ``UBOOT_LOADADDRESS`` variable is passed as a |
7551 | command-line parameter to the ``uboot-mkimage`` utility. | 8475 | command-line parameter to the ``uboot-mkimage`` utility. |
7552 | 8476 | ||
7553 | UBOOT_LOCALVERSION | 8477 | UBOOT_LOCALVERSION |
7554 | Appends a string to the name of the local version of the U-Boot | 8478 | Appends a string to the name of the local version of the U-Boot |
7555 | image. For example, assuming the version of the U-Boot image built | 8479 | image. For example, assuming the version of the U-Boot image built |
7556 | was "2013.10", the full version string reported by U-Boot would be | 8480 | was "2013.10", the full version string reported by U-Boot would be |
7557 | "2013.10-yocto" given the following statement: UBOOT_LOCALVERSION = | 8481 | "2013.10-yocto" given the following statement: |
7558 | "-yocto" | 8482 | :: |
7559 | 8483 | ||
8484 | UBOOT_LOCALVERSION = "-yocto" | ||
8485 | |||
7560 | UBOOT_MACHINE | 8486 | UBOOT_MACHINE |
7561 | Specifies the value passed on the ``make`` command line when building | 8487 | Specifies the value passed on the ``make`` command line when building |
7562 | a U-Boot image. The value indicates the target platform | 8488 | a U-Boot image. The value indicates the target platform |
7563 | configuration. You typically set this variable from the machine | 8489 | configuration. You typically set this variable from the machine |
7564 | configuration file (i.e. ``conf/machine/machine_name.conf``). | 8490 | configuration file (i.e. ``conf/machine/machine_name.conf``). |
7565 | 8491 | ||
7566 | Please see the "Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type" | 8492 | Please see the "Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type" |
7567 | section in the U-Boot README for valid values for this variable. | 8493 | section in the U-Boot README for valid values for this variable. |
7568 | 8494 | ||
7569 | UBOOT_MAKE_TARGET | 8495 | UBOOT_MAKE_TARGET |
7570 | Specifies the target called in the ``Makefile``. The default target | 8496 | Specifies the target called in the ``Makefile``. The default target |
7571 | is "all". | 8497 | is "all". |
7572 | 8498 | ||
7573 | UBOOT_MKIMAGE_DTCOPTS | 8499 | UBOOT_MKIMAGE_DTCOPTS |
7574 | Options for the device tree compiler passed to mkimage '-D' | 8500 | Options for the device tree compiler passed to mkimage '-D' |
7575 | feature while creating FIT image in ``kernel-fitimage`` class. | 8501 | feature while creating FIT image in :ref:`kernel-fitimage <ref-classes-kernel-fitimage>` class. |
7576 | 8502 | ||
7577 | UBOOT_RD_LOADADDRESS | 8503 | UBOOT_RD_LOADADDRESS |
7578 | Specifies the load address for the RAM disk image. | 8504 | Specifies the load address for the RAM disk image. |
7579 | During FIT image creation, the | 8505 | During FIT image creation, the |
7580 | ``UBOOT_RD_LOADADDRESS`` variable is used | 8506 | ``UBOOT_RD_LOADADDRESS`` variable is used |
7581 | in ``kernel-fitimage`` class to specify the | 8507 | in :ref:`kernel-fitimage <ref-classes-kernel-fitimage>` class to specify the |
7582 | load address to be used in creating the Image Tree Source for | 8508 | load address to be used in creating the Image Tree Source for |
7583 | the FIT image. | 8509 | the FIT image. |
7584 | 8510 | ||
@@ -7586,10 +8512,10 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7586 | Specifies the entrypoint for the RAM disk image. | 8512 | Specifies the entrypoint for the RAM disk image. |
7587 | During FIT image creation, the | 8513 | During FIT image creation, the |
7588 | ``UBOOT_RD_ENTRYPOINT`` variable is used | 8514 | ``UBOOT_RD_ENTRYPOINT`` variable is used |
7589 | in ``kernel-fitimage`` class to specify the | 8515 | in :ref:`kernel-fitimage <ref-classes-kernel-fitimage>` class to specify the |
7590 | entrypoint to be used in creating the Image Tree Source for | 8516 | entrypoint to be used in creating the Image Tree Source for |
7591 | the FIT image. | 8517 | the FIT image. |
7592 | 8518 | ||
7593 | UBOOT_SIGN_ENABLE | 8519 | UBOOT_SIGN_ENABLE |
7594 | Enable signing of FIT image. The default value is "0". | 8520 | Enable signing of FIT image. The default value is "0". |
7595 | 8521 | ||
@@ -7628,40 +8554,44 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7628 | configure scripts. It follows that no benefit exists in seeing a | 8554 | configure scripts. It follows that no benefit exists in seeing a |
7629 | warning about these options. For these cases, the options are added | 8555 | warning about these options. For these cases, the options are added |
7630 | to ``UNKNOWN_CONFIGURE_WHITELIST``. | 8556 | to ``UNKNOWN_CONFIGURE_WHITELIST``. |
7631 | 8557 | ||
7632 | The configure arguments check that uses | 8558 | The configure arguments check that uses |
7633 | ``UNKNOWN_CONFIGURE_WHITELIST`` is part of the | 8559 | ``UNKNOWN_CONFIGURE_WHITELIST`` is part of the |
7634 | :ref:`insane <ref-classes-insane>` class and is only enabled if the | 8560 | :ref:`insane <ref-classes-insane>` class and is only enabled if the |
7635 | recipe inherits the :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` class. | 8561 | recipe inherits the :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` class. |
7636 | 8562 | ||
7637 | UPDATERCPN | 8563 | UPDATERCPN |
7638 | For recipes inheriting the | 8564 | For recipes inheriting the |
7639 | :ref:`update-rc.d <ref-classes-update-rc.d>` class, ``UPDATERCPN`` | 8565 | :ref:`update-rc.d <ref-classes-update-rc.d>` class, ``UPDATERCPN`` |
7640 | specifies the package that contains the initscript that is enabled. | 8566 | specifies the package that contains the initscript that is enabled. |
7641 | 8567 | ||
7642 | The default value is "${PN}". Given that almost all recipes that | 8568 | The default value is "${PN}". Given that almost all recipes that |
7643 | install initscripts package them in the main package for the recipe, | 8569 | install initscripts package them in the main package for the recipe, |
7644 | you rarely need to set this variable in individual recipes. | 8570 | you rarely need to set this variable in individual recipes. |
7645 | 8571 | ||
7646 | UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX | 8572 | UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX |
7647 | You can perform a per-recipe check for what the latest upstream | 8573 | You can perform a per-recipe check for what the latest upstream |
7648 | source code version is by calling ``bitbake -c checkpkg`` recipe. If | 8574 | source code version is by calling ``bitbake -c checkpkg`` recipe. If |
7649 | the recipe source code is provided from Git repositories, the | 8575 | the recipe source code is provided from Git repositories, the |
7650 | OpenEmbedded build system determines the latest upstream version by | 8576 | OpenEmbedded build system determines the latest upstream version by |
7651 | picking the latest tag from the list of all repository tags. | 8577 | picking the latest tag from the list of all repository tags. |
7652 | 8578 | ||
7653 | You can use the ``UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX`` variable to provide a | 8579 | You can use the ``UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX`` variable to provide a |
7654 | regular expression to filter only the relevant tags should the | 8580 | regular expression to filter only the relevant tags should the |
7655 | default filter not work correctly. UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX = | 8581 | default filter not work correctly. |
7656 | "git_tag_regex" | 8582 | :: |
7657 | 8583 | ||
8584 | UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX = "git_tag_regex" | ||
8585 | |||
7658 | UPSTREAM_CHECK_REGEX | 8586 | UPSTREAM_CHECK_REGEX |
7659 | Use the ``UPSTREAM_CHECK_REGEX`` variable to specify a different | 8587 | Use the ``UPSTREAM_CHECK_REGEX`` variable to specify a different |
7660 | regular expression instead of the default one when the package | 8588 | regular expression instead of the default one when the package |
7661 | checking system is parsing the page found using | 8589 | checking system is parsing the page found using |
7662 | :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI`. | 8590 | :term:`UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI`. |
7663 | UPSTREAM_CHECK_REGEX = "package_regex" | 8591 | :: |
7664 | 8592 | ||
8593 | UPSTREAM_CHECK_REGEX = "package_regex" | ||
8594 | |||
7665 | UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI | 8595 | UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI |
7666 | You can perform a per-recipe check for what the latest upstream | 8596 | You can perform a per-recipe check for what the latest upstream |
7667 | source code version is by calling ``bitbake -c checkpkg`` recipe. If | 8597 | source code version is by calling ``bitbake -c checkpkg`` recipe. If |
@@ -7669,43 +8599,48 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7669 | determined by fetching the directory listing where the tarball is and | 8599 | determined by fetching the directory listing where the tarball is and |
7670 | attempting to find a later tarball. When this approach does not work, | 8600 | attempting to find a later tarball. When this approach does not work, |
7671 | you can use ``UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI`` to provide a different URI that | 8601 | you can use ``UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI`` to provide a different URI that |
7672 | contains the link to the latest tarball. UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI = | 8602 | contains the link to the latest tarball. |
7673 | "recipe_url" | 8603 | :: |
7674 | 8604 | ||
8605 | UPSTREAM_CHECK_URI = "recipe_url" | ||
8606 | |||
7675 | USE_DEVFS | 8607 | USE_DEVFS |
7676 | Determines if ``devtmpfs`` is used for ``/dev`` population. The | 8608 | Determines if ``devtmpfs`` is used for ``/dev`` population. The |
7677 | default value used for ``USE_DEVFS`` is "1" when no value is | 8609 | default value used for ``USE_DEVFS`` is "1" when no value is |
7678 | specifically set. Typically, you would set ``USE_DEVFS`` to "0" for a | 8610 | specifically set. Typically, you would set ``USE_DEVFS`` to "0" for a |
7679 | statically populated ``/dev`` directory. | 8611 | statically populated ``/dev`` directory. |
7680 | 8612 | ||
7681 | See the "`Selecting a Device | 8613 | See the ":ref:`selecting-dev-manager`" section in |
7682 | Manager <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#selecting-dev-manager>`__" section in | ||
7683 | the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for information on how to | 8614 | the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual for information on how to |
7684 | use this variable. | 8615 | use this variable. |
7685 | 8616 | ||
7686 | USE_VT | 8617 | USE_VT |
7687 | When using | 8618 | When using |
7688 | `SysVinit <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#new-recipe-enabling-system-services>`__, | 8619 | :ref:`SysVinit <new-recipe-enabling-system-services>`, |
7689 | determines whether or not to run a | 8620 | determines whether or not to run a |
7690 | `getty <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Getty_%28Unix%29>`__ on any | 8621 | `getty <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Getty_%28Unix%29>`__ on any |
7691 | virtual terminals in order to enable logging in through those | 8622 | virtual terminals in order to enable logging in through those |
7692 | terminals. | 8623 | terminals. |
7693 | 8624 | ||
7694 | The default value used for ``USE_VT`` is "1" when no default value is | 8625 | The default value used for ``USE_VT`` is "1" when no default value is |
7695 | specifically set. Typically, you would set ``USE_VT`` to "0" in the | 8626 | specifically set. Typically, you would set ``USE_VT`` to "0" in the |
7696 | machine configuration file for machines that do not have a graphical | 8627 | machine configuration file for machines that do not have a graphical |
7697 | display attached and therefore do not need virtual terminal | 8628 | display attached and therefore do not need virtual terminal |
7698 | functionality. | 8629 | functionality. |
7699 | 8630 | ||
7700 | USER_CLASSES | 8631 | USER_CLASSES |
7701 | A list of classes to globally inherit. These classes are used by the | 8632 | A list of classes to globally inherit. These classes are used by the |
7702 | OpenEmbedded build system to enable extra features (e.g. | 8633 | OpenEmbedded build system to enable extra features (e.g. |
7703 | ``buildstats``, ``image-mklibs``, and so forth). | 8634 | ``buildstats``, ``image-mklibs``, and so forth). |
7704 | 8635 | ||
7705 | The default list is set in your ``local.conf`` file: USER_CLASSES ?= | 8636 | The default list is set in your ``local.conf`` file: |
7706 | "buildstats image-mklibs image-prelink" For more information, see | 8637 | :: |
8638 | |||
8639 | USER_CLASSES ?= "buildstats image-mklibs image-prelink" | ||
8640 | |||
8641 | For more information, see | ||
7707 | ``meta-poky/conf/local.conf.sample`` in the :term:`Source Directory`. | 8642 | ``meta-poky/conf/local.conf.sample`` in the :term:`Source Directory`. |
7708 | 8643 | ||
7709 | USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC | 8644 | USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC |
7710 | If set to ``error``, forces the OpenEmbedded build system to produce | 8645 | If set to ``error``, forces the OpenEmbedded build system to produce |
7711 | an error if the user identification (``uid``) and group | 8646 | an error if the user identification (``uid``) and group |
@@ -7713,21 +8648,26 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7713 | listed in :term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES` and | 8648 | listed in :term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES` and |
7714 | :term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES`. If set to | 8649 | :term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES`. If set to |
7715 | ``warn``, a warning will be issued instead. | 8650 | ``warn``, a warning will be issued instead. |
7716 | 8651 | ||
7717 | The default behavior for the build system is to dynamically apply | 8652 | The default behavior for the build system is to dynamically apply |
7718 | ``uid`` and ``gid`` values. Consequently, the | 8653 | ``uid`` and ``gid`` values. Consequently, the |
7719 | ``USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC`` variable is by default not set. If you plan | 8654 | ``USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC`` variable is by default not set. If you plan |
7720 | on using statically assigned ``gid`` and ``uid`` values, you should | 8655 | on using statically assigned ``gid`` and ``uid`` values, you should |
7721 | set the ``USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC`` variable in your ``local.conf`` | 8656 | set the ``USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC`` variable in your ``local.conf`` |
7722 | file as follows: USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC = "error" Overriding the | 8657 | file as follows: |
8658 | :: | ||
8659 | |||
8660 | USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC = "error" | ||
8661 | |||
8662 | Overriding the | ||
7723 | default behavior implies you are going to also take steps to set | 8663 | default behavior implies you are going to also take steps to set |
7724 | static ``uid`` and ``gid`` values through use of the | 8664 | static ``uid`` and ``gid`` values through use of the |
7725 | :term:`USERADDEXTENSION`, | 8665 | :term:`USERADDEXTENSION`, |
7726 | :term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES`, and | 8666 | :term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES`, and |
7727 | :term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES` variables. | 8667 | :term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES` variables. |
7728 | 8668 | ||
7729 | .. note:: | 8669 | .. note:: |
7730 | 8670 | ||
7731 | There is a difference in behavior between setting | 8671 | There is a difference in behavior between setting |
7732 | USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC | 8672 | USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC |
7733 | to | 8673 | to |
@@ -7745,38 +8685,44 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7745 | , it will only report errors for recipes that are actually built. | 8685 | , it will only report errors for recipes that are actually built. |
7746 | This saves you from having to add static IDs for recipes that you | 8686 | This saves you from having to add static IDs for recipes that you |
7747 | know will never be built. | 8687 | know will never be built. |
7748 | 8688 | ||
7749 | USERADD_GID_TABLES | 8689 | USERADD_GID_TABLES |
7750 | Specifies a password file to use for obtaining static group | 8690 | Specifies a password file to use for obtaining static group |
7751 | identification (``gid``) values when the OpenEmbedded build system | 8691 | identification (``gid``) values when the OpenEmbedded build system |
7752 | adds a group to the system during package installation. | 8692 | adds a group to the system during package installation. |
7753 | 8693 | ||
7754 | When applying static group identification (``gid``) values, the | 8694 | When applying static group identification (``gid``) values, the |
7755 | OpenEmbedded build system looks in :term:`BBPATH` for a | 8695 | OpenEmbedded build system looks in :term:`BBPATH` for a |
7756 | ``files/group`` file and then applies those ``uid`` values. Set the | 8696 | ``files/group`` file and then applies those ``uid`` values. Set the |
7757 | variable as follows in your ``local.conf`` file: USERADD_GID_TABLES = | 8697 | variable as follows in your ``local.conf`` file: |
7758 | "files/group" | 8698 | :: |
7759 | 8699 | ||
8700 | |||
8701 | USERADD_GID_TABLES = "files/group" | ||
8702 | |||
7760 | .. note:: | 8703 | .. note:: |
7761 | 8704 | ||
7762 | Setting the | 8705 | Setting the |
7763 | USERADDEXTENSION | 8706 | USERADDEXTENSION |
7764 | variable to "useradd-staticids" causes the build system to use | 8707 | variable to "useradd-staticids" causes the build system to use |
7765 | static | 8708 | static |
7766 | gid | 8709 | gid |
7767 | values. | 8710 | values. |
7768 | 8711 | ||
7769 | USERADD_PACKAGES | 8712 | USERADD_PACKAGES |
7770 | When inheriting the :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class, | 8713 | When inheriting the :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class, |
7771 | this variable specifies the individual packages within the recipe | 8714 | this variable specifies the individual packages within the recipe |
7772 | that require users and/or groups to be added. | 8715 | that require users and/or groups to be added. |
7773 | 8716 | ||
7774 | You must set this variable if the recipe inherits the class. For | 8717 | You must set this variable if the recipe inherits the class. For |
7775 | example, the following enables adding a user for the main package in | 8718 | example, the following enables adding a user for the main package in |
7776 | a recipe: USERADD_PACKAGES = "${PN}" | 8719 | a recipe: |
7777 | 8720 | :: | |
8721 | |||
8722 | USERADD_PACKAGES = "${PN}" | ||
8723 | |||
7778 | .. note:: | 8724 | .. note:: |
7779 | 8725 | ||
7780 | It follows that if you are going to use the | 8726 | It follows that if you are going to use the |
7781 | USERADD_PACKAGES | 8727 | USERADD_PACKAGES |
7782 | variable, you need to set one or more of the | 8728 | variable, you need to set one or more of the |
@@ -7786,50 +8732,57 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7786 | , or | 8732 | , or |
7787 | GROUPMEMS_PARAM | 8733 | GROUPMEMS_PARAM |
7788 | variables. | 8734 | variables. |
7789 | 8735 | ||
7790 | USERADD_PARAM | 8736 | USERADD_PARAM |
7791 | When inheriting the :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class, | 8737 | When inheriting the :ref:`useradd <ref-classes-useradd>` class, |
7792 | this variable specifies for a package what parameters should pass to | 8738 | this variable specifies for a package what parameters should pass to |
7793 | the ``useradd`` command if you add a user to the system when the | 8739 | the ``useradd`` command if you add a user to the system when the |
7794 | package is installed. | 8740 | package is installed. |
7795 | 8741 | ||
7796 | Here is an example from the ``dbus`` recipe: USERADD_PARAM_${PN} = | 8742 | Here is an example from the ``dbus`` recipe: |
7797 | "--system --home ${localstatedir}/lib/dbus \\ --no-create-home | 8743 | :: |
7798 | --shell /bin/false \\ --user-group messagebus" For information on the | 8744 | |
8745 | USERADD_PARAM_${PN} = "--system --home ${localstatedir}/lib/dbus \ | ||
8746 | --no-create-home --shell /bin/false \ | ||
8747 | --user-group messagebus" | ||
8748 | |||
8749 | For information on the | ||
7799 | standard Linux shell command ``useradd``, see | 8750 | standard Linux shell command ``useradd``, see |
7800 | http://linux.die.net/man/8/useradd. | 8751 | http://linux.die.net/man/8/useradd. |
7801 | 8752 | ||
7802 | USERADD_UID_TABLES | 8753 | USERADD_UID_TABLES |
7803 | Specifies a password file to use for obtaining static user | 8754 | Specifies a password file to use for obtaining static user |
7804 | identification (``uid``) values when the OpenEmbedded build system | 8755 | identification (``uid``) values when the OpenEmbedded build system |
7805 | adds a user to the system during package installation. | 8756 | adds a user to the system during package installation. |
7806 | 8757 | ||
7807 | When applying static user identification (``uid``) values, the | 8758 | When applying static user identification (``uid``) values, the |
7808 | OpenEmbedded build system looks in :term:`BBPATH` for a | 8759 | OpenEmbedded build system looks in :term:`BBPATH` for a |
7809 | ``files/passwd`` file and then applies those ``uid`` values. Set the | 8760 | ``files/passwd`` file and then applies those ``uid`` values. Set the |
7810 | variable as follows in your ``local.conf`` file: USERADD_UID_TABLES = | 8761 | variable as follows in your ``local.conf`` file: |
7811 | "files/passwd" | 8762 | :: |
7812 | 8763 | ||
8764 | USERADD_UID_TABLES = "files/passwd" | ||
8765 | |||
7813 | .. note:: | 8766 | .. note:: |
7814 | 8767 | ||
7815 | Setting the | 8768 | Setting the |
7816 | USERADDEXTENSION | 8769 | USERADDEXTENSION |
7817 | variable to "useradd-staticids" causes the build system to use | 8770 | variable to "useradd-staticids" causes the build system to use |
7818 | static | 8771 | static |
7819 | uid | 8772 | uid |
7820 | values. | 8773 | values. |
7821 | 8774 | ||
7822 | USERADDEXTENSION | 8775 | USERADDEXTENSION |
7823 | When set to "useradd-staticids", causes the OpenEmbedded build system | 8776 | When set to "useradd-staticids", causes the OpenEmbedded build system |
7824 | to base all user and group additions on a static ``passwd`` and | 8777 | to base all user and group additions on a static ``passwd`` and |
7825 | ``group`` files found in :term:`BBPATH`. | 8778 | ``group`` files found in :term:`BBPATH`. |
7826 | 8779 | ||
7827 | To use static user identification (``uid``) and group identification | 8780 | To use static user identification (``uid``) and group identification |
7828 | (``gid``) values, set the variable as follows in your ``local.conf`` | 8781 | (``gid``) values, set the variable as follows in your ``local.conf`` |
7829 | file: USERADDEXTENSION = "useradd-staticids" | 8782 | file: USERADDEXTENSION = "useradd-staticids" |
7830 | 8783 | ||
7831 | .. note:: | 8784 | .. note:: |
7832 | 8785 | ||
7833 | Setting this variable to use static | 8786 | Setting this variable to use static |
7834 | uid | 8787 | uid |
7835 | and | 8788 | and |
@@ -7837,29 +8790,29 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7837 | values causes the OpenEmbedded build system to employ the | 8790 | values causes the OpenEmbedded build system to employ the |
7838 | useradd-staticids | 8791 | useradd-staticids |
7839 | class. | 8792 | class. |
7840 | 8793 | ||
7841 | If you use static ``uid`` and ``gid`` information, you must also | 8794 | If you use static ``uid`` and ``gid`` information, you must also |
7842 | specify the ``files/passwd`` and ``files/group`` files by setting the | 8795 | specify the ``files/passwd`` and ``files/group`` files by setting the |
7843 | :term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES` and | 8796 | :term:`USERADD_UID_TABLES` and |
7844 | :term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES` variables. | 8797 | :term:`USERADD_GID_TABLES` variables. |
7845 | Additionally, you should also set the | 8798 | Additionally, you should also set the |
7846 | :term:`USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC` variable. | 8799 | :term:`USERADD_ERROR_DYNAMIC` variable. |
7847 | 8800 | ||
7848 | VOLATILE_LOG_DIR | 8801 | VOLATILE_LOG_DIR |
7849 | Specifies the persistence of the target's ``/var/log`` directory, | 8802 | Specifies the persistence of the target's ``/var/log`` directory, |
7850 | which is used to house postinstall target log files. | 8803 | which is used to house postinstall target log files. |
7851 | 8804 | ||
7852 | By default, ``VOLATILE_LOG_DIR`` is set to "yes", which means the | 8805 | By default, ``VOLATILE_LOG_DIR`` is set to "yes", which means the |
7853 | file is not persistent. You can override this setting by setting the | 8806 | file is not persistent. You can override this setting by setting the |
7854 | variable to "no" to make the log directory persistent. | 8807 | variable to "no" to make the log directory persistent. |
7855 | 8808 | ||
7856 | WARN_QA | 8809 | WARN_QA |
7857 | Specifies the quality assurance checks whose failures are reported as | 8810 | Specifies the quality assurance checks whose failures are reported as |
7858 | warnings by the OpenEmbedded build system. You set this variable in | 8811 | warnings by the OpenEmbedded build system. You set this variable in |
7859 | your distribution configuration file. For a list of the checks you | 8812 | your distribution configuration file. For a list of the checks you |
7860 | can control with this variable, see the | 8813 | can control with this variable, see the |
7861 | ":ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`" section. | 8814 | ":ref:`insane.bbclass <ref-classes-insane>`" section. |
7862 | 8815 | ||
7863 | WKS_FILE_DEPENDS | 8816 | WKS_FILE_DEPENDS |
7864 | When placed in the recipe that builds your image, this variable lists | 8817 | When placed in the recipe that builds your image, this variable lists |
7865 | build-time dependencies. The ``WKS_FILE_DEPENDS`` variable is only | 8818 | build-time dependencies. The ``WKS_FILE_DEPENDS`` variable is only |
@@ -7867,39 +8820,46 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7867 | :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` contains entries related | 8820 | :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` contains entries related |
7868 | to Wic). If your recipe does not create Wic images, the variable has | 8821 | to Wic). If your recipe does not create Wic images, the variable has |
7869 | no effect. | 8822 | no effect. |
7870 | 8823 | ||
7871 | The ``WKS_FILE_DEPENDS`` variable is similar to the | 8824 | The ``WKS_FILE_DEPENDS`` variable is similar to the |
7872 | :term:`DEPENDS` variable. When you use the variable in | 8825 | :term:`DEPENDS` variable. When you use the variable in |
7873 | your recipe that builds the Wic image, dependencies you list in the | 8826 | your recipe that builds the Wic image, dependencies you list in the |
7874 | ``WIC_FILE_DEPENDS`` variable are added to the ``DEPENDS`` variable. | 8827 | ``WIC_FILE_DEPENDS`` variable are added to the ``DEPENDS`` variable. |
7875 | 8828 | ||
7876 | With the ``WKS_FILE_DEPENDS`` variable, you have the possibility to | 8829 | With the ``WKS_FILE_DEPENDS`` variable, you have the possibility to |
7877 | specify a list of additional dependencies (e.g. native tools, | 8830 | specify a list of additional dependencies (e.g. native tools, |
7878 | bootloaders, and so forth), that are required to build Wic images. | 8831 | bootloaders, and so forth), that are required to build Wic images. |
7879 | Following is an example: WKS_FILE_DEPENDS = "some-native-tool" In the | 8832 | Following is an example: |
8833 | :: | ||
8834 | |||
8835 | WKS_FILE_DEPENDS = "some-native-tool" | ||
8836 | |||
8837 | In the | ||
7880 | previous example, some-native-tool would be replaced with an actual | 8838 | previous example, some-native-tool would be replaced with an actual |
7881 | native tool on which the build would depend. | 8839 | native tool on which the build would depend. |
7882 | 8840 | ||
7883 | WKS_FILE | 8841 | WKS_FILE |
7884 | Specifies the location of the Wic kickstart file that is used by the | 8842 | Specifies the location of the Wic kickstart file that is used by the |
7885 | OpenEmbedded build system to create a partitioned image | 8843 | OpenEmbedded build system to create a partitioned image |
7886 | (image\ ``.wic``). For information on how to create a partitioned | 8844 | (image\ ``.wic``). For information on how to create a partitioned |
7887 | image, see the "`Creating Partitioned Images Using | 8845 | image, see the |
7888 | Wic <&YOCTO_DOCS_DEV_URL;#creating-partitioned-images-using-wic>`__" | 8846 | ":ref:`dev-manual/dev-manual-common-tasks:creating partitioned images using wic`" |
7889 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. For details on | 8847 | section in the Yocto Project Development Tasks Manual. For details on |
7890 | the kickstart file format, see the "`OpenEmbedded Kickstart | 8848 | the kickstart file format, see the ":doc:`../ref-manual/ref-kickstart`" Chapter. |
7891 | (``.wks``) Reference <#ref-kickstart>`__" Chapter. | 8849 | |
7892 | |||
7893 | WORKDIR | 8850 | WORKDIR |
7894 | The pathname of the work directory in which the OpenEmbedded build | 8851 | The pathname of the work directory in which the OpenEmbedded build |
7895 | system builds a recipe. This directory is located within the | 8852 | system builds a recipe. This directory is located within the |
7896 | :term:`TMPDIR` directory structure and is specific to | 8853 | :term:`TMPDIR` directory structure and is specific to |
7897 | the recipe being built and the system for which it is being built. | 8854 | the recipe being built and the system for which it is being built. |
7898 | 8855 | ||
7899 | The ``WORKDIR`` directory is defined as follows: | 8856 | The ``WORKDIR`` directory is defined as follows: |
7900 | ${TMPDIR}/work/${MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS}/${PN}/${EXTENDPE}${PV}-${PR} | 8857 | :: |
8858 | |||
8859 | ${TMPDIR}/work/${MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS}/${PN}/${EXTENDPE}${PV}-${PR} | ||
8860 | |||
7901 | The actual directory depends on several things: | 8861 | The actual directory depends on several things: |
7902 | 8862 | ||
7903 | - TMPDIR | 8863 | - TMPDIR |
7904 | : The top-level build output directory | 8864 | : The top-level build output directory |
7905 | - MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS | 8865 | - MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS |
@@ -7916,21 +8876,24 @@ system and gives an overview of their function and contents. | |||
7916 | : The recipe version | 8876 | : The recipe version |
7917 | - PR | 8877 | - PR |
7918 | : The recipe revision | 8878 | : The recipe revision |
7919 | 8879 | ||
7920 | As an example, assume a Source Directory top-level folder name | 8880 | As an example, assume a Source Directory top-level folder name |
7921 | ``poky``, a default Build Directory at ``poky/build``, and a | 8881 | ``poky``, a default Build Directory at ``poky/build``, and a |
7922 | ``qemux86-poky-linux`` machine target system. Furthermore, suppose | 8882 | ``qemux86-poky-linux`` machine target system. Furthermore, suppose |
7923 | your recipe is named ``foo_1.3.0-r0.bb``. In this case, the work | 8883 | your recipe is named ``foo_1.3.0-r0.bb``. In this case, the work |
7924 | directory the build system uses to build the package would be as | 8884 | directory the build system uses to build the package would be as |
7925 | follows: poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/foo/1.3.0-r0 | 8885 | follows: |
7926 | 8886 | :: | |
8887 | |||
8888 | poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/foo/1.3.0-r0 | ||
8889 | |||
7927 | XSERVER | 8890 | XSERVER |
7928 | Specifies the packages that should be installed to provide an X | 8891 | Specifies the packages that should be installed to provide an X |
7929 | server and drivers for the current machine, assuming your image | 8892 | server and drivers for the current machine, assuming your image |
7930 | directly includes ``packagegroup-core-x11-xserver`` or, perhaps | 8893 | directly includes ``packagegroup-core-x11-xserver`` or, perhaps |
7931 | indirectly, includes "x11-base" in | 8894 | indirectly, includes "x11-base" in |
7932 | :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`. | 8895 | :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`. |
7933 | 8896 | ||
7934 | The default value of ``XSERVER``, if not specified in the machine | 8897 | The default value of ``XSERVER``, if not specified in the machine |
7935 | configuration, is "xserver-xorg xf86-video-fbdev xf86-input-evdev". | 8898 | configuration, is "xserver-xorg xf86-video-fbdev xf86-input-evdev". |
7936 | 8899 | ||